summaryrefslogtreecommitdiff
path: root/.emacs.d/org-7.4/doc/org.texi
diff options
context:
space:
mode:
authorLuke Shumaker <LukeShu@sbcglobal.net>2011-04-13 23:20:15 -0400
committerLuke Shumaker <LukeShu@sbcglobal.net>2011-04-13 23:20:15 -0400
commitf7464fdd2e33e5dc6c159a4adc8f53902e6d4511 (patch)
treeb1d65db982af54cc2088de3228174c4ea710c2f4 /.emacs.d/org-7.4/doc/org.texi
Initial commit of Luke Shumaker's "dot-files".
Diffstat (limited to '.emacs.d/org-7.4/doc/org.texi')
-rw-r--r--.emacs.d/org-7.4/doc/org.texi14774
1 files changed, 14774 insertions, 0 deletions
diff --git a/.emacs.d/org-7.4/doc/org.texi b/.emacs.d/org-7.4/doc/org.texi
new file mode 100644
index 0000000..5a67678
--- /dev/null
+++ b/.emacs.d/org-7.4/doc/org.texi
@@ -0,0 +1,14774 @@
+
+\input texinfo
+@c %**start of header
+@setfilename ../../info/org
+@settitle The Org Manual
+
+@set VERSION 7.4
+@set DATE December 2010
+
+@c Use proper quote and backtick for code sections in PDF output
+@c Cf. Texinfo manual 14.2
+@set txicodequoteundirected
+@set txicodequotebacktick
+
+@c Version and Contact Info
+@set MAINTAINERSITE @uref{http://orgmode.org,maintainers webpage}
+@set AUTHOR Carsten Dominik
+@set MAINTAINER Carsten Dominik
+@set MAINTAINEREMAIL @email{carsten at orgmode dot org}
+@set MAINTAINERCONTACT @uref{mailto:carsten at orgmode dot org,contact the maintainer}
+@c %**end of header
+@finalout
+
+
+@c -----------------------------------------------------------------------------
+
+@c Macro definitions for commands and keys
+@c =======================================
+
+@c The behavior of the key/command macros will depend on the flag cmdnames
+@c When set, commands names are shown. When clear, they are not shown.
+
+@set cmdnames
+
+@c Below we define the following macros for Org key tables:
+
+@c orgkey{key} A key item
+@c orgcmd{key,cmd} Key with command name
+@c xorgcmd{key,cmmand} Key with command name as @itemx
+@c orgcmdnki{key,cmd} Like orgcmd, but do not index the key
+@c orgcmdtkc{text,key,cmd} Like orgcmd,special text instead of key
+@c orgcmdkkc{key1,key2,cmd} Two keys with one command name, use "or"
+@c orgcmdkxkc{key1,key2,cmd} Two keys with one command name, but
+@c different functions, so format as @itemx
+@c orgcmdkskc{key1,key2,cmd} Same as orgcmdkkc, but use "or short"
+@c xorgcmdkskc{key1,key2,cmd} Same as previous, but use @itemx
+@c orgcmdkkcc{key1,key2,cmd1,cmd2} Two keys and two commands
+
+@c a key but no command
+@c Inserts: @item key
+@macro orgkey{key}
+@kindex \key\
+@item @kbd{\key\}
+@end macro
+
+@macro xorgkey{key}
+@kindex \key\
+@itemx @kbd{\key\}
+@end macro
+
+@c one key with a command
+@c Inserts: @item KEY COMMAND
+@macro orgcmd{key,command}
+@ifset cmdnames
+@kindex \key\
+@findex \command\
+@iftex
+@item @kbd{\key\} @hskip 0pt plus 1filll @code{\command\}
+@end iftex
+@ifnottex
+@item @kbd{\key\} @tie{}@tie{}@tie{}@tie{}(@code{\command\})
+@end ifnottex
+@end ifset
+@ifclear cmdnames
+@kindex \key\
+@item @kbd{\key\}
+@end ifclear
+@end macro
+
+@c One key with one command, formatted using @itemx
+@c Inserts: @itemx KEY COMMAND
+@macro xorgcmd{key,command}
+@ifset cmdnames
+@kindex \key\
+@findex \command\
+@iftex
+@itemx @kbd{\key\} @hskip 0pt plus 1filll @code{\command\}
+@end iftex
+@ifnottex
+@itemx @kbd{\key\} @tie{}@tie{}@tie{}@tie{}(@code{\command\})
+@end ifnottex
+@end ifset
+@ifclear cmdnames
+@kindex \key\
+@itemx @kbd{\key\}
+@end ifclear
+@end macro
+
+@c one key with a command, bit do not index the key
+@c Inserts: @item KEY COMMAND
+@macro orgcmdnki{key,command}
+@ifset cmdnames
+@findex \command\
+@iftex
+@item @kbd{\key\} @hskip 0pt plus 1filll @code{\command\}
+@end iftex
+@ifnottex
+@item @kbd{\key\} @tie{}@tie{}@tie{}@tie{}(@code{\command\})
+@end ifnottex
+@end ifset
+@ifclear cmdnames
+@item @kbd{\key\}
+@end ifclear
+@end macro
+
+@c one key with a command, and special text to replace key in item
+@c Inserts: @item TEXT COMMAND
+@macro orgcmdtkc{text,key,command}
+@ifset cmdnames
+@kindex \key\
+@findex \command\
+@iftex
+@item @kbd{\text\} @hskip 0pt plus 1filll @code{\command\}
+@end iftex
+@ifnottex
+@item @kbd{\text\} @tie{}@tie{}@tie{}@tie{}(@code{\command\})
+@end ifnottex
+@end ifset
+@ifclear cmdnames
+@kindex \key\
+@item @kbd{\text\}
+@end ifclear
+@end macro
+
+@c two keys with one command
+@c Inserts: @item KEY1 or KEY2 COMMAND
+@macro orgcmdkkc{key1,key2,command}
+@ifset cmdnames
+@kindex \key1\
+@kindex \key2\
+@findex \command\
+@iftex
+@item @kbd{\key1\} @ @r{or} @ @kbd{\key2\} @hskip 0pt plus 1filll @code{\command\}
+@end iftex
+@ifnottex
+@item @kbd{\key1\} @ @r{or} @ @kbd{\key2\} @tie{}@tie{}@tie{}@tie{}(@code{\command\})
+@end ifnottex
+@end ifset
+@ifclear cmdnames
+@kindex \key1\
+@kindex \key2\
+@item @kbd{\key1\} @ @r{or} @ @kbd{\key2\}
+@end ifclear
+@end macro
+
+@c Two keys with one command name, but different functions, so format as
+@c @itemx
+@c Inserts: @item KEY1
+@c @itemx KEY2 COMMAND
+@macro orgcmdkxkc{key1,key2,command}
+@ifset cmdnames
+@kindex \key1\
+@kindex \key2\
+@findex \command\
+@iftex
+@item @kbd{\key1\}
+@itemx @kbd{\key2\} @hskip 0pt plus 1filll @code{\command\}
+@end iftex
+@ifnottex
+@item @kbd{\key1\}
+@itemx @kbd{\key2\} @tie{}@tie{}@tie{}@tie{}(@code{\command\})
+@end ifnottex
+@end ifset
+@ifclear cmdnames
+@kindex \key1\
+@kindex \key2\
+@item @kbd{\key1\}
+@itemx @kbd{\key2\}
+@end ifclear
+@end macro
+
+@c Same as previous, but use "or short"
+@c Inserts: @item KEY1 or short KEY2 COMMAND
+@macro orgcmdkskc{key1,key2,command}
+@ifset cmdnames
+@kindex \key1\
+@kindex \key2\
+@findex \command\
+@iftex
+@item @kbd{\key1\} @ @r{or short} @ @kbd{\key2\} @hskip 0pt plus 1filll @code{\command\}
+@end iftex
+@ifnottex
+@item @kbd{\key1\} @ @r{or short} @ @kbd{\key2\} @tie{}@tie{}@tie{}@tie{}(@code{\command\})
+@end ifnottex
+@end ifset
+@ifclear cmdnames
+@kindex \key1\
+@kindex \key2\
+@item @kbd{\key1\} @ @r{or short} @ @kbd{\key2\}
+@end ifclear
+@end macro
+
+@c Same as previous, but use @itemx
+@c Inserts: @itemx KEY1 or short KEY2 COMMAND
+@macro xorgcmdkskc{key1,key2,command}
+@ifset cmdnames
+@kindex \key1\
+@kindex \key2\
+@findex \command\
+@iftex
+@itemx @kbd{\key1\} @ @r{or short} @ @kbd{\key2\} @hskip 0pt plus 1filll @code{\command\}
+@end iftex
+@ifnottex
+@itemx @kbd{\key1\} @ @r{or short} @ @kbd{\key2\} @tie{}@tie{}@tie{}@tie{}(@code{\command\})
+@end ifnottex
+@end ifset
+@ifclear cmdnames
+@kindex \key1\
+@kindex \key2\
+@itemx @kbd{\key1\} @ @r{or short} @ @kbd{\key2\}
+@end ifclear
+@end macro
+
+@c two keys with two commands
+@c Inserts: @item KEY1 COMMAND1
+@c @itemx KEY2 COMMAND2
+@macro orgcmdkkcc{key1,key2,command1,command2}
+@ifset cmdnames
+@kindex \key1\
+@kindex \key2\
+@findex \command1\
+@findex \command2\
+@iftex
+@item @kbd{\key1\} @hskip 0pt plus 1filll @code{\command1\}
+@itemx @kbd{\key2\} @hskip 0pt plus 1filll @code{\command2\}
+@end iftex
+@ifnottex
+@item @kbd{\key1\} @tie{}@tie{}@tie{}@tie{}(@code{\command1\})
+@itemx @kbd{\key2\} @tie{}@tie{}@tie{}@tie{}(@code{\command2\})
+@end ifnottex
+@end ifset
+@ifclear cmdnames
+@kindex \key1\
+@kindex \key2\
+@item @kbd{\key1\}
+@itemx @kbd{\key2\}
+@end ifclear
+@end macro
+@c -----------------------------------------------------------------------------
+
+@iftex
+@c @hyphenation{time-stamp time-stamps time-stamp-ing time-stamp-ed}
+@end iftex
+
+@c Subheadings inside a table.
+@macro tsubheading{text}
+@ifinfo
+@subsubheading \text\
+@end ifinfo
+@ifnotinfo
+@item @b{\text\}
+@end ifnotinfo
+@end macro
+
+@copying
+This manual is for Org version @value{VERSION}.
+
+Copyright @copyright{} 2004, 2005, 2006, 2007, 2008, 2009, 2010
+Free Software Foundation, Inc.
+
+@quotation
+Permission is granted to copy, distribute and/or modify this document
+under the terms of the GNU Free Documentation License, Version 1.3 or
+any later version published by the Free Software Foundation; with no
+Invariant Sections, with the Front-Cover texts being ``A GNU Manual,''
+and with the Back-Cover Texts as in (a) below. A copy of the license
+is included in the section entitled ``GNU Free Documentation License.''
+
+(a) The FSF's Back-Cover Text is: ``You have the freedom to copy and
+modify this GNU manual. Buying copies from the FSF supports it in
+developing GNU and promoting software freedom.''
+
+This document is part of a collection distributed under the GNU Free
+Documentation License. If you want to distribute this document
+separately from the collection, you can do so by adding a copy of the
+license to the document, as described in section 6 of the license.
+@end quotation
+@end copying
+
+@dircategory Emacs
+@direntry
+* Org Mode: (org). Outline-based notes management and organizer
+@end direntry
+
+@titlepage
+@title The Org Manual
+
+@subtitle Release @value{VERSION}
+@author by Carsten Dominik
+with contributions by David O'Toole, Bastien Guerry, Philip Rooke, Dan Davison, Eric Schulte, and Thomas Dye
+
+@c The following two commands start the copyright page.
+@page
+@vskip 0pt plus 1filll
+@insertcopying
+@end titlepage
+
+@c Output the table of contents at the beginning.
+@contents
+
+@ifnottex
+@node Top, Introduction, (dir), (dir)
+@top Org Mode Manual
+
+@insertcopying
+@end ifnottex
+
+@menu
+* Introduction:: Getting started
+* Document Structure:: A tree works like your brain
+* Tables:: Pure magic for quick formatting
+* Hyperlinks:: Notes in context
+* TODO Items:: Every tree branch can be a TODO item
+* Tags:: Tagging headlines and matching sets of tags
+* Properties and Columns:: Storing information about an entry
+* Dates and Times:: Making items useful for planning
+* Capture - Refile - Archive:: The ins and outs for projects
+* Agenda Views:: Collecting information into views
+* Markup:: Prepare text for rich export
+* Exporting:: Sharing and publishing of notes
+* Publishing:: Create a web site of linked Org files
+* Working With Source Code:: Export, evaluate, and tangle code blocks
+* Miscellaneous:: All the rest which did not fit elsewhere
+* Hacking:: How to hack your way around
+* MobileOrg:: Viewing and capture on a mobile device
+* History and Acknowledgments:: How Org came into being
+* Main Index:: An index of Org's concepts and features
+* Key Index:: Key bindings and where they are described
+* Command and Function Index:: Command names and some internal functions
+* Variable Index:: Variables mentioned in the manual
+
+@detailmenu
+ --- The Detailed Node Listing ---
+
+Introduction
+
+* Summary:: Brief summary of what Org does
+* Installation:: How to install a downloaded version of Org
+* Activation:: How to activate Org for certain buffers
+* Feedback:: Bug reports, ideas, patches etc.
+* Conventions:: Type-setting conventions in the manual
+
+Document structure
+
+* Outlines:: Org is based on Outline mode
+* Headlines:: How to typeset Org tree headlines
+* Visibility cycling:: Show and hide, much simplified
+* Motion:: Jumping to other headlines
+* Structure editing:: Changing sequence and level of headlines
+* Sparse trees:: Matches embedded in context
+* Plain lists:: Additional structure within an entry
+* Drawers:: Tucking stuff away
+* Blocks:: Folding blocks
+* Footnotes:: How footnotes are defined in Org's syntax
+* Orgstruct mode:: Structure editing outside Org
+
+Tables
+
+* Built-in table editor:: Simple tables
+* Column width and alignment:: Overrule the automatic settings
+* Column groups:: Grouping to trigger vertical lines
+* Orgtbl mode:: The table editor as minor mode
+* The spreadsheet:: The table editor has spreadsheet capabilities
+* Org-Plot:: Plotting from org tables
+
+The spreadsheet
+
+* References:: How to refer to another field or range
+* Formula syntax for Calc:: Using Calc to compute stuff
+* Formula syntax for Lisp:: Writing formulas in Emacs Lisp
+* Field formulas:: Formulas valid for a single field
+* Column formulas:: Formulas valid for an entire column
+* Editing and debugging formulas:: Fixing formulas
+* Updating the table:: Recomputing all dependent fields
+* Advanced features:: Field names, parameters and automatic recalc
+
+Hyperlinks
+
+* Link format:: How links in Org are formatted
+* Internal links:: Links to other places in the current file
+* External links:: URL-like links to the world
+* Handling links:: Creating, inserting and following
+* Using links outside Org:: Linking from my C source code?
+* Link abbreviations:: Shortcuts for writing complex links
+* Search options:: Linking to a specific location
+* Custom searches:: When the default search is not enough
+
+Internal links
+
+* Radio targets:: Make targets trigger links in plain text
+
+TODO items
+
+* TODO basics:: Marking and displaying TODO entries
+* TODO extensions:: Workflow and assignments
+* Progress logging:: Dates and notes for progress
+* Priorities:: Some things are more important than others
+* Breaking down tasks:: Splitting a task into manageable pieces
+* Checkboxes:: Tick-off lists
+
+Extended use of TODO keywords
+
+* Workflow states:: From TODO to DONE in steps
+* TODO types:: I do this, Fred does the rest
+* Multiple sets in one file:: Mixing it all, and still finding your way
+* Fast access to TODO states:: Single letter selection of a state
+* Per-file keywords:: Different files, different requirements
+* Faces for TODO keywords:: Highlighting states
+* TODO dependencies:: When one task needs to wait for others
+
+Progress logging
+
+* Closing items:: When was this entry marked DONE?
+* Tracking TODO state changes:: When did the status change?
+* Tracking your habits:: How consistent have you been?
+
+Tags
+
+* Tag inheritance:: Tags use the tree structure of the outline
+* Setting tags:: How to assign tags to a headline
+* Tag searches:: Searching for combinations of tags
+
+Properties and columns
+
+* Property syntax:: How properties are spelled out
+* Special properties:: Access to other Org-mode features
+* Property searches:: Matching property values
+* Property inheritance:: Passing values down the tree
+* Column view:: Tabular viewing and editing
+* Property API:: Properties for Lisp programmers
+
+Column view
+
+* Defining columns:: The COLUMNS format property
+* Using column view:: How to create and use column view
+* Capturing column view:: A dynamic block for column view
+
+Defining columns
+
+* Scope of column definitions:: Where defined, where valid?
+* Column attributes:: Appearance and content of a column
+
+Dates and times
+
+* Timestamps:: Assigning a time to a tree entry
+* Creating timestamps:: Commands which insert timestamps
+* Deadlines and scheduling:: Planning your work
+* Clocking work time:: Tracking how long you spend on a task
+* Effort estimates:: Planning work effort in advance
+* Relative timer:: Notes with a running timer
+* Countdown timer:: Starting a countdown timer for a task
+
+Creating timestamps
+
+* The date/time prompt:: How Org-mode helps you entering date and time
+* Custom time format:: Making dates look different
+
+Deadlines and scheduling
+
+* Inserting deadline/schedule:: Planning items
+* Repeated tasks:: Items that show up again and again
+
+Clocking work time
+
+* Clocking commands:: Starting and stopping a clock
+* The clock table:: Detailed reports
+* Resolving idle time:: Resolving time when you've been idle
+
+Capture - Refile - Archive
+
+* Capture:: Capturing new stuff
+* Attachments:: Add files to tasks
+* RSS Feeds:: Getting input from RSS feeds
+* Protocols:: External (e.g. Browser) access to Emacs and Org
+* Refiling notes:: Moving a tree from one place to another
+* Archiving:: What to do with finished projects
+
+Capture
+
+* Setting up capture:: Where notes will be stored
+* Using capture:: Commands to invoke and terminate capture
+* Capture templates:: Define the outline of different note types
+
+Capture templates
+
+* Template elements:: What is needed for a complete template entry
+* Template expansion:: Filling in information about time and context
+
+Archiving
+
+* Moving subtrees:: Moving a tree to an archive file
+* Internal archiving:: Switch off a tree but keep it in the file
+
+Agenda views
+
+* Agenda files:: Files being searched for agenda information
+* Agenda dispatcher:: Keyboard access to agenda views
+* Built-in agenda views:: What is available out of the box?
+* Presentation and sorting:: How agenda items are prepared for display
+* Agenda commands:: Remote editing of Org trees
+* Custom agenda views:: Defining special searches and views
+* Exporting Agenda Views:: Writing a view to a file
+* Agenda column view:: Using column view for collected entries
+
+The built-in agenda views
+
+* Weekly/daily agenda:: The calendar page with current tasks
+* Global TODO list:: All unfinished action items
+* Matching tags and properties:: Structured information with fine-tuned search
+* Timeline:: Time-sorted view for single file
+* Search view:: Find entries by searching for text
+* Stuck projects:: Find projects you need to review
+
+Presentation and sorting
+
+* Categories:: Not all tasks are equal
+* Time-of-day specifications:: How the agenda knows the time
+* Sorting of agenda items:: The order of things
+
+Custom agenda views
+
+* Storing searches:: Type once, use often
+* Block agenda:: All the stuff you need in a single buffer
+* Setting Options:: Changing the rules
+
+Markup for rich export
+
+* Structural markup elements:: The basic structure as seen by the exporter
+* Images and tables:: Tables and Images will be included
+* Literal examples:: Source code examples with special formatting
+* Include files:: Include additional files into a document
+* Index entries:: Making an index
+* Macro replacement:: Use macros to create complex output
+* Embedded LaTeX:: LaTeX can be freely used inside Org documents
+
+Structural markup elements
+
+* Document title:: Where the title is taken from
+* Headings and sections:: The document structure as seen by the exporter
+* Table of contents:: The if and where of the table of contents
+* Initial text:: Text before the first heading?
+* Lists:: Lists
+* Paragraphs:: Paragraphs
+* Footnote markup:: Footnotes
+* Emphasis and monospace:: Bold, italic, etc.
+* Horizontal rules:: Make a line
+* Comment lines:: What will *not* be exported
+
+Embedded @LaTeX{}
+
+* Special symbols:: Greek letters and other symbols
+* Subscripts and superscripts:: Simple syntax for raising/lowering text
+* LaTeX fragments:: Complex formulas made easy
+* Previewing LaTeX fragments:: What will this snippet look like?
+* CDLaTeX mode:: Speed up entering of formulas
+
+Exporting
+
+* Selective export:: Using tags to select and exclude trees
+* Export options:: Per-file export settings
+* The export dispatcher:: How to access exporter commands
+* ASCII/Latin-1/UTF-8 export:: Exporting to flat files with encoding
+* HTML export:: Exporting to HTML
+* LaTeX and PDF export:: Exporting to @LaTeX{}, and processing to PDF
+* DocBook export:: Exporting to DocBook
+* TaskJuggler export:: Exporting to TaskJuggler
+* Freemind export:: Exporting to Freemind mind maps
+* XOXO export:: Exporting to XOXO
+* iCalendar export:: Exporting in iCalendar format
+
+HTML export
+
+* HTML Export commands:: How to invoke HTML export
+* Quoting HTML tags:: Using direct HTML in Org-mode
+* Links in HTML export:: How links will be interpreted and formatted
+* Tables in HTML export:: How to modify the formatting of tables
+* Images in HTML export:: How to insert figures into HTML output
+* Math formatting in HTML export:: Beautiful math also on the web
+* Text areas in HTML export:: An alternative way to show an example
+* CSS support:: Changing the appearance of the output
+* JavaScript support:: Info and Folding in a web browser
+
+@LaTeX{} and PDF export
+
+* LaTeX/PDF export commands:: Which key invokes which commands
+* Header and sectioning:: Setting up the export file structure
+* Quoting LaTeX code:: Incorporating literal @LaTeX{} code
+* Tables in LaTeX export:: Options for exporting tables to @LaTeX{}
+* Images in LaTeX export:: How to insert figures into @LaTeX{} output
+* Beamer class export:: Turning the file into a presentation
+
+DocBook export
+
+* DocBook export commands:: How to invoke DocBook export
+* Quoting DocBook code:: Incorporating DocBook code in Org files
+* Recursive sections:: Recursive sections in DocBook
+* Tables in DocBook export:: Tables are exported as HTML tables
+* Images in DocBook export:: How to insert figures into DocBook output
+* Special characters:: How to handle special characters
+
+Publishing
+
+* Configuration:: Defining projects
+* Uploading files:: How to get files up on the server
+* Sample configuration:: Example projects
+* Triggering publication:: Publication commands
+
+Configuration
+
+* Project alist:: The central configuration variable
+* Sources and destinations:: From here to there
+* Selecting files:: What files are part of the project?
+* Publishing action:: Setting the function doing the publishing
+* Publishing options:: Tweaking HTML export
+* Publishing links:: Which links keep working after publishing?
+* Sitemap:: Generating a list of all pages
+* Generating an index:: An index that reaches across pages
+
+Sample configuration
+
+* Simple example:: One-component publishing
+* Complex example:: A multi-component publishing example
+
+Working with source code
+
+* Structure of code blocks:: Code block syntax described
+* Editing source code:: Language major-mode editing
+* Exporting code blocks:: Export contents and/or results
+* Extracting source code:: Create pure source code files
+* Evaluating code blocks:: Place results of evaluation in the Org-mode buffer
+* Library of Babel:: Use and contribute to a library of useful code blocks
+* Languages:: List of supported code block languages
+* Header arguments:: Configure code block functionality
+* Results of evaluation:: How evaluation results are handled
+* Noweb reference syntax:: Literate programming in Org-mode
+* Key bindings and useful functions:: Work quickly with code blocks
+* Batch execution:: Call functions from the command line
+
+Header arguments
+
+* Using header arguments:: Different ways to set header arguments
+* Specific header arguments:: List of header arguments
+
+Using header arguments
+
+* System-wide header arguments:: Set global default values
+* Language-specific header arguments:: Set default values by language
+* Buffer-wide header arguments:: Set default values for a specific buffer
+* Header arguments in Org-mode properties:: Set default values for a buffer or heading
+* Code block specific header arguments:: The most common way to set values
+* Header arguments in function calls:: The most specific level
+
+Specific header arguments
+
+* var:: Pass arguments to code blocks
+* results:: Specify the type of results and how they will
+ be collected and handled
+* file:: Specify a path for file output
+* dir:: Specify the default (possibly remote)
+ directory for code block execution
+* exports:: Export code and/or results
+* tangle:: Toggle tangling and specify file name
+* comments:: Toggle insertion of comments in tangled
+ code files
+* no-expand:: Turn off variable assignment and noweb
+ expansion during tangling
+* session:: Preserve the state of code evaluation
+* noweb:: Toggle expansion of noweb references
+* cache:: Avoid re-evaluating unchanged code blocks
+* hlines:: Handle horizontal lines in tables
+* colnames:: Handle column names in tables
+* rownames:: Handle row names in tables
+* shebang:: Make tangled files executable
+* eval:: Limit evaluation of specific code blocks
+
+Miscellaneous
+
+* Completion:: M-TAB knows what you need
+* Easy Templates:: Quick insertion of structural elements
+* Speed keys:: Electric commands at the beginning of a headline
+* Code evaluation security:: Org mode files evaluate inline code
+* Customization:: Adapting Org to your taste
+* In-buffer settings:: Overview of the #+KEYWORDS
+* The very busy C-c C-c key:: When in doubt, press C-c C-c
+* Clean view:: Getting rid of leading stars in the outline
+* TTY keys:: Using Org on a tty
+* Interaction:: Other Emacs packages
+
+Interaction with other packages
+
+* Cooperation:: Packages Org cooperates with
+* Conflicts:: Packages that lead to conflicts
+
+Hacking
+
+* Hooks:: Who to reach into Org's internals
+* Add-on packages:: Available extensions
+* Adding hyperlink types:: New custom link types
+* Context-sensitive commands:: How to add functionality to such commands
+* Tables in arbitrary syntax:: Orgtbl for @LaTeX{} and other programs
+* Dynamic blocks:: Automatically filled blocks
+* Special agenda views:: Customized views
+* Extracting agenda information:: Postprocessing of agenda information
+* Using the property API:: Writing programs that use entry properties
+* Using the mapping API:: Mapping over all or selected entries
+
+Tables and lists in arbitrary syntax
+
+* Radio tables:: Sending and receiving radio tables
+* A LaTeX example:: Step by step, almost a tutorial
+* Translator functions:: Copy and modify
+* Radio lists:: Doing the same for lists
+
+MobileOrg
+
+* Setting up the staging area:: Where to interact with the mobile device
+* Pushing to MobileOrg:: Uploading Org files and agendas
+* Pulling from MobileOrg:: Integrating captured and flagged items
+
+@end detailmenu
+@end menu
+
+@node Introduction, Document Structure, Top, Top
+@chapter Introduction
+@cindex introduction
+
+@menu
+* Summary:: Brief summary of what Org does
+* Installation:: How to install a downloaded version of Org
+* Activation:: How to activate Org for certain buffers
+* Feedback:: Bug reports, ideas, patches etc.
+* Conventions:: Type-setting conventions in the manual
+@end menu
+
+@node Summary, Installation, Introduction, Introduction
+@section Summary
+@cindex summary
+
+Org is a mode for keeping notes, maintaining TODO lists, and doing
+project planning with a fast and effective plain-text system.
+
+Org develops organizational tasks around NOTES files that contain
+lists or information about projects as plain text. Org is
+implemented on top of Outline mode, which makes it possible to keep the
+content of large files well structured. Visibility cycling and
+structure editing help to work with the tree. Tables are easily created
+with a built-in table editor. Org supports TODO items, deadlines,
+timestamps, and scheduling. It dynamically compiles entries into an
+agenda that utilizes and smoothly integrates much of the Emacs calendar
+and diary. Plain text URL-like links connect to websites, emails,
+Usenet messages, BBDB entries, and any files related to the projects.
+For printing and sharing of notes, an Org file can be exported as a
+structured ASCII file, as HTML, or (TODO and agenda items only) as an
+iCalendar file. It can also serve as a publishing tool for a set of
+linked web pages.
+
+As a project planning environment, Org works by adding metadata to outline
+nodes. Based on this data, specific entries can be extracted in queries and
+create dynamic @i{agenda views}.
+
+Org mode contains the Org Babel environment which allows you to work with
+embedded source code blocks in a file, to facilitate code evaluation,
+documentation, and tangling.
+
+Org's automatic, context-sensitive table editor with spreadsheet
+capabilities can be integrated into any major mode by activating the
+minor Orgtbl mode. Using a translation step, it can be used to maintain
+tables in arbitrary file types, for example in @LaTeX{}. The structure
+editing and list creation capabilities can be used outside Org with
+the minor Orgstruct mode.
+
+Org keeps simple things simple. When first fired up, it should
+feel like a straightforward, easy to use outliner. Complexity is not
+imposed, but a large amount of functionality is available when you need
+it. Org is a toolbox and can be used in different ways and for different
+ends, for example:
+
+@example
+@r{@bullet{} an outline extension with visibility cycling and structure editing}
+@r{@bullet{} an ASCII system and table editor for taking structured notes}
+@r{@bullet{} a TODO list editor}
+@r{@bullet{} a full agenda and planner with deadlines and work scheduling}
+@pindex GTD, Getting Things Done
+@r{@bullet{} an environment in which to implement David Allen's GTD system}
+@r{@bullet{} a simple hypertext system, with HTML and @LaTeX{} export}
+@r{@bullet{} a publishing tool to create a set of interlinked webpages}
+@r{@bullet{} an environment for literate programming}
+@end example
+
+
+@cindex FAQ
+There is a website for Org which provides links to the newest
+version of Org, as well as additional information, frequently asked
+questions (FAQ), links to tutorials, etc@. This page is located at
+@uref{http://orgmode.org}.
+
+@page
+
+
+@node Installation, Activation, Summary, Introduction
+@section Installation
+@cindex installation
+@cindex XEmacs
+
+@b{Important:} @i{If you are using a version of Org that is part of the Emacs
+distribution or an XEmacs package, please skip this section and go directly
+to @ref{Activation}.}
+
+If you have downloaded Org from the Web, either as a distribution @file{.zip}
+or @file{.tar} file, or as a Git archive, you must take the following steps
+to install it: go into the unpacked Org distribution directory and edit the
+top section of the file @file{Makefile}. You must set the name of the Emacs
+binary (likely either @file{emacs} or @file{xemacs}), and the paths to the
+directories where local Lisp and Info files are kept. If you don't have
+access to the system-wide directories, you can simply run Org directly from
+the distribution directory by adding the @file{lisp} subdirectory to the
+Emacs load path. To do this, add the following line to @file{.emacs}:
+
+@example
+(setq load-path (cons "~/path/to/orgdir/lisp" load-path))
+@end example
+
+@noindent
+If you plan to use code from the @file{contrib} subdirectory, do a similar
+step for this directory:
+
+@example
+(setq load-path (cons "~/path/to/orgdir/contrib/lisp" load-path))
+@end example
+
+@noindent Now byte-compile the Lisp files with the shell command:
+
+@example
+make
+@end example
+
+@noindent If you are running Org from the distribution directory, this is
+all. If you want to install Org into the system directories, use (as
+administrator)
+
+@example
+make install
+@end example
+
+Installing Info files is system dependent, because of differences in the
+@file{install-info} program. In Debian it copies the info files into the
+correct directory and modifies the info directory file. In many other
+systems, the files need to be copied to the correct directory separately, and
+@file{install-info} then only modifies the directory file. Check your system
+documentation to find out which of the following commands you need:
+
+@example
+make install-info
+make install-info-debian
+@end example
+
+Then add the following line to @file{.emacs}. It is needed so that
+Emacs can autoload functions that are located in files not immediately loaded
+when Org-mode starts.
+@lisp
+(require 'org-install)
+@end lisp
+
+Do not forget to activate Org as described in the following section.
+@page
+
+@node Activation, Feedback, Installation, Introduction
+@section Activation
+@cindex activation
+@cindex autoload
+@cindex global key bindings
+@cindex key bindings, global
+
+Add the following lines to your @file{.emacs} file. The last three lines
+define @emph{global} keys for the commands @command{org-store-link},
+@command{org-agenda}, and @command{org-iswitchb}---please choose suitable
+keys yourself.
+
+@lisp
+;; The following lines are always needed. Choose your own keys.
+(add-to-list 'auto-mode-alist '("\\.org\\'" . org-mode))
+(global-set-key "\C-cl" 'org-store-link)
+(global-set-key "\C-ca" 'org-agenda)
+(global-set-key "\C-cb" 'org-iswitchb)
+@end lisp
+
+Furthermore, you must activate @code{font-lock-mode} in Org
+buffers, because significant functionality depends on font-locking being
+active. You can do this with either one of the following two lines
+(XEmacs users must use the second option):
+@lisp
+(global-font-lock-mode 1) ; for all buffers
+(add-hook 'org-mode-hook 'turn-on-font-lock) ; Org buffers only
+@end lisp
+
+@cindex Org-mode, turning on
+With this setup, all files with extension @samp{.org} will be put
+into Org-mode. As an alternative, make the first line of a file look
+like this:
+
+@example
+MY PROJECTS -*- mode: org; -*-
+@end example
+
+@vindex org-insert-mode-line-in-empty-file
+@noindent which will select Org-mode for this buffer no matter what
+the file's name is. See also the variable
+@code{org-insert-mode-line-in-empty-file}.
+
+Many commands in Org work on the region if the region is @i{active}. To make
+use of this, you need to have @code{transient-mark-mode}
+(@code{zmacs-regions} in XEmacs) turned on. In Emacs 23 this is the default,
+in Emacs 22 you need to do this yourself with
+@lisp
+(transient-mark-mode 1)
+@end lisp
+@noindent If you do not like @code{transient-mark-mode}, you can create an
+active region by using the mouse to select a region, or pressing
+@kbd{C-@key{SPC}} twice before moving the cursor.
+
+@node Feedback, Conventions, Activation, Introduction
+@section Feedback
+@cindex feedback
+@cindex bug reports
+@cindex maintainer
+@cindex author
+
+If you find problems with Org, or if you have questions, remarks, or ideas
+about it, please mail to the Org mailing list @email{emacs-orgmode@@gnu.org}.
+If you are not a member of the mailing list, your mail will be passed to the
+list after a moderator has approved it@footnote{Please consider subscribing
+to the mailing list, in order to minimize the work the mailing list
+moderators have to do.}.
+
+For bug reports, please first try to reproduce the bug with the latest
+version of Org available---if you are running an outdated version, it is
+quite possible that the bug has been fixed already. If the bug persists,
+prepare a report and provide as much information as possible, including the
+version information of Emacs (@kbd{M-x emacs-version @key{RET}}) and Org
+(@kbd{M-x org-version @key{RET}}), as well as the Org related setup in
+@file{.emacs}. The easiest way to do this is to use the command
+@example
+@kbd{M-x org-submit-bug-report}
+@end example
+@noindent which will put all this information into an Emacs mail buffer so
+that you only need to add your description. If you re not sending the Email
+from within Emacs, please copy and paste the content into your Email program.
+
+If an error occurs, a backtrace can be very useful (see below on how to
+create one). Often a small example file helps, along with clear information
+about:
+
+@enumerate
+@item What exactly did you do?
+@item What did you expect to happen?
+@item What happened instead?
+@end enumerate
+@noindent Thank you for helping to improve this program.
+
+@subsubheading How to create a useful backtrace
+
+@cindex backtrace of an error
+If working with Org produces an error with a message you don't
+understand, you may have hit a bug. The best way to report this is by
+providing, in addition to what was mentioned above, a @emph{backtrace}.
+This is information from the built-in debugger about where and how the
+error occurred. Here is how to produce a useful backtrace:
+
+@enumerate
+@item
+Reload uncompiled versions of all Org-mode Lisp files. The backtrace
+contains much more information if it is produced with uncompiled code.
+To do this, use
+@example
+C-u M-x org-reload RET
+@end example
+@noindent
+or select @code{Org -> Refresh/Reload -> Reload Org uncompiled} from the
+menu.
+@item
+Go to the @code{Options} menu and select @code{Enter Debugger on Error}
+(XEmacs has this option in the @code{Troubleshooting} sub-menu).
+@item
+Do whatever you have to do to hit the error. Don't forget to
+document the steps you take.
+@item
+When you hit the error, a @file{*Backtrace*} buffer will appear on the
+screen. Save this buffer to a file (for example using @kbd{C-x C-w}) and
+attach it to your bug report.
+@end enumerate
+
+@node Conventions, , Feedback, Introduction
+@section Typesetting conventions used in this manual
+
+Org uses three types of keywords: TODO keywords, tags, and property
+names. In this manual we use the following conventions:
+
+@table @code
+@item TODO
+@itemx WAITING
+TODO keywords are written with all capitals, even if they are
+user-defined.
+@item boss
+@itemx ARCHIVE
+User-defined tags are written in lowercase; built-in tags with special
+meaning are written with all capitals.
+@item Release
+@itemx PRIORITY
+User-defined properties are capitalized; built-in properties with
+special meaning are written with all capitals.
+@end table
+
+The manual lists both the keys and the corresponding commands for accessing
+functionality. Org mode often uses the same key for different functions,
+depending on context. The command that is bound to such keys has a generic
+name, like @code{org-metaright}. In the manual we will, wherever possible,
+give the function that is internally called by the generic command. For
+example, in the chapter on document structure, @kbd{M-@key{right}} will be
+listed to call @code{org-do-demote}, while in the chapter on tables, it will
+be listed to call org-table-move-column-right.
+
+If you prefer, you can compile the manual without the command names by
+unsetting the flag @code{cmdnames} in @file{org.texi}.
+
+@node Document Structure, Tables, Introduction, Top
+@chapter Document structure
+@cindex document structure
+@cindex structure of document
+
+Org is based on Outline mode and provides flexible commands to
+edit the structure of the document.
+
+@menu
+* Outlines:: Org is based on Outline mode
+* Headlines:: How to typeset Org tree headlines
+* Visibility cycling:: Show and hide, much simplified
+* Motion:: Jumping to other headlines
+* Structure editing:: Changing sequence and level of headlines
+* Sparse trees:: Matches embedded in context
+* Plain lists:: Additional structure within an entry
+* Drawers:: Tucking stuff away
+* Blocks:: Folding blocks
+* Footnotes:: How footnotes are defined in Org's syntax
+* Orgstruct mode:: Structure editing outside Org
+@end menu
+
+@node Outlines, Headlines, Document Structure, Document Structure
+@section Outlines
+@cindex outlines
+@cindex Outline mode
+
+Org is implemented on top of Outline mode. Outlines allow a
+document to be organized in a hierarchical structure, which (at least
+for me) is the best representation of notes and thoughts. An overview
+of this structure is achieved by folding (hiding) large parts of the
+document to show only the general document structure and the parts
+currently being worked on. Org greatly simplifies the use of
+outlines by compressing the entire show/hide functionality into a single
+command, @command{org-cycle}, which is bound to the @key{TAB} key.
+
+@node Headlines, Visibility cycling, Outlines, Document Structure
+@section Headlines
+@cindex headlines
+@cindex outline tree
+@vindex org-special-ctrl-a/e
+@vindex org-special-ctrl-k
+@vindex org-ctrl-k-protect-subtree
+
+Headlines define the structure of an outline tree. The headlines in Org
+start with one or more stars, on the left margin@footnote{See the variables
+@code{org-special-ctrl-a/e}, @code{org-special-ctrl-k}, and
+@code{org-ctrl-k-protect-subtree} to configure special behavior of @kbd{C-a},
+@kbd{C-e}, and @kbd{C-k} in headlines.}. For example:
+
+@example
+* Top level headline
+** Second level
+*** 3rd level
+ some text
+*** 3rd level
+ more text
+
+* Another top level headline
+@end example
+
+@noindent Some people find the many stars too noisy and would prefer an
+outline that has whitespace followed by a single star as headline
+starters. @ref{Clean view}, describes a setup to realize this.
+
+@vindex org-cycle-separator-lines
+An empty line after the end of a subtree is considered part of it and
+will be hidden when the subtree is folded. However, if you leave at
+least two empty lines, one empty line will remain visible after folding
+the subtree, in order to structure the collapsed view. See the
+variable @code{org-cycle-separator-lines} to modify this behavior.
+
+@node Visibility cycling, Motion, Headlines, Document Structure
+@section Visibility cycling
+@cindex cycling, visibility
+@cindex visibility cycling
+@cindex trees, visibility
+@cindex show hidden text
+@cindex hide text
+
+Outlines make it possible to hide parts of the text in the buffer.
+Org uses just two commands, bound to @key{TAB} and
+@kbd{S-@key{TAB}} to change the visibility in the buffer.
+
+@cindex subtree visibility states
+@cindex subtree cycling
+@cindex folded, subtree visibility state
+@cindex children, subtree visibility state
+@cindex subtree, subtree visibility state
+@table @asis
+@orgcmd{@key{TAB},org-cycle}
+@emph{Subtree cycling}: Rotate current subtree among the states
+
+@example
+,-> FOLDED -> CHILDREN -> SUBTREE --.
+'-----------------------------------'
+@end example
+
+@vindex org-cycle-emulate-tab
+@vindex org-cycle-global-at-bob
+The cursor must be on a headline for this to work@footnote{see, however,
+the option @code{org-cycle-emulate-tab}.}. When the cursor is at the
+beginning of the buffer and the first line is not a headline, then
+@key{TAB} actually runs global cycling (see below)@footnote{see the
+option @code{org-cycle-global-at-bob}.}. Also when called with a prefix
+argument (@kbd{C-u @key{TAB}}), global cycling is invoked.
+
+@cindex global visibility states
+@cindex global cycling
+@cindex overview, global visibility state
+@cindex contents, global visibility state
+@cindex show all, global visibility state
+@orgcmd{S-@key{TAB},org-global-cycle}
+@itemx C-u @key{TAB}
+@emph{Global cycling}: Rotate the entire buffer among the states
+
+@example
+,-> OVERVIEW -> CONTENTS -> SHOW ALL --.
+'--------------------------------------'
+@end example
+
+When @kbd{S-@key{TAB}} is called with a numeric prefix argument N, the
+CONTENTS view up to headlines of level N will be shown. Note that inside
+tables, @kbd{S-@key{TAB}} jumps to the previous field.
+
+@cindex show all, command
+@orgcmd{C-u C-u C-u @key{TAB},show-all}
+Show all, including drawers.
+@orgcmd{C-c C-r,org-reveal}
+Reveal context around point, showing the current entry, the following heading
+and the hierarchy above. Useful for working near a location that has been
+exposed by a sparse tree command (@pxref{Sparse trees}) or an agenda command
+(@pxref{Agenda commands}). With a prefix argument show, on each
+level, all sibling headings. With double prefix arg, also show the entire
+subtree of the parent.
+@orgcmd{C-c C-k,show-branches}
+Expose all the headings of the subtree, CONTENT view for just one subtree.
+@orgcmd{C-c C-x b,org-tree-to-indirect-buffer}
+Show the current subtree in an indirect buffer@footnote{The indirect
+buffer
+@ifinfo
+(@pxref{Indirect Buffers,,,emacs,GNU Emacs Manual})
+@end ifinfo
+@ifnotinfo
+(see the Emacs manual for more information about indirect buffers)
+@end ifnotinfo
+will contain the entire buffer, but will be narrowed to the current
+tree. Editing the indirect buffer will also change the original buffer,
+but without affecting visibility in that buffer.}. With a numeric
+prefix argument N, go up to level N and then take that tree. If N is
+negative then go up that many levels. With a @kbd{C-u} prefix, do not remove
+the previously used indirect buffer.
+@end table
+
+@vindex org-startup-folded
+@cindex @code{overview}, STARTUP keyword
+@cindex @code{content}, STARTUP keyword
+@cindex @code{showall}, STARTUP keyword
+@cindex @code{showeverything}, STARTUP keyword
+
+When Emacs first visits an Org file, the global state is set to
+OVERVIEW, i.e. only the top level headlines are visible. This can be
+configured through the variable @code{org-startup-folded}, or on a
+per-file basis by adding one of the following lines anywhere in the
+buffer:
+
+@example
+#+STARTUP: overview
+#+STARTUP: content
+#+STARTUP: showall
+#+STARTUP: showeverything
+@end example
+
+@cindex property, VISIBILITY
+@noindent
+Furthermore, any entries with a @samp{VISIBILITY} property (@pxref{Properties
+and Columns}) will get their visibility adapted accordingly. Allowed values
+for this property are @code{folded}, @code{children}, @code{content}, and
+@code{all}.
+@table @asis
+@orgcmd{C-u C-u @key{TAB},org-set-startup-visibility}
+Switch back to the startup visibility of the buffer, i.e. whatever is
+requested by startup options and @samp{VISIBILITY} properties in individual
+entries.
+@end table
+
+@node Motion, Structure editing, Visibility cycling, Document Structure
+@section Motion
+@cindex motion, between headlines
+@cindex jumping, to headlines
+@cindex headline navigation
+The following commands jump to other headlines in the buffer.
+
+@table @asis
+@orgcmd{C-c C-n,outline-next-visible-heading}
+Next heading.
+@orgcmd{C-c C-p,outline-previous-visible-heading}
+Previous heading.
+@orgcmd{C-c C-f,org-forward-same-level}
+Next heading same level.
+@orgcmd{C-c C-b,org-backward-same-level}
+Previous heading same level.
+@orgcmd{C-c C-u,outline-up-heading}
+Backward to higher level heading.
+@orgcmd{C-c C-j,org-goto}
+Jump to a different place without changing the current outline
+visibility. Shows the document structure in a temporary buffer, where
+you can use the following keys to find your destination:
+@vindex org-goto-auto-isearch
+@example
+@key{TAB} @r{Cycle visibility.}
+@key{down} / @key{up} @r{Next/previous visible headline.}
+@key{RET} @r{Select this location.}
+@kbd{/} @r{Do a Sparse-tree search}
+@r{The following keys work if you turn off @code{org-goto-auto-isearch}}
+n / p @r{Next/previous visible headline.}
+f / b @r{Next/previous headline same level.}
+u @r{One level up.}
+0-9 @r{Digit argument.}
+q @r{Quit}
+@end example
+@vindex org-goto-interface
+@noindent
+See also the variable @code{org-goto-interface}.
+@end table
+
+@node Structure editing, Sparse trees, Motion, Document Structure
+@section Structure editing
+@cindex structure editing
+@cindex headline, promotion and demotion
+@cindex promotion, of subtrees
+@cindex demotion, of subtrees
+@cindex subtree, cut and paste
+@cindex pasting, of subtrees
+@cindex cutting, of subtrees
+@cindex copying, of subtrees
+@cindex sorting, of subtrees
+@cindex subtrees, cut and paste
+
+@table @asis
+@orgcmd{M-@key{RET},org-insert-heading}
+@vindex org-M-RET-may-split-line
+Insert new heading with same level as current. If the cursor is in a
+plain list item, a new item is created (@pxref{Plain lists}). To force
+creation of a new headline, use a prefix argument, or first press @key{RET}
+to get to the beginning of the next line. When this command is used in
+the middle of a line, the line is split and the rest of the line becomes
+the new headline@footnote{If you do not want the line to be split,
+customize the variable @code{org-M-RET-may-split-line}.}. If the
+command is used at the beginning of a headline, the new headline is
+created before the current line. If at the beginning of any other line,
+the content of that line is made the new heading. If the command is
+used at the end of a folded subtree (i.e. behind the ellipses at the end
+of a headline), then a headline like the current one will be inserted
+after the end of the subtree.
+@orgcmd{C-@key{RET},org-insert-heading-respect-content}
+Just like @kbd{M-@key{RET}}, except when adding a new heading below the
+current heading, the new heading is placed after the body instead of before
+it. This command works from anywhere in the entry.
+@orgcmd{M-S-@key{RET},org-insert-todo-heading}
+@vindex org-treat-insert-todo-heading-as-state-change
+Insert new TODO entry with same level as current heading. See also the
+variable @code{org-treat-insert-todo-heading-as-state-change}.
+@orgcmd{C-S-@key{RET},org-insert-todo-heading-respect-content}
+Insert new TODO entry with same level as current heading. Like
+@kbd{C-@key{RET}}, the new headline will be inserted after the current
+subtree.
+@orgcmd{@key{TAB},org-cycle}
+In a new entry with no text yet, the first @key{TAB} demotes the entry to
+become a child of the previous one. The next @key{TAB} makes it a parent,
+and so on, all the way to top level. Yet another @key{TAB}, and you are back
+to the initial level.
+@orgcmd{M-@key{left},org-do-promote}
+Promote current heading by one level.
+@orgcmd{M-@key{right},org-do-demote}
+Demote current heading by one level.
+@orgcmd{M-S-@key{left},org-promote-subtree}
+Promote the current subtree by one level.
+@orgcmd{M-S-@key{right},org-demote-subtree}
+Demote the current subtree by one level.
+@orgcmd{M-S-@key{up},org-move-subtree-up}
+Move subtree up (swap with previous subtree of same
+level).
+@orgcmd{M-S-@key{down},org-move-subtree-down}
+Move subtree down (swap with next subtree of same level).
+@orgcmd{C-c C-x C-w,org-cut-subtree}
+Kill subtree, i.e. remove it from buffer but save in kill ring.
+With a numeric prefix argument N, kill N sequential subtrees.
+@orgcmd{C-c C-x M-w,org-copy-subtree}
+Copy subtree to kill ring. With a numeric prefix argument N, copy the N
+sequential subtrees.
+@orgcmd{C-c C-x C-y,org-paste-subtree}
+Yank subtree from kill ring. This does modify the level of the subtree to
+make sure the tree fits in nicely at the yank position. The yank level can
+also be specified with a numeric prefix argument, or by yanking after a
+headline marker like @samp{****}.
+@orgcmd{C-y,org-yank}
+@vindex org-yank-adjusted-subtrees
+@vindex org-yank-folded-subtrees
+Depending on the variables @code{org-yank-adjusted-subtrees} and
+@code{org-yank-folded-subtrees}, Org's internal @code{yank} command will
+paste subtrees folded and in a clever way, using the same command as @kbd{C-c
+C-x C-y}. With the default settings, no level adjustment will take place,
+but the yanked tree will be folded unless doing so would swallow text
+previously visible. Any prefix argument to this command will force a normal
+@code{yank} to be executed, with the prefix passed along. A good way to
+force a normal yank is @kbd{C-u C-y}. If you use @code{yank-pop} after a
+yank, it will yank previous kill items plainly, without adjustment and
+folding.
+@orgcmd{C-c C-x c,org-clone-subtree-with-time-shift}
+Clone a subtree by making a number of sibling copies of it. You will be
+prompted for the number of copies to make, and you can also specify if any
+timestamps in the entry should be shifted. This can be useful, for example,
+to create a number of tasks related to a series of lectures to prepare. For
+more details, see the docstring of the command
+@code{org-clone-subtree-with-time-shift}.
+@orgcmd{C-c C-w,org-refile}
+Refile entry or region to a different location. @xref{Refiling notes}.
+@orgcmd{C-c ^,org-sort-entries-or-items}
+Sort same-level entries. When there is an active region, all entries in the
+region will be sorted. Otherwise the children of the current headline are
+sorted. The command prompts for the sorting method, which can be
+alphabetically, numerically, by time (first timestamp with active preferred,
+creation time, scheduled time, deadline time), by priority, by TODO keyword
+(in the sequence the keywords have been defined in the setup) or by the value
+of a property. Reverse sorting is possible as well. You can also supply
+your own function to extract the sorting key. With a @kbd{C-u} prefix,
+sorting will be case-sensitive. With two @kbd{C-u C-u} prefixes, duplicate
+entries will also be removed.
+@orgcmd{C-x n s,org-narrow-to-subtree}
+Narrow buffer to current subtree.
+@orgcmd{C-x n w,widen}
+Widen buffer to remove narrowing.
+@orgcmd{C-c *,org-toggle-heading}
+Turn a normal line or plain list item into a headline (so that it becomes a
+subheading at its location). Also turn a headline into a normal line by
+removing the stars. If there is an active region, turn all lines in the
+region into headlines. If the first line in the region was an item, turn
+only the item lines into headlines. Finally, if the first line is a
+headline, remove the stars from all headlines in the region.
+@end table
+
+@cindex region, active
+@cindex active region
+@cindex transient mark mode
+When there is an active region (Transient Mark mode), promotion and
+demotion work on all headlines in the region. To select a region of
+headlines, it is best to place both point and mark at the beginning of a
+line, mark at the beginning of the first headline, and point at the line
+just after the last headline to change. Note that when the cursor is
+inside a table (@pxref{Tables}), the Meta-Cursor keys have different
+functionality.
+
+
+@node Sparse trees, Plain lists, Structure editing, Document Structure
+@section Sparse trees
+@cindex sparse trees
+@cindex trees, sparse
+@cindex folding, sparse trees
+@cindex occur, command
+
+@vindex org-show-hierarchy-above
+@vindex org-show-following-heading
+@vindex org-show-siblings
+@vindex org-show-entry-below
+An important feature of Org-mode is the ability to construct @emph{sparse
+trees} for selected information in an outline tree, so that the entire
+document is folded as much as possible, but the selected information is made
+visible along with the headline structure above it@footnote{See also the
+variables @code{org-show-hierarchy-above}, @code{org-show-following-heading},
+@code{org-show-siblings}, and @code{org-show-entry-below} for detailed
+control on how much context is shown around each match.}. Just try it out
+and you will see immediately how it works.
+
+Org-mode contains several commands creating such trees, all these
+commands can be accessed through a dispatcher:
+
+@table @asis
+@orgcmd{C-c /,org-sparse-tree}
+This prompts for an extra key to select a sparse-tree creating command.
+@orgcmd{C-c / r,org-occur}
+@vindex org-remove-highlights-with-change
+Occur. Prompts for a regexp and shows a sparse tree with all matches. If
+the match is in a headline, the headline is made visible. If the match is in
+the body of an entry, headline and body are made visible. In order to
+provide minimal context, also the full hierarchy of headlines above the match
+is shown, as well as the headline following the match. Each match is also
+highlighted; the highlights disappear when the buffer is changed by an
+editing command@footnote{This depends on the option
+@code{org-remove-highlights-with-change}}, or by pressing @kbd{C-c C-c}.
+When called with a @kbd{C-u} prefix argument, previous highlights are kept,
+so several calls to this command can be stacked.
+@end table
+
+@noindent
+@vindex org-agenda-custom-commands
+For frequently used sparse trees of specific search strings, you can
+use the variable @code{org-agenda-custom-commands} to define fast
+keyboard access to specific sparse trees. These commands will then be
+accessible through the agenda dispatcher (@pxref{Agenda dispatcher}).
+For example:
+
+@lisp
+(setq org-agenda-custom-commands
+ '(("f" occur-tree "FIXME")))
+@end lisp
+
+@noindent will define the key @kbd{C-c a f} as a shortcut for creating
+a sparse tree matching the string @samp{FIXME}.
+
+The other sparse tree commands select headings based on TODO keywords,
+tags, or properties and will be discussed later in this manual.
+
+@kindex C-c C-e v
+@cindex printing sparse trees
+@cindex visible text, printing
+To print a sparse tree, you can use the Emacs command
+@code{ps-print-buffer-with-faces} which does not print invisible parts
+of the document @footnote{This does not work under XEmacs, because
+XEmacs uses selective display for outlining, not text properties.}.
+Or you can use the command @kbd{C-c C-e v} to export only the visible
+part of the document and print the resulting file.
+
+@node Plain lists, Drawers, Sparse trees, Document Structure
+@section Plain lists
+@cindex plain lists
+@cindex lists, plain
+@cindex lists, ordered
+@cindex ordered lists
+
+Within an entry of the outline tree, hand-formatted lists can provide
+additional structure. They also provide a way to create lists of checkboxes
+(@pxref{Checkboxes}). Org supports editing such lists, and every exporter
+(@pxref{Exporting}) can parse and format them.
+
+Org knows ordered lists, unordered lists, and description lists.
+@itemize @bullet
+@item
+@emph{Unordered} list items start with @samp{-}, @samp{+}, or
+@samp{*}@footnote{When using @samp{*} as a bullet, lines must be indented or
+they will be seen as top-level headlines. Also, when you are hiding leading
+stars to get a clean outline view, plain list items starting with a star are
+visually indistinguishable from true headlines. In short: even though
+@samp{*} is supported, it may be better to not use it for plain list items.}
+as bullets.
+@item
+@vindex org-plain-list-ordered-item-terminator
+@emph{Ordered} list items start with a numeral followed by either a period or
+a right parenthesis@footnote{You can filter out any of them by configuring
+@code{org-plain-list-ordered-item-terminator}.}, such as @samp{1.} or
+@samp{1)}. If you want a list to start with a different value (e.g. 20), start
+the text of the item with @code{[@@20]}@footnote{If there's a checkbox in the
+item, the cookie must be put @emph{before} the checkbox.}. Those constructs
+can be used in any item of the list in order to enforce a particular
+numbering.
+@item
+@emph{Description} list items are unordered list items, and contain the
+separator @samp{ :: } to separate the description @emph{term} from the
+description.
+@end itemize
+
+Items belonging to the same list must have the same indentation on the first
+line. In particular, if an ordered list reaches number @samp{10.}, then the
+2--digit numbers must be written left-aligned with the other numbers in the
+list.
+
+@vindex org-list-ending-method
+@vindex org-list-end-regexp
+@vindex org-empty-line-terminates-plain-lists
+Two methods@footnote{To disable either of them, configure
+@code{org-list-ending-method}.} are provided to terminate lists. A list ends
+before the next line that is indented like the bullet/number or less, or it
+ends before two blank lines@footnote{See also
+@code{org-empty-line-terminates-plain-lists}.}. In both cases, all levels of
+the list are closed@footnote{So you cannot have a sublist, some text and then
+another sublist while still in the same top-level list item. This used to be
+possible, but it was only supported in the HTML exporter and difficult to
+manage with automatic indentation.}. For finer control, you can end lists
+with any pattern set in @code{org-list-end-regexp}. Here is an example:
+
+@example
+@group
+** Lord of the Rings
+ My favorite scenes are (in this order)
+ 1. The attack of the Rohirrim
+ 2. Eowyn's fight with the witch king
+ + this was already my favorite scene in the book
+ + I really like Miranda Otto.
+ 3. Peter Jackson being shot by Legolas
+ He makes a really funny face when it happens.
+ - on DVD only
+ But in the end, no individual scenes matter but the film as a whole.
+ Important actors in this film are:
+ - @b{Elijah Wood} :: He plays Frodo
+ - @b{Sean Austin} :: He plays Sam, Frodo's friend. I still remember
+ him very well from his role as Mikey Walsh in @i{The Goonies}.
+@end group
+@end example
+
+Org supports these lists by tuning filling and wrapping commands to deal with
+them correctly@footnote{Org only changes the filling settings for Emacs. For
+XEmacs, you should use Kyle E. Jones' @file{filladapt.el}. To turn this on,
+put into @file{.emacs}: @code{(require 'filladapt)}}, and by exporting them
+properly (@pxref{Exporting}). Since indentation is what governs the
+structure of these lists, many structural constructs like @code{#+BEGIN_...}
+blocks can be indented to signal that they should be considered as a list
+item.
+
+@vindex org-list-demote-modify-bullet
+If you find that using a different bullet for a sub-list (than that used for
+the current list-level) improves readability, customize the variable
+@code{org-list-demote-modify-bullet}.
+
+@vindex org-list-automatic-rules
+The following commands act on items when the cursor is in the first line of
+an item (the line with the bullet or number). Some of them imply the
+application of automatic rules to keep list structure intact. If some of
+these actions get in your way, configure @code{org-list-automatic-rules}
+to disable them individually.
+
+@table @asis
+@orgcmd{@key{TAB},org-cycle}
+@vindex org-cycle-include-plain-lists
+Items can be folded just like headline levels. Normally this works only if
+the cursor is on a plain list item. For more details, see the variable
+@code{org-cycle-include-plain-lists}. If this variable is set to
+@code{integrate}, plain list items will be treated like low-level
+headlines. The level of an item is then given by the
+indentation of the bullet/number. Items are always subordinate to real
+headlines, however; the hierarchies remain completely separated.
+@orgcmd{M-@key{RET},org-insert-heading}
+@vindex org-M-RET-may-split-line
+@vindex org-list-automatic-rules
+Insert new item at current level. With a prefix argument, force a new
+heading (@pxref{Structure editing}). If this command is used in the middle
+of a line, the line is @emph{split} and the rest of the line becomes the new
+item@footnote{If you do not want the line to be split, customize the variable
+@code{org-M-RET-may-split-line}.}. If this command is executed @emph{before
+an item's body}, the new item is created @emph{before} the current item. If the
+command is executed in the white space before the text that is part of an
+item but does not contain the bullet, a bullet is added to the current line.
+
+As a new item cannot be inserted in a structural construct (like an example
+or source code block) within a list, Org will instead insert it right before
+the structure, or return an error.
+@kindex M-S-@key{RET}
+@item M-S-@key{RET}
+Insert a new item with a checkbox (@pxref{Checkboxes}).
+@orgcmd{@key{TAB},org-cycle}
+In a new item with no text yet, the first @key{TAB} demotes the item to
+become a child of the previous one. Subsequent @key{TAB}s move the item to
+meaningful levels in the list and eventually get it back to its initial
+position.
+@kindex S-@key{down}
+@item S-@key{up}
+@itemx S-@key{down}
+@cindex shift-selection-mode
+@vindex org-support-shift-select
+Jump to the previous/next item in the current list, but only if
+@code{org-support-shift-select} is off. If not, you can still use paragraph
+jumping commands like @kbd{C-@key{up}} and @kbd{C-@key{down}} to quite
+similar effect.
+@kindex M-S-@key{up}
+@kindex M-S-@key{down}
+@item M-S-@key{up}
+@itemx M-S-@key{down}
+Move the item including subitems up/down (swap with previous/next item
+of same indentation). If the list is ordered, renumbering is
+automatic.
+@kindex M-@key{left}
+@kindex M-@key{right}
+@item M-@key{left}
+@itemx M-@key{right}
+Decrease/increase the indentation of an item, leaving children alone.
+@kindex M-S-@key{left}
+@kindex M-S-@key{right}
+@item M-S-@key{left}
+@itemx M-S-@key{right}
+Decrease/increase the indentation of the item, including subitems.
+Initially, the item tree is selected based on current indentation. When
+these commands are executed several times in direct succession, the initially
+selected region is used, even if the new indentation would imply a different
+hierarchy. To use the new hierarchy, break the command chain with a cursor
+motion or so.
+
+As a special case, using this command on the very first item of a list will
+move the whole list. This behavior can be disabled by configuring
+@code{org-list-automatic-rules}. The global indentation of a list has no
+influence on the text @emph{after} the list.
+@kindex C-c C-c
+@item C-c C-c
+If there is a checkbox (@pxref{Checkboxes}) in the item line, toggle the
+state of the checkbox. Also, makes sure that all the
+items on this list level use the same bullet and that the numbering of list
+items (if applicable) is correct.
+@kindex C-c -
+@vindex org-plain-list-ordered-item-terminator
+@vindex org-list-automatic-rules
+@item C-c -
+Cycle the entire list level through the different itemize/enumerate bullets
+(@samp{-}, @samp{+}, @samp{*}, @samp{1.}, @samp{1)}) or a subset of them,
+depending on @code{org-plain-list-ordered-item-terminator}, the type of list,
+and its position@footnote{See @code{bullet} rule in
+@code{org-list-automatic-rules} for more information.}. With a numeric
+prefix argument N, select the Nth bullet from this list. If there is an
+active region when calling this, all lines will be converted to list items.
+If the first line already was a list item, any item markers will be removed
+from the list. Finally, even without an active region, a normal line will be
+converted into a list item.
+@kindex C-c *
+@item C-c *
+Turn a plain list item into a headline (so that it becomes a subheading at
+its location). @xref{Structure editing}, for a detailed explanation.
+@kindex S-@key{left}
+@kindex S-@key{right}
+@item S-@key{left}/@key{right}
+@vindex org-support-shift-select
+This command also cycles bullet styles when the cursor in on the bullet or
+anywhere in an item line, details depending on
+@code{org-support-shift-select}.
+@kindex C-c ^
+@item C-c ^
+Sort the plain list. You will be prompted for the sorting method:
+numerically, alphabetically, by time, or by custom function.
+@end table
+
+@node Drawers, Blocks, Plain lists, Document Structure
+@section Drawers
+@cindex drawers
+@cindex #+DRAWERS
+@cindex visibility cycling, drawers
+
+@vindex org-drawers
+Sometimes you want to keep information associated with an entry, but you
+normally don't want to see it. For this, Org-mode has @emph{drawers}.
+Drawers need to be configured with the variable
+@code{org-drawers}@footnote{You can define drawers on a per-file basis
+with a line like @code{#+DRAWERS: HIDDEN PROPERTIES STATE}}. Drawers
+look like this:
+
+@example
+** This is a headline
+ Still outside the drawer
+ :DRAWERNAME:
+ This is inside the drawer.
+ :END:
+ After the drawer.
+@end example
+
+Visibility cycling (@pxref{Visibility cycling}) on the headline will hide and
+show the entry, but keep the drawer collapsed to a single line. In order to
+look inside the drawer, you need to move the cursor to the drawer line and
+press @key{TAB} there. Org-mode uses the @code{PROPERTIES} drawer for
+storing properties (@pxref{Properties and Columns}), and you can also arrange
+for state change notes (@pxref{Tracking TODO state changes}) and clock times
+(@pxref{Clocking work time}) to be stored in a drawer @code{LOGBOOK}. If you
+want to store a quick note in the LOGBOOK drawer, in a similar way to state changes, use
+
+@table @kbd
+@kindex C-c C-z
+@item C-c C-z
+Add a time-stamped note to the LOGBOOK drawer.
+@end table
+
+@node Blocks, Footnotes, Drawers, Document Structure
+@section Blocks
+
+@vindex org-hide-block-startup
+@cindex blocks, folding
+Org-mode uses begin...end blocks for various purposes from including source
+code examples (@pxref{Literal examples}) to capturing time logging
+information (@pxref{Clocking work time}). These blocks can be folded and
+unfolded by pressing TAB in the begin line. You can also get all blocks
+folded at startup by configuring the variable @code{org-hide-block-startup}
+or on a per-file basis by using
+
+@cindex @code{hideblocks}, STARTUP keyword
+@cindex @code{nohideblocks}, STARTUP keyword
+@example
+#+STARTUP: hideblocks
+#+STARTUP: nohideblocks
+@end example
+
+@node Footnotes, Orgstruct mode, Blocks, Document Structure
+@section Footnotes
+@cindex footnotes
+
+Org-mode supports the creation of footnotes. In contrast to the
+@file{footnote.el} package, Org-mode's footnotes are designed for work on a
+larger document, not only for one-off documents like emails. The basic
+syntax is similar to the one used by @file{footnote.el}, i.e. a footnote is
+defined in a paragraph that is started by a footnote marker in square
+brackets in column 0, no indentation allowed. If you need a paragraph break
+inside a footnote, use the @LaTeX{} idiom @samp{\par}. The footnote reference
+is simply the marker in square brackets, inside text. For example:
+
+@example
+The Org homepage[fn:1] now looks a lot better than it used to.
+...
+[fn:1] The link is: http://orgmode.org
+@end example
+
+Org-mode extends the number-based syntax to @emph{named} footnotes and
+optional inline definition. Using plain numbers as markers (as
+@file{footnote.el} does) is supported for backward compatibility, but not
+encouraged because of possible conflicts with @LaTeX{} snippets (@pxref{Embedded
+LaTeX}). Here are the valid references:
+
+@table @code
+@item [1]
+A plain numeric footnote marker. Compatible with @file{footnote.el}, but not
+recommended because something like @samp{[1]} could easily be part of a code
+snippet.
+@item [fn:name]
+A named footnote reference, where @code{name} is a unique label word, or, for
+simplicity of automatic creation, a number.
+@item [fn:: This is the inline definition of this footnote]
+A @LaTeX{}-like anonymous footnote where the definition is given directly at the
+reference point.
+@item [fn:name: a definition]
+An inline definition of a footnote, which also specifies a name for the note.
+Since Org allows multiple references to the same note, you can then use
+@code{[fn:name]} to create additional references.
+@end table
+
+@vindex org-footnote-auto-label
+Footnote labels can be created automatically, or you can create names yourself.
+This is handled by the variable @code{org-footnote-auto-label} and its
+corresponding @code{#+STARTUP} keywords. See the docstring of that variable
+for details.
+
+@noindent The following command handles footnotes:
+
+@table @kbd
+@kindex C-c C-x f
+@item C-c C-x f
+The footnote action command.
+
+When the cursor is on a footnote reference, jump to the definition. When it
+is at a definition, jump to the (first) reference.
+
+@vindex org-footnote-define-inline
+@vindex org-footnote-section
+@vindex org-footnote-auto-adjust
+Otherwise, create a new footnote. Depending on the variable
+@code{org-footnote-define-inline}@footnote{The corresponding in-buffer
+setting is: @code{#+STARTUP: fninline} or @code{#+STARTUP: nofninline}}, the
+definition will be placed right into the text as part of the reference, or
+separately into the location determined by the variable
+@code{org-footnote-section}.
+
+When this command is called with a prefix argument, a menu of additional
+options is offered:
+@example
+s @r{Sort the footnote definitions by reference sequence. During editing,}
+ @r{Org makes no effort to sort footnote definitions into a particular}
+ @r{sequence. If you want them sorted, use this command, which will}
+ @r{also move entries according to @code{org-footnote-section}. Automatic}
+ @r{sorting after each insertion/deletion can be configured using the}
+ @r{variable @code{org-footnote-auto-adjust}.}
+r @r{Renumber the simple @code{fn:N} footnotes. Automatic renumbering}
+ @r{after each insertion/deletion can be configured using the variable}
+ @r{@code{org-footnote-auto-adjust}.}
+S @r{Short for first @code{r}, then @code{s} action.}
+n @r{Normalize the footnotes by collecting all definitions (including}
+ @r{inline definitions) into a special section, and then numbering them}
+ @r{in sequence. The references will then also be numbers. This is}
+ @r{meant to be the final step before finishing a document (e.g. sending}
+ @r{off an email). The exporters do this automatically, and so could}
+ @r{something like @code{message-send-hook}.}
+d @r{Delete the footnote at point, and all definitions of and references}
+ @r{to it.}
+@end example
+Depending on the variable @code{org-footnote-auto-adjust}@footnote{the
+corresponding in-buffer options are @code{fnadjust} and @code{nofnadjust}.},
+renumbering and sorting footnotes can be automatic after each insertion or
+deletion.
+
+@kindex C-c C-c
+@item C-c C-c
+If the cursor is on a footnote reference, jump to the definition. If it is a
+the definition, jump back to the reference. When called at a footnote
+location with a prefix argument, offer the same menu as @kbd{C-c C-x f}.
+@kindex C-c C-o
+@kindex mouse-1
+@kindex mouse-2
+@item C-c C-o @r{or} mouse-1/2
+Footnote labels are also links to the corresponding definition/reference, and
+you can use the usual commands to follow these links.
+@end table
+
+@node Orgstruct mode, , Footnotes, Document Structure
+@section The Orgstruct minor mode
+@cindex Orgstruct mode
+@cindex minor mode for structure editing
+
+If you like the intuitive way the Org-mode structure editing and list
+formatting works, you might want to use these commands in other modes like
+Text mode or Mail mode as well. The minor mode @code{orgstruct-mode} makes
+this possible. Toggle the mode with @kbd{M-x orgstruct-mode}, or
+turn it on by default, for example in Mail mode, with one of:
+
+@lisp
+(add-hook 'mail-mode-hook 'turn-on-orgstruct)
+(add-hook 'mail-mode-hook 'turn-on-orgstruct++)
+@end lisp
+
+When this mode is active and the cursor is on a line that looks to Org like a
+headline or the first line of a list item, most structure editing commands
+will work, even if the same keys normally have different functionality in the
+major mode you are using. If the cursor is not in one of those special
+lines, Orgstruct mode lurks silently in the shadows. When you use
+@code{orgstruct++-mode}, Org will also export indentation and autofill
+settings into that mode, and detect item context after the first line of an
+item.
+
+@node Tables, Hyperlinks, Document Structure, Top
+@chapter Tables
+@cindex tables
+@cindex editing tables
+
+Org comes with a fast and intuitive table editor. Spreadsheet-like
+calculations are supported using the Emacs @file{calc} package
+@ifinfo
+(@pxref{Top,Calc,,Calc,Gnu Emacs Calculator Manual}).
+@end ifinfo
+@ifnotinfo
+(see the Emacs Calculator manual for more information about the Emacs
+calculator).
+@end ifnotinfo
+
+@menu
+* Built-in table editor:: Simple tables
+* Column width and alignment:: Overrule the automatic settings
+* Column groups:: Grouping to trigger vertical lines
+* Orgtbl mode:: The table editor as minor mode
+* The spreadsheet:: The table editor has spreadsheet capabilities
+* Org-Plot:: Plotting from org tables
+@end menu
+
+@node Built-in table editor, Column width and alignment, Tables, Tables
+@section The built-in table editor
+@cindex table editor, built-in
+
+Org makes it easy to format tables in plain ASCII. Any line with
+@samp{|} as the first non-whitespace character is considered part of a
+table. @samp{|} is also the column separator. A table might look like
+this:
+
+@example
+| Name | Phone | Age |
+|-------+-------+-----|
+| Peter | 1234 | 17 |
+| Anna | 4321 | 25 |
+@end example
+
+A table is re-aligned automatically each time you press @key{TAB} or
+@key{RET} or @kbd{C-c C-c} inside the table. @key{TAB} also moves to
+the next field (@key{RET} to the next row) and creates new table rows
+at the end of the table or before horizontal lines. The indentation
+of the table is set by the first line. Any line starting with
+@samp{|-} is considered as a horizontal separator line and will be
+expanded on the next re-align to span the whole table width. So, to
+create the above table, you would only type
+
+@example
+|Name|Phone|Age|
+|-
+@end example
+
+@noindent and then press @key{TAB} to align the table and start filling in
+fields. Even faster would be to type @code{|Name|Phone|Age} followed by
+@kbd{C-c @key{RET}}.
+
+@vindex org-enable-table-editor
+@vindex org-table-auto-blank-field
+When typing text into a field, Org treats @key{DEL},
+@key{Backspace}, and all character keys in a special way, so that
+inserting and deleting avoids shifting other fields. Also, when
+typing @emph{immediately after the cursor was moved into a new field
+with @kbd{@key{TAB}}, @kbd{S-@key{TAB}} or @kbd{@key{RET}}}, the
+field is automatically made blank. If this behavior is too
+unpredictable for you, configure the variables
+@code{org-enable-table-editor} and @code{org-table-auto-blank-field}.
+
+@table @kbd
+@tsubheading{Creation and conversion}
+@orgcmd{C-c |,org-table-create-or-convert-from-region}
+Convert the active region to table. If every line contains at least one
+TAB character, the function assumes that the material is tab separated.
+If every line contains a comma, comma-separated values (CSV) are assumed.
+If not, lines are split at whitespace into fields. You can use a prefix
+argument to force a specific separator: @kbd{C-u} forces CSV, @kbd{C-u
+C-u} forces TAB, and a numeric argument N indicates that at least N
+consecutive spaces, or alternatively a TAB will be the separator.
+@*
+If there is no active region, this command creates an empty Org
+table. But it's easier just to start typing, like
+@kbd{|Name|Phone|Age @key{RET} |- @key{TAB}}.
+
+@tsubheading{Re-aligning and field motion}
+@orgcmd{C-c C-c,org-table-align}
+Re-align the table without moving the cursor.
+@c
+@orgcmd{<TAB>,org-table-next-field}
+Re-align the table, move to the next field. Creates a new row if
+necessary.
+@c
+@orgcmd{S-@key{TAB},org-table-previous-field}
+Re-align, move to previous field.
+@c
+@orgcmd{@key{RET},org-table-next-row}
+Re-align the table and move down to next row. Creates a new row if
+necessary. At the beginning or end of a line, @key{RET} still does
+NEWLINE, so it can be used to split a table.
+@c
+@orgcmd{M-a,org-table-beginning-of-field}
+Move to beginning of the current table field, or on to the previous field.
+@orgcmd{M-e,org-table-end-of-field}
+Move to end of the current table field, or on to the next field.
+
+@tsubheading{Column and row editing}
+@orgcmdkkcc{M-@key{left},M-@key{right},org-table-move-column-left,org-table-move-column-right}
+Move the current column left/right.
+@c
+@orgcmd{M-S-@key{left},org-table-delete-column}
+Kill the current column.
+@c
+@orgcmd{M-S-@key{right},org-table-insert-column}
+Insert a new column to the left of the cursor position.
+@c
+@orgcmdkkcc{M-@key{up},M-@key{down},org-table-move-row-up,org-table-move-row-down}
+Move the current row up/down.
+@c
+@orgcmd{M-S-@key{up},org-table-kill-row}
+Kill the current row or horizontal line.
+@c
+@orgcmd{M-S-@key{down},org-table-insert-row}
+Insert a new row above the current row. With a prefix argument, the line is
+created below the current one.
+@c
+@orgcmd{C-c -,org-table-insert-hline}
+Insert a horizontal line below current row. With a prefix argument, the line
+is created above the current line.
+@c
+@orgcmd{C-c @key{RET},org-table-hline-and-move}
+Insert a horizontal line below current row, and move the cursor into the row
+below that line.
+@c
+@orgcmd{C-c ^,org-table-sort-lines}
+Sort the table lines in the region. The position of point indicates the
+column to be used for sorting, and the range of lines is the range
+between the nearest horizontal separator lines, or the entire table. If
+point is before the first column, you will be prompted for the sorting
+column. If there is an active region, the mark specifies the first line
+and the sorting column, while point should be in the last line to be
+included into the sorting. The command prompts for the sorting type
+(alphabetically, numerically, or by time). When called with a prefix
+argument, alphabetic sorting will be case-sensitive.
+
+@tsubheading{Regions}
+@orgcmd{C-c C-x M-w,org-table-copy-region}
+Copy a rectangular region from a table to a special clipboard. Point and
+mark determine edge fields of the rectangle. If there is no active region,
+copy just the current field. The process ignores horizontal separator lines.
+@c
+@orgcmd{C-c C-x C-w,org-table-cut-region}
+Copy a rectangular region from a table to a special clipboard, and
+blank all fields in the rectangle. So this is the ``cut'' operation.
+@c
+@orgcmd{C-c C-x C-y,org-table-paste-rectangle}
+Paste a rectangular region into a table.
+The upper left corner ends up in the current field. All involved fields
+will be overwritten. If the rectangle does not fit into the present table,
+the table is enlarged as needed. The process ignores horizontal separator
+lines.
+@c
+@orgcmd{M-@key{RET},org-table-wrap-region}
+Split the current field at the cursor position and move the rest to the line
+below. If there is an active region, and both point and mark are in the same
+column, the text in the column is wrapped to minimum width for the given
+number of lines. A numeric prefix argument may be used to change the number
+of desired lines. If there is no region, but you specify a prefix argument,
+the current field is made blank, and the content is appended to the field
+above.
+
+@tsubheading{Calculations}
+@cindex formula, in tables
+@cindex calculations, in tables
+@cindex region, active
+@cindex active region
+@cindex transient mark mode
+@orgcmd{C-c +,org-table-sum}
+Sum the numbers in the current column, or in the rectangle defined by
+the active region. The result is shown in the echo area and can
+be inserted with @kbd{C-y}.
+@c
+@orgcmd{S-@key{RET},org-table-copy-down}
+@vindex org-table-copy-increment
+When current field is empty, copy from first non-empty field above. When not
+empty, copy current field down to next row and move cursor along with it.
+Depending on the variable @code{org-table-copy-increment}, integer field
+values will be incremented during copy. Integers that are too large will not
+be incremented. Also, a @code{0} prefix argument temporarily disables the
+increment. This key is also used by shift-selection and related modes
+(@pxref{Conflicts}).
+
+@tsubheading{Miscellaneous}
+@orgcmd{C-c `,org-table-edit-field}
+Edit the current field in a separate window. This is useful for fields that
+are not fully visible (@pxref{Column width and alignment}). When called with
+a @kbd{C-u} prefix, just make the full field visible, so that it can be
+edited in place.
+@c
+@item M-x org-table-import
+Import a file as a table. The table should be TAB or whitespace
+separated. Use, for example, to import a spreadsheet table or data
+from a database, because these programs generally can write
+TAB-separated text files. This command works by inserting the file into
+the buffer and then converting the region to a table. Any prefix
+argument is passed on to the converter, which uses it to determine the
+separator.
+@orgcmd{C-c |,org-table-create-or-convert-from-region}
+Tables can also be imported by pasting tabular text into the Org
+buffer, selecting the pasted text with @kbd{C-x C-x} and then using the
+@kbd{C-c |} command (see above under @i{Creation and conversion}).
+@c
+@item M-x org-table-export
+@findex org-table-export
+@vindex org-table-export-default-format
+Export the table, by default as a TAB-separated file. Use for data
+exchange with, for example, spreadsheet or database programs. The format
+used to export the file can be configured in the variable
+@code{org-table-export-default-format}. You may also use properties
+@code{TABLE_EXPORT_FILE} and @code{TABLE_EXPORT_FORMAT} to specify the file
+name and the format for table export in a subtree. Org supports quite
+general formats for exported tables. The exporter format is the same as the
+format used by Orgtbl radio tables, see @ref{Translator functions}, for a
+detailed description.
+@end table
+
+If you don't like the automatic table editor because it gets in your
+way on lines which you would like to start with @samp{|}, you can turn
+it off with
+
+@lisp
+(setq org-enable-table-editor nil)
+@end lisp
+
+@noindent Then the only table command that still works is
+@kbd{C-c C-c} to do a manual re-align.
+
+@node Column width and alignment, Column groups, Built-in table editor, Tables
+@section Column width and alignment
+@cindex narrow columns in tables
+@cindex alignment in tables
+
+The width of columns is automatically determined by the table editor. And
+also the alignment of a column is determined automatically from the fraction
+of number-like versus non-number fields in the column.
+
+Sometimes a single field or a few fields need to carry more text, leading to
+inconveniently wide columns. Or maybe you want to make a table with several
+columns having a fixed width, regardless of content. To set@footnote{This
+feature does not work on XEmacs.} the width of a column, one field anywhere
+in the column may contain just the string @samp{<N>} where @samp{N} is an
+integer specifying the width of the column in characters. The next re-align
+will then set the width of this column to this value.
+
+@example
+@group
+|---+------------------------------| |---+--------|
+| | | | | <6> |
+| 1 | one | | 1 | one |
+| 2 | two | ----\ | 2 | two |
+| 3 | This is a long chunk of text | ----/ | 3 | This=> |
+| 4 | four | | 4 | four |
+|---+------------------------------| |---+--------|
+@end group
+@end example
+
+@noindent
+Fields that are wider become clipped and end in the string @samp{=>}.
+Note that the full text is still in the buffer but is hidden.
+To see the full text, hold the mouse over the field---a tool-tip window
+will show the full content. To edit such a field, use the command
+@kbd{C-c `} (that is @kbd{C-c} followed by the backquote). This will
+open a new window with the full field. Edit it and finish with @kbd{C-c
+C-c}.
+
+@vindex org-startup-align-all-tables
+When visiting a file containing a table with narrowed columns, the
+necessary character hiding has not yet happened, and the table needs to
+be aligned before it looks nice. Setting the option
+@code{org-startup-align-all-tables} will realign all tables in a file
+upon visiting, but also slow down startup. You can also set this option
+on a per-file basis with:
+
+@example
+#+STARTUP: align
+#+STARTUP: noalign
+@end example
+
+If you would like to overrule the automatic alignment of number-rich columns
+to the right and of string-rich column to the left, you can use @samp{<r>},
+@samp{c}@footnote{Centering does not work inside Emacs, but it does have an
+effect when exporting to HTML.} or @samp{<l>} in a similar fashion. You may
+also combine alignment and field width like this: @samp{<l10>}.
+
+Lines which only contain these formatting cookies will be removed
+automatically when exporting the document.
+
+@node Column groups, Orgtbl mode, Column width and alignment, Tables
+@section Column groups
+@cindex grouping columns in tables
+
+When Org exports tables, it does so by default without vertical
+lines because that is visually more satisfying in general. Occasionally
+however, vertical lines can be useful to structure a table into groups
+of columns, much like horizontal lines can do for groups of rows. In
+order to specify column groups, you can use a special row where the
+first field contains only @samp{/}. The further fields can either
+contain @samp{<} to indicate that this column should start a group,
+@samp{>} to indicate the end of a column, or @samp{<>} to make a column
+a group of its own. Boundaries between column groups will upon export be
+marked with vertical lines. Here is an example:
+
+@example
+| N | N^2 | N^3 | N^4 | sqrt(n) | sqrt[4](N) |
+|---+-----+-----+-----+---------+------------|
+| / | < | | > | < | > |
+| 1 | 1 | 1 | 1 | 1 | 1 |
+| 2 | 4 | 8 | 16 | 1.4142 | 1.1892 |
+| 3 | 9 | 27 | 81 | 1.7321 | 1.3161 |
+|---+-----+-----+-----+---------+------------|
+#+TBLFM: $2=$1^2::$3=$1^3::$4=$1^4::$5=sqrt($1)::$6=sqrt(sqrt(($1)))
+@end example
+
+It is also sufficient to just insert the column group starters after
+every vertical line you would like to have:
+
+@example
+| N | N^2 | N^3 | N^4 | sqrt(n) | sqrt[4](N) |
+|----+-----+-----+-----+---------+------------|
+| / | < | | | < | |
+@end example
+
+@node Orgtbl mode, The spreadsheet, Column groups, Tables
+@section The Orgtbl minor mode
+@cindex Orgtbl mode
+@cindex minor mode for tables
+
+If you like the intuitive way the Org table editor works, you
+might also want to use it in other modes like Text mode or Mail mode.
+The minor mode Orgtbl mode makes this possible. You can always toggle
+the mode with @kbd{M-x orgtbl-mode}. To turn it on by default, for
+example in mail mode, use
+
+@lisp
+(add-hook 'mail-mode-hook 'turn-on-orgtbl)
+@end lisp
+
+Furthermore, with some special setup, it is possible to maintain tables
+in arbitrary syntax with Orgtbl mode. For example, it is possible to
+construct @LaTeX{} tables with the underlying ease and power of
+Orgtbl mode, including spreadsheet capabilities. For details, see
+@ref{Tables in arbitrary syntax}.
+
+@node The spreadsheet, Org-Plot, Orgtbl mode, Tables
+@section The spreadsheet
+@cindex calculations, in tables
+@cindex spreadsheet capabilities
+@cindex @file{calc} package
+
+The table editor makes use of the Emacs @file{calc} package to implement
+spreadsheet-like capabilities. It can also evaluate Emacs Lisp forms to
+derive fields from other fields. While fully featured, Org's implementation
+is not identical to other spreadsheets. For example, Org knows the concept
+of a @emph{column formula} that will be applied to all non-header fields in a
+column without having to copy the formula to each relevant field. There is
+also a formula debugger, and a formula editor with features for highlighting
+fields in the table corresponding to the references at the point in the
+formula, moving these references by arrow keys
+
+@menu
+* References:: How to refer to another field or range
+* Formula syntax for Calc:: Using Calc to compute stuff
+* Formula syntax for Lisp:: Writing formulas in Emacs Lisp
+* Field formulas:: Formulas valid for a single field
+* Column formulas:: Formulas valid for an entire column
+* Editing and debugging formulas:: Fixing formulas
+* Updating the table:: Recomputing all dependent fields
+* Advanced features:: Field names, parameters and automatic recalc
+@end menu
+
+@node References, Formula syntax for Calc, The spreadsheet, The spreadsheet
+@subsection References
+@cindex references
+
+To compute fields in the table from other fields, formulas must
+reference other fields or ranges. In Org, fields can be referenced
+by name, by absolute coordinates, and by relative coordinates. To find
+out what the coordinates of a field are, press @kbd{C-c ?} in that
+field, or press @kbd{C-c @}} to toggle the display of a grid.
+
+@subsubheading Field references
+@cindex field references
+@cindex references, to fields
+
+Formulas can reference the value of another field in two ways. Like in
+any other spreadsheet, you may reference fields with a letter/number
+combination like @code{B3}, meaning the 2nd field in the 3rd row.
+@c Such references are always fixed to that field, they don't change
+@c when you copy and paste a formula to a different field. So
+@c Org's @code{B3} behaves like @code{$B$3} in other spreadsheets.
+
+@noindent
+Org also uses another, more general operator that looks like this:
+@example
+@@@var{row}$@var{column}
+@end example
+
+@noindent
+Column references can be absolute like @samp{1}, @samp{2},...@samp{@var{N}},
+or relative to the current column like @samp{+1} or @samp{-2}.
+
+The row specification only counts data lines and ignores horizontal
+separator lines (hlines). You can use absolute row numbers
+@samp{1}...@samp{@var{N}}, and row numbers relative to the current row like
+@samp{+3} or @samp{-1}. Or specify the row relative to one of the
+hlines: @samp{I} refers to the first hline@footnote{Note that only
+hlines are counted that @emph{separate} table lines. If the table
+starts with a hline above the header, it does not count.}, @samp{II} to
+the second, etc@. @samp{-I} refers to the first such line above the
+current line, @samp{+I} to the first such line below the current line.
+You can also write @samp{III+2} which is the second data line after the
+third hline in the table.
+
+@samp{0} refers to the current row and column. Also, if you omit
+either the column or the row part of the reference, the current
+row/column is implied.
+
+Org's references with @emph{unsigned} numbers are fixed references
+in the sense that if you use the same reference in the formula for two
+different fields, the same field will be referenced each time.
+Org's references with @emph{signed} numbers are floating
+references because the same reference operator can reference different
+fields depending on the field being calculated by the formula.
+
+As a special case, references like @samp{$LR5} and @samp{$LR12} can be used
+to refer in a stable way to the 5th and 12th field in the last row of the
+table.
+
+Here are a few examples:
+
+@example
+@@2$3 @r{2nd row, 3rd column}
+C2 @r{same as previous}
+$5 @r{column 5 in the current row}
+E& @r{same as previous}
+@@2 @r{current column, row 2}
+@@-1$-3 @r{the field one row up, three columns to the left}
+@@-I$2 @r{field just under hline above current row, column 2}
+@end example
+
+@subsubheading Range references
+@cindex range references
+@cindex references, to ranges
+
+You may reference a rectangular range of fields by specifying two field
+references connected by two dots @samp{..}. If both fields are in the
+current row, you may simply use @samp{$2..$7}, but if at least one field
+is in a different row, you need to use the general @code{@@row$column}
+format at least for the first field (i.e the reference must start with
+@samp{@@} in order to be interpreted correctly). Examples:
+
+@example
+$1..$3 @r{First three fields in the current row.}
+$P..$Q @r{Range, using column names (see under Advanced)}
+@@2$1..@@4$3 @r{6 fields between these two fields.}
+A2..C4 @r{Same as above.}
+@@-1$-2..@@-1 @r{3 numbers from the column to the left, 2 up to current row}
+@end example
+
+@noindent Range references return a vector of values that can be fed
+into Calc vector functions. Empty fields in ranges are normally
+suppressed, so that the vector contains only the non-empty fields (but
+see the @samp{E} mode switch below). If there are no non-empty fields,
+@samp{[0]} is returned to avoid syntax errors in formulas.
+
+@subsubheading Field coordinates in formulas
+@cindex field coordinates
+@cindex coordinates, of field
+@cindex row, of field coordinates
+@cindex column, of field coordinates
+
+For Calc formulas and Lisp formulas @code{@@#} and @code{$#} can be used to
+get the row or column number of the field where the formula result goes.
+The traditional Lisp formula equivalents are @code{org-table-current-dline}
+and @code{org-table-current-column}. Examples:
+
+@example
+if(@@# % 2, $#, string("")) @r{column number on odd lines only}
+$3 = remote(FOO, @@@@#$2) @r{copy column 2 from table FOO into}
+ @r{column 3 of the current table}
+@end example
+
+@noindent For the second example, table FOO must have at least as many rows
+as the current table. Inefficient@footnote{The computation time scales as
+O(N^2) because table FOO is parsed for each field to be copied.} for large
+number of rows.
+
+@subsubheading Named references
+@cindex named references
+@cindex references, named
+@cindex name, of column or field
+@cindex constants, in calculations
+@cindex #+CONSTANTS
+
+@vindex org-table-formula-constants
+@samp{$name} is interpreted as the name of a column, parameter or
+constant. Constants are defined globally through the variable
+@code{org-table-formula-constants}, and locally (for the file) through a
+line like
+
+@example
+#+CONSTANTS: c=299792458. pi=3.14 eps=2.4e-6
+@end example
+
+@noindent
+@vindex constants-unit-system
+@pindex constants.el
+Also properties (@pxref{Properties and Columns}) can be used as
+constants in table formulas: for a property @samp{:Xyz:} use the name
+@samp{$PROP_Xyz}, and the property will be searched in the current
+outline entry and in the hierarchy above it. If you have the
+@file{constants.el} package, it will also be used to resolve constants,
+including natural constants like @samp{$h} for Planck's constant, and
+units like @samp{$km} for kilometers@footnote{@file{constants.el} can
+supply the values of constants in two different unit systems, @code{SI}
+and @code{cgs}. Which one is used depends on the value of the variable
+@code{constants-unit-system}. You can use the @code{#+STARTUP} options
+@code{constSI} and @code{constcgs} to set this value for the current
+buffer.}. Column names and parameters can be specified in special table
+lines. These are described below, see @ref{Advanced features}. All
+names must start with a letter, and further consist of letters and
+numbers.
+
+@subsubheading Remote references
+@cindex remote references
+@cindex references, remote
+@cindex references, to a different table
+@cindex name, of column or field
+@cindex constants, in calculations
+@cindex #+TBLNAME
+
+You may also reference constants, fields and ranges from a different table,
+either in the current file or even in a different file. The syntax is
+
+@example
+remote(NAME-OR-ID,REF)
+@end example
+
+@noindent
+where NAME can be the name of a table in the current file as set by a
+@code{#+TBLNAME: NAME} line before the table. It can also be the ID of an
+entry, even in a different file, and the reference then refers to the first
+table in that entry. REF is an absolute field or range reference as
+described above for example @code{@@3$3} or @code{$somename}, valid in the
+referenced table.
+
+@node Formula syntax for Calc, Formula syntax for Lisp, References, The spreadsheet
+@subsection Formula syntax for Calc
+@cindex formula syntax, Calc
+@cindex syntax, of formulas
+
+A formula can be any algebraic expression understood by the Emacs
+@file{Calc} package. @b{Note that @file{calc} has the
+non-standard convention that @samp{/} has lower precedence than
+@samp{*}, so that @samp{a/b*c} is interpreted as @samp{a/(b*c)}.} Before
+evaluation by @code{calc-eval} (@pxref{Calling Calc from
+Your Programs,calc-eval,Calling Calc from Your Lisp Programs,Calc,GNU
+Emacs Calc Manual}),
+@c FIXME: The link to the Calc manual in HTML does not work.
+variable substitution takes place according to the rules described above.
+@cindex vectors, in table calculations
+The range vectors can be directly fed into the Calc vector functions
+like @samp{vmean} and @samp{vsum}.
+
+@cindex format specifier
+@cindex mode, for @file{calc}
+@vindex org-calc-default-modes
+A formula can contain an optional mode string after a semicolon. This
+string consists of flags to influence Calc and other modes during
+execution. By default, Org uses the standard Calc modes (precision
+12, angular units degrees, fraction and symbolic modes off). The display
+format, however, has been changed to @code{(float 8)} to keep tables
+compact. The default settings can be configured using the variable
+@code{org-calc-default-modes}.
+
+@example
+p20 @r{set the internal Calc calculation precision to 20 digits}
+n3 s3 e2 f4 @r{Normal, scientific, engineering, or fixed}
+ @r{format of the result of Calc passed back to Org.}
+ @r{Calc formatting is unlimited in precision as}
+ @r{long as the Calc calculation precision is greater.}
+D R @r{angle modes: degrees, radians}
+F S @r{fraction and symbolic modes}
+N @r{interpret all fields as numbers, use 0 for non-numbers}
+T @r{force text interpretation}
+E @r{keep empty fields in ranges}
+L @r{literal}
+@end example
+
+@noindent
+Unless you use large integer numbers or high-precision-calculation
+and -display for floating point numbers you may alternatively provide a
+@code{printf} format specifier to reformat the Calc result after it has been
+passed back to Org instead of letting Calc already do the
+formatting@footnote{The @code{printf} reformatting is limited in precision
+because the value passed to it is converted into an @code{integer} or
+@code{double}. The @code{integer} is limited in size by truncating the
+signed value to 32 bits. The @code{double} is limited in precision to 64
+bits overall which leaves approximately 16 significant decimal digits.}.
+A few examples:
+
+@example
+$1+$2 @r{Sum of first and second field}
+$1+$2;%.2f @r{Same, format result to two decimals}
+exp($2)+exp($1) @r{Math functions can be used}
+$0;%.1f @r{Reformat current cell to 1 decimal}
+($3-32)*5/9 @r{Degrees F -> C conversion}
+$c/$1/$cm @r{Hz -> cm conversion, using @file{constants.el}}
+tan($1);Dp3s1 @r{Compute in degrees, precision 3, display SCI 1}
+sin($1);Dp3%.1e @r{Same, but use printf specifier for display}
+vmean($2..$7) @r{Compute column range mean, using vector function}
+vmean($2..$7);EN @r{Same, but treat empty fields as 0}
+taylor($3,x=7,2) @r{Taylor series of $3, at x=7, second degree}
+@end example
+
+Calc also contains a complete set of logical operations. For example
+
+@example
+if($1<20,teen,string("")) @r{``teen'' if age $1 less than 20, else empty}
+@end example
+
+@node Formula syntax for Lisp, Field formulas, Formula syntax for Calc, The spreadsheet
+@subsection Emacs Lisp forms as formulas
+@cindex Lisp forms, as table formulas
+
+It is also possible to write a formula in Emacs Lisp; this can be useful for
+string manipulation and control structures, if Calc's functionality is not
+enough. If a formula starts with a single-quote followed by an opening
+parenthesis, then it is evaluated as a Lisp form. The evaluation should
+return either a string or a number. Just as with @file{calc} formulas, you
+can specify modes and a printf format after a semicolon. With Emacs Lisp
+forms, you need to be conscious about the way field references are
+interpolated into the form. By default, a reference will be interpolated as
+a Lisp string (in double-quotes) containing the field. If you provide the
+@samp{N} mode switch, all referenced elements will be numbers (non-number
+fields will be zero) and interpolated as Lisp numbers, without quotes. If
+you provide the @samp{L} flag, all fields will be interpolated literally,
+without quotes. I.e., if you want a reference to be interpreted as a string
+by the Lisp form, enclose the reference operator itself in double-quotes,
+like @code{"$3"}. Ranges are inserted as space-separated fields, so you can
++embed them in list or vector syntax. Here are a few examples---note how the
+@samp{N} mode is used when we do computations in Lisp:
+
+@example
+@r{Swap the first two characters of the content of column 1}
+ '(concat (substring $1 1 2) (substring $1 0 1) (substring $1 2))
+@r{Add columns 1 and 2, equivalent to Calc's @code{$1+$2}}
+ '(+ $1 $2);N
+@r{Compute the sum of columns 1-4, like Calc's @code{vsum($1..$4)}}
+ '(apply '+ '($1..$4));N
+@end example
+
+@node Field formulas, Column formulas, Formula syntax for Lisp, The spreadsheet
+@subsection Field formulas
+@cindex field formula
+@cindex formula, for individual table field
+
+To assign a formula to a particular field, type it directly into the
+field, preceded by @samp{:=}, for example @samp{:=$1+$2}. When you
+press @key{TAB} or @key{RET} or @kbd{C-c C-c} with the cursor still in
+the field, the formula will be stored as the formula for this field,
+evaluated, and the current field replaced with the result.
+
+@cindex #+TBLFM
+Formulas are stored in a special line starting with @samp{#+TBLFM:}
+directly below the table. If you type the equation in the 4th field of
+the 3rd data line in the table, the formula will look like
+@samp{@@3$4=$1+$2}. When inserting/deleting/swapping column and rows
+with the appropriate commands, @i{absolute references} (but not relative
+ones) in stored formulas are modified in order to still reference the
+same field. Of course this is not true if you edit the table structure
+with normal editing commands---then you must fix the equations yourself.
+The left-hand side of a formula may also be a named field (@pxref{Advanced
+features}), or a last-row reference like @samp{$LR3}.
+
+Instead of typing an equation into the field, you may also use the
+following command
+
+@table @kbd
+@orgcmd{C-u C-c =,org-table-eval-formula}
+Install a new formula for the current field. The command prompts for a
+formula with default taken from the @samp{#+TBLFM:} line, applies
+it to the current field, and stores it.
+@end table
+
+@node Column formulas, Editing and debugging formulas, Field formulas, The spreadsheet
+@subsection Column formulas
+@cindex column formula
+@cindex formula, for table column
+
+Often in a table, the same formula should be used for all fields in a
+particular column. Instead of having to copy the formula to all fields
+in that column, Org allows you to assign a single formula to an entire
+column. If the table contains horizontal separator hlines, everything
+before the first such line is considered part of the table @emph{header}
+and will not be modified by column formulas.
+
+To assign a formula to a column, type it directly into any field in the
+column, preceded by an equal sign, like @samp{=$1+$2}. When you press
+@key{TAB} or @key{RET} or @kbd{C-c C-c} with the cursor still in the field,
+the formula will be stored as the formula for the current column, evaluated
+and the current field replaced with the result. If the field contains only
+@samp{=}, the previously stored formula for this column is used. For each
+column, Org will only remember the most recently used formula. In the
+@samp{#+TBLFM:} line, column formulas will look like @samp{$4=$1+$2}. The left-hand
+side of a column formula cannot currently be the name of column, it
+must be the numeric column reference.
+
+Instead of typing an equation into the field, you may also use the
+following command:
+
+@table @kbd
+@orgcmd{C-c =,org-table-eval-formula}
+Install a new formula for the current column and replace current field with
+the result of the formula. The command prompts for a formula, with default
+taken from the @samp{#+TBLFM} line, applies it to the current field and
+stores it. With a numeric prefix argument(e.g. @kbd{C-5 C-c =}) the command
+will apply it to that many consecutive fields in the current column.
+@end table
+
+@node Editing and debugging formulas, Updating the table, Column formulas, The spreadsheet
+@subsection Editing and debugging formulas
+@cindex formula editing
+@cindex editing, of table formulas
+
+@vindex org-table-use-standard-references
+You can edit individual formulas in the minibuffer or directly in the
+field. Org can also prepare a special buffer with all active
+formulas of a table. When offering a formula for editing, Org
+converts references to the standard format (like @code{B3} or @code{D&})
+if possible. If you prefer to only work with the internal format (like
+@code{@@3$2} or @code{$4}), configure the variable
+@code{org-table-use-standard-references}.
+
+@table @kbd
+@orgcmdkkc{C-c =,C-u C-c =,org-table-eval-formula}
+Edit the formula associated with the current column/field in the
+minibuffer. See @ref{Column formulas}, and @ref{Field formulas}.
+@orgcmd{C-u C-u C-c =,org-table-eval-formula}
+Re-insert the active formula (either a
+field formula, or a column formula) into the current field, so that you
+can edit it directly in the field. The advantage over editing in the
+minibuffer is that you can use the command @kbd{C-c ?}.
+@orgcmd{C-c ?,org-table-field-info}
+While editing a formula in a table field, highlight the field(s)
+referenced by the reference at the cursor position in the formula.
+@kindex C-c @}
+@findex org-table-toggle-coordinate-overlays
+@item C-c @}
+Toggle the display of row and column numbers for a table, using overlays
+(@command{org-table-toggle-coordinate-overlays}). These are updated each
+time the table is aligned; you can force it with @kbd{C-c C-c}.
+@kindex C-c @{
+@findex org-table-toggle-formula-debugger
+@item C-c @{
+Toggle the formula debugger on and off
+(@command{org-table-toggle-formula-debugger}). See below.
+@orgcmd{C-c ',org-table-edit-formulas}
+Edit all formulas for the current table in a special buffer, where the
+formulas will be displayed one per line. If the current field has an
+active formula, the cursor in the formula editor will mark it.
+While inside the special buffer, Org will automatically highlight
+any field or range reference at the cursor position. You may edit,
+remove and add formulas, and use the following commands:
+@table @kbd
+@orgcmdkkc{C-c C-c,C-x C-s,org-table-fedit-finish}
+Exit the formula editor and store the modified formulas. With @kbd{C-u}
+prefix, also apply the new formulas to the entire table.
+@orgcmd{C-c C-q,org-table-fedit-abort}
+Exit the formula editor without installing changes.
+@orgcmd{C-c C-r,org-table-fedit-toggle-ref-type}
+Toggle all references in the formula editor between standard (like
+@code{B3}) and internal (like @code{@@3$2}).
+@orgcmd{@key{TAB},org-table-fedit-lisp-indent}
+Pretty-print or indent Lisp formula at point. When in a line containing
+a Lisp formula, format the formula according to Emacs Lisp rules.
+Another @key{TAB} collapses the formula back again. In the open
+formula, @key{TAB} re-indents just like in Emacs Lisp mode.
+@orgcmd{M-@key{TAB},lisp-complete-symbol}
+Complete Lisp symbols, just like in Emacs Lisp mode.
+@kindex S-@key{up}
+@kindex S-@key{down}
+@kindex S-@key{left}
+@kindex S-@key{right}
+@findex org-table-fedit-ref-up
+@findex org-table-fedit-ref-down
+@findex org-table-fedit-ref-left
+@findex org-table-fedit-ref-right
+@item S-@key{up}/@key{down}/@key{left}/@key{right}
+Shift the reference at point. For example, if the reference is
+@code{B3} and you press @kbd{S-@key{right}}, it will become @code{C3}.
+This also works for relative references and for hline references.
+@orgcmdkkcc{M-S-@key{up},M-S-@key{down},org-table-fedit-line-up,org-table-fedit-line-down}
+Move the test line for column formulas in the Org buffer up and
+down.
+@orgcmdkkcc{M-@key{up},M-@key{down},org-table-fedit-scroll-down,org-table-fedit-scroll-up}
+Scroll the window displaying the table.
+@kindex C-c @}
+@findex org-table-toggle-coordinate-overlays
+@item C-c @}
+Turn the coordinate grid in the table on and off.
+@end table
+@end table
+
+Making a table field blank does not remove the formula associated with
+the field, because that is stored in a different line (the @samp{#+TBLFM}
+line)---during the next recalculation the field will be filled again.
+To remove a formula from a field, you have to give an empty reply when
+prompted for the formula, or to edit the @samp{#+TBLFM} line.
+
+@kindex C-c C-c
+You may edit the @samp{#+TBLFM} directly and re-apply the changed
+equations with @kbd{C-c C-c} in that line or with the normal
+recalculation commands in the table.
+
+@subsubheading Debugging formulas
+@cindex formula debugging
+@cindex debugging, of table formulas
+When the evaluation of a formula leads to an error, the field content
+becomes the string @samp{#ERROR}. If you would like see what is going
+on during variable substitution and calculation in order to find a bug,
+turn on formula debugging in the @code{Tbl} menu and repeat the
+calculation, for example by pressing @kbd{C-u C-u C-c = @key{RET}} in a
+field. Detailed information will be displayed.
+
+@node Updating the table, Advanced features, Editing and debugging formulas, The spreadsheet
+@subsection Updating the table
+@cindex recomputing table fields
+@cindex updating, table
+
+Recalculation of a table is normally not automatic, but needs to be
+triggered by a command. See @ref{Advanced features}, for a way to make
+recalculation at least semi-automatic.
+
+In order to recalculate a line of a table or the entire table, use the
+following commands:
+
+@table @kbd
+@orgcmd{C-c *,org-table-recalculate}
+Recalculate the current row by first applying the stored column formulas
+from left to right, and all field formulas in the current row.
+@c
+@kindex C-u C-c *
+@item C-u C-c *
+@kindex C-u C-c C-c
+@itemx C-u C-c C-c
+Recompute the entire table, line by line. Any lines before the first
+hline are left alone, assuming that these are part of the table header.
+@c
+@orgcmdkkc{C-u C-u C-c *,C-u C-u C-c C-c,org-table-iterate}
+Iterate the table by recomputing it until no further changes occur.
+This may be necessary if some computed fields use the value of other
+fields that are computed @i{later} in the calculation sequence.
+@item M-x org-table-recalculate-buffer-tables
+@findex org-table-recalculate-buffer-tables
+Recompute all tables in the current buffer.
+@item M-x org-table-iterate-buffer-tables
+@findex org-table-iterate-buffer-tables
+Iterate all tables in the current buffer, in order to converge table-to-table
+dependencies.
+@end table
+
+@node Advanced features, , Updating the table, The spreadsheet
+@subsection Advanced features
+
+If you want the recalculation of fields to happen automatically, or if
+you want to be able to assign @i{names} to fields and columns, you need
+to reserve the first column of the table for special marking characters.
+@table @kbd
+@orgcmd{C-#,org-table-rotate-recalc-marks}
+Rotate the calculation mark in first column through the states @samp{ },
+@samp{#}, @samp{*}, @samp{!}, @samp{$}. When there is an active region,
+change all marks in the region.
+@end table
+
+Here is an example of a table that collects exam results of students and
+makes use of these features:
+
+@example
+@group
+|---+---------+--------+--------+--------+-------+------|
+| | Student | Prob 1 | Prob 2 | Prob 3 | Total | Note |
+|---+---------+--------+--------+--------+-------+------|
+| ! | | P1 | P2 | P3 | Tot | |
+| # | Maximum | 10 | 15 | 25 | 50 | 10.0 |
+| ^ | | m1 | m2 | m3 | mt | |
+|---+---------+--------+--------+--------+-------+------|
+| # | Peter | 10 | 8 | 23 | 41 | 8.2 |
+| # | Sam | 2 | 4 | 3 | 9 | 1.8 |
+|---+---------+--------+--------+--------+-------+------|
+| | Average | | | | 29.7 | |
+| ^ | | | | | at | |
+| $ | max=50 | | | | | |
+|---+---------+--------+--------+--------+-------+------|
+#+TBLFM: $6=vsum($P1..$P3)::$7=10*$Tot/$max;%.1f::$at=vmean(@@-II..@@-I);%.1f
+@end group
+@end example
+
+@noindent @b{Important}: please note that for these special tables,
+recalculating the table with @kbd{C-u C-c *} will only affect rows that
+are marked @samp{#} or @samp{*}, and fields that have a formula assigned
+to the field itself. The column formulas are not applied in rows with
+empty first field.
+
+@cindex marking characters, tables
+The marking characters have the following meaning:
+@table @samp
+@item !
+The fields in this line define names for the columns, so that you may
+refer to a column as @samp{$Tot} instead of @samp{$6}.
+@item ^
+This row defines names for the fields @emph{above} the row. With such
+a definition, any formula in the table may use @samp{$m1} to refer to
+the value @samp{10}. Also, if you assign a formula to a names field, it
+will be stored as @samp{$name=...}.
+@item _
+Similar to @samp{^}, but defines names for the fields in the row
+@emph{below}.
+@item $
+Fields in this row can define @emph{parameters} for formulas. For
+example, if a field in a @samp{$} row contains @samp{max=50}, then
+formulas in this table can refer to the value 50 using @samp{$max}.
+Parameters work exactly like constants, only that they can be defined on
+a per-table basis.
+@item #
+Fields in this row are automatically recalculated when pressing
+@key{TAB} or @key{RET} or @kbd{S-@key{TAB}} in this row. Also, this row
+is selected for a global recalculation with @kbd{C-u C-c *}. Unmarked
+lines will be left alone by this command.
+@item *
+Selects this line for global recalculation with @kbd{C-u C-c *}, but
+not for automatic recalculation. Use this when automatic
+recalculation slows down editing too much.
+@item
+Unmarked lines are exempt from recalculation with @kbd{C-u C-c *}.
+All lines that should be recalculated should be marked with @samp{#}
+or @samp{*}.
+@item /
+Do not export this line. Useful for lines that contain the narrowing
+@samp{<N>} markers or column group markers.
+@end table
+
+Finally, just to whet your appetite for what can be done with the
+fantastic @file{calc.el} package, here is a table that computes the Taylor
+series of degree @code{n} at location @code{x} for a couple of
+functions.
+
+@example
+@group
+|---+-------------+---+-----+--------------------------------------|
+| | Func | n | x | Result |
+|---+-------------+---+-----+--------------------------------------|
+| # | exp(x) | 1 | x | 1 + x |
+| # | exp(x) | 2 | x | 1 + x + x^2 / 2 |
+| # | exp(x) | 3 | x | 1 + x + x^2 / 2 + x^3 / 6 |
+| # | x^2+sqrt(x) | 2 | x=0 | x*(0.5 / 0) + x^2 (2 - 0.25 / 0) / 2 |
+| # | x^2+sqrt(x) | 2 | x=1 | 2 + 2.5 x - 2.5 + 0.875 (x - 1)^2 |
+| * | tan(x) | 3 | x | 0.0175 x + 1.77e-6 x^3 |
+|---+-------------+---+-----+--------------------------------------|
+#+TBLFM: $5=taylor($2,$4,$3);n3
+@end group
+@end example
+
+@node Org-Plot, , The spreadsheet, Tables
+@section Org-Plot
+@cindex graph, in tables
+@cindex plot tables using Gnuplot
+@cindex #+PLOT
+
+Org-Plot can produce 2D and 3D graphs of information stored in org tables
+using @file{Gnuplot} @uref{http://www.gnuplot.info/} and @file{gnuplot-mode}
+@uref{http://cars9.uchicago.edu/~ravel/software/gnuplot-mode.html}. To see
+this in action, ensure that you have both Gnuplot and Gnuplot mode installed
+on your system, then call @code{org-plot/gnuplot} on the following table.
+
+@example
+@group
+#+PLOT: title:"Citas" ind:1 deps:(3) type:2d with:histograms set:"yrange [0:]"
+| Sede | Max cites | H-index |
+|-----------+-----------+---------|
+| Chile | 257.72 | 21.39 |
+| Leeds | 165.77 | 19.68 |
+| Sao Paolo | 71.00 | 11.50 |
+| Stockholm | 134.19 | 14.33 |
+| Morelia | 257.56 | 17.67 |
+@end group
+@end example
+
+Notice that Org Plot is smart enough to apply the table's headers as labels.
+Further control over the labels, type, content, and appearance of plots can
+be exercised through the @code{#+PLOT:} lines preceding a table. See below
+for a complete list of Org-plot options. For more information and examples
+see the Org-plot tutorial at
+@uref{http://orgmode.org/worg/org-tutorials/org-plot.php}.
+
+@subsubheading Plot Options
+
+@table @code
+@item set
+Specify any @command{gnuplot} option to be set when graphing.
+
+@item title
+Specify the title of the plot.
+
+@item ind
+Specify which column of the table to use as the @code{x} axis.
+
+@item deps
+Specify the columns to graph as a Lisp style list, surrounded by parentheses
+and separated by spaces for example @code{dep:(3 4)} to graph the third and
+fourth columns (defaults to graphing all other columns aside from the @code{ind}
+column).
+
+@item type
+Specify whether the plot will be @code{2d}, @code{3d}, or @code{grid}.
+
+@item with
+Specify a @code{with} option to be inserted for every col being plotted
+(e.g. @code{lines}, @code{points}, @code{boxes}, @code{impulses}, etc...).
+Defaults to @code{lines}.
+
+@item file
+If you want to plot to a file, specify @code{"@var{path/to/desired/output-file}"}.
+
+@item labels
+List of labels to be used for the @code{deps} (defaults to the column headers
+if they exist).
+
+@item line
+Specify an entire line to be inserted in the Gnuplot script.
+
+@item map
+When plotting @code{3d} or @code{grid} types, set this to @code{t} to graph a
+flat mapping rather than a @code{3d} slope.
+
+@item timefmt
+Specify format of Org-mode timestamps as they will be parsed by Gnuplot.
+Defaults to @samp{%Y-%m-%d-%H:%M:%S}.
+
+@item script
+If you want total control, you can specify a script file (place the file name
+between double-quotes) which will be used to plot. Before plotting, every
+instance of @code{$datafile} in the specified script will be replaced with
+the path to the generated data file. Note: even if you set this option, you
+may still want to specify the plot type, as that can impact the content of
+the data file.
+@end table
+
+@node Hyperlinks, TODO Items, Tables, Top
+@chapter Hyperlinks
+@cindex hyperlinks
+
+Like HTML, Org provides links inside a file, external links to
+other files, Usenet articles, emails, and much more.
+
+@menu
+* Link format:: How links in Org are formatted
+* Internal links:: Links to other places in the current file
+* External links:: URL-like links to the world
+* Handling links:: Creating, inserting and following
+* Using links outside Org:: Linking from my C source code?
+* Link abbreviations:: Shortcuts for writing complex links
+* Search options:: Linking to a specific location
+* Custom searches:: When the default search is not enough
+@end menu
+
+@node Link format, Internal links, Hyperlinks, Hyperlinks
+@section Link format
+@cindex link format
+@cindex format, of links
+
+Org will recognize plain URL-like links and activate them as
+clickable links. The general link format, however, looks like this:
+
+@example
+[[link][description]] @r{or alternatively} [[link]]
+@end example
+
+@noindent
+Once a link in the buffer is complete (all brackets present), Org
+will change the display so that @samp{description} is displayed instead
+of @samp{[[link][description]]} and @samp{link} is displayed instead of
+@samp{[[link]]}. Links will be highlighted in the face @code{org-link},
+which by default is an underlined face. You can directly edit the
+visible part of a link. Note that this can be either the @samp{link}
+part (if there is no description) or the @samp{description} part. To
+edit also the invisible @samp{link} part, use @kbd{C-c C-l} with the
+cursor on the link.
+
+If you place the cursor at the beginning or just behind the end of the
+displayed text and press @key{BACKSPACE}, you will remove the
+(invisible) bracket at that location. This makes the link incomplete
+and the internals are again displayed as plain text. Inserting the
+missing bracket hides the link internals again. To show the
+internal structure of all links, use the menu entry
+@code{Org->Hyperlinks->Literal links}.
+
+@node Internal links, External links, Link format, Hyperlinks
+@section Internal links
+@cindex internal links
+@cindex links, internal
+@cindex targets, for links
+
+@cindex property, CUSTOM_ID
+If the link does not look like a URL, it is considered to be internal in the
+current file. The most important case is a link like
+@samp{[[#my-custom-id]]} which will link to the entry with the
+@code{CUSTOM_ID} property @samp{my-custom-id}. Such custom IDs are very good
+for HTML export (@pxref{HTML export}) where they produce pretty section
+links. You are responsible yourself to make sure these custom IDs are unique
+in a file.
+
+Links such as @samp{[[My Target]]} or @samp{[[My Target][Find my target]]}
+lead to a text search in the current file.
+
+The link can be followed with @kbd{C-c C-o} when the cursor is on the link,
+or with a mouse click (@pxref{Handling links}). Links to custom IDs will
+point to the corresponding headline. The preferred match for a text link is
+a @i{dedicated target}: the same string in double angular brackets. Targets
+may be located anywhere; sometimes it is convenient to put them into a
+comment line. For example
+
+@example
+# <<My Target>>
+@end example
+
+@noindent In HTML export (@pxref{HTML export}), such targets will become
+named anchors for direct access through @samp{http} links@footnote{Note that
+text before the first headline is usually not exported, so the first such
+target should be after the first headline, or in the line directly before the
+first headline.}.
+
+If no dedicated target exists, Org will search for a headline that is exactly
+the link text but may also include a TODO keyword and tags@footnote{To insert
+a link targeting a headline, in-buffer completion can be used. Just type a
+star followed by a few optional letters into the buffer and press
+@kbd{M-@key{TAB}}. All headlines in the current buffer will be offered as
+completions.}. In non-Org files, the search will look for the words in the
+link text. In the above example the search would be for @samp{my target}.
+
+Following a link pushes a mark onto Org's own mark ring. You can
+return to the previous position with @kbd{C-c &}. Using this command
+several times in direct succession goes back to positions recorded
+earlier.
+
+@menu
+* Radio targets:: Make targets trigger links in plain text
+@end menu
+
+@node Radio targets, , Internal links, Internal links
+@subsection Radio targets
+@cindex radio targets
+@cindex targets, radio
+@cindex links, radio targets
+
+Org can automatically turn any occurrences of certain target names
+in normal text into a link. So without explicitly creating a link, the
+text connects to the target radioing its position. Radio targets are
+enclosed by triple angular brackets. For example, a target @samp{<<<My
+Target>>>} causes each occurrence of @samp{my target} in normal text to
+become activated as a link. The Org file is scanned automatically
+for radio targets only when the file is first loaded into Emacs. To
+update the target list during editing, press @kbd{C-c C-c} with the
+cursor on or at a target.
+
+@node External links, Handling links, Internal links, Hyperlinks
+@section External links
+@cindex links, external
+@cindex external links
+@cindex links, external
+@cindex Gnus links
+@cindex BBDB links
+@cindex IRC links
+@cindex URL links
+@cindex file links
+@cindex VM links
+@cindex RMAIL links
+@cindex WANDERLUST links
+@cindex MH-E links
+@cindex USENET links
+@cindex SHELL links
+@cindex Info links
+@cindex Elisp links
+
+Org supports links to files, websites, Usenet and email messages,
+BBDB database entries and links to both IRC conversations and their
+logs. External links are URL-like locators. They start with a short
+identifying string followed by a colon. There can be no space after
+the colon. The following list shows examples for each link type.
+
+@example
+http://www.astro.uva.nl/~dominik @r{on the web}
+doi:10.1000/182 @r{DOI for an electronic resource}
+file:/home/dominik/images/jupiter.jpg @r{file, absolute path}
+/home/dominik/images/jupiter.jpg @r{same as above}
+file:papers/last.pdf @r{file, relative path}
+./papers/last.pdf @r{same as above}
+file:/myself@@some.where:papers/last.pdf @r{file, path on remote machine}
+/myself@@some.where:papers/last.pdf @r{same as above}
+file:sometextfile::NNN @r{file with line number to jump to}
+file:projects.org @r{another Org file}
+file:projects.org::some words @r{text search in Org file}
+file:projects.org::*task title @r{heading search in Org file}
+docview:papers/last.pdf::NNN @r{open file in doc-view mode at page NNN}
+id:B7423F4D-2E8A-471B-8810-C40F074717E9 @r{Link to heading by ID}
+news:comp.emacs @r{Usenet link}
+mailto:adent@@galaxy.net @r{Mail link}
+vm:folder @r{VM folder link}
+vm:folder#id @r{VM message link}
+vm://myself@@some.where.org/folder#id @r{VM on remote machine}
+wl:folder @r{WANDERLUST folder link}
+wl:folder#id @r{WANDERLUST message link}
+mhe:folder @r{MH-E folder link}
+mhe:folder#id @r{MH-E message link}
+rmail:folder @r{RMAIL folder link}
+rmail:folder#id @r{RMAIL message link}
+gnus:group @r{Gnus group link}
+gnus:group#id @r{Gnus article link}
+bbdb:R.*Stallman @r{BBDB link (with regexp)}
+irc:/irc.com/#emacs/bob @r{IRC link}
+info:org:External%20links @r{Info node link (with encoded space)}
+shell:ls *.org @r{A shell command}
+elisp:org-agenda @r{Interactive Elisp command}
+elisp:(find-file-other-frame "Elisp.org") @r{Elisp form to evaluate}
+@end example
+
+A link should be enclosed in double brackets and may contain a
+descriptive text to be displayed instead of the URL (@pxref{Link
+format}), for example:
+
+@example
+[[http://www.gnu.org/software/emacs/][GNU Emacs]]
+@end example
+
+@noindent
+If the description is a file name or URL that points to an image, HTML
+export (@pxref{HTML export}) will inline the image as a clickable
+button. If there is no description at all and the link points to an
+image,
+that image will be inlined into the exported HTML file.
+
+@cindex square brackets, around links
+@cindex plain text external links
+Org also finds external links in the normal text and activates them
+as links. If spaces must be part of the link (for example in
+@samp{bbdb:Richard Stallman}), or if you need to remove ambiguities
+about the end of the link, enclose them in square brackets.
+
+@node Handling links, Using links outside Org, External links, Hyperlinks
+@section Handling links
+@cindex links, handling
+
+Org provides methods to create a link in the correct syntax, to
+insert it into an Org file, and to follow the link.
+
+@table @kbd
+@orgcmd{C-c l,org-store-link}
+@cindex storing links
+Store a link to the current location. This is a @emph{global} command (you
+must create the key binding yourself) which can be used in any buffer to
+create a link. The link will be stored for later insertion into an Org
+buffer (see below). What kind of link will be created depends on the current
+buffer:
+
+@b{Org-mode buffers}@*
+For Org files, if there is a @samp{<<target>>} at the cursor, the link points
+to the target. Otherwise it points to the current headline, which will also
+be the description.
+
+@vindex org-link-to-org-use-id
+@cindex property, CUSTOM_ID
+@cindex property, ID
+If the headline has a @code{CUSTOM_ID} property, a link to this custom ID
+will be stored. In addition or alternatively (depending on the value of
+@code{org-link-to-org-use-id}), a globally unique @code{ID} property will be
+created and/or used to construct a link. So using this command in Org
+buffers will potentially create two links: a human-readable from the custom
+ID, and one that is globally unique and works even if the entry is moved from
+file to file. Later, when inserting the link, you need to decide which one
+to use.
+
+@b{Email/News clients: VM, Rmail, Wanderlust, MH-E, Gnus}@*
+Pretty much all Emacs mail clients are supported. The link will point to the
+current article, or, in some GNUS buffers, to the group. The description is
+constructed from the author and the subject.
+
+@b{Web browsers: W3 and W3M}@*
+Here the link will be the current URL, with the page title as description.
+
+@b{Contacts: BBDB}@*
+Links created in a BBDB buffer will point to the current entry.
+
+@b{Chat: IRC}@*
+@vindex org-irc-link-to-logs
+For IRC links, if you set the variable @code{org-irc-link-to-logs} to
+@code{t}, a @samp{file:/} style link to the relevant point in the logs for
+the current conversation is created. Otherwise an @samp{irc:/} style link to
+the user/channel/server under the point will be stored.
+
+@b{Other files}@*
+For any other files, the link will point to the file, with a search string
+(@pxref{Search options}) pointing to the contents of the current line. If
+there is an active region, the selected words will form the basis of the
+search string. If the automatically created link is not working correctly or
+accurately enough, you can write custom functions to select the search string
+and to do the search for particular file types---see @ref{Custom searches}.
+The key binding @kbd{C-c l} is only a suggestion---see @ref{Installation}.
+
+@b{Agenda view}@*
+When the cursor is in an agenda view, the created link points to the
+entry referenced by the current line.
+
+@c
+@orgcmd{C-c C-l,org-insert-link}
+@cindex link completion
+@cindex completion, of links
+@cindex inserting links
+@vindex org-keep-stored-link-after-insertion
+Insert a link@footnote{ Note that you don't have to use this command to
+insert a link. Links in Org are plain text, and you can type or paste them
+straight into the buffer. By using this command, the links are automatically
+enclosed in double brackets, and you will be asked for the optional
+descriptive text.}. This prompts for a link to be inserted into the buffer.
+You can just type a link, using text for an internal link, or one of the link
+type prefixes mentioned in the examples above. The link will be inserted
+into the buffer@footnote{After insertion of a stored link, the link will be
+removed from the list of stored links. To keep it in the list later use, use
+a triple @kbd{C-u} prefix argument to @kbd{C-c C-l}, or configure the option
+@code{org-keep-stored-link-after-insertion}.}, along with a descriptive text.
+If some text was selected when this command is called, the selected text
+becomes the default description.
+
+@b{Inserting stored links}@*
+All links stored during the
+current session are part of the history for this prompt, so you can access
+them with @key{up} and @key{down} (or @kbd{M-p/n}).
+
+@b{Completion support}@* Completion with @key{TAB} will help you to insert
+valid link prefixes like @samp{http:} or @samp{ftp:}, including the prefixes
+defined through link abbreviations (@pxref{Link abbreviations}). If you
+press @key{RET} after inserting only the @var{prefix}, Org will offer
+specific completion support for some link types@footnote{This works by
+calling a special function @code{org-PREFIX-complete-link}.} For
+example, if you type @kbd{file @key{RET}}, file name completion (alternative
+access: @kbd{C-u C-c C-l}, see below) will be offered, and after @kbd{bbdb
+@key{RET}} you can complete contact names.
+@orgkey C-u C-c C-l
+@cindex file name completion
+@cindex completion, of file names
+When @kbd{C-c C-l} is called with a @kbd{C-u} prefix argument, a link to
+a file will be inserted and you may use file name completion to select
+the name of the file. The path to the file is inserted relative to the
+directory of the current Org file, if the linked file is in the current
+directory or in a sub-directory of it, or if the path is written relative
+to the current directory using @samp{../}. Otherwise an absolute path
+is used, if possible with @samp{~/} for your home directory. You can
+force an absolute path with two @kbd{C-u} prefixes.
+@c
+@item C-c C-l @ @r{(with cursor on existing link)}
+When the cursor is on an existing link, @kbd{C-c C-l} allows you to edit the
+link and description parts of the link.
+@c
+@cindex following links
+@orgcmd{C-c C-o,org-open-at-point}
+@vindex org-file-apps
+Open link at point. This will launch a web browser for URLs (using
+@command{browse-url-at-point}), run VM/MH-E/Wanderlust/Rmail/Gnus/BBDB for
+the corresponding links, and execute the command in a shell link. When the
+cursor is on an internal link, this command runs the corresponding search.
+When the cursor is on a TAG list in a headline, it creates the corresponding
+TAGS view. If the cursor is on a timestamp, it compiles the agenda for that
+date. Furthermore, it will visit text and remote files in @samp{file:} links
+with Emacs and select a suitable application for local non-text files.
+Classification of files is based on file extension only. See option
+@code{org-file-apps}. If you want to override the default application and
+visit the file with Emacs, use a @kbd{C-u} prefix. If you want to avoid
+opening in Emacs, use a @kbd{C-u C-u} prefix.@*
+If the cursor is on a headline, but not on a link, offer all links in the
+headline and entry text.
+@orgkey @key{RET}
+@vindex org-return-follows-link
+When @code{org-return-follows-link} is set, @kbd{@key{RET}} will also follow
+the link at point.
+@c
+@kindex mouse-2
+@kindex mouse-1
+@item mouse-2
+@itemx mouse-1
+On links, @kbd{mouse-2} will open the link just as @kbd{C-c C-o}
+would. Under Emacs 22 and later, @kbd{mouse-1} will also follow a link.
+@c
+@kindex mouse-3
+@item mouse-3
+@vindex org-display-internal-link-with-indirect-buffer
+Like @kbd{mouse-2}, but force file links to be opened with Emacs, and
+internal links to be displayed in another window@footnote{See the
+variable @code{org-display-internal-link-with-indirect-buffer}}.
+@c
+@orgcmd{C-c C-x C-v,org-toggle-inline-images}
+@cindex inlining images
+@cindex images, inlining
+@vindex org-startup-with-inline-images
+@cindex @code{inlineimages}, STARTUP keyword
+@cindex @code{noinlineimages}, STARTUP keyword
+Toggle the inline display of linked images. Normally this will only inline
+images that have no description part in the link, i.e. images that will also
+be inlined during export. When called with a prefix argument, also display
+images that do have a link description. You can ask for inline images to be
+displayed at startup by configuring the variable
+@code{org-startup-with-inline-images}@footnote{with corresponding
+@code{#+STARTUP} keywords @code{inlineimages} and @code{inlineimages}}.
+@orgcmd{C-c %,org-mark-ring-push}
+@cindex mark ring
+Push the current position onto the mark ring, to be able to return
+easily. Commands following an internal link do this automatically.
+@c
+@orgcmd{C-c &,org-mark-ring-goto}
+@cindex links, returning to
+Jump back to a recorded position. A position is recorded by the
+commands following internal links, and by @kbd{C-c %}. Using this
+command several times in direct succession moves through a ring of
+previously recorded positions.
+@c
+@orgcmdkkcc{C-c C-x C-n,C-c C-x C-p,org-next-link,org-previous-link}
+@cindex links, finding next/previous
+Move forward/backward to the next link in the buffer. At the limit of
+the buffer, the search fails once, and then wraps around. The key
+bindings for this are really too long; you might want to bind this also
+to @kbd{C-n} and @kbd{C-p}
+@lisp
+(add-hook 'org-load-hook
+ (lambda ()
+ (define-key 'org-mode-map "\C-n" 'org-next-link)
+ (define-key 'org-mode-map "\C-p" 'org-previous-link)))
+@end lisp
+@end table
+
+@node Using links outside Org, Link abbreviations, Handling links, Hyperlinks
+@section Using links outside Org
+
+You can insert and follow links that have Org syntax not only in
+Org, but in any Emacs buffer. For this, you should create two
+global commands, like this (please select suitable global keys
+yourself):
+
+@lisp
+(global-set-key "\C-c L" 'org-insert-link-global)
+(global-set-key "\C-c o" 'org-open-at-point-global)
+@end lisp
+
+@node Link abbreviations, Search options, Using links outside Org, Hyperlinks
+@section Link abbreviations
+@cindex link abbreviations
+@cindex abbreviation, links
+
+Long URLs can be cumbersome to type, and often many similar links are
+needed in a document. For this you can use link abbreviations. An
+abbreviated link looks like this
+
+@example
+[[linkword:tag][description]]
+@end example
+
+@noindent
+@vindex org-link-abbrev-alist
+where the tag is optional.
+The @i{linkword} must be a word, starting with a letter, followed by
+letters, numbers, @samp{-}, and @samp{_}. Abbreviations are resolved
+according to the information in the variable @code{org-link-abbrev-alist}
+that relates the linkwords to replacement text. Here is an example:
+
+@smalllisp
+@group
+(setq org-link-abbrev-alist
+ '(("bugzilla" . "http://10.1.2.9/bugzilla/show_bug.cgi?id=")
+ ("google" . "http://www.google.com/search?q=")
+ ("gmap" . "http://maps.google.com/maps?q=%s")
+ ("omap" . "http://nominatim.openstreetmap.org/search?q=%s&polygon=1")
+ ("ads" . "http://adsabs.harvard.edu/cgi-bin/nph-abs_connect?author=%s&db_key=AST")))
+@end group
+@end smalllisp
+
+If the replacement text contains the string @samp{%s}, it will be
+replaced with the tag. Otherwise the tag will be appended to the string
+in order to create the link. You may also specify a function that will
+be called with the tag as the only argument to create the link.
+
+With the above setting, you could link to a specific bug with
+@code{[[bugzilla:129]]}, search the web for @samp{OrgMode} with
+@code{[[google:OrgMode]]}, show the map location of the Free Software
+Foundation @code{[[gmap:51 Franklin Street, Boston]]} or of Carsten office
+@code{[[omap:Science Park 904, Amsterdam, The Netherlands]]} and find out
+what the Org author is doing besides Emacs hacking with
+@code{[[ads:Dominik,C]]}.
+
+If you need special abbreviations just for a single Org buffer, you
+can define them in the file with
+
+@cindex #+LINK
+@example
+#+LINK: bugzilla http://10.1.2.9/bugzilla/show_bug.cgi?id=
+#+LINK: google http://www.google.com/search?q=%s
+@end example
+
+@noindent
+In-buffer completion (@pxref{Completion}) can be used after @samp{[} to
+complete link abbreviations. You may also define a function
+@code{org-PREFIX-complete-link} that implements special (e.g. completion)
+support for inserting such a link with @kbd{C-c C-l}. Such a function should
+not accept any arguments, and return the full link with prefix.
+
+@node Search options, Custom searches, Link abbreviations, Hyperlinks
+@section Search options in file links
+@cindex search option in file links
+@cindex file links, searching
+
+File links can contain additional information to make Emacs jump to a
+particular location in the file when following a link. This can be a
+line number or a search option after a double@footnote{For backward
+compatibility, line numbers can also follow a single colon.} colon. For
+example, when the command @kbd{C-c l} creates a link (@pxref{Handling
+links}) to a file, it encodes the words in the current line as a search
+string that can be used to find this line back later when following the
+link with @kbd{C-c C-o}.
+
+Here is the syntax of the different ways to attach a search to a file
+link, together with an explanation:
+
+@example
+[[file:~/code/main.c::255]]
+[[file:~/xx.org::My Target]]
+[[file:~/xx.org::*My Target]]
+[[file:~/xx.org::#my-custom-id]]
+[[file:~/xx.org::/regexp/]]
+@end example
+
+@table @code
+@item 255
+Jump to line 255.
+@item My Target
+Search for a link target @samp{<<My Target>>}, or do a text search for
+@samp{my target}, similar to the search in internal links, see
+@ref{Internal links}. In HTML export (@pxref{HTML export}), such a file
+link will become an HTML reference to the corresponding named anchor in
+the linked file.
+@item *My Target
+In an Org file, restrict search to headlines.
+@item #my-custom-id
+Link to a heading with a @code{CUSTOM_ID} property
+@item /regexp/
+Do a regular expression search for @code{regexp}. This uses the Emacs
+command @code{occur} to list all matches in a separate window. If the
+target file is in Org-mode, @code{org-occur} is used to create a
+sparse tree with the matches.
+@c If the target file is a directory,
+@c @code{grep} will be used to search all files in the directory.
+@end table
+
+As a degenerate case, a file link with an empty file name can be used
+to search the current file. For example, @code{[[file:::find me]]} does
+a search for @samp{find me} in the current file, just as
+@samp{[[find me]]} would.
+
+@node Custom searches, , Search options, Hyperlinks
+@section Custom Searches
+@cindex custom search strings
+@cindex search strings, custom
+
+The default mechanism for creating search strings and for doing the
+actual search related to a file link may not work correctly in all
+cases. For example, Bib@TeX{} database files have many entries like
+@samp{year="1993"} which would not result in good search strings,
+because the only unique identification for a Bib@TeX{} entry is the
+citation key.
+
+@vindex org-create-file-search-functions
+@vindex org-execute-file-search-functions
+If you come across such a problem, you can write custom functions to set
+the right search string for a particular file type, and to do the search
+for the string in the file. Using @code{add-hook}, these functions need
+to be added to the hook variables
+@code{org-create-file-search-functions} and
+@code{org-execute-file-search-functions}. See the docstring for these
+variables for more information. Org actually uses this mechanism
+for Bib@TeX{} database files, and you can use the corresponding code as
+an implementation example. See the file @file{org-bibtex.el}.
+
+@node TODO Items, Tags, Hyperlinks, Top
+@chapter TODO items
+@cindex TODO items
+
+Org-mode does not maintain TODO lists as separate documents@footnote{Of
+course, you can make a document that contains only long lists of TODO items,
+but this is not required.}. Instead, TODO items are an integral part of the
+notes file, because TODO items usually come up while taking notes! With Org
+mode, simply mark any entry in a tree as being a TODO item. In this way,
+information is not duplicated, and the entire context from which the TODO
+item emerged is always present.
+
+Of course, this technique for managing TODO items scatters them
+throughout your notes file. Org-mode compensates for this by providing
+methods to give you an overview of all the things that you have to do.
+
+@menu
+* TODO basics:: Marking and displaying TODO entries
+* TODO extensions:: Workflow and assignments
+* Progress logging:: Dates and notes for progress
+* Priorities:: Some things are more important than others
+* Breaking down tasks:: Splitting a task into manageable pieces
+* Checkboxes:: Tick-off lists
+@end menu
+
+@node TODO basics, TODO extensions, TODO Items, TODO Items
+@section Basic TODO functionality
+
+Any headline becomes a TODO item when it starts with the word
+@samp{TODO}, for example:
+
+@example
+*** TODO Write letter to Sam Fortune
+@end example
+
+@noindent
+The most important commands to work with TODO entries are:
+
+@table @kbd
+@orgcmd{C-c C-t,org-todo}
+@cindex cycling, of TODO states
+Rotate the TODO state of the current item among
+
+@example
+,-> (unmarked) -> TODO -> DONE --.
+'--------------------------------'
+@end example
+
+The same rotation can also be done ``remotely'' from the timeline and
+agenda buffers with the @kbd{t} command key (@pxref{Agenda commands}).
+
+@orgkey{C-u C-c C-t}
+Select a specific keyword using completion or (if it has been set up)
+the fast selection interface. For the latter, you need to assign keys
+to TODO states, see @ref{Per-file keywords}, and @ref{Setting tags}, for
+more information.
+
+@kindex S-@key{right}
+@kindex S-@key{left}
+@item S-@key{right} @ @r{/} @ S-@key{left}
+@vindex org-treat-S-cursor-todo-selection-as-state-change
+Select the following/preceding TODO state, similar to cycling. Useful
+mostly if more than two TODO states are possible (@pxref{TODO
+extensions}). See also @ref{Conflicts}, for a discussion of the interaction
+with @code{shift-selection-mode}. See also the variable
+@code{org-treat-S-cursor-todo-selection-as-state-change}.
+@orgcmd{C-c / t,org-show-todo-key}
+@cindex sparse tree, for TODO
+@vindex org-todo-keywords
+View TODO items in a @emph{sparse tree} (@pxref{Sparse trees}). Folds the
+entire buffer, but shows all TODO items (with not-DONE state) and the
+headings hierarchy above them. With a prefix argument (or by using @kbd{C-c
+/ T}), search for a specific TODO. You will be prompted for the keyword, and
+you can also give a list of keywords like @code{KWD1|KWD2|...} to list
+entries that match any one of these keywords. With numeric prefix argument
+N, show the tree for the Nth keyword in the variable
+@code{org-todo-keywords}. With two prefix arguments, find all TODO states,
+both un-done and done.
+@orgcmd{C-c a t,org-todo-list}
+Show the global TODO list. Collects the TODO items (with not-DONE states)
+from all agenda files (@pxref{Agenda Views}) into a single buffer. The new
+buffer will be in @code{agenda-mode}, which provides commands to examine and
+manipulate the TODO entries from the new buffer (@pxref{Agenda commands}).
+@xref{Global TODO list}, for more information.
+@orgcmd{S-M-@key{RET},org-insert-todo-heading}
+Insert a new TODO entry below the current one.
+@end table
+
+@noindent
+@vindex org-todo-state-tags-triggers
+Changing a TODO state can also trigger tag changes. See the docstring of the
+option @code{org-todo-state-tags-triggers} for details.
+
+@node TODO extensions, Progress logging, TODO basics, TODO Items
+@section Extended use of TODO keywords
+@cindex extended TODO keywords
+
+@vindex org-todo-keywords
+By default, marked TODO entries have one of only two states: TODO and
+DONE. Org-mode allows you to classify TODO items in more complex ways
+with @emph{TODO keywords} (stored in @code{org-todo-keywords}). With
+special setup, the TODO keyword system can work differently in different
+files.
+
+Note that @i{tags} are another way to classify headlines in general and
+TODO items in particular (@pxref{Tags}).
+
+@menu
+* Workflow states:: From TODO to DONE in steps
+* TODO types:: I do this, Fred does the rest
+* Multiple sets in one file:: Mixing it all, and still finding your way
+* Fast access to TODO states:: Single letter selection of a state
+* Per-file keywords:: Different files, different requirements
+* Faces for TODO keywords:: Highlighting states
+* TODO dependencies:: When one task needs to wait for others
+@end menu
+
+@node Workflow states, TODO types, TODO extensions, TODO extensions
+@subsection TODO keywords as workflow states
+@cindex TODO workflow
+@cindex workflow states as TODO keywords
+
+You can use TODO keywords to indicate different @emph{sequential} states
+in the process of working on an item, for example@footnote{Changing
+this variable only becomes effective after restarting Org-mode in a
+buffer.}:
+
+@lisp
+(setq org-todo-keywords
+ '((sequence "TODO" "FEEDBACK" "VERIFY" "|" "DONE" "DELEGATED")))
+@end lisp
+
+The vertical bar separates the TODO keywords (states that @emph{need
+action}) from the DONE states (which need @emph{no further action}). If
+you don't provide the separator bar, the last state is used as the DONE
+state.
+@cindex completion, of TODO keywords
+With this setup, the command @kbd{C-c C-t} will cycle an entry from TODO
+to FEEDBACK, then to VERIFY, and finally to DONE and DELEGATED. You may
+also use a numeric prefix argument to quickly select a specific state. For
+example @kbd{C-3 C-c C-t} will change the state immediately to VERIFY.
+Or you can use @kbd{S-@key{left}} to go backward through the sequence. If you
+define many keywords, you can use in-buffer completion
+(@pxref{Completion}) or even a special one-key selection scheme
+(@pxref{Fast access to TODO states}) to insert these words into the
+buffer. Changing a TODO state can be logged with a timestamp, see
+@ref{Tracking TODO state changes}, for more information.
+
+@node TODO types, Multiple sets in one file, Workflow states, TODO extensions
+@subsection TODO keywords as types
+@cindex TODO types
+@cindex names as TODO keywords
+@cindex types as TODO keywords
+
+The second possibility is to use TODO keywords to indicate different
+@emph{types} of action items. For example, you might want to indicate
+that items are for ``work'' or ``home''. Or, when you work with several
+people on a single project, you might want to assign action items
+directly to persons, by using their names as TODO keywords. This would
+be set up like this:
+
+@lisp
+(setq org-todo-keywords '((type "Fred" "Sara" "Lucy" "|" "DONE")))
+@end lisp
+
+In this case, different keywords do not indicate a sequence, but rather
+different types. So the normal work flow would be to assign a task to a
+person, and later to mark it DONE. Org-mode supports this style by adapting
+the workings of the command @kbd{C-c C-t}@footnote{This is also true for the
+@kbd{t} command in the timeline and agenda buffers.}. When used several
+times in succession, it will still cycle through all names, in order to first
+select the right type for a task. But when you return to the item after some
+time and execute @kbd{C-c C-t} again, it will switch from any name directly
+to DONE. Use prefix arguments or completion to quickly select a specific
+name. You can also review the items of a specific TODO type in a sparse tree
+by using a numeric prefix to @kbd{C-c / t}. For example, to see all things
+Lucy has to do, you would use @kbd{C-3 C-c / t}. To collect Lucy's items
+from all agenda files into a single buffer, you would use the numeric prefix
+argument as well when creating the global TODO list: @kbd{C-3 C-c a t}.
+
+@node Multiple sets in one file, Fast access to TODO states, TODO types, TODO extensions
+@subsection Multiple keyword sets in one file
+@cindex TODO keyword sets
+
+Sometimes you may want to use different sets of TODO keywords in
+parallel. For example, you may want to have the basic
+@code{TODO}/@code{DONE}, but also a workflow for bug fixing, and a
+separate state indicating that an item has been canceled (so it is not
+DONE, but also does not require action). Your setup would then look
+like this:
+
+@lisp
+(setq org-todo-keywords
+ '((sequence "TODO" "|" "DONE")
+ (sequence "REPORT" "BUG" "KNOWNCAUSE" "|" "FIXED")
+ (sequence "|" "CANCELED")))
+@end lisp
+
+The keywords should all be different, this helps Org-mode to keep track
+of which subsequence should be used for a given entry. In this setup,
+@kbd{C-c C-t} only operates within a subsequence, so it switches from
+@code{DONE} to (nothing) to @code{TODO}, and from @code{FIXED} to
+(nothing) to @code{REPORT}. Therefore you need a mechanism to initially
+select the correct sequence. Besides the obvious ways like typing a
+keyword or using completion, you may also apply the following commands:
+
+@table @kbd
+@kindex C-S-@key{right}
+@kindex C-S-@key{left}
+@kindex C-u C-u C-c C-t
+@item C-u C-u C-c C-t
+@itemx C-S-@key{right}
+@itemx C-S-@key{left}
+These keys jump from one TODO subset to the next. In the above example,
+@kbd{C-u C-u C-c C-t} or @kbd{C-S-@key{right}} would jump from @code{TODO} or
+@code{DONE} to @code{REPORT}, and any of the words in the second row to
+@code{CANCELED}. Note that the @kbd{C-S-} key binding conflict with
+@code{shift-selection-mode} (@pxref{Conflicts}).
+@kindex S-@key{right}
+@kindex S-@key{left}
+@item S-@key{right}
+@itemx S-@key{left}
+@kbd{S-@key{<left>}} and @kbd{S-@key{<right>}} and walk through @emph{all}
+keywords from all sets, so for example @kbd{S-@key{<right>}} would switch
+from @code{DONE} to @code{REPORT} in the example above. See also
+@ref{Conflicts}, for a discussion of the interaction with
+@code{shift-selection-mode}.
+@end table
+
+@node Fast access to TODO states, Per-file keywords, Multiple sets in one file, TODO extensions
+@subsection Fast access to TODO states
+
+If you would like to quickly change an entry to an arbitrary TODO state
+instead of cycling through the states, you can set up keys for
+single-letter access to the states. This is done by adding the section
+key after each keyword, in parentheses. For example:
+
+@lisp
+(setq org-todo-keywords
+ '((sequence "TODO(t)" "|" "DONE(d)")
+ (sequence "REPORT(r)" "BUG(b)" "KNOWNCAUSE(k)" "|" "FIXED(f)")
+ (sequence "|" "CANCELED(c)")))
+@end lisp
+
+@vindex org-fast-tag-selection-include-todo
+If you then press @code{C-c C-t} followed by the selection key, the entry
+will be switched to this state. @key{SPC} can be used to remove any TODO
+keyword from an entry.@footnote{Check also the variable
+@code{org-fast-tag-selection-include-todo}, it allows you to change the TODO
+state through the tags interface (@pxref{Setting tags}), in case you like to
+mingle the two concepts. Note that this means you need to come up with
+unique keys across both sets of keywords.}
+
+@node Per-file keywords, Faces for TODO keywords, Fast access to TODO states, TODO extensions
+@subsection Setting up keywords for individual files
+@cindex keyword options
+@cindex per-file keywords
+@cindex #+TODO
+@cindex #+TYP_TODO
+@cindex #+SEQ_TODO
+
+It can be very useful to use different aspects of the TODO mechanism in
+different files. For file-local settings, you need to add special lines
+to the file which set the keywords and interpretation for that file
+only. For example, to set one of the two examples discussed above, you
+need one of the following lines, starting in column zero anywhere in the
+file:
+
+@example
+#+TODO: TODO FEEDBACK VERIFY | DONE CANCELED
+@end example
+@noindent (you may also write @code{#+SEQ_TODO} to be explicit about the
+interpretation, but it means the same as @code{#+TODO}), or
+@example
+#+TYP_TODO: Fred Sara Lucy Mike | DONE
+@end example
+
+A setup for using several sets in parallel would be:
+
+@example
+#+TODO: TODO | DONE
+#+TODO: REPORT BUG KNOWNCAUSE | FIXED
+#+TODO: | CANCELED
+@end example
+
+@cindex completion, of option keywords
+@kindex M-@key{TAB}
+@noindent To make sure you are using the correct keyword, type
+@samp{#+} into the buffer and then use @kbd{M-@key{TAB}} completion.
+
+@cindex DONE, final TODO keyword
+Remember that the keywords after the vertical bar (or the last keyword
+if no bar is there) must always mean that the item is DONE (although you
+may use a different word). After changing one of these lines, use
+@kbd{C-c C-c} with the cursor still in the line to make the changes
+known to Org-mode@footnote{Org-mode parses these lines only when
+Org-mode is activated after visiting a file. @kbd{C-c C-c} with the
+cursor in a line starting with @samp{#+} is simply restarting Org-mode
+for the current buffer.}.
+
+@node Faces for TODO keywords, TODO dependencies, Per-file keywords, TODO extensions
+@subsection Faces for TODO keywords
+@cindex faces, for TODO keywords
+
+@vindex org-todo @r{(face)}
+@vindex org-done @r{(face)}
+@vindex org-todo-keyword-faces
+Org-mode highlights TODO keywords with special faces: @code{org-todo}
+for keywords indicating that an item still has to be acted upon, and
+@code{org-done} for keywords indicating that an item is finished. If
+you are using more than 2 different states, you might want to use
+special faces for some of them. This can be done using the variable
+@code{org-todo-keyword-faces}. For example:
+
+@lisp
+@group
+(setq org-todo-keyword-faces
+ '(("TODO" . org-warning) ("STARTED" . "yellow")
+ ("CANCELED" . (:foreground "blue" :weight bold))))
+@end group
+@end lisp
+
+While using a list with face properties as shown for CANCELED @emph{should}
+work, this does not aways seem to be the case. If necessary, define a
+special face and use that. A string is interpreted as a color. The variable
+@code{org-faces-easy-properties} determines if that color is interpreted as a
+foreground or a background color.
+
+@node TODO dependencies, , Faces for TODO keywords, TODO extensions
+@subsection TODO dependencies
+@cindex TODO dependencies
+@cindex dependencies, of TODO states
+
+@vindex org-enforce-todo-dependencies
+@cindex property, ORDERED
+The structure of Org files (hierarchy and lists) makes it easy to define TODO
+dependencies. Usually, a parent TODO task should not be marked DONE until
+all subtasks (defined as children tasks) are marked as DONE. And sometimes
+there is a logical sequence to a number of (sub)tasks, so that one task
+cannot be acted upon before all siblings above it are done. If you customize
+the variable @code{org-enforce-todo-dependencies}, Org will block entries
+from changing state to DONE while they have children that are not DONE.
+Furthermore, if an entry has a property @code{ORDERED}, each of its children
+will be blocked until all earlier siblings are marked DONE. Here is an
+example:
+
+@example
+* TODO Blocked until (two) is done
+** DONE one
+** TODO two
+
+* Parent
+ :PROPERTIES:
+ :ORDERED: t
+ :END:
+** TODO a
+** TODO b, needs to wait for (a)
+** TODO c, needs to wait for (a) and (b)
+@end example
+
+@table @kbd
+@orgcmd{C-c C-x o,org-toggle-ordered-property}
+@vindex org-track-ordered-property-with-tag
+@cindex property, ORDERED
+Toggle the @code{ORDERED} property of the current entry. A property is used
+for this behavior because this should be local to the current entry, not
+inherited like a tag. However, if you would like to @i{track} the value of
+this property with a tag for better visibility, customize the variable
+@code{org-track-ordered-property-with-tag}.
+@orgkey{C-u C-u C-u C-c C-t}
+Change TODO state, circumventing any state blocking.
+@end table
+
+@vindex org-agenda-dim-blocked-tasks
+If you set the variable @code{org-agenda-dim-blocked-tasks}, TODO entries
+that cannot be closed because of such dependencies will be shown in a dimmed
+font or even made invisible in agenda views (@pxref{Agenda Views}).
+
+@cindex checkboxes and TODO dependencies
+@vindex org-enforce-todo-dependencies
+You can also block changes of TODO states by looking at checkboxes
+(@pxref{Checkboxes}). If you set the variable
+@code{org-enforce-todo-checkbox-dependencies}, an entry that has unchecked
+checkboxes will be blocked from switching to DONE.
+
+If you need more complex dependency structures, for example dependencies
+between entries in different trees or files, check out the contributed
+module @file{org-depend.el}.
+
+@page
+@node Progress logging, Priorities, TODO extensions, TODO Items
+@section Progress logging
+@cindex progress logging
+@cindex logging, of progress
+
+Org-mode can automatically record a timestamp and possibly a note when
+you mark a TODO item as DONE, or even each time you change the state of
+a TODO item. This system is highly configurable, settings can be on a
+per-keyword basis and can be localized to a file or even a subtree. For
+information on how to clock working time for a task, see @ref{Clocking
+work time}.
+
+@menu
+* Closing items:: When was this entry marked DONE?
+* Tracking TODO state changes:: When did the status change?
+* Tracking your habits:: How consistent have you been?
+@end menu
+
+@node Closing items, Tracking TODO state changes, Progress logging, Progress logging
+@subsection Closing items
+
+The most basic logging is to keep track of @emph{when} a certain TODO
+item was finished. This is achieved with@footnote{The corresponding
+in-buffer setting is: @code{#+STARTUP: logdone}}
+
+@lisp
+(setq org-log-done 'time)
+@end lisp
+
+@noindent
+Then each time you turn an entry from a TODO (not-done) state into any
+of the DONE states, a line @samp{CLOSED: [timestamp]} will be inserted
+just after the headline. If you turn the entry back into a TODO item
+through further state cycling, that line will be removed again. If you
+want to record a note along with the timestamp, use@footnote{The
+corresponding in-buffer setting is: @code{#+STARTUP: lognotedone}}
+
+@lisp
+(setq org-log-done 'note)
+@end lisp
+
+@noindent
+You will then be prompted for a note, and that note will be stored below
+the entry with a @samp{Closing Note} heading.
+
+In the timeline (@pxref{Timeline}) and in the agenda
+(@pxref{Weekly/daily agenda}), you can then use the @kbd{l} key to
+display the TODO items with a @samp{CLOSED} timestamp on each day,
+giving you an overview of what has been done.
+
+@node Tracking TODO state changes, Tracking your habits, Closing items, Progress logging
+@subsection Tracking TODO state changes
+@cindex drawer, for state change recording
+
+@vindex org-log-states-order-reversed
+@vindex org-log-into-drawer
+@cindex property, LOG_INTO_DRAWER
+When TODO keywords are used as workflow states (@pxref{Workflow states}), you
+might want to keep track of when a state change occurred and maybe take a
+note about this change. You can either record just a timestamp, or a
+time-stamped note for a change. These records will be inserted after the
+headline as an itemized list, newest first@footnote{See the variable
+@code{org-log-states-order-reversed}}. When taking a lot of notes, you might
+want to get the notes out of the way into a drawer (@pxref{Drawers}).
+Customize the variable @code{org-log-into-drawer} to get this
+behavior---the recommended drawer for this is called @code{LOGBOOK}. You can
+also overrule the setting of this variable for a subtree by setting a
+@code{LOG_INTO_DRAWER} property.
+
+Since it is normally too much to record a note for every state, Org-mode
+expects configuration on a per-keyword basis for this. This is achieved by
+adding special markers @samp{!} (for a timestamp) and @samp{@@} (for a note)
+in parentheses after each keyword. For example, with the setting
+
+@lisp
+(setq org-todo-keywords
+ '((sequence "TODO(t)" "WAIT(w@@/!)" "|" "DONE(d!)" "CANCELED(c@@)")))
+@end lisp
+
+@noindent
+@vindex org-log-done
+you not only define global TODO keywords and fast access keys, but also
+request that a time is recorded when the entry is set to
+DONE@footnote{It is possible that Org-mode will record two timestamps
+when you are using both @code{org-log-done} and state change logging.
+However, it will never prompt for two notes---if you have configured
+both, the state change recording note will take precedence and cancel
+the @samp{Closing Note}.}, and that a note is recorded when switching to
+WAIT or CANCELED. The setting for WAIT is even more special: the
+@samp{!} after the slash means that in addition to the note taken when
+entering the state, a timestamp should be recorded when @i{leaving} the
+WAIT state, if and only if the @i{target} state does not configure
+logging for entering it. So it has no effect when switching from WAIT
+to DONE, because DONE is configured to record a timestamp only. But
+when switching from WAIT back to TODO, the @samp{/!} in the WAIT
+setting now triggers a timestamp even though TODO has no logging
+configured.
+
+You can use the exact same syntax for setting logging preferences local
+to a buffer:
+@example
+#+TODO: TODO(t) WAIT(w@@/!) | DONE(d!) CANCELED(c@@)
+@end example
+
+@cindex property, LOGGING
+In order to define logging settings that are local to a subtree or a
+single item, define a LOGGING property in this entry. Any non-empty
+LOGGING property resets all logging settings to nil. You may then turn
+on logging for this specific tree using STARTUP keywords like
+@code{lognotedone} or @code{logrepeat}, as well as adding state specific
+settings like @code{TODO(!)}. For example
+
+@example
+* TODO Log each state with only a time
+ :PROPERTIES:
+ :LOGGING: TODO(!) WAIT(!) DONE(!) CANCELED(!)
+ :END:
+* TODO Only log when switching to WAIT, and when repeating
+ :PROPERTIES:
+ :LOGGING: WAIT(@@) logrepeat
+ :END:
+* TODO No logging at all
+ :PROPERTIES:
+ :LOGGING: nil
+ :END:
+@end example
+
+@node Tracking your habits, , Tracking TODO state changes, Progress logging
+@subsection Tracking your habits
+@cindex habits
+
+Org has the ability to track the consistency of a special category of TODOs,
+called ``habits''. A habit has the following properties:
+
+@enumerate
+@item
+You have enabled the @code{habits} module by customizing the variable
+@code{org-modules}.
+@item
+The habit is a TODO, with a TODO keyword representing an open state.
+@item
+The property @code{STYLE} is set to the value @code{habit}.
+@item
+The TODO has a scheduled date, usually with a @code{.+} style repeat
+interval. A @code{++} style may be appropriate for habits with time
+constraints, e.g., must be done on weekends, or a @code{+} style for an
+unusual habit that can have a backlog, e.g., weekly reports.
+@item
+The TODO may also have minimum and maximum ranges specified by using the
+syntax @samp{.+2d/3d}, which says that you want to do the task at least every
+three days, but at most every two days.
+@item
+You must also have state logging for the @code{DONE} state enabled, in order
+for historical data to be represented in the consistency graph. If it's not
+enabled it's not an error, but the consistency graphs will be largely
+meaningless.
+@end enumerate
+
+To give you an idea of what the above rules look like in action, here's an
+actual habit with some history:
+
+@example
+** TODO Shave
+ SCHEDULED: <2009-10-17 Sat .+2d/4d>
+ - State "DONE" from "TODO" [2009-10-15 Thu]
+ - State "DONE" from "TODO" [2009-10-12 Mon]
+ - State "DONE" from "TODO" [2009-10-10 Sat]
+ - State "DONE" from "TODO" [2009-10-04 Sun]
+ - State "DONE" from "TODO" [2009-10-02 Fri]
+ - State "DONE" from "TODO" [2009-09-29 Tue]
+ - State "DONE" from "TODO" [2009-09-25 Fri]
+ - State "DONE" from "TODO" [2009-09-19 Sat]
+ - State "DONE" from "TODO" [2009-09-16 Wed]
+ - State "DONE" from "TODO" [2009-09-12 Sat]
+ :PROPERTIES:
+ :STYLE: habit
+ :LAST_REPEAT: [2009-10-19 Mon 00:36]
+ :END:
+@end example
+
+What this habit says is: I want to shave at most every 2 days (given by the
+@code{SCHEDULED} date and repeat interval) and at least every 4 days. If
+today is the 15th, then the habit first appears in the agenda on Oct 17,
+after the minimum of 2 days has elapsed, and will appear overdue on Oct 19,
+after four days have elapsed.
+
+What's really useful about habits is that they are displayed along with a
+consistency graph, to show how consistent you've been at getting that task
+done in the past. This graph shows every day that the task was done over the
+past three weeks, with colors for each day. The colors used are:
+
+@table @code
+@item Blue
+If the task wasn't to be done yet on that day.
+@item Green
+If the task could have been done on that day.
+@item Yellow
+If the task was going to be overdue the next day.
+@item Red
+If the task was overdue on that day.
+@end table
+
+In addition to coloring each day, the day is also marked with an asterisk if
+the task was actually done that day, and an exclamation mark to show where
+the current day falls in the graph.
+
+There are several configuration variables that can be used to change the way
+habits are displayed in the agenda.
+
+@table @code
+@item org-habit-graph-column
+The buffer column at which the consistency graph should be drawn. This will
+overwrite any text in that column, so it's a good idea to keep your habits'
+titles brief and to the point.
+@item org-habit-preceding-days
+The amount of history, in days before today, to appear in consistency graphs.
+@item org-habit-following-days
+The number of days after today that will appear in consistency graphs.
+@item org-habit-show-habits-only-for-today
+If non-nil, only show habits in today's agenda view. This is set to true by
+default.
+@end table
+
+Lastly, pressing @kbd{K} in the agenda buffer will cause habits to
+temporarily be disabled and they won't appear at all. Press @kbd{K} again to
+bring them back. They are also subject to tag filtering, if you have habits
+which should only be done in certain contexts, for example.
+
+@node Priorities, Breaking down tasks, Progress logging, TODO Items
+@section Priorities
+@cindex priorities
+
+If you use Org-mode extensively, you may end up with enough TODO items that
+it starts to make sense to prioritize them. Prioritizing can be done by
+placing a @emph{priority cookie} into the headline of a TODO item, like this
+
+@example
+*** TODO [#A] Write letter to Sam Fortune
+@end example
+
+@noindent
+@vindex org-priority-faces
+By default, Org-mode supports three priorities: @samp{A}, @samp{B}, and
+@samp{C}. @samp{A} is the highest priority. An entry without a cookie is
+treated just like priority @samp{B}. Priorities make a difference only for
+sorting in the agenda (@pxref{Weekly/daily agenda}); outside the agenda, they
+have no inherent meaning to Org-mode. The cookies can be highlighted with
+special faces by customizing the variable @code{org-priority-faces}.
+
+Priorities can be attached to any outline node; they do not need to be TODO
+items.
+
+@table @kbd
+@item @kbd{C-c ,}
+@kindex @kbd{C-c ,}
+@findex org-priority
+Set the priority of the current headline (@command{org-priority}). The
+command prompts for a priority character @samp{A}, @samp{B} or @samp{C}.
+When you press @key{SPC} instead, the priority cookie is removed from the
+headline. The priorities can also be changed ``remotely'' from the timeline
+and agenda buffer with the @kbd{,} command (@pxref{Agenda commands}).
+@c
+@orgcmdkkcc{S-@key{up},S-@key{down},org-priority-up,org-priority-down}
+@vindex org-priority-start-cycle-with-default
+Increase/decrease priority of current headline@footnote{See also the option
+@code{org-priority-start-cycle-with-default}.}. Note that these keys are
+also used to modify timestamps (@pxref{Creating timestamps}). See also
+@ref{Conflicts}, for a discussion of the interaction with
+@code{shift-selection-mode}.
+@end table
+
+@vindex org-highest-priority
+@vindex org-lowest-priority
+@vindex org-default-priority
+You can change the range of allowed priorities by setting the variables
+@code{org-highest-priority}, @code{org-lowest-priority}, and
+@code{org-default-priority}. For an individual buffer, you may set
+these values (highest, lowest, default) like this (please make sure that
+the highest priority is earlier in the alphabet than the lowest
+priority):
+
+@cindex #+PRIORITIES
+@example
+#+PRIORITIES: A C B
+@end example
+
+@node Breaking down tasks, Checkboxes, Priorities, TODO Items
+@section Breaking tasks down into subtasks
+@cindex tasks, breaking down
+@cindex statistics, for TODO items
+
+@vindex org-agenda-todo-list-sublevels
+It is often advisable to break down large tasks into smaller, manageable
+subtasks. You can do this by creating an outline tree below a TODO item,
+with detailed subtasks on the tree@footnote{To keep subtasks out of the
+global TODO list, see the @code{org-agenda-todo-list-sublevels}.}. To keep
+the overview over the fraction of subtasks that are already completed, insert
+either @samp{[/]} or @samp{[%]} anywhere in the headline. These cookies will
+be updated each time the TODO status of a child changes, or when pressing
+@kbd{C-c C-c} on the cookie. For example:
+
+@example
+* Organize Party [33%]
+** TODO Call people [1/2]
+*** TODO Peter
+*** DONE Sarah
+** TODO Buy food
+** DONE Talk to neighbor
+@end example
+
+@cindex property, COOKIE_DATA
+If a heading has both checkboxes and TODO children below it, the meaning of
+the statistics cookie become ambiguous. Set the property
+@code{COOKIE_DATA} to either @samp{checkbox} or @samp{todo} to resolve
+this issue.
+
+@vindex org-hierarchical-todo-statistics
+If you would like to have the statistics cookie count any TODO entries in the
+subtree (not just direct children), configure the variable
+@code{org-hierarchical-todo-statistics}. To do this for a single subtree,
+include the word @samp{recursive} into the value of the @code{COOKIE_DATA}
+property.
+
+@example
+* Parent capturing statistics [2/20]
+ :PROPERTIES:
+ :COOKIE_DATA: todo recursive
+ :END:
+@end example
+
+If you would like a TODO entry to automatically change to DONE
+when all children are done, you can use the following setup:
+
+@example
+(defun org-summary-todo (n-done n-not-done)
+ "Switch entry to DONE when all subentries are done, to TODO otherwise."
+ (let (org-log-done org-log-states) ; turn off logging
+ (org-todo (if (= n-not-done 0) "DONE" "TODO"))))
+
+(add-hook 'org-after-todo-statistics-hook 'org-summary-todo)
+@end example
+
+
+Another possibility is the use of checkboxes to identify (a hierarchy of) a
+large number of subtasks (@pxref{Checkboxes}).
+
+
+@node Checkboxes, , Breaking down tasks, TODO Items
+@section Checkboxes
+@cindex checkboxes
+
+@vindex org-list-automatic-rules
+Every item in a plain list@footnote{With the exception of description
+lists. But you can allow it by modifying @code{org-list-automatic-rules}
+accordingly.} (@pxref{Plain lists}) can be made into a checkbox by starting
+it with the string @samp{[ ]}. This feature is similar to TODO items
+(@pxref{TODO Items}), but is more lightweight. Checkboxes are not included
+into the global TODO list, so they are often great to split a task into a
+number of simple steps. Or you can use them in a shopping list. To toggle a
+checkbox, use @kbd{C-c C-c}, or use the mouse (thanks to Piotr Zielinski's
+@file{org-mouse.el}).
+
+Here is an example of a checkbox list.
+
+@example
+* TODO Organize party [2/4]
+ - [-] call people [1/3]
+ - [ ] Peter
+ - [X] Sarah
+ - [ ] Sam
+ - [X] order food
+ - [ ] think about what music to play
+ - [X] talk to the neighbors
+@end example
+
+Checkboxes work hierarchically, so if a checkbox item has children that
+are checkboxes, toggling one of the children checkboxes will make the
+parent checkbox reflect if none, some, or all of the children are
+checked.
+
+@cindex statistics, for checkboxes
+@cindex checkbox statistics
+@cindex property, COOKIE_DATA
+@vindex org-hierarchical-checkbox-statistics
+The @samp{[2/4]} and @samp{[1/3]} in the first and second line are cookies
+indicating how many checkboxes present in this entry have been checked off,
+and the total number of checkboxes present. This can give you an idea on how
+many checkboxes remain, even without opening a folded entry. The cookies can
+be placed into a headline or into (the first line of) a plain list item.
+Each cookie covers checkboxes of direct children structurally below the
+headline/item on which the cookie appears@footnote{Set the variable
+@code{org-hierarchical-checkbox-statistics} if you want such cookies to
+represent the all checkboxes below the cookie, not just the direct
+children.}. You have to insert the cookie yourself by typing either
+@samp{[/]} or @samp{[%]}. With @samp{[/]} you get an @samp{n out of m}
+result, as in the examples above. With @samp{[%]} you get information about
+the percentage of checkboxes checked (in the above example, this would be
+@samp{[50%]} and @samp{[33%]}, respectively). In a headline, a cookie can
+count either checkboxes below the heading or TODO states of children, and it
+will display whatever was changed last. Set the property @code{COOKIE_DATA}
+to either @samp{checkbox} or @samp{todo} to resolve this issue.
+
+@cindex blocking, of checkboxes
+@cindex checkbox blocking
+@cindex property, ORDERED
+If the current outline node has an @code{ORDERED} property, checkboxes must
+be checked off in sequence, and an error will be thrown if you try to check
+off a box while there are unchecked boxes above it.
+
+@noindent The following commands work with checkboxes:
+
+@table @kbd
+@orgcmd{C-c C-c,org-toggle-checkbox}
+Toggle checkbox status or (with prefix arg) checkbox presence at point. With
+double prefix argument, set it to @samp{[-]}, which is considered to be an
+intermediate state.
+@orgcmd{C-c C-x C-b,org-toggle-checkbox}
+Toggle checkbox status or (with prefix arg) checkbox presence at point. With
+double prefix argument, set it to @samp{[-]}, which is considered to be an
+intermediate state.
+@itemize @minus
+@item
+If there is an active region, toggle the first checkbox in the region
+and set all remaining boxes to the same status as the first. With a prefix
+arg, add or remove the checkbox for all items in the region.
+@item
+If the cursor is in a headline, toggle checkboxes in the region between
+this headline and the next (so @emph{not} the entire subtree).
+@item
+If there is no active region, just toggle the checkbox at point.
+@end itemize
+@orgcmd{M-S-@key{RET},org-insert-todo-heading}
+Insert a new item with a checkbox.
+This works only if the cursor is already in a plain list item
+(@pxref{Plain lists}).
+@orgcmd{C-c C-x o,org-toggle-ordered-property}
+@vindex org-track-ordered-property-with-tag
+@cindex property, ORDERED
+Toggle the @code{ORDERED} property of the entry, to toggle if checkboxes must
+be checked off in sequence. A property is used for this behavior because
+this should be local to the current entry, not inherited like a tag.
+However, if you would like to @i{track} the value of this property with a tag
+for better visibility, customize the variable
+@code{org-track-ordered-property-with-tag}.
+@orgcmd{C-c #,org-update-statistics-cookies}
+Update the statistics cookie in the current outline entry. When called with
+a @kbd{C-u} prefix, update the entire file. Checkbox statistic cookies are
+updated automatically if you toggle checkboxes with @kbd{C-c C-c} and make
+new ones with @kbd{M-S-@key{RET}}. TODO statistics cookies update when
+changing TODO states. If you delete boxes/entries or add/change them by
+hand, use this command to get things back into sync. Or simply toggle any
+entry twice (checkboxes with @kbd{C-c C-c}).
+@end table
+
+@node Tags, Properties and Columns, TODO Items, Top
+@chapter Tags
+@cindex tags
+@cindex headline tagging
+@cindex matching, tags
+@cindex sparse tree, tag based
+
+An excellent way to implement labels and contexts for cross-correlating
+information is to assign @i{tags} to headlines. Org-mode has extensive
+support for tags.
+
+@vindex org-tag-faces
+Every headline can contain a list of tags; they occur at the end of the
+headline. Tags are normal words containing letters, numbers, @samp{_}, and
+@samp{@@}. Tags must be preceded and followed by a single colon, e.g.,
+@samp{:work:}. Several tags can be specified, as in @samp{:work:urgent:}.
+Tags will by default be in bold face with the same color as the headline.
+You may specify special faces for specific tags using the variable
+@code{org-tag-faces}, in much the same way as you can for TODO keywords
+(@pxref{Faces for TODO keywords}).
+
+@menu
+* Tag inheritance:: Tags use the tree structure of the outline
+* Setting tags:: How to assign tags to a headline
+* Tag searches:: Searching for combinations of tags
+@end menu
+
+@node Tag inheritance, Setting tags, Tags, Tags
+@section Tag inheritance
+@cindex tag inheritance
+@cindex inheritance, of tags
+@cindex sublevels, inclusion into tags match
+
+@i{Tags} make use of the hierarchical structure of outline trees. If a
+heading has a certain tag, all subheadings will inherit the tag as
+well. For example, in the list
+
+@example
+* Meeting with the French group :work:
+** Summary by Frank :boss:notes:
+*** TODO Prepare slides for him :action:
+@end example
+
+@noindent
+the final heading will have the tags @samp{:work:}, @samp{:boss:},
+@samp{:notes:}, and @samp{:action:} even though the final heading is not
+explicitly marked with those tags. You can also set tags that all entries in
+a file should inherit just as if these tags were defined in a hypothetical
+level zero that surrounds the entire file. Use a line like this@footnote{As
+with all these in-buffer settings, pressing @kbd{C-c C-c} activates any
+changes in the line.}:
+
+@cindex #+FILETAGS
+@example
+#+FILETAGS: :Peter:Boss:Secret:
+@end example
+
+@noindent
+@vindex org-use-tag-inheritance
+@vindex org-tags-exclude-from-inheritance
+To limit tag inheritance to specific tags, or to turn it off entirely, use
+the variables @code{org-use-tag-inheritance} and
+@code{org-tags-exclude-from-inheritance}.
+
+@vindex org-tags-match-list-sublevels
+When a headline matches during a tags search while tag inheritance is turned
+on, all the sublevels in the same tree will (for a simple match form) match
+as well@footnote{This is only true if the search does not involve more
+complex tests including properties (@pxref{Property searches}).}. The list
+of matches may then become very long. If you only want to see the first tags
+match in a subtree, configure the variable
+@code{org-tags-match-list-sublevels} (not recommended).
+
+@node Setting tags, Tag searches, Tag inheritance, Tags
+@section Setting tags
+@cindex setting tags
+@cindex tags, setting
+
+@kindex M-@key{TAB}
+Tags can simply be typed into the buffer at the end of a headline.
+After a colon, @kbd{M-@key{TAB}} offers completion on tags. There is
+also a special command for inserting tags:
+
+@table @kbd
+@orgcmd{C-c C-q,org-set-tags-command}
+@cindex completion, of tags
+@vindex org-tags-column
+Enter new tags for the current headline. Org-mode will either offer
+completion or a special single-key interface for setting tags, see
+below. After pressing @key{RET}, the tags will be inserted and aligned
+to @code{org-tags-column}. When called with a @kbd{C-u} prefix, all
+tags in the current buffer will be aligned to that column, just to make
+things look nice. TAGS are automatically realigned after promotion,
+demotion, and TODO state changes (@pxref{TODO basics}).
+@orgcmd{C-c C-c,org-set-tags-command}
+When the cursor is in a headline, this does the same as @kbd{C-c C-q}.
+@end table
+
+@vindex org-tag-alist
+Org will support tag insertion based on a @emph{list of tags}. By
+default this list is constructed dynamically, containing all tags
+currently used in the buffer. You may also globally specify a hard list
+of tags with the variable @code{org-tag-alist}. Finally you can set
+the default tags for a given file with lines like
+
+@cindex #+TAGS
+@example
+#+TAGS: @@work @@home @@tennisclub
+#+TAGS: laptop car pc sailboat
+@end example
+
+If you have globally defined your preferred set of tags using the
+variable @code{org-tag-alist}, but would like to use a dynamic tag list
+in a specific file, add an empty TAGS option line to that file:
+
+@example
+#+TAGS:
+@end example
+
+@vindex org-tag-persistent-alist
+If you have a preferred set of tags that you would like to use in every file,
+in addition to those defined on a per-file basis by TAGS option lines, then
+you may specify a list of tags with the variable
+@code{org-tag-persistent-alist}. You may turn this off on a per-file basis
+by adding a STARTUP option line to that file:
+
+@example
+#+STARTUP: noptag
+@end example
+
+By default Org-mode uses the standard minibuffer completion facilities for
+entering tags. However, it also implements another, quicker, tag selection
+method called @emph{fast tag selection}. This allows you to select and
+deselect tags with just a single key press. For this to work well you should
+assign unique letters to most of your commonly used tags. You can do this
+globally by configuring the variable @code{org-tag-alist} in your
+@file{.emacs} file. For example, you may find the need to tag many items in
+different files with @samp{:@@home:}. In this case you can set something
+like:
+
+@lisp
+(setq org-tag-alist '(("@@work" . ?w) ("@@home" . ?h) ("laptop" . ?l)))
+@end lisp
+
+@noindent If the tag is only relevant to the file you are working on, then you
+can instead set the TAGS option line as:
+
+@example
+#+TAGS: @@work(w) @@home(h) @@tennisclub(t) laptop(l) pc(p)
+@end example
+
+@noindent The tags interface will show the available tags in a splash
+window. If you want to start a new line after a specific tag, insert
+@samp{\n} into the tag list
+
+@example
+#+TAGS: @@work(w) @@home(h) @@tennisclub(t) \n laptop(l) pc(p)
+@end example
+
+@noindent or write them in two lines:
+
+@example
+#+TAGS: @@work(w) @@home(h) @@tennisclub(t)
+#+TAGS: laptop(l) pc(p)
+@end example
+
+@noindent
+You can also group together tags that are mutually exclusive by using
+braces, as in:
+
+@example
+#+TAGS: @{ @@work(w) @@home(h) @@tennisclub(t) @} laptop(l) pc(p)
+@end example
+
+@noindent you indicate that at most one of @samp{@@work}, @samp{@@home},
+and @samp{@@tennisclub} should be selected. Multiple such groups are allowed.
+
+@noindent Don't forget to press @kbd{C-c C-c} with the cursor in one of
+these lines to activate any changes.
+
+@noindent
+To set these mutually exclusive groups in the variable @code{org-tags-alist},
+you must use the dummy tags @code{:startgroup} and @code{:endgroup} instead
+of the braces. Similarly, you can use @code{:newline} to indicate a line
+break. The previous example would be set globally by the following
+configuration:
+
+@lisp
+(setq org-tag-alist '((:startgroup . nil)
+ ("@@work" . ?w) ("@@home" . ?h)
+ ("@@tennisclub" . ?t)
+ (:endgroup . nil)
+ ("laptop" . ?l) ("pc" . ?p)))
+@end lisp
+
+If at least one tag has a selection key then pressing @kbd{C-c C-c} will
+automatically present you with a special interface, listing inherited tags,
+the tags of the current headline, and a list of all valid tags with
+corresponding keys@footnote{Keys will automatically be assigned to tags which
+have no configured keys.}. In this interface, you can use the following
+keys:
+
+@table @kbd
+@item a-z...
+Pressing keys assigned to tags will add or remove them from the list of
+tags in the current line. Selecting a tag in a group of mutually
+exclusive tags will turn off any other tags from that group.
+@kindex @key{TAB}
+@item @key{TAB}
+Enter a tag in the minibuffer, even if the tag is not in the predefined
+list. You will be able to complete on all tags present in the buffer.
+@kindex @key{SPC}
+@item @key{SPC}
+Clear all tags for this line.
+@kindex @key{RET}
+@item @key{RET}
+Accept the modified set.
+@item C-g
+Abort without installing changes.
+@item q
+If @kbd{q} is not assigned to a tag, it aborts like @kbd{C-g}.
+@item !
+Turn off groups of mutually exclusive tags. Use this to (as an
+exception) assign several tags from such a group.
+@item C-c
+Toggle auto-exit after the next change (see below).
+If you are using expert mode, the first @kbd{C-c} will display the
+selection window.
+@end table
+
+@noindent
+This method lets you assign tags to a headline with very few keys. With
+the above setup, you could clear the current tags and set @samp{@@home},
+@samp{laptop} and @samp{pc} tags with just the following keys: @kbd{C-c
+C-c @key{SPC} h l p @key{RET}}. Switching from @samp{@@home} to
+@samp{@@work} would be done with @kbd{C-c C-c w @key{RET}} or
+alternatively with @kbd{C-c C-c C-c w}. Adding the non-predefined tag
+@samp{Sarah} could be done with @kbd{C-c C-c @key{TAB} S a r a h
+@key{RET} @key{RET}}.
+
+@vindex org-fast-tag-selection-single-key
+If you find that most of the time you need only a single key press to
+modify your list of tags, set the variable
+@code{org-fast-tag-selection-single-key}. Then you no longer have to
+press @key{RET} to exit fast tag selection---it will immediately exit
+after the first change. If you then occasionally need more keys, press
+@kbd{C-c} to turn off auto-exit for the current tag selection process
+(in effect: start selection with @kbd{C-c C-c C-c} instead of @kbd{C-c
+C-c}). If you set the variable to the value @code{expert}, the special
+window is not even shown for single-key tag selection, it comes up only
+when you press an extra @kbd{C-c}.
+
+@node Tag searches, , Setting tags, Tags
+@section Tag searches
+@cindex tag searches
+@cindex searching for tags
+
+Once a system of tags has been set up, it can be used to collect related
+information into special lists.
+
+@table @kbd
+@orgcmdkkc{C-c / m,C-c \,org-match-sparse-tree}
+Create a sparse tree with all headlines matching a tags search. With a
+@kbd{C-u} prefix argument, ignore headlines that are not a TODO line.
+@orgcmd{C-c a m,org-tags-view}
+Create a global list of tag matches from all agenda files.
+@xref{Matching tags and properties}.
+@orgcmd{C-c a M,org-tags-view}
+@vindex org-tags-match-list-sublevels
+Create a global list of tag matches from all agenda files, but check
+only TODO items and force checking subitems (see variable
+@code{org-tags-match-list-sublevels}).
+@end table
+
+These commands all prompt for a match string which allows basic Boolean logic
+like @samp{+boss+urgent-project1}, to find entries with tags @samp{boss} and
+@samp{urgent}, but not @samp{project1}, or @samp{Kathy|Sally} to find entries
+which are tagged, like @samp{Kathy} or @samp{Sally}. The full syntax of the search
+string is rich and allows also matching against TODO keywords, entry levels
+and properties. For a complete description with many examples, see
+@ref{Matching tags and properties}.
+
+
+@node Properties and Columns, Dates and Times, Tags, Top
+@chapter Properties and columns
+@cindex properties
+
+Properties are a set of key-value pairs associated with an entry. There
+are two main applications for properties in Org-mode. First, properties
+are like tags, but with a value. Second, you can use properties to
+implement (very basic) database capabilities in an Org buffer. For
+an example of the first application, imagine maintaining a file where
+you document bugs and plan releases for a piece of software. Instead of
+using tags like @code{:release_1:}, @code{:release_2:}, one can use a
+property, say @code{:Release:}, that in different subtrees has different
+values, such as @code{1.0} or @code{2.0}. For an example of the second
+application of properties, imagine keeping track of your music CDs,
+where properties could be things such as the album, artist, date of
+release, number of tracks, and so on.
+
+Properties can be conveniently edited and viewed in column view
+(@pxref{Column view}).
+
+@menu
+* Property syntax:: How properties are spelled out
+* Special properties:: Access to other Org-mode features
+* Property searches:: Matching property values
+* Property inheritance:: Passing values down the tree
+* Column view:: Tabular viewing and editing
+* Property API:: Properties for Lisp programmers
+@end menu
+
+@node Property syntax, Special properties, Properties and Columns, Properties and Columns
+@section Property syntax
+@cindex property syntax
+@cindex drawer, for properties
+
+Properties are key-value pairs. They need to be inserted into a special
+drawer (@pxref{Drawers}) with the name @code{PROPERTIES}. Each property
+is specified on a single line, with the key (surrounded by colons)
+first, and the value after it. Here is an example:
+
+@example
+* CD collection
+** Classic
+*** Goldberg Variations
+ :PROPERTIES:
+ :Title: Goldberg Variations
+ :Composer: J.S. Bach
+ :Artist: Glen Gould
+ :Publisher: Deutsche Grammophon
+ :NDisks: 1
+ :END:
+@end example
+
+You may define the allowed values for a particular property @samp{:Xyz:}
+by setting a property @samp{:Xyz_ALL:}. This special property is
+@emph{inherited}, so if you set it in a level 1 entry, it will apply to
+the entire tree. When allowed values are defined, setting the
+corresponding property becomes easier and is less prone to typing
+errors. For the example with the CD collection, we can predefine
+publishers and the number of disks in a box like this:
+
+@example
+* CD collection
+ :PROPERTIES:
+ :NDisks_ALL: 1 2 3 4
+ :Publisher_ALL: "Deutsche Grammophon" Philips EMI
+ :END:
+@end example
+
+If you want to set properties that can be inherited by any entry in a
+file, use a line like
+@cindex property, _ALL
+@cindex #+PROPERTY
+@example
+#+PROPERTY: NDisks_ALL 1 2 3 4
+@end example
+
+@vindex org-global-properties
+Property values set with the global variable
+@code{org-global-properties} can be inherited by all entries in all
+Org files.
+
+@noindent
+The following commands help to work with properties:
+
+@table @kbd
+@orgcmd{M-@key{TAB},org-complete}
+After an initial colon in a line, complete property keys. All keys used
+in the current file will be offered as possible completions.
+@orgcmd{C-c C-x p,org-set-property}
+Set a property. This prompts for a property name and a value. If
+necessary, the property drawer is created as well.
+@item M-x org-insert-property-drawer
+@findex org-insert-property-drawer
+Insert a property drawer into the current entry. The drawer will be
+inserted early in the entry, but after the lines with planning
+information like deadlines.
+@orgcmd{C-c C-c,org-property-action}
+With the cursor in a property drawer, this executes property commands.
+@orgcmd{C-c C-c s,org-set-property}
+Set a property in the current entry. Both the property and the value
+can be inserted using completion.
+@orgcmdkkcc{S-@key{right},S-@key{left},org-property-next-allowed-value,org-property-previous-allowed-value}
+Switch property at point to the next/previous allowed value.
+@orgcmd{C-c C-c d,org-delete-property}
+Remove a property from the current entry.
+@orgcmd{C-c C-c D,org-delete-property-globally}
+Globally remove a property, from all entries in the current file.
+@orgcmd{C-c C-c c,org-compute-property-at-point}
+Compute the property at point, using the operator and scope from the
+nearest column format definition.
+@end table
+
+@node Special properties, Property searches, Property syntax, Properties and Columns
+@section Special properties
+@cindex properties, special
+
+Special properties provide an alternative access method to Org-mode
+features, like the TODO state or the priority of an entry, discussed in the
+previous chapters. This interface exists so that you can include
+these states in a column view (@pxref{Column view}), or to use them in
+queries. The following property names are special and should not be
+used as keys in the properties drawer:
+
+@cindex property, special, TODO
+@cindex property, special, TAGS
+@cindex property, special, ALLTAGS
+@cindex property, special, CATEGORY
+@cindex property, special, PRIORITY
+@cindex property, special, DEADLINE
+@cindex property, special, SCHEDULED
+@cindex property, special, CLOSED
+@cindex property, special, TIMESTAMP
+@cindex property, special, TIMESTAMP_IA
+@cindex property, special, CLOCKSUM
+@cindex property, special, BLOCKED
+@c guessing that ITEM is needed in this area; also, should this list be sorted?
+@cindex property, special, ITEM
+@example
+TODO @r{The TODO keyword of the entry.}
+TAGS @r{The tags defined directly in the headline.}
+ALLTAGS @r{All tags, including inherited ones.}
+CATEGORY @r{The category of an entry.}
+PRIORITY @r{The priority of the entry, a string with a single letter.}
+DEADLINE @r{The deadline time string, without the angular brackets.}
+SCHEDULED @r{The scheduling timestamp, without the angular brackets.}
+CLOSED @r{When was this entry closed?}
+TIMESTAMP @r{The first keyword-less timestamp in the entry.}
+TIMESTAMP_IA @r{The first inactive timestamp in the entry.}
+CLOCKSUM @r{The sum of CLOCK intervals in the subtree. @code{org-clock-sum}}
+ @r{must be run first to compute the values.}
+BLOCKED @r{"t" if task is currently blocked by children or siblings}
+ITEM @r{The content of the entry.}
+@end example
+
+@node Property searches, Property inheritance, Special properties, Properties and Columns
+@section Property searches
+@cindex properties, searching
+@cindex searching, of properties
+
+To create sparse trees and special lists with selection based on properties,
+the same commands are used as for tag searches (@pxref{Tag searches}).
+@table @kbd
+@orgcmdkkc{C-c / m,C-c \,org-match-sparse-tree}
+Create a sparse tree with all matching entries. With a
+@kbd{C-u} prefix argument, ignore headlines that are not a TODO line.
+@orgcmd{C-c a m,org-tags-view}
+Create a global list of tag/property matches from all agenda files.
+@xref{Matching tags and properties}.
+@orgcmd{C-c a M,org-tags-view}
+@vindex org-tags-match-list-sublevels
+Create a global list of tag matches from all agenda files, but check
+only TODO items and force checking of subitems (see variable
+@code{org-tags-match-list-sublevels}).
+@end table
+
+The syntax for the search string is described in @ref{Matching tags and
+properties}.
+
+There is also a special command for creating sparse trees based on a
+single property:
+
+@table @kbd
+@orgkey{C-c / p}
+Create a sparse tree based on the value of a property. This first
+prompts for the name of a property, and then for a value. A sparse tree
+is created with all entries that define this property with the given
+value. If you enclose the value in curly braces, it is interpreted as
+a regular expression and matched against the property values.
+@end table
+
+@node Property inheritance, Column view, Property searches, Properties and Columns
+@section Property Inheritance
+@cindex properties, inheritance
+@cindex inheritance, of properties
+
+@vindex org-use-property-inheritance
+The outline structure of Org-mode documents lends itself to an
+inheritance model of properties: if the parent in a tree has a certain
+property, the children can inherit this property. Org-mode does not
+turn this on by default, because it can slow down property searches
+significantly and is often not needed. However, if you find inheritance
+useful, you can turn it on by setting the variable
+@code{org-use-property-inheritance}. It may be set to @code{t} to make
+all properties inherited from the parent, to a list of properties
+that should be inherited, or to a regular expression that matches
+inherited properties. If a property has the value @samp{nil}, this is
+interpreted as an explicit undefine of the property, so that inheritance
+search will stop at this value and return @code{nil}.
+
+Org-mode has a few properties for which inheritance is hard-coded, at
+least for the special applications for which they are used:
+
+@cindex property, COLUMNS
+@table @code
+@item COLUMNS
+The @code{:COLUMNS:} property defines the format of column view
+(@pxref{Column view}). It is inherited in the sense that the level
+where a @code{:COLUMNS:} property is defined is used as the starting
+point for a column view table, independently of the location in the
+subtree from where columns view is turned on.
+@item CATEGORY
+@cindex property, CATEGORY
+For agenda view, a category set through a @code{:CATEGORY:} property
+applies to the entire subtree.
+@item ARCHIVE
+@cindex property, ARCHIVE
+For archiving, the @code{:ARCHIVE:} property may define the archive
+location for the entire subtree (@pxref{Moving subtrees}).
+@item LOGGING
+@cindex property, LOGGING
+The LOGGING property may define logging settings for an entry or a
+subtree (@pxref{Tracking TODO state changes}).
+@end table
+
+@node Column view, Property API, Property inheritance, Properties and Columns
+@section Column view
+
+A great way to view and edit properties in an outline tree is
+@emph{column view}. In column view, each outline node is turned into a
+table row. Columns in this table provide access to properties of the
+entries. Org-mode implements columns by overlaying a tabular structure
+over the headline of each item. While the headlines have been turned
+into a table row, you can still change the visibility of the outline
+tree. For example, you get a compact table by switching to CONTENTS
+view (@kbd{S-@key{TAB} S-@key{TAB}}, or simply @kbd{c} while column view
+is active), but you can still open, read, and edit the entry below each
+headline. Or, you can switch to column view after executing a sparse
+tree command and in this way get a table only for the selected items.
+Column view also works in agenda buffers (@pxref{Agenda Views}) where
+queries have collected selected items, possibly from a number of files.
+
+@menu
+* Defining columns:: The COLUMNS format property
+* Using column view:: How to create and use column view
+* Capturing column view:: A dynamic block for column view
+@end menu
+
+@node Defining columns, Using column view, Column view, Column view
+@subsection Defining columns
+@cindex column view, for properties
+@cindex properties, column view
+
+Setting up a column view first requires defining the columns. This is
+done by defining a column format line.
+
+@menu
+* Scope of column definitions:: Where defined, where valid?
+* Column attributes:: Appearance and content of a column
+@end menu
+
+@node Scope of column definitions, Column attributes, Defining columns, Defining columns
+@subsubsection Scope of column definitions
+
+To define a column format for an entire file, use a line like
+
+@cindex #+COLUMNS
+@example
+#+COLUMNS: %25ITEM %TAGS %PRIORITY %TODO
+@end example
+
+To specify a format that only applies to a specific tree, add a
+@code{:COLUMNS:} property to the top node of that tree, for example:
+
+@example
+** Top node for columns view
+ :PROPERTIES:
+ :COLUMNS: %25ITEM %TAGS %PRIORITY %TODO
+ :END:
+@end example
+
+If a @code{:COLUMNS:} property is present in an entry, it defines columns
+for the entry itself, and for the entire subtree below it. Since the
+column definition is part of the hierarchical structure of the document,
+you can define columns on level 1 that are general enough for all
+sublevels, and more specific columns further down, when you edit a
+deeper part of the tree.
+
+@node Column attributes, , Scope of column definitions, Defining columns
+@subsubsection Column attributes
+A column definition sets the attributes of a column. The general
+definition looks like this:
+
+@example
+ %[@var{width}]@var{property}[(@var{title})][@{@var{summary-type}@}]
+@end example
+
+@noindent
+Except for the percent sign and the property name, all items are
+optional. The individual parts have the following meaning:
+
+@example
+@var{width} @r{An integer specifying the width of the column in characters.}
+ @r{If omitted, the width will be determined automatically.}
+@var{property} @r{The property that should be edited in this column.}
+ @r{Special properties representing meta data are allowed here}
+ @r{as well (@pxref{Special properties})}
+@var{title} @r{The header text for the column. If omitted, the property}
+ @r{name is used.}
+@{@var{summary-type}@} @r{The summary type. If specified, the column values for}
+ @r{parent nodes are computed from the children.}
+ @r{Supported summary types are:}
+ @{+@} @r{Sum numbers in this column.}
+ @{+;%.1f@} @r{Like @samp{+}, but format result with @samp{%.1f}.}
+ @{$@} @r{Currency, short for @samp{+;%.2f}.}
+ @{:@} @r{Sum times, HH:MM, plain numbers are hours.}
+ @{X@} @r{Checkbox status, @samp{[X]} if all children are @samp{[X]}.}
+ @{X/@} @r{Checkbox status, @samp{[n/m]}.}
+ @{X%@} @r{Checkbox status, @samp{[n%]}.}
+ @{min@} @r{Smallest number in column.}
+ @{max@} @r{Largest number.}
+ @{mean@} @r{Arithmetic mean of numbers.}
+ @{:min@} @r{Smallest time value in column.}
+ @{:max@} @r{Largest time value.}
+ @{:mean@} @r{Arithmetic mean of time values.}
+ @{@@min@} @r{Minimum age (in days/hours/mins/seconds).}
+ @{@@max@} @r{Maximum age (in days/hours/mins/seconds).}
+ @{@@mean@} @r{Arithmetic mean of ages (in days/hours/mins/seconds).}
+ @{est+@} @r{Add low-high estimates.}
+@end example
+
+@noindent
+Be aware that you can only have one summary type for any property you
+include. Subsequent columns referencing the same property will all display the
+same summary information.
+
+The @code{est+} summary type requires further explanation. It is used for
+combining estimates, expressed as low-high ranges. For example, instead
+of estimating a particular task will take 5 days, you might estimate it as
+5-6 days if you're fairly confident you know how much work is required, or
+1-10 days if you don't really know what needs to be done. Both ranges
+average at 5.5 days, but the first represents a more predictable delivery.
+
+When combining a set of such estimates, simply adding the lows and highs
+produces an unrealistically wide result. Instead, @code{est+} adds the
+statistical mean and variance of the sub-tasks, generating a final estimate
+from the sum. For example, suppose you had ten tasks, each of which was
+estimated at 0.5 to 2 days of work. Straight addition produces an estimate
+of 5 to 20 days, representing what to expect if everything goes either
+extremely well or extremely poorly. In contrast, @code{est+} estimates the
+full job more realistically, at 10-15 days.
+
+Here is an example for a complete columns definition, along with allowed
+values.
+
+@example
+:COLUMNS: %25ITEM %9Approved(Approved?)@{X@} %Owner %11Status \@footnote{Please note that the COLUMNS definition must be on a single line---it is wrapped here only because of formatting constraints.}
+ %10Time_Estimate@{:@} %CLOCKSUM
+:Owner_ALL: Tammy Mark Karl Lisa Don
+:Status_ALL: "In progress" "Not started yet" "Finished" ""
+:Approved_ALL: "[ ]" "[X]"
+@end example
+
+@noindent
+The first column, @samp{%25ITEM}, means the first 25 characters of the
+item itself, i.e. of the headline. You probably always should start the
+column definition with the @samp{ITEM} specifier. The other specifiers
+create columns @samp{Owner} with a list of names as allowed values, for
+@samp{Status} with four different possible values, and for a checkbox
+field @samp{Approved}. When no width is given after the @samp{%}
+character, the column will be exactly as wide as it needs to be in order
+to fully display all values. The @samp{Approved} column does have a
+modified title (@samp{Approved?}, with a question mark). Summaries will
+be created for the @samp{Time_Estimate} column by adding time duration
+expressions like HH:MM, and for the @samp{Approved} column, by providing
+an @samp{[X]} status if all children have been checked. The
+@samp{CLOCKSUM} column is special, it lists the sum of CLOCK intervals
+in the subtree.
+
+@node Using column view, Capturing column view, Defining columns, Column view
+@subsection Using column view
+
+@table @kbd
+@tsubheading{Turning column view on and off}
+@orgcmd{C-c C-x C-c,org-columns}
+@vindex org-columns-default-format
+Turn on column view. If the cursor is before the first headline in the file,
+column view is turned on for the entire file, using the @code{#+COLUMNS}
+definition. If the cursor is somewhere inside the outline, this command
+searches the hierarchy, up from point, for a @code{:COLUMNS:} property that
+defines a format. When one is found, the column view table is established
+for the tree starting at the entry that contains the @code{:COLUMNS:}
+property. If no such property is found, the format is taken from the
+@code{#+COLUMNS} line or from the variable @code{org-columns-default-format},
+and column view is established for the current entry and its subtree.
+@orgcmd{r,org-columns-redo}
+Recreate the column view, to include recent changes made in the buffer.
+@orgcmd{g,org-columns-redo}
+Same as @kbd{r}.
+@orgcmd{q,org-columns-quit}
+Exit column view.
+@tsubheading{Editing values}
+@item @key{left} @key{right} @key{up} @key{down}
+Move through the column view from field to field.
+@kindex S-@key{left}
+@kindex S-@key{right}
+@item S-@key{left}/@key{right}
+Switch to the next/previous allowed value of the field. For this, you
+have to have specified allowed values for a property.
+@item 1..9,0
+Directly select the Nth allowed value, @kbd{0} selects the 10th value.
+@orgcmdkkcc{n,p,org-columns-next-allowed-value,org-columns-previous-allowed-value}
+Same as @kbd{S-@key{left}/@key{right}}
+@orgcmd{e,org-columns-edit-value}
+Edit the property at point. For the special properties, this will
+invoke the same interface that you normally use to change that
+property. For example, when editing a TAGS property, the tag completion
+or fast selection interface will pop up.
+@orgcmd{C-c C-c,org-columns-set-tags-or-toggle}
+When there is a checkbox at point, toggle it.
+@orgcmd{v,org-columns-show-value}
+View the full value of this property. This is useful if the width of
+the column is smaller than that of the value.
+@orgcmd{a,org-columns-edit-allowed}
+Edit the list of allowed values for this property. If the list is found
+in the hierarchy, the modified values is stored there. If no list is
+found, the new value is stored in the first entry that is part of the
+current column view.
+@tsubheading{Modifying the table structure}
+@orgcmdkkcc{<,>,org-columns-narrow,org-columns-widen}
+Make the column narrower/wider by one character.
+@orgcmd{S-M-@key{right},org-columns-new}
+Insert a new column, to the left of the current column.
+@orgcmd{S-M-@key{left},org-columns-delete}
+Delete the current column.
+@end table
+
+@node Capturing column view, , Using column view, Column view
+@subsection Capturing column view
+
+Since column view is just an overlay over a buffer, it cannot be
+exported or printed directly. If you want to capture a column view, use
+a @code{columnview} dynamic block (@pxref{Dynamic blocks}). The frame
+of this block looks like this:
+
+@cindex #+BEGIN, columnview
+@example
+* The column view
+#+BEGIN: columnview :hlines 1 :id "label"
+
+#+END:
+@end example
+
+@noindent This dynamic block has the following parameters:
+
+@table @code
+@item :id
+This is the most important parameter. Column view is a feature that is
+often localized to a certain (sub)tree, and the capture block might be
+at a different location in the file. To identify the tree whose view to
+capture, you can use 4 values:
+@cindex property, ID
+@example
+local @r{use the tree in which the capture block is located}
+global @r{make a global view, including all headings in the file}
+"file:@var{path-to-file}"
+ @r{run column view at the top of this file}
+"@var{ID}" @r{call column view in the tree that has an @code{:ID:}}
+ @r{property with the value @i{label}. You can use}
+ @r{@kbd{M-x org-id-copy} to create a globally unique ID for}
+ @r{the current entry and copy it to the kill-ring.}
+@end example
+@item :hlines
+When @code{t}, insert an hline after every line. When a number @var{N}, insert
+an hline before each headline with level @code{<= @var{N}}.
+@item :vlines
+When set to @code{t}, force column groups to get vertical lines.
+@item :maxlevel
+When set to a number, don't capture entries below this level.
+@item :skip-empty-rows
+When set to @code{t}, skip rows where the only non-empty specifier of the
+column view is @code{ITEM}.
+
+@end table
+
+@noindent
+The following commands insert or update the dynamic block:
+
+@table @kbd
+@orgcmd{C-c C-x i,org-insert-columns-dblock}
+Insert a dynamic block capturing a column view. You will be prompted
+for the scope or ID of the view.
+@orgcmdkkc{C-c C-c,C-c C-x C-u,org-dblock-update}
+Update dynamic block at point. The cursor needs to be in the
+@code{#+BEGIN} line of the dynamic block.
+@orgcmd{C-u C-c C-x C-u,org-update-all-dblocks}
+Update all dynamic blocks (@pxref{Dynamic blocks}). This is useful if
+you have several clock table blocks, column-capturing blocks or other dynamic
+blocks in a buffer.
+@end table
+
+You can add formulas to the column view table and you may add plotting
+instructions in front of the table---these will survive an update of the
+block. If there is a @code{#+TBLFM:} after the table, the table will
+actually be recalculated automatically after an update.
+
+An alternative way to capture and process property values into a table is
+provided by Eric Schulte's @file{org-collector.el} which is a contributed
+package@footnote{Contributed packages are not part of Emacs, but are
+distributed with the main distribution of Org (visit
+@uref{http://orgmode.org}).}. It provides a general API to collect
+properties from entries in a certain scope, and arbitrary Lisp expressions to
+process these values before inserting them into a table or a dynamic block.
+
+@node Property API, , Column view, Properties and Columns
+@section The Property API
+@cindex properties, API
+@cindex API, for properties
+
+There is a full API for accessing and changing properties. This API can
+be used by Emacs Lisp programs to work with properties and to implement
+features based on them. For more information see @ref{Using the
+property API}.
+
+@node Dates and Times, Capture - Refile - Archive, Properties and Columns, Top
+@chapter Dates and times
+@cindex dates
+@cindex times
+@cindex timestamp
+@cindex date stamp
+
+To assist project planning, TODO items can be labeled with a date and/or
+a time. The specially formatted string carrying the date and time
+information is called a @emph{timestamp} in Org-mode. This may be a
+little confusing because timestamp is often used as indicating when
+something was created or last changed. However, in Org-mode this term
+is used in a much wider sense.
+
+@menu
+* Timestamps:: Assigning a time to a tree entry
+* Creating timestamps:: Commands which insert timestamps
+* Deadlines and scheduling:: Planning your work
+* Clocking work time:: Tracking how long you spend on a task
+* Effort estimates:: Planning work effort in advance
+* Relative timer:: Notes with a running timer
+* Countdown timer:: Starting a countdown timer for a task
+@end menu
+
+
+@node Timestamps, Creating timestamps, Dates and Times, Dates and Times
+@section Timestamps, deadlines, and scheduling
+@cindex timestamps
+@cindex ranges, time
+@cindex date stamps
+@cindex deadlines
+@cindex scheduling
+
+A timestamp is a specification of a date (possibly with a time or a range of
+times) in a special format, either @samp{<2003-09-16 Tue>} or
+@samp{<2003-09-16 Tue 09:39>} or @samp{<2003-09-16 Tue
+12:00-12:30>}@footnote{This is inspired by the standard ISO 8601 date/time
+format. To use an alternative format, see @ref{Custom time format}.}. A
+timestamp can appear anywhere in the headline or body of an Org tree entry.
+Its presence causes entries to be shown on specific dates in the agenda
+(@pxref{Weekly/daily agenda}). We distinguish:
+
+@table @var
+@item Plain timestamp; Event; Appointment
+@cindex timestamp
+A simple timestamp just assigns a date/time to an item. This is just
+like writing down an appointment or event in a paper agenda. In the
+timeline and agenda displays, the headline of an entry associated with a
+plain timestamp will be shown exactly on that date.
+
+@example
+* Meet Peter at the movies <2006-11-01 Wed 19:15>
+* Discussion on climate change <2006-11-02 Thu 20:00-22:00>
+@end example
+
+@item Timestamp with repeater interval
+@cindex timestamp, with repeater interval
+A timestamp may contain a @emph{repeater interval}, indicating that it
+applies not only on the given date, but again and again after a certain
+interval of N days (d), weeks (w), months (m), or years (y). The
+following will show up in the agenda every Wednesday:
+
+@example
+* Pick up Sam at school <2007-05-16 Wed 12:30 +1w>
+@end example
+
+@item Diary-style sexp entries
+For more complex date specifications, Org-mode supports using the
+special sexp diary entries implemented in the Emacs calendar/diary
+package. For example
+
+@example
+* The nerd meeting on every 2nd Thursday of the month
+ <%%(diary-float t 4 2)>
+@end example
+
+@item Time/Date range
+@cindex timerange
+@cindex date range
+Two timestamps connected by @samp{--} denote a range. The headline
+will be shown on the first and last day of the range, and on any dates
+that are displayed and fall in the range. Here is an example:
+
+@example
+** Meeting in Amsterdam
+ <2004-08-23 Mon>--<2004-08-26 Thu>
+@end example
+
+@item Inactive timestamp
+@cindex timestamp, inactive
+@cindex inactive timestamp
+Just like a plain timestamp, but with square brackets instead of
+angular ones. These timestamps are inactive in the sense that they do
+@emph{not} trigger an entry to show up in the agenda.
+
+@example
+* Gillian comes late for the fifth time [2006-11-01 Wed]
+@end example
+
+@end table
+
+@node Creating timestamps, Deadlines and scheduling, Timestamps, Dates and Times
+@section Creating timestamps
+@cindex creating timestamps
+@cindex timestamps, creating
+
+For Org-mode to recognize timestamps, they need to be in the specific
+format. All commands listed below produce timestamps in the correct
+format.
+
+@table @kbd
+@orgcmd{C-c .,org-time-stamp}
+Prompt for a date and insert a corresponding timestamp. When the cursor is
+at an existing timestamp in the buffer, the command is used to modify this
+timestamp instead of inserting a new one. When this command is used twice in
+succession, a time range is inserted.
+@c
+@orgcmd{C-c !,org-time-stamp-inactive}
+Like @kbd{C-c .}, but insert an inactive timestamp that will not cause
+an agenda entry.
+@c
+@kindex C-u C-c .
+@kindex C-u C-c !
+@item C-u C-c .
+@itemx C-u C-c !
+@vindex org-time-stamp-rounding-minutes
+Like @kbd{C-c .} and @kbd{C-c !}, but use the alternative format which
+contains date and time. The default time can be rounded to multiples of 5
+minutes, see the option @code{org-time-stamp-rounding-minutes}.
+@c
+@orgcmd{C-c <,org-date-from-calendar}
+Insert a timestamp corresponding to the cursor date in the Calendar.
+@c
+@orgcmd{C-c >,org-goto-calendar}
+Access the Emacs calendar for the current date. If there is a
+timestamp in the current line, go to the corresponding date
+instead.
+@c
+@orgcmd{C-c C-o,org-open-at-point}
+Access the agenda for the date given by the timestamp or -range at
+point (@pxref{Weekly/daily agenda}).
+@c
+@orgcmdkkcc{S-@key{left},S-@key{right},org-timestamp-down-day,org-timestamp-up-day}
+Change date at cursor by one day. These key bindings conflict with
+shift-selection and related modes (@pxref{Conflicts}).
+@c
+@orgcmdkkcc{S-@key{up},S-@key{down},org-timestamp-up,org-timestamp-down-down}
+Change the item under the cursor in a timestamp. The cursor can be on a
+year, month, day, hour or minute. When the timestamp contains a time range
+like @samp{15:30-16:30}, modifying the first time will also shift the second,
+shifting the time block with constant length. To change the length, modify
+the second time. Note that if the cursor is in a headline and not at a
+timestamp, these same keys modify the priority of an item.
+(@pxref{Priorities}). The key bindings also conflict with shift-selection and
+related modes (@pxref{Conflicts}).
+@c
+@orgcmd{C-c C-y,org-evaluate-time-range}
+@cindex evaluate time range
+Evaluate a time range by computing the difference between start and end.
+With a prefix argument, insert result after the time range (in a table: into
+the following column).
+@end table
+
+
+@menu
+* The date/time prompt:: How Org-mode helps you entering date and time
+* Custom time format:: Making dates look different
+@end menu
+
+@node The date/time prompt, Custom time format, Creating timestamps, Creating timestamps
+@subsection The date/time prompt
+@cindex date, reading in minibuffer
+@cindex time, reading in minibuffer
+
+@vindex org-read-date-prefer-future
+When Org-mode prompts for a date/time, the default is shown in default
+date/time format, and the prompt therefore seems to ask for a specific
+format. But it will in fact accept any string containing some date and/or
+time information, and it is really smart about interpreting your input. You
+can, for example, use @kbd{C-y} to paste a (possibly multi-line) string
+copied from an email message. Org-mode will find whatever information is in
+there and derive anything you have not specified from the @emph{default date
+and time}. The default is usually the current date and time, but when
+modifying an existing timestamp, or when entering the second stamp of a
+range, it is taken from the stamp in the buffer. When filling in
+information, Org-mode assumes that most of the time you will want to enter a
+date in the future: if you omit the month/year and the given day/month is
+@i{before} today, it will assume that you mean a future date@footnote{See the
+variable @code{org-read-date-prefer-future}. You may set that variable to
+the symbol @code{time} to even make a time before now shift the date to
+tomorrow.}. If the date has been automatically shifted into the future, the
+time prompt will show this with @samp{(=>F).}
+
+For example, let's assume that today is @b{June 13, 2006}. Here is how
+various inputs will be interpreted, the items filled in by Org-mode are
+in @b{bold}.
+
+@example
+3-2-5 --> 2003-02-05
+2/5/3 --> 2003-02-05
+14 --> @b{2006}-@b{06}-14
+12 --> @b{2006}-@b{07}-12
+2/5 --> @b{2007}-02-05
+Fri --> nearest Friday (default date or later)
+sep 15 --> @b{2006}-09-15
+feb 15 --> @b{2007}-02-15
+sep 12 9 --> 2009-09-12
+12:45 --> @b{2006}-@b{06}-@b{13} 12:45
+22 sept 0:34 --> @b{2006}-09-22 0:34
+w4 --> ISO week for of the current year @b{2006}
+2012 w4 fri --> Friday of ISO week 4 in 2012
+2012-w04-5 --> Same as above
+@end example
+
+Furthermore you can specify a relative date by giving, as the
+@emph{first} thing in the input: a plus/minus sign, a number and a
+letter ([dwmy]) to indicate change in days, weeks, months, or years. With a
+single plus or minus, the date is always relative to today. With a
+double plus or minus, it is relative to the default date. If instead of
+a single letter, you use the abbreviation of day name, the date will be
+the Nth such day. E.g.
+
+@example
++0 --> today
+. --> today
++4d --> four days from today
++4 --> same as above
++2w --> two weeks from today
+++5 --> five days from default date
++2tue --> second Tuesday from now.
+@end example
+
+@vindex parse-time-months
+@vindex parse-time-weekdays
+The function understands English month and weekday abbreviations. If
+you want to use unabbreviated names and/or other languages, configure
+the variables @code{parse-time-months} and @code{parse-time-weekdays}.
+
+You can specify a time range by giving start and end times or by giving a
+start time and a duration (in HH:MM format). Use `-' or `-@{@}-' as the separator
+in the former case and use '+' as the separator in the latter case. E.g.
+
+@example
+11am-1:15pm --> 11:00-13:15
+11am--1:15pm --> same as above
+11am+2:15 --> same as above
+@end example
+
+@cindex calendar, for selecting date
+@vindex org-popup-calendar-for-date-prompt
+Parallel to the minibuffer prompt, a calendar is popped up@footnote{If
+you don't need/want the calendar, configure the variable
+@code{org-popup-calendar-for-date-prompt}.}. When you exit the date
+prompt, either by clicking on a date in the calendar, or by pressing
+@key{RET}, the date selected in the calendar will be combined with the
+information entered at the prompt. You can control the calendar fully
+from the minibuffer:
+
+@kindex <
+@kindex >
+@kindex M-v
+@kindex C-v
+@kindex mouse-1
+@kindex S-@key{right}
+@kindex S-@key{left}
+@kindex S-@key{down}
+@kindex S-@key{up}
+@kindex M-S-@key{right}
+@kindex M-S-@key{left}
+@kindex @key{RET}
+@example
+@key{RET} @r{Choose date at cursor in calendar.}
+mouse-1 @r{Select date by clicking on it.}
+S-@key{right}/@key{left} @r{One day forward/backward.}
+S-@key{down}/@key{up} @r{One week forward/backward.}
+M-S-@key{right}/@key{left} @r{One month forward/backward.}
+> / < @r{Scroll calendar forward/backward by one month.}
+M-v / C-v @r{Scroll calendar forward/backward by 3 months.}
+@end example
+
+@vindex org-read-date-display-live
+The actions of the date/time prompt may seem complex, but I assure you they
+will grow on you, and you will start getting annoyed by pretty much any other
+way of entering a date/time out there. To help you understand what is going
+on, the current interpretation of your input will be displayed live in the
+minibuffer@footnote{If you find this distracting, turn the display of with
+@code{org-read-date-display-live}.}.
+
+@node Custom time format, , The date/time prompt, Creating timestamps
+@subsection Custom time format
+@cindex custom date/time format
+@cindex time format, custom
+@cindex date format, custom
+
+@vindex org-display-custom-times
+@vindex org-time-stamp-custom-formats
+Org-mode uses the standard ISO notation for dates and times as it is
+defined in ISO 8601. If you cannot get used to this and require another
+representation of date and time to keep you happy, you can get it by
+customizing the variables @code{org-display-custom-times} and
+@code{org-time-stamp-custom-formats}.
+
+@table @kbd
+@orgcmd{C-c C-x C-t,org-toggle-time-stamp-overlays}
+Toggle the display of custom formats for dates and times.
+@end table
+
+@noindent
+Org-mode needs the default format for scanning, so the custom date/time
+format does not @emph{replace} the default format---instead it is put
+@emph{over} the default format using text properties. This has the
+following consequences:
+@itemize @bullet
+@item
+You cannot place the cursor onto a timestamp anymore, only before or
+after.
+@item
+The @kbd{S-@key{up}/@key{down}} keys can no longer be used to adjust
+each component of a timestamp. If the cursor is at the beginning of
+the stamp, @kbd{S-@key{up}/@key{down}} will change the stamp by one day,
+just like @kbd{S-@key{left}/@key{right}}. At the end of the stamp, the
+time will be changed by one minute.
+@item
+If the timestamp contains a range of clock times or a repeater, these
+will not be overlaid, but remain in the buffer as they were.
+@item
+When you delete a timestamp character-by-character, it will only
+disappear from the buffer after @emph{all} (invisible) characters
+belonging to the ISO timestamp have been removed.
+@item
+If the custom timestamp format is longer than the default and you are
+using dates in tables, table alignment will be messed up. If the custom
+format is shorter, things do work as expected.
+@end itemize
+
+
+@node Deadlines and scheduling, Clocking work time, Creating timestamps, Dates and Times
+@section Deadlines and scheduling
+
+A timestamp may be preceded by special keywords to facilitate planning:
+
+@table @var
+@item DEADLINE
+@cindex DEADLINE keyword
+
+Meaning: the task (most likely a TODO item, though not necessarily) is supposed
+to be finished on that date.
+
+@vindex org-deadline-warning-days
+On the deadline date, the task will be listed in the agenda. In
+addition, the agenda for @emph{today} will carry a warning about the
+approaching or missed deadline, starting
+@code{org-deadline-warning-days} before the due date, and continuing
+until the entry is marked DONE. An example:
+
+@example
+*** TODO write article about the Earth for the Guide
+ The editor in charge is [[bbdb:Ford Prefect]]
+ DEADLINE: <2004-02-29 Sun>
+@end example
+
+You can specify a different lead time for warnings for a specific
+deadlines using the following syntax. Here is an example with a warning
+period of 5 days @code{DEADLINE: <2004-02-29 Sun -5d>}.
+
+@item SCHEDULED
+@cindex SCHEDULED keyword
+
+Meaning: you are planning to start working on that task on the given
+date.
+
+@vindex org-agenda-skip-scheduled-if-done
+The headline will be listed under the given date@footnote{It will still
+be listed on that date after it has been marked DONE. If you don't like
+this, set the variable @code{org-agenda-skip-scheduled-if-done}.}. In
+addition, a reminder that the scheduled date has passed will be present
+in the compilation for @emph{today}, until the entry is marked DONE, i.e.
+the task will automatically be forwarded until completed.
+
+@example
+*** TODO Call Trillian for a date on New Years Eve.
+ SCHEDULED: <2004-12-25 Sat>
+@end example
+
+@noindent
+@b{Important:} Scheduling an item in Org-mode should @i{not} be
+understood in the same way that we understand @i{scheduling a meeting}.
+Setting a date for a meeting is just a simple appointment, you should
+mark this entry with a simple plain timestamp, to get this item shown
+on the date where it applies. This is a frequent misunderstanding by
+Org users. In Org-mode, @i{scheduling} means setting a date when you
+want to start working on an action item.
+@end table
+
+You may use timestamps with repeaters in scheduling and deadline
+entries. Org-mode will issue early and late warnings based on the
+assumption that the timestamp represents the @i{nearest instance} of
+the repeater. However, the use of diary sexp entries like
+@c
+@code{<%%(diary-float t 42)>}
+@c
+in scheduling and deadline timestamps is limited. Org-mode does not
+know enough about the internals of each sexp function to issue early and
+late warnings. However, it will show the item on each day where the
+sexp entry matches.
+
+@menu
+* Inserting deadline/schedule:: Planning items
+* Repeated tasks:: Items that show up again and again
+@end menu
+
+@node Inserting deadline/schedule, Repeated tasks, Deadlines and scheduling, Deadlines and scheduling
+@subsection Inserting deadlines or schedules
+
+The following commands allow you to quickly insert a deadline or to schedule
+an item:
+
+@table @kbd
+@c
+@orgcmd{C-c C-d,org-deadline}
+Insert @samp{DEADLINE} keyword along with a stamp. The insertion will happen
+in the line directly following the headline. When called with a prefix arg,
+an existing deadline will be removed from the entry. Depending on the
+variable @code{org-log-redeadline}@footnote{with corresponding
+@code{#+STARTUP} keywords @code{logredeadline}, @code{lognoteredeadline},
+and @code{nologredeadline}}, a note will be taken when changing an existing
+deadline.
+@c FIXME Any CLOSED timestamp will be removed.????????
+@c
+@orgcmd{C-c C-s,org-schedule}
+Insert @samp{SCHEDULED} keyword along with a stamp. The insertion will
+happen in the line directly following the headline. Any CLOSED timestamp
+will be removed. When called with a prefix argument, remove the scheduling
+date from the entry. Depending on the variable
+@code{org-log-reschedule}@footnote{with corresponding @code{#+STARTUP}
+keywords @code{logredeadline}, @code{lognoteredeadline}, and
+@code{nologredeadline}}, a note will be taken when changing an existing
+scheduling time.
+@c
+@orgcmd{C-c C-x C-k,org-mark-entry-for-agenda-action}
+@kindex k a
+@kindex k s
+Mark the current entry for agenda action. After you have marked the entry
+like this, you can open the agenda or the calendar to find an appropriate
+date. With the cursor on the selected date, press @kbd{k s} or @kbd{k d} to
+schedule the marked item.
+@c
+@orgcmd{C-c / d,org-check-deadlines}
+@cindex sparse tree, for deadlines
+@vindex org-deadline-warning-days
+Create a sparse tree with all deadlines that are either past-due, or
+which will become due within @code{org-deadline-warning-days}.
+With @kbd{C-u} prefix, show all deadlines in the file. With a numeric
+prefix, check that many days. For example, @kbd{C-1 C-c / d} shows
+all deadlines due tomorrow.
+@c
+@orgcmd{C-c / b,org-check-before-date}
+Sparse tree for deadlines and scheduled items before a given date.
+@c
+@orgcmd{C-c / a,org-check-after-date}
+Sparse tree for deadlines and scheduled items after a given date.
+@end table
+
+@node Repeated tasks, , Inserting deadline/schedule, Deadlines and scheduling
+@subsection Repeated tasks
+@cindex tasks, repeated
+@cindex repeated tasks
+
+Some tasks need to be repeated again and again. Org-mode helps to
+organize such tasks using a so-called repeater in a DEADLINE, SCHEDULED,
+or plain timestamp. In the following example
+@example
+** TODO Pay the rent
+ DEADLINE: <2005-10-01 Sat +1m>
+@end example
+@noindent
+the @code{+1m} is a repeater; the intended interpretation is that the task
+has a deadline on <2005-10-01> and repeats itself every (one) month starting
+from that time. If you need both a repeater and a special warning period in
+a deadline entry, the repeater should come first and the warning period last:
+@code{DEADLINE: <2005-10-01 Sat +1m -3d>}.
+
+@vindex org-todo-repeat-to-state
+Deadlines and scheduled items produce entries in the agenda when they are
+over-due, so it is important to be able to mark such an entry as completed
+once you have done so. When you mark a DEADLINE or a SCHEDULE with the TODO
+keyword DONE, it will no longer produce entries in the agenda. The problem
+with this is, however, that then also the @emph{next} instance of the
+repeated entry will not be active. Org-mode deals with this in the following
+way: When you try to mark such an entry DONE (using @kbd{C-c C-t}), it will
+shift the base date of the repeating timestamp by the repeater interval, and
+immediately set the entry state back to TODO@footnote{In fact, the target
+state is taken from, in this sequence, the @code{REPEAT_TO_STATE} property or
+the variable @code{org-todo-repeat-to-state}. If neither of these is
+specified, the target state defaults to the first state of the TODO state
+sequence.}. In the example above, setting the state to DONE would actually
+switch the date like this:
+
+@example
+** TODO Pay the rent
+ DEADLINE: <2005-11-01 Tue +1m>
+@end example
+
+@vindex org-log-repeat
+A timestamp@footnote{You can change this using the option
+@code{org-log-repeat}, or the @code{#+STARTUP} options @code{logrepeat},
+@code{lognoterepeat}, and @code{nologrepeat}. With @code{lognoterepeat}, you
+will also be prompted for a note.} will be added under the deadline, to keep
+a record that you actually acted on the previous instance of this deadline.
+
+As a consequence of shifting the base date, this entry will no longer be
+visible in the agenda when checking past dates, but all future instances
+will be visible.
+
+With the @samp{+1m} cookie, the date shift will always be exactly one
+month. So if you have not paid the rent for three months, marking this
+entry DONE will still keep it as an overdue deadline. Depending on the
+task, this may not be the best way to handle it. For example, if you
+forgot to call your father for 3 weeks, it does not make sense to call
+him 3 times in a single day to make up for it. Finally, there are tasks
+like changing batteries which should always repeat a certain time
+@i{after} the last time you did it. For these tasks, Org-mode has
+special repeaters @samp{++} and @samp{.+}. For example:
+
+@example
+** TODO Call Father
+ DEADLINE: <2008-02-10 Sun ++1w>
+ Marking this DONE will shift the date by at least one week,
+ but also by as many weeks as it takes to get this date into
+ the future. However, it stays on a Sunday, even if you called
+ and marked it done on Saturday.
+** TODO Check the batteries in the smoke detectors
+ DEADLINE: <2005-11-01 Tue .+1m>
+ Marking this DONE will shift the date to one month after
+ today.
+@end example
+
+You may have both scheduling and deadline information for a specific
+task---just make sure that the repeater intervals on both are the same.
+
+An alternative to using a repeater is to create a number of copies of a task
+subtree, with dates shifted in each copy. The command @kbd{C-c C-x c} was
+created for this purpose, it is described in @ref{Structure editing}.
+
+
+@node Clocking work time, Effort estimates, Deadlines and scheduling, Dates and Times
+@section Clocking work time
+@cindex clocking time
+@cindex time clocking
+
+Org-mode allows you to clock the time you spend on specific tasks in a
+project. When you start working on an item, you can start the clock.
+When you stop working on that task, or when you mark the task done, the
+clock is stopped and the corresponding time interval is recorded. It
+also computes the total time spent on each subtree of a project. And it
+remembers a history or tasks recently clocked, to that you can jump quickly
+between a number of tasks absorbing your time.
+
+To save the clock history across Emacs sessions, use
+@lisp
+(setq org-clock-persist 'history)
+(org-clock-persistence-insinuate)
+@end lisp
+When you clock into a new task after resuming Emacs, the incomplete
+clock@footnote{To resume the clock under the assumption that you have worked
+on this task while outside Emacs, use @code{(setq org-clock-persist t)}.}
+will be found (@pxref{Resolving idle time}) and you will be prompted about
+what to do with it.
+
+@menu
+* Clocking commands:: Starting and stopping a clock
+* The clock table:: Detailed reports
+* Resolving idle time:: Resolving time when you've been idle
+@end menu
+
+@node Clocking commands, The clock table, Clocking work time, Clocking work time
+@subsection Clocking commands
+
+@table @kbd
+@orgcmd{C-c C-x C-i,org-clock-in}
+@vindex org-clock-into-drawer
+Start the clock on the current item (clock-in). This inserts the CLOCK
+keyword together with a timestamp. If this is not the first clocking of
+this item, the multiple CLOCK lines will be wrapped into a
+@code{:LOGBOOK:} drawer (see also the variable
+@code{org-clock-into-drawer}). When called with a @kbd{C-u} prefix argument,
+select the task from a list of recently clocked tasks. With two @kbd{C-u
+C-u} prefixes, clock into the task at point and mark it as the default task.
+The default task will always be available when selecting a clocking task,
+with letter @kbd{d}.@*
+@cindex property: CLOCK_MODELINE_TOTAL
+@cindex property: LAST_REPEAT
+@vindex org-clock-modeline-total
+While the clock is running, the current clocking time is shown in the mode
+line, along with the title of the task. The clock time shown will be all
+time ever clocked for this task and its children. If the task has an effort
+estimate (@pxref{Effort estimates}), the mode line displays the current
+clocking time against it@footnote{To add an effort estimate ``on the fly'',
+hook a function doing this to @code{org-clock-in-prepare-hook}.} If the task
+is a repeating one (@pxref{Repeated tasks}), only the time since the last
+reset of the task @footnote{as recorded by the @code{LAST_REPEAT} property}
+will be shown. More control over what time is shown can be exercised with
+the @code{CLOCK_MODELINE_TOTAL} property. It may have the values
+@code{current} to show only the current clocking instance, @code{today} to
+show all time clocked on this tasks today (see also the variable
+@code{org-extend-today-until}), @code{all} to include all time, or
+@code{auto} which is the default@footnote{See also the variable
+@code{org-clock-modeline-total}.}.@* Clicking with @kbd{mouse-1} onto the
+mode line entry will pop up a menu with clocking options.
+@c
+@orgcmd{C-c C-x C-o,org-clock-out}
+@vindex org-log-note-clock-out
+Stop the clock (clock-out). This inserts another timestamp at the same
+location where the clock was last started. It also directly computes
+the resulting time in inserts it after the time range as @samp{=>
+HH:MM}. See the variable @code{org-log-note-clock-out} for the
+possibility to record an additional note together with the clock-out
+timestamp@footnote{The corresponding in-buffer setting is:
+@code{#+STARTUP: lognoteclock-out}}.
+@orgcmd{C-c C-x C-e,org-clock-modify-effort-estimate}
+Update the effort estimate for the current clock task.
+@kindex C-c C-y
+@kindex C-c C-c
+@orgcmdkkc{C-c C-c,C-c C-y,org-evaluate-time-range}
+Recompute the time interval after changing one of the timestamps. This
+is only necessary if you edit the timestamps directly. If you change
+them with @kbd{S-@key{cursor}} keys, the update is automatic.
+@orgcmd{C-c C-t,org-todo}
+Changing the TODO state of an item to DONE automatically stops the clock
+if it is running in this same item.
+@orgcmd{C-c C-x C-x,org-clock-cancel}
+Cancel the current clock. This is useful if a clock was started by
+mistake, or if you ended up working on something else.
+@orgcmd{C-c C-x C-j,org-clock-goto}
+Jump to the headline of the currently clocked in task. With a @kbd{C-u}
+prefix arg, select the target task from a list of recently clocked tasks.
+@orgcmd{C-c C-x C-d,org-clock-display}
+@vindex org-remove-highlights-with-change
+Display time summaries for each subtree in the current buffer. This
+puts overlays at the end of each headline, showing the total time
+recorded under that heading, including the time of any subheadings. You
+can use visibility cycling to study the tree, but the overlays disappear
+when you change the buffer (see variable
+@code{org-remove-highlights-with-change}) or press @kbd{C-c C-c}.
+@end table
+
+The @kbd{l} key may be used in the timeline (@pxref{Timeline}) and in
+the agenda (@pxref{Weekly/daily agenda}) to show which tasks have been
+worked on or closed during a day.
+
+@node The clock table, Resolving idle time, Clocking commands, Clocking work time
+@subsection The clock table
+@cindex clocktable, dynamic block
+@cindex report, of clocked time
+
+Org mode can produce quite complex reports based on the time clocking
+information. Such a report is called a @emph{clock table}, because it is
+formatted as one or several Org tables.
+
+@table @kbd
+@orgcmd{C-c C-x C-r,org-clock-report}
+Insert a dynamic block (@pxref{Dynamic blocks}) containing a clock
+report as an Org-mode table into the current file. When the cursor is
+at an existing clock table, just update it. When called with a prefix
+argument, jump to the first clock report in the current document and
+update it.
+@orgcmdkkc{C-c C-c,C-c C-x C-u,org-dblock-update}
+Update dynamic block at point. The cursor needs to be in the
+@code{#+BEGIN} line of the dynamic block.
+@orgkey{C-u C-c C-x C-u}
+Update all dynamic blocks (@pxref{Dynamic blocks}). This is useful if
+you have several clock table blocks in a buffer.
+@orgcmdkxkc{S-@key{left},S-@key{right},org-clocktable-try-shift}
+Shift the current @code{:block} interval and update the table. The cursor
+needs to be in the @code{#+BEGIN: clocktable} line for this command. If
+@code{:block} is @code{today}, it will be shifted to @code{today-1} etc.
+@end table
+
+
+Here is an example of the frame for a clock table as it is inserted into the
+buffer with the @kbd{C-c C-x C-r} command:
+
+@cindex #+BEGIN, clocktable
+@example
+#+BEGIN: clocktable :maxlevel 2 :emphasize nil :scope file
+#+END: clocktable
+@end example
+@noindent
+@vindex org-clocktable-defaults
+The @samp{BEGIN} line and specify a number of options to define the scope,
+structure, and formatting of the report. Defaults for all these options can
+be configured in the variable @code{org-clocktable-defaults}.
+
+@noindent First there are options that determine which clock entries are to
+be selected:
+@example
+:maxlevel @r{Maximum level depth to which times are listed in the table.}
+ @r{Clocks at deeper levels will be summed into the upper level.}
+:scope @r{The scope to consider. This can be any of the following:}
+ nil @r{the current buffer or narrowed region}
+ file @r{the full current buffer}
+ subtree @r{the subtree where the clocktable is located}
+ tree@var{N} @r{the surrounding level @var{N} tree, for example @code{tree3}}
+ tree @r{the surrounding level 1 tree}
+ agenda @r{all agenda files}
+ ("file"..) @r{scan these files}
+ file-with-archives @r{current file and its archives}
+ agenda-with-archives @r{all agenda files, including archives}
+:block @r{The time block to consider. This block is specified either}
+ @r{absolute, or relative to the current time and may be any of}
+ @r{these formats:}
+ 2007-12-31 @r{New year eve 2007}
+ 2007-12 @r{December 2007}
+ 2007-W50 @r{ISO-week 50 in 2007}
+ 2007-Q2 @r{2nd quarter in 2007}
+ 2007 @r{the year 2007}
+ today, yesterday, today-@var{N} @r{a relative day}
+ thisweek, lastweek, thisweek-@var{N} @r{a relative week}
+ thismonth, lastmonth, thismonth-@var{N} @r{a relative month}
+ thisyear, lastyear, thisyear-@var{N} @r{a relative year}
+ @r{Use @kbd{S-@key{left}/@key{right}} keys to shift the time interval.}
+:tstart @r{A time string specifying when to start considering times.}
+:tend @r{A time string specifying when to stop considering times.}
+:step @r{@code{week} or @code{day}, to split the table into chunks.}
+ @r{To use this, @code{:block} or @code{:tstart}, @code{:tend} are needed.}
+:stepskip0 @r{Do not show steps that have zero time.}
+:fileskip0 @r{Do not show table sections from files which did not contribute.}
+:tags @r{A tags match to select entries that should contribute}.
+@end example
+
+Then there are options which determine the formatting of the table. There
+options are interpreted by the function @code{org-clocktable-write-default},
+but you can specify your own function using the @code{:formatter} parameter.
+@example
+:emphasize @r{When @code{t}, emphasize level one and level two items.}
+:link @r{Link the item headlines in the table to their origins.}
+:narrow @r{An integer to limit the width of the headline column in}
+ @r{the org table. If you write it like @samp{50!}, then the}
+ @r{headline will also be shortened in export.}
+:indent @r{Indent each headline field according to its level.}
+:tcolumns @r{Number of columns to be used for times. If this is smaller}
+ @r{than @code{:maxlevel}, lower levels will be lumped into one column.}
+:level @r{Should a level number column be included?}
+:compact @r{Abbreviation for @code{:level nil :indent t :narrow 40! :tcolumns 1}}
+ @r{All are overwritten except if there is an explicit @code{:narrow}}
+:timestamp @r{A timestamp for the entry, when available. Look for SCHEDULED,}
+ @r{DEADLINE, TIMESTAMP and TIMESTAMP_IA, in this order.}
+:formula @r{Content of a @code{#+TBLFM} line to be added and evaluated.}
+ @r{As a special case, @samp{:formula %} adds a column with % time.}
+ @r{If you do not specify a formula here, any existing formula}
+ @r{below the clock table will survive updates and be evaluated.}
+:formatter @r{A function to format clock data and insert it into the buffer.}
+@end example
+To get a clock summary of the current level 1 tree, for the current
+day, you could write
+@example
+#+BEGIN: clocktable :maxlevel 2 :block today :scope tree1 :link t
+#+END: clocktable
+@end example
+@noindent
+and to use a specific time range you could write@footnote{Note that all
+parameters must be specified in a single line---the line is broken here
+only to fit it into the manual.}
+@example
+#+BEGIN: clocktable :tstart "<2006-08-10 Thu 10:00>"
+ :tend "<2006-08-10 Thu 12:00>"
+#+END: clocktable
+@end example
+A summary of the current subtree with % times would be
+@example
+#+BEGIN: clocktable :scope subtree :link t :formula %
+#+END: clocktable
+@end example
+A horizontally compact representation of everything clocked during last week
+would be
+@example
+#+BEGIN: clocktable :scope agenda :block lastweek :compact t
+#+END: clocktable
+@end example
+
+@node Resolving idle time, , The clock table, Clocking work time
+@subsection Resolving idle time
+@cindex resolve idle time
+
+@cindex idle, resolve, dangling
+If you clock in on a work item, and then walk away from your
+computer---perhaps to take a phone call---you often need to ``resolve'' the
+time you were away by either subtracting it from the current clock, or
+applying it to another one.
+
+@vindex org-clock-idle-time
+By customizing the variable @code{org-clock-idle-time} to some integer, such
+as 10 or 15, Emacs can alert you when you get back to your computer after
+being idle for that many minutes@footnote{On computers using Mac OS X,
+idleness is based on actual user idleness, not just Emacs' idle time. For
+X11, you can install a utility program @file{x11idle.c}, available in the
+UTILITIES directory of the Org git distribution, to get the same general
+treatment of idleness. On other systems, idle time refers to Emacs idle time
+only.}, and ask what you want to do with the idle time. There will be a
+question waiting for you when you get back, indicating how much idle time has
+passed (constantly updated with the current amount), as well as a set of
+choices to correct the discrepancy:
+
+@table @kbd
+@item k
+To keep some or all of the minutes and stay clocked in, press @kbd{k}. Org
+will ask how many of the minutes to keep. Press @key{RET} to keep them all,
+effectively changing nothing, or enter a number to keep that many minutes.
+@item K
+If you use the shift key and press @kbd{K}, it will keep however many minutes
+you request and then immediately clock out of that task. If you keep all of
+the minutes, this is the same as just clocking out of the current task.
+@item s
+To keep none of the minutes, use @kbd{s} to subtract all the away time from
+the clock, and then check back in from the moment you returned.
+@item S
+To keep none of the minutes and just clock out at the start of the away time,
+use the shift key and press @kbd{S}. Remember that using shift will always
+leave you clocked out, no matter which option you choose.
+@item C
+To cancel the clock altogether, use @kbd{C}. Note that if instead of
+canceling you subtract the away time, and the resulting clock amount is less
+than a minute, the clock will still be canceled rather than clutter up the
+log with an empty entry.
+@end table
+
+What if you subtracted those away minutes from the current clock, and now
+want to apply them to a new clock? Simply clock in to any task immediately
+after the subtraction. Org will notice that you have subtracted time ``on
+the books'', so to speak, and will ask if you want to apply those minutes to
+the next task you clock in on.
+
+There is one other instance when this clock resolution magic occurs. Say you
+were clocked in and hacking away, and suddenly your cat chased a mouse who
+scared a hamster that crashed into your UPS's power button! You suddenly
+lose all your buffers, but thanks to auto-save you still have your recent Org
+mode changes, including your last clock in.
+
+If you restart Emacs and clock into any task, Org will notice that you have a
+dangling clock which was never clocked out from your last session. Using
+that clock's starting time as the beginning of the unaccounted-for period,
+Org will ask how you want to resolve that time. The logic and behavior is
+identical to dealing with away time due to idleness; it's just happening due
+to a recovery event rather than a set amount of idle time.
+
+You can also check all the files visited by your Org agenda for dangling
+clocks at any time using @kbd{M-x org-resolve-clocks}.
+
+@node Effort estimates, Relative timer, Clocking work time, Dates and Times
+@section Effort estimates
+@cindex effort estimates
+
+@cindex property, Effort
+@vindex org-effort-property
+If you want to plan your work in a very detailed way, or if you need to
+produce offers with quotations of the estimated work effort, you may want to
+assign effort estimates to entries. If you are also clocking your work, you
+may later want to compare the planned effort with the actual working time, a
+great way to improve planning estimates. Effort estimates are stored in a
+special property @samp{Effort}@footnote{You may change the property being
+used with the variable @code{org-effort-property}.}. You can set the effort
+for an entry with the following commands:
+
+@table @kbd
+@orgcmd{C-c C-x e,org-set-effort}
+Set the effort estimate for the current entry. With a numeric prefix
+argument, set it to the Nth allowed value (see below). This command is also
+accessible from the agenda with the @kbd{e} key.
+@orgcmd{C-c C-x C-e,org-clock-modify-effort-estimate}
+Modify the effort estimate of the item currently being clocked.
+@end table
+
+Clearly the best way to work with effort estimates is through column view
+(@pxref{Column view}). You should start by setting up discrete values for
+effort estimates, and a @code{COLUMNS} format that displays these values
+together with clock sums (if you want to clock your time). For a specific
+buffer you can use
+
+@example
+#+PROPERTY: Effort_ALL 0 0:10 0:30 1:00 2:00 3:00 4:00 5:00 6:00 7:00 8:00
+#+COLUMNS: %40ITEM(Task) %17Effort(Estimated Effort)@{:@} %CLOCKSUM
+@end example
+
+@noindent
+@vindex org-global-properties
+@vindex org-columns-default-format
+or, even better, you can set up these values globally by customizing the
+variables @code{org-global-properties} and @code{org-columns-default-format}.
+In particular if you want to use this setup also in the agenda, a global
+setup may be advised.
+
+The way to assign estimates to individual items is then to switch to column
+mode, and to use @kbd{S-@key{right}} and @kbd{S-@key{left}} to change the
+value. The values you enter will immediately be summed up in the hierarchy.
+In the column next to it, any clocked time will be displayed.
+
+@vindex org-agenda-columns-add-appointments-to-effort-sum
+If you switch to column view in the daily/weekly agenda, the effort column
+will summarize the estimated work effort for each day@footnote{Please note
+the pitfalls of summing hierarchical data in a flat list (@pxref{Agenda
+column view}).}, and you can use this to find space in your schedule. To get
+an overview of the entire part of the day that is committed, you can set the
+option @code{org-agenda-columns-add-appointments-to-effort-sum}. The
+appointments on a day that take place over a specified time interval will
+then also be added to the load estimate of the day.
+
+Effort estimates can be used in secondary agenda filtering that is triggered
+with the @kbd{/} key in the agenda (@pxref{Agenda commands}). If you have
+these estimates defined consistently, two or three key presses will narrow
+down the list to stuff that fits into an available time slot.
+
+@node Relative timer, Countdown timer, Effort estimates, Dates and Times
+@section Taking notes with a relative timer
+@cindex relative timer
+
+When taking notes during, for example, a meeting or a video viewing, it can
+be useful to have access to times relative to a starting time. Org provides
+such a relative timer and make it easy to create timed notes.
+
+@table @kbd
+@orgcmd{C-c C-x .,org-timer}
+Insert a relative time into the buffer. The first time you use this, the
+timer will be started. When called with a prefix argument, the timer is
+restarted.
+@orgcmd{C-c C-x -,org-timer-item}
+Insert a description list item with the current relative time. With a prefix
+argument, first reset the timer to 0.
+@orgcmd{M-@key{RET},org-insert-heading}
+Once the timer list is started, you can also use @kbd{M-@key{RET}} to insert
+new timer items.
+@c for key sequences with a comma, command name macros fail :(
+@kindex C-c C-x ,
+@item C-c C-x ,
+Pause the timer, or continue it if it is already paused
+(@command{org-timer-pause-or-continue}).
+@c removed the sentence because it is redundant to the following item
+@kindex C-u C-c C-x ,
+@item C-u C-c C-x ,
+Stop the timer. After this, you can only start a new timer, not continue the
+old one. This command also removes the timer from the mode line.
+@orgcmd{C-c C-x 0,org-timer-start}
+Reset the timer without inserting anything into the buffer. By default, the
+timer is reset to 0. When called with a @kbd{C-u} prefix, reset the timer to
+specific starting offset. The user is prompted for the offset, with a
+default taken from a timer string at point, if any, So this can be used to
+restart taking notes after a break in the process. When called with a double
+prefix argument @kbd{C-u C-u}, change all timer strings in the active region
+by a certain amount. This can be used to fix timer strings if the timer was
+not started at exactly the right moment.
+@end table
+
+@node Countdown timer, , Relative timer, Dates and Times
+@section Countdown timer
+@cindex Countdown timer
+@kindex C-c C-x ;
+@kindex ;
+
+Calling @code{org-timer-set-timer} from an Org-mode buffer runs a countdown
+timer. Use @key{;} from agenda buffers, @key{C-c C-x ;} everwhere else.
+
+@code{org-timer-set-timer} prompts the user for a duration and displays a
+countdown timer in the modeline. @code{org-timer-default-timer} sets the
+default countdown value. Giving a prefix numeric argument overrides this
+default value.
+
+@node Capture - Refile - Archive, Agenda Views, Dates and Times, Top
+@chapter Capture - Refile - Archive
+@cindex capture
+
+An important part of any organization system is the ability to quickly
+capture new ideas and tasks, and to associate reference material with them.
+Org does this using a process called @i{capture}. It also can store files
+related to a task (@i{attachments}) in a special directory. Once in the
+system, tasks and projects need to be moved around. Moving completed project
+trees to an archive file keeps the system compact and fast.
+
+@menu
+* Capture:: Capturing new stuff
+* Attachments:: Add files to tasks
+* RSS Feeds:: Getting input from RSS feeds
+* Protocols:: External (e.g. Browser) access to Emacs and Org
+* Refiling notes:: Moving a tree from one place to another
+* Archiving:: What to do with finished projects
+@end menu
+
+@node Capture, Attachments, Capture - Refile - Archive, Capture - Refile - Archive
+@section Capture
+@cindex capture
+
+Org's method for capturing new items is heavily inspired by John Wiegley
+excellent remember package. Up to version 6.36 Org used a special setup
+for @file{remember.el}. @file{org-remember.el} is still part of Org-mode for
+backward compatibility with existing setups. You can find the documentation
+for org-remember at @url{http://orgmode.org/org-remember.pdf}.
+
+The new capturing setup described here is preferred and should be used by new
+users. To convert your @code{org-remember-templates}, run the command
+@example
+@kbd{M-x org-capture-import-remember-templates @key{RET}}
+@end example
+@noindent and then customize the new variable with @kbd{M-x
+customize-variable org-capture-templates}, check the result, and save the
+customization. You can then use both remember and capture until
+you are familiar with the new mechanism.
+
+Capture lets you quickly store notes with little interruption of your work
+flow. The basic process of capturing is very similar to remember, but Org
+does enhance it with templates and more.
+
+@menu
+* Setting up capture:: Where notes will be stored
+* Using capture:: Commands to invoke and terminate capture
+* Capture templates:: Define the outline of different note types
+@end menu
+
+@node Setting up capture, Using capture, Capture, Capture
+@subsection Setting up capture
+
+The following customization sets a default target file for notes, and defines
+a global key@footnote{Please select your own key, @kbd{C-c c} is only a
+suggestion.} for capturing new material.
+
+@vindex org-default-notes-file
+@example
+(setq org-default-notes-file (concat org-directory "/notes.org"))
+(define-key global-map "\C-cc" 'org-capture)
+@end example
+
+@node Using capture, Capture templates, Setting up capture, Capture
+@subsection Using capture
+
+@table @kbd
+@orgcmd{C-c c,org-capture}
+Call the command @code{org-capture}. Note that this keybinding is global and
+not active by default - you need to install it. If you have templates
+defined @pxref{Capture templates}, it will offer these templates for
+selection or use a new Org outline node as the default template. It will
+insert the template into the target file and switch to an indirect buffer
+narrowed to this new node. You may then insert the information you want.
+
+@orgcmd{C-c C-c,org-capture-finalize}
+Once you have finished entering information into the capture buffer, @kbd{C-c
+C-c} will return you to the window configuration before the capture process,
+so that you can resume your work without further distraction. When called
+with a prefix arg, finalize and then jump to the captured item.
+
+@orgcmd{C-c C-w,org-capture-refile}
+Finalize the capture process by refiling (@pxref{Refiling notes}) the note to
+a different place. Please realize that this is a normal refiling command
+that will be executed---so the cursor position at the moment you run this
+command is important. If you have inserted a tree with a parent and
+children, first move the cursor back to the parent. Any prefix argument
+given to this command will be passed on to the @code{org-refile} command.
+
+@orgcmd{C-c C-k,org-capture-kill}
+Abort the capture process and return to the previous state.
+
+@end table
+
+You can also call @code{org-capture} in a special way from the agenda, using
+the @kbd{k c} key combination. With this access, any timestamps inserted by
+the selected capture template will default to the cursor date in the agenda,
+rather than to the current date.
+
+To find the locations of the last stored capture, use @code{org-capture} with
+prefix commands:
+
+@table @kbd
+@orgkey{C-u C-c c}
+Visit the target location of a cpature template. You get to select the
+template in the usual way.
+@orgkey{C-u C-u C-c c}
+Visit the last stored capture item in its buffer.
+@end table
+
+@node Capture templates, , Using capture, Capture
+@subsection Capture templates
+@cindex templates, for Capture
+
+You can use templates for different types of capture items, and
+for different target locations. The easiest way to create such templates is
+through the customize interface.
+
+@table @kbd
+@orgkey{C-c c C}
+Customize the variable @code{org-capture-templates}.
+@end table
+
+Before we give the formal description of template definitions, let's look at
+an example. Say you would like to use one template to create general TODO
+entries, and you want to put these entries under the heading @samp{Tasks} in
+your file @file{~/org/gtd.org}. Also, a date tree in the file
+@file{journal.org} should capture journal entries. A possible configuration
+would look like:
+
+@example
+(setq org-capture-templates
+ '(("t" "Todo" entry (file+headline "~/org/gtd.org" "Tasks")
+ "* TODO %?\n %i\n %a")
+ ("j" "Journal" entry (file+datetree "~/org/journal.org")
+ "* %?\nEntered on %U\n %i\n %a")))
+@end example
+
+@noindent If you then press @kbd{C-c c t}, Org will prepare the template
+for you like this:
+@example
+* TODO
+ [[file:@var{link to where you initiated capture}]]
+@end example
+
+@noindent
+During expansion of the template, @code{%a} has been replaced by a link to
+the location from where you called the capture command. This can be
+extremely useful for deriving tasks from emails, for example. You fill in
+the task definition, press @code{C-c C-c} and Org returns you to the same
+place where you started the capture process.
+
+
+@menu
+* Template elements:: What is needed for a complete template entry
+* Template expansion:: Filling in information about time and context
+@end menu
+
+@node Template elements, Template expansion, Capture templates, Capture templates
+@subsubsection Template elements
+
+Now lets look at the elements of a template definition. Each entry in
+@code{org-capture-templates} is a list with the following items:
+
+@table @var
+@item keys
+The keys that will select the template, as a string, characters
+only, for example @code{"a"} for a template to be selected with a
+single key, or @code{"bt"} for selection with two keys. When using
+several keys, keys using the same prefix key must be sequential
+in the list and preceded by a 2-element entry explaining the
+prefix key, for example
+@example
+ ("b" "Templates for marking stuff to buy")
+@end example
+@noindent If you do not define a template for the @kbd{C} key, this key will
+be used to open the customize buffer for this complex variable.
+
+@item description
+A short string describing the template, which will be shown during
+selection.
+
+@item type
+The type of entry, a symbol. Valid values are:
+@table @code
+@item entry
+An Org-mode node, with a headline. Will be filed as the child of the
+target entry or as a top-level entry. The target file should be an Org-mode
+file.
+@item item
+A plain list item, placed in the first plain list at the target
+location. Again the target file should be an Org file.
+@item checkitem
+A checkbox item. This only differs from the plain list item by the
+default template.
+@item table-line
+a new line in the first table at the target location. Where exactly the
+line will be inserted depends on the properties @code{:prepend} and
+@code{:table-line-pos} (see below).
+@item plain
+Text to be inserted as it is.
+@end table
+
+@item target
+@vindex org-default-notes-file
+Specification of where the captured item should be placed. In Org-mode
+files, targets usually define a node. Entries will become children of this
+node. Other types will be added to the table or list in the body of this
+node. Most target specifications contain a file name. If that file name is
+the empty string, it defaults to @code{org-default-notes-file}.
+
+Valid values are:
+@table @code
+@item (file "path/to/file")
+Text will be placed at the beginning or end of that file.
+
+@item (id "id of existing org entry")
+Filing as child of this entry, or in the body of the entry.
+
+@item (file+headline "path/to/file" "node headline")
+Fast configuration if the target heading is unique in the file.
+
+@item (file+olp "path/to/file" "Level 1 heading" "Level 2" ...)
+For non-unique headings, the full path is safer.
+
+@item (file+regexp "path/to/file" "regexp to find location")
+Use a regular expression to position the cursor.
+
+@item (file+datetree "path/to/file")
+Will create a heading in a date tree for today's date.
+
+@item (file+datetree+prompt "path/to/file")
+Will create a heading in a date tree, but will prompt for the date.
+
+@item (file+function "path/to/file" function-finding-location)
+A function to find the right location in the file.
+
+@item (clock)
+File to the entry that is currently being clocked.
+
+@item (function function-finding-location)
+Most general way, write your own function to find both
+file and location.
+@end table
+
+@item template
+The template for creating the capture item. If you leave this empty, an
+appropriate default template will be used. Otherwise this is a string with
+escape codes, which will be replaced depending on time and context of the
+capture call. The string with escapes may be loaded from a template file,
+using the special syntax @code{(file "path/to/template")}. See below for
+more details.
+
+@item properties
+The rest of the entry is a property list of additional options.
+Recognized properties are:
+@table @code
+@item :prepend
+Normally new captured information will be appended at
+the target location (last child, last table line, last list item...).
+Setting this property will change that.
+
+@item :immediate-finish
+When set, do not offer to edit the information, just
+file it away immediately. This makes sense if the template only needs
+information that can be added automatically.
+
+@item :empty-lines
+Set this to the number of lines to insert
+before and after the new item. Default 0, only common other value is 1.
+
+@item :clock-in
+Start the clock in this item.
+
+@item :clock-resume
+If starting the capture interrupted a clock, restart that clock when finished
+with the capture.
+
+@item :unnarrowed
+Do not narrow the target buffer, simply show the full buffer. Default is to
+narrow it so that you only see the new material.
+
+@item :kill-buffer
+If the target file was not yet visited when capture was invoked, kill the
+buffer again after capture is completed.
+@end table
+@end table
+
+@node Template expansion, , Template elements, Capture templates
+@subsubsection Template expansion
+
+In the template itself, special @kbd{%}-escapes@footnote{If you need one of
+these sequences literally, escape the @kbd{%} with a backslash.} allow
+dynamic insertion of content:
+
+@comment SJE: should these sentences terminate in period?
+@smallexample
+%^@{@var{prompt}@} @r{prompt the user for a string and replace this sequence with it.}
+ @r{You may specify a default value and a completion table with}
+ @r{%^@{prompt|default|completion2|completion3...@}}
+ @r{The arrow keys access a prompt-specific history.}
+%a @r{annotation, normally the link created with @code{org-store-link}}
+%A @r{like @code{%a}, but prompt for the description part}
+%i @r{initial content, the region when capture is called while the}
+ @r{region is active.}
+ @r{The entire text will be indented like @code{%i} itself.}
+%t @r{timestamp, date only}
+%T @r{timestamp with date and time}
+%u, %U @r{like the above, but inactive timestamps}
+%^t @r{like @code{%t}, but prompt for date. Similarly @code{%^T}, @code{%^u}, @code{%^U}}
+ @r{You may define a prompt like @code{%^@{Birthday@}t}}
+%n @r{user name (taken from @code{user-full-name})}
+%c @r{Current kill ring head.}
+%x @r{Content of the X clipboard.}
+%^C @r{Interactive selection of which kill or clip to use.}
+%^L @r{Like @code{%^C}, but insert as link.}
+%k @r{title of the currently clocked task}
+%K @r{link to the currently clocked task}
+%^g @r{prompt for tags, with completion on tags in target file.}
+%^G @r{prompt for tags, with completion all tags in all agenda files.}
+%^@{@var{prop}@}p @r{Prompt the user for a value for property @var{prop}}
+%:keyword @r{specific information for certain link types, see below}
+%[@var{file}] @r{insert the contents of the file given by @var{file}}
+%(@var{sexp}) @r{evaluate Elisp @var{sexp} and replace with the result}
+@end smallexample
+
+@noindent
+For specific link types, the following keywords will be
+defined@footnote{If you define your own link types (@pxref{Adding
+hyperlink types}), any property you store with
+@code{org-store-link-props} can be accessed in capture templates in a
+similar way.}:
+
+@vindex org-from-is-user-regexp
+@smallexample
+Link type | Available keywords
+-------------------+----------------------------------------------
+bbdb | %:name %:company
+irc | %:server %:port %:nick
+vm, wl, mh, mew, rmail | %:type %:subject %:message-id
+ | %:from %:fromname %:fromaddress
+ | %:to %:toname %:toaddress
+ | %:date @r{(message date header field)}
+ | %:date-timestamp @r{(date as active timestamp)}
+ | %:date-timestamp-inactive @r{(date as inactive timestamp)}
+ | %:fromto @r{(either "to NAME" or "from NAME")@footnote{This will always be the other, not the user. See the variable @code{org-from-is-user-regexp}.}}
+gnus | %:group, @r{for messages also all email fields}
+w3, w3m | %:url
+info | %:file %:node
+calendar | %:date
+@end smallexample
+
+@noindent
+To place the cursor after template expansion use:
+
+@smallexample
+%? @r{After completing the template, position cursor here.}
+@end smallexample
+
+
+@node Attachments, RSS Feeds, Capture, Capture - Refile - Archive
+@section Attachments
+@cindex attachments
+
+@vindex org-attach-directory
+It is often useful to associate reference material with an outline node/task.
+Small chunks of plain text can simply be stored in the subtree of a project.
+Hyperlinks (@pxref{Hyperlinks}) can establish associations with
+files that live elsewhere on your computer or in the cloud, like emails or
+source code files belonging to a project. Another method is @i{attachments},
+which are files located in a directory belonging to an outline node. Org
+uses directories named by the unique ID of each entry. These directories are
+located in the @file{data} directory which lives in the same directory where
+your Org file lives@footnote{If you move entries or Org files from one
+directory to another, you may want to configure @code{org-attach-directory}
+to contain an absolute path.}. If you initialize this directory with
+@code{git init}, Org will automatically commit changes when it sees them.
+The attachment system has been contributed to Org by John Wiegley.
+
+In cases where it seems better to do so, you can also attach a directory of your
+choice to an entry. You can also make children inherit the attachment
+directory from a parent, so that an entire subtree uses the same attached
+directory.
+
+@noindent The following commands deal with attachments:
+
+@table @kbd
+
+@orgcmd{C-c C-a,org-attach}
+The dispatcher for commands related to the attachment system. After these
+keys, a list of commands is displayed and you must press an additional key
+to select a command:
+
+@table @kbd
+@orgcmdtkc{a,C-c C-a a,org-attach-attach}
+@vindex org-attach-method
+Select a file and move it into the task's attachment directory. The file
+will be copied, moved, or linked, depending on @code{org-attach-method}.
+Note that hard links are not supported on all systems.
+
+@kindex C-c C-a c
+@kindex C-c C-a m
+@kindex C-c C-a l
+@item c/m/l
+Attach a file using the copy/move/link method.
+Note that hard links are not supported on all systems.
+
+@orgcmdtkc{n,C-c C-a n,org-attach-new}
+Create a new attachment as an Emacs buffer.
+
+@orgcmdtkc{z,C-c C-a z,org-attach-sync}
+Synchronize the current task with its attachment directory, in case you added
+attachments yourself.
+
+@orgcmdtkc{p,C-c C-a o,org-attach-open}
+@vindex org-file-apps
+Open current task's attachment. If there is more than one, prompt for a
+file name first. Opening will follow the rules set by @code{org-file-apps}.
+For more details, see the information on following hyperlinks
+(@pxref{Handling links}).
+
+@orgcmdtkc{O,C-c C-a O,org-attach-open-in-emacs}
+Also open the attachment, but force opening the file in Emacs.
+
+@orgcmdtkc{f,C-c C-a f,org-attach-reveal}
+Open the current task's attachment directory.
+
+@orgcmdtkc{F,C-c C-a F,org-attach-reveal-in-emacs}
+Also open the directory, but force using @command{dired} in Emacs.
+
+@orgcmdtkc{d,C-c C-a d,org-attach-delete-one}
+Select and delete a single attachment.
+
+@orgcmdtkc{D,C-c C-a D,org-attach-delete-all}
+Delete all of a task's attachments. A safer way is to open the directory in
+@command{dired} and delete from there.
+
+@orgcmdtkc{s,C-c C-a s,org-attach-set-directory}
+@cindex property, ATTACH_DIR
+Set a specific directory as the entry's attachment directory. This works by
+putting the directory path into the @code{ATTACH_DIR} property.
+
+@orgcmdtkc{i,C-c C-a i,org-attach-set-inherit}
+@cindex property, ATTACH_DIR_INHERIT
+Set the @code{ATTACH_DIR_INHERIT} property, so that children will use the
+same directory for attachments as the parent does.
+@end table
+@end table
+
+@node RSS Feeds, Protocols, Attachments, Capture - Refile - Archive
+@section RSS feeds
+@cindex RSS feeds
+@cindex Atom feeds
+
+Org can add and change entries based on information found in RSS feeds and
+Atom feeds. You could use this to make a task out of each new podcast in a
+podcast feed. Or you could use a phone-based note-creating service on the
+web to import tasks into Org. To access feeds, configure the variable
+@code{org-feed-alist}. The docstring of this variable has detailed
+information. Here is just an example:
+
+@example
+(setq org-feed-alist
+ '(("Slashdot"
+ "http://rss.slashdot.org/Slashdot/slashdot"
+ "~/txt/org/feeds.org" "Slashdot Entries")))
+@end example
+
+@noindent
+will configure that new items from the feed provided by
+@code{rss.slashdot.org} will result in new entries in the file
+@file{~/org/feeds.org} under the heading @samp{Slashdot Entries}, whenever
+the following command is used:
+
+@table @kbd
+@orgcmd{C-c C-x g,org-feed-update-all}
+@item C-c C-x g
+Collect items from the feeds configured in @code{org-feed-alist} and act upon
+them.
+@orgcmd{C-c C-x G,org-feed-goto-inbox}
+Prompt for a feed name and go to the inbox configured for this feed.
+@end table
+
+Under the same headline, Org will create a drawer @samp{FEEDSTATUS} in which
+it will store information about the status of items in the feed, to avoid
+adding the same item several times. You should add @samp{FEEDSTATUS} to the
+list of drawers in that file:
+
+@example
+#+DRAWERS: LOGBOOK PROPERTIES FEEDSTATUS
+@end example
+
+For more information, including how to read atom feeds, see
+@file{org-feed.el} and the docstring of @code{org-feed-alist}.
+
+@node Protocols, Refiling notes, RSS Feeds, Capture - Refile - Archive
+@section Protocols for external access
+@cindex protocols, for external access
+@cindex emacsserver
+
+You can set up Org for handling protocol calls from outside applications that
+are passed to Emacs through the @file{emacsserver}. For example, you can
+configure bookmarks in your web browser to send a link to the current page to
+Org and create a note from it using capture (@pxref{Capture}). Or you
+could create a bookmark that will tell Emacs to open the local source file of
+a remote website you are looking at with the browser. See
+@uref{http://orgmode.org/worg/org-contrib/org-protocol.php} for detailed
+documentation and setup instructions.
+
+@node Refiling notes, Archiving, Protocols, Capture - Refile - Archive
+@section Refiling notes
+@cindex refiling notes
+
+When reviewing the captured data, you may want to refile some of the entries
+into a different list, for example into a project. Cutting, finding the
+right location, and then pasting the note is cumbersome. To simplify this
+process, you can use the following special command:
+
+@table @kbd
+@orgcmd{C-c C-w,org-refile}
+@vindex org-reverse-note-order
+@vindex org-refile-targets
+@vindex org-refile-use-outline-path
+@vindex org-outline-path-complete-in-steps
+@vindex org-refile-allow-creating-parent-nodes
+@vindex org-log-refile
+@vindex org-refile-use-cache
+Refile the entry or region at point. This command offers possible locations
+for refiling the entry and lets you select one with completion. The item (or
+all items in the region) is filed below the target heading as a subitem.
+Depending on @code{org-reverse-note-order}, it will be either the first or
+last subitem.@*
+By default, all level 1 headlines in the current buffer are considered to be
+targets, but you can have more complex definitions across a number of files.
+See the variable @code{org-refile-targets} for details. If you would like to
+select a location via a file-path-like completion along the outline path, see
+the variables @code{org-refile-use-outline-path} and
+@code{org-outline-path-complete-in-steps}. If you would like to be able to
+create new nodes as new parents for refiling on the fly, check the
+variable @code{org-refile-allow-creating-parent-nodes}.
+When the variable @code{org-log-refile}@footnote{with corresponding
+@code{#+STARTUP} keywords @code{logrefile}, @code{lognoterefile},
+and @code{nologrefile}} is set, a time stamp or a note will be
+recorded when an entry has been refiled.
+@orgkey{C-u C-c C-w}
+Use the refile interface to jump to a heading.
+@orgcmd{C-u C-u C-c C-w,org-refile-goto-last-stored}
+Jump to the location where @code{org-refile} last moved a tree to.
+@item C-2 C-c C-w
+Refile as the child of the item currently being clocked.
+@item C-0 C-c C-w @ @r{or} @ C-u C-u C-u C-c C-w
+
+@orgcmdtkc{C-0 C-c C-w @ @r{or} @ C-u C-u C-u C-c C-w,C-0 C-c C-w,org-refile-cache-clear}
+
+Clear the target cache. Caching of refile targets can be turned on by
+setting @code{org-refile-use-cache}. To make the command see new possible
+targets, you have to clear the cache with this command.
+@end table
+
+@node Archiving, , Refiling notes, Capture - Refile - Archive
+@section Archiving
+@cindex archiving
+
+When a project represented by a (sub)tree is finished, you may want
+to move the tree out of the way and to stop it from contributing to the
+agenda. Archiving is important to keep your working files compact and global
+searches like the construction of agenda views fast.
+
+@table @kbd
+@orgcmd{C-c C-x C-a,org-archive-subtree-default}
+@vindex org-archive-default-command
+Archive the current entry using the command specified in the variable
+@code{org-archive-default-command}.
+@end table
+
+@menu
+* Moving subtrees:: Moving a tree to an archive file
+* Internal archiving:: Switch off a tree but keep it in the file
+@end menu
+
+@node Moving subtrees, Internal archiving, Archiving, Archiving
+@subsection Moving a tree to the archive file
+@cindex external archiving
+
+The most common archiving action is to move a project tree to another file,
+the archive file.
+
+@table @kbd
+@orgcmdkskc{C-c C-x C-s,C-c $,org-archive-subtree}
+@vindex org-archive-location
+Archive the subtree starting at the cursor position to the location
+given by @code{org-archive-location}.
+@orgkey{C-u C-c C-x C-s}
+Check if any direct children of the current headline could be moved to
+the archive. To do this, each subtree is checked for open TODO entries.
+If none are found, the command offers to move it to the archive
+location. If the cursor is @emph{not} on a headline when this command
+is invoked, the level 1 trees will be checked.
+@end table
+
+@cindex archive locations
+The default archive location is a file in the same directory as the
+current file, with the name derived by appending @file{_archive} to the
+current file name. For information and examples on how to change this,
+see the documentation string of the variable
+@code{org-archive-location}. There is also an in-buffer option for
+setting this variable, for example@footnote{For backward compatibility,
+the following also works: If there are several such lines in a file,
+each specifies the archive location for the text below it. The first
+such line also applies to any text before its definition. However,
+using this method is @emph{strongly} deprecated as it is incompatible
+with the outline structure of the document. The correct method for
+setting multiple archive locations in a buffer is using properties.}:
+
+@cindex #+ARCHIVE
+@example
+#+ARCHIVE: %s_done::
+@end example
+
+@cindex property, ARCHIVE
+@noindent
+If you would like to have a special ARCHIVE location for a single entry
+or a (sub)tree, give the entry an @code{:ARCHIVE:} property with the
+location as the value (@pxref{Properties and Columns}).
+
+@vindex org-archive-save-context-info
+When a subtree is moved, it receives a number of special properties that
+record context information like the file from where the entry came, its
+outline path the archiving time etc. Configure the variable
+@code{org-archive-save-context-info} to adjust the amount of information
+added.
+
+
+@node Internal archiving, , Moving subtrees, Archiving
+@subsection Internal archiving
+
+If you want to just switch off (for agenda views) certain subtrees without
+moving them to a different file, you can use the @code{ARCHIVE tag}.
+
+A headline that is marked with the ARCHIVE tag (@pxref{Tags}) stays at
+its location in the outline tree, but behaves in the following way:
+@itemize @minus
+@item
+@vindex org-cycle-open-archived-trees
+It does not open when you attempt to do so with a visibility cycling
+command (@pxref{Visibility cycling}). You can force cycling archived
+subtrees with @kbd{C-@key{TAB}}, or by setting the option
+@code{org-cycle-open-archived-trees}. Also normal outline commands like
+@code{show-all} will open archived subtrees.
+@item
+@vindex org-sparse-tree-open-archived-trees
+During sparse tree construction (@pxref{Sparse trees}), matches in
+archived subtrees are not exposed, unless you configure the option
+@code{org-sparse-tree-open-archived-trees}.
+@item
+@vindex org-agenda-skip-archived-trees
+During agenda view construction (@pxref{Agenda Views}), the content of
+archived trees is ignored unless you configure the option
+@code{org-agenda-skip-archived-trees}, in which case these trees will always
+be included. In the agenda you can press @kbd{v a} to get archives
+temporarily included.
+@item
+@vindex org-export-with-archived-trees
+Archived trees are not exported (@pxref{Exporting}), only the headline
+is. Configure the details using the variable
+@code{org-export-with-archived-trees}.
+@item
+@vindex org-columns-skip-archived-trees
+Archived trees are excluded from column view unless the variable
+@code{org-columns-skip-archived-trees} is configured to @code{nil}.
+@end itemize
+
+The following commands help manage the ARCHIVE tag:
+
+@table @kbd
+@orgcmd{C-c C-x a,org-toggle-archive-tag}
+Toggle the ARCHIVE tag for the current headline. When the tag is set,
+the headline changes to a shadowed face, and the subtree below it is
+hidden.
+@orgkey{C-u C-c C-x a}
+Check if any direct children of the current headline should be archived.
+To do this, each subtree is checked for open TODO entries. If none are
+found, the command offers to set the ARCHIVE tag for the child. If the
+cursor is @emph{not} on a headline when this command is invoked, the
+level 1 trees will be checked.
+@orgcmd{C-@kbd{TAB},org-force-cycle-archived}
+Cycle a tree even if it is tagged with ARCHIVE.
+@orgcmd{C-c C-x A,org-archive-to-archive-sibling}
+Move the current entry to the @emph{Archive Sibling}. This is a sibling of
+the entry with the heading @samp{Archive} and the tag @samp{ARCHIVE}. The
+entry becomes a child of that sibling and in this way retains a lot of its
+original context, including inherited tags and approximate position in the
+outline.
+@end table
+
+
+@node Agenda Views, Markup, Capture - Refile - Archive, Top
+@chapter Agenda views
+@cindex agenda views
+
+Due to the way Org works, TODO items, time-stamped items, and
+tagged headlines can be scattered throughout a file or even a number of
+files. To get an overview of open action items, or of events that are
+important for a particular date, this information must be collected,
+sorted and displayed in an organized way.
+
+Org can select items based on various criteria and display them
+in a separate buffer. Seven different view types are provided:
+
+@itemize @bullet
+@item
+an @emph{agenda} that is like a calendar and shows information
+for specific dates,
+@item
+a @emph{TODO list} that covers all unfinished
+action items,
+@item
+a @emph{match view}, showings headlines based on the tags, properties, and
+TODO state associated with them,
+@item
+a @emph{timeline view} that shows all events in a single Org file,
+in time-sorted view,
+@item
+a @emph{text search view} that shows all entries from multiple files
+that contain specified keywords,
+@item
+a @emph{stuck projects view} showing projects that currently don't move
+along, and
+@item
+@emph{custom views} that are special searches and combinations of different
+views.
+@end itemize
+
+@noindent
+The extracted information is displayed in a special @emph{agenda
+buffer}. This buffer is read-only, but provides commands to visit the
+corresponding locations in the original Org files, and even to
+edit these files remotely.
+
+@vindex org-agenda-window-setup
+@vindex org-agenda-restore-windows-after-quit
+Two variables control how the agenda buffer is displayed and whether the
+window configuration is restored when the agenda exits:
+@code{org-agenda-window-setup} and
+@code{org-agenda-restore-windows-after-quit}.
+
+@menu
+* Agenda files:: Files being searched for agenda information
+* Agenda dispatcher:: Keyboard access to agenda views
+* Built-in agenda views:: What is available out of the box?
+* Presentation and sorting:: How agenda items are prepared for display
+* Agenda commands:: Remote editing of Org trees
+* Custom agenda views:: Defining special searches and views
+* Exporting Agenda Views:: Writing a view to a file
+* Agenda column view:: Using column view for collected entries
+@end menu
+
+@node Agenda files, Agenda dispatcher, Agenda Views, Agenda Views
+@section Agenda files
+@cindex agenda files
+@cindex files for agenda
+
+@vindex org-agenda-files
+The information to be shown is normally collected from all @emph{agenda
+files}, the files listed in the variable
+@code{org-agenda-files}@footnote{If the value of that variable is not a
+list, but a single file name, then the list of agenda files will be
+maintained in that external file.}. If a directory is part of this list,
+all files with the extension @file{.org} in this directory will be part
+of the list.
+
+Thus, even if you only work with a single Org file, that file should
+be put into the list@footnote{When using the dispatcher, pressing
+@kbd{<} before selecting a command will actually limit the command to
+the current file, and ignore @code{org-agenda-files} until the next
+dispatcher command.}. You can customize @code{org-agenda-files}, but
+the easiest way to maintain it is through the following commands
+
+@cindex files, adding to agenda list
+@table @kbd
+@orgcmd{C-c [,org-agenda-to-front}
+Add current file to the list of agenda files. The file is added to
+the front of the list. If it was already in the list, it is moved to
+the front. With a prefix argument, file is added/moved to the end.
+@orgcmd{C-c ],org-remove-file}
+Remove current file from the list of agenda files.
+@kindex C-,
+@orgcmd{C-',org-cycle-agenda-files}
+@itemx C-,
+Cycle through agenda file list, visiting one file after the other.
+@kindex M-x org-iswitchb
+@item M-x org-iswitchb
+Command to use an @code{iswitchb}-like interface to switch to and between Org
+buffers.
+@end table
+
+@noindent
+The Org menu contains the current list of files and can be used
+to visit any of them.
+
+If you would like to focus the agenda temporarily on a file not in
+this list, or on just one file in the list, or even on only a subtree in a
+file, then this can be done in different ways. For a single agenda command,
+you may press @kbd{<} once or several times in the dispatcher
+(@pxref{Agenda dispatcher}). To restrict the agenda scope for an
+extended period, use the following commands:
+
+@table @kbd
+@orgcmd{C-c C-x <,org-agenda-set-restriction-lock}
+Permanently restrict the agenda to the current subtree. When with a
+prefix argument, or with the cursor before the first headline in a file,
+the agenda scope is set to the entire file. This restriction remains in
+effect until removed with @kbd{C-c C-x >}, or by typing either @kbd{<}
+or @kbd{>} in the agenda dispatcher. If there is a window displaying an
+agenda view, the new restriction takes effect immediately.
+@orgcmd{C-c C-x >,org-agenda-remove-restriction-lock}
+Remove the permanent restriction created by @kbd{C-c C-x <}.
+@end table
+
+@noindent
+When working with @file{speedbar.el}, you can use the following commands in
+the Speedbar frame:
+@table @kbd
+@orgcmdtkc{< @r{in the speedbar frame},<,org-speedbar-set-agenda-restriction}
+Permanently restrict the agenda to the item---either an Org file or a subtree
+in such a file---at the cursor in the Speedbar frame.
+If there is a window displaying an agenda view, the new restriction takes
+effect immediately.
+@orgcmdtkc{> @r{in the speedbar frame},>,org-agenda-remove-restriction-lock}
+Lift the restriction.
+@end table
+
+@node Agenda dispatcher, Built-in agenda views, Agenda files, Agenda Views
+@section The agenda dispatcher
+@cindex agenda dispatcher
+@cindex dispatching agenda commands
+The views are created through a dispatcher, which should be bound to a
+global key---for example @kbd{C-c a} (@pxref{Installation}). In the
+following we will assume that @kbd{C-c a} is indeed how the dispatcher
+is accessed and list keyboard access to commands accordingly. After
+pressing @kbd{C-c a}, an additional letter is required to execute a
+command. The dispatcher offers the following default commands:
+@table @kbd
+@item a
+Create the calendar-like agenda (@pxref{Weekly/daily agenda}).
+@item t @r{/} T
+Create a list of all TODO items (@pxref{Global TODO list}).
+@item m @r{/} M
+Create a list of headlines matching a TAGS expression (@pxref{Matching
+tags and properties}).
+@item L
+Create the timeline view for the current buffer (@pxref{Timeline}).
+@item s
+Create a list of entries selected by a boolean expression of keywords
+and/or regular expressions that must or must not occur in the entry.
+@item /
+@vindex org-agenda-text-search-extra-files
+Search for a regular expression in all agenda files and additionally in
+the files listed in @code{org-agenda-text-search-extra-files}. This
+uses the Emacs command @code{multi-occur}. A prefix argument can be
+used to specify the number of context lines for each match, default is
+1.
+@item # @r{/} !
+Create a list of stuck projects (@pxref{Stuck projects}).
+@item <
+Restrict an agenda command to the current buffer@footnote{For backward
+compatibility, you can also press @kbd{1} to restrict to the current
+buffer.}. After pressing @kbd{<}, you still need to press the character
+selecting the command.
+@item < <
+If there is an active region, restrict the following agenda command to
+the region. Otherwise, restrict it to the current subtree@footnote{For
+backward compatibility, you can also press @kbd{0} to restrict to the
+current region/subtree.}. After pressing @kbd{< <}, you still need to press the
+character selecting the command.
+@end table
+
+You can also define custom commands that will be accessible through the
+dispatcher, just like the default commands. This includes the
+possibility to create extended agenda buffers that contain several
+blocks together, for example the weekly agenda, the global TODO list and
+a number of special tags matches. @xref{Custom agenda views}.
+
+@node Built-in agenda views, Presentation and sorting, Agenda dispatcher, Agenda Views
+@section The built-in agenda views
+
+In this section we describe the built-in views.
+
+@menu
+* Weekly/daily agenda:: The calendar page with current tasks
+* Global TODO list:: All unfinished action items
+* Matching tags and properties:: Structured information with fine-tuned search
+* Timeline:: Time-sorted view for single file
+* Search view:: Find entries by searching for text
+* Stuck projects:: Find projects you need to review
+@end menu
+
+@node Weekly/daily agenda, Global TODO list, Built-in agenda views, Built-in agenda views
+@subsection The weekly/daily agenda
+@cindex agenda
+@cindex weekly agenda
+@cindex daily agenda
+
+The purpose of the weekly/daily @emph{agenda} is to act like a page of a
+paper agenda, showing all the tasks for the current week or day.
+
+@table @kbd
+@cindex org-agenda, command
+@orgcmd{C-c a a,org-agenda-list}
+Compile an agenda for the current week from a list of Org files. The agenda
+shows the entries for each day. With a numeric prefix@footnote{For backward
+compatibility, the universal prefix @kbd{C-u} causes all TODO entries to be
+listed before the agenda. This feature is deprecated, use the dedicated TODO
+list, or a block agenda instead (@pxref{Block agenda}).} (like @kbd{C-u 2 1
+C-c a a}) you may set the number of days to be displayed.
+@end table
+
+@vindex org-agenda-span
+@vindex org-agenda-ndays
+The default number of days displayed in the agenda is set by the variable
+@code{org-agenda-span} (or the obsolete @code{org-agenda-ndays}). This
+variable can be set to any number of days you want to see by default in the
+agenda, or to a span name, such a @code{day}, @code{week}, @code{month} or
+@code{year}.
+
+Remote editing from the agenda buffer means, for example, that you can
+change the dates of deadlines and appointments from the agenda buffer.
+The commands available in the Agenda buffer are listed in @ref{Agenda
+commands}.
+
+@subsubheading Calendar/Diary integration
+@cindex calendar integration
+@cindex diary integration
+
+Emacs contains the calendar and diary by Edward M. Reingold. The
+calendar displays a three-month calendar with holidays from different
+countries and cultures. The diary allows you to keep track of
+anniversaries, lunar phases, sunrise/set, recurrent appointments
+(weekly, monthly) and more. In this way, it is quite complementary to
+Org. It can be very useful to combine output from Org with
+the diary.
+
+In order to include entries from the Emacs diary into Org-mode's
+agenda, you only need to customize the variable
+
+@lisp
+(setq org-agenda-include-diary t)
+@end lisp
+
+@noindent After that, everything will happen automatically. All diary
+entries including holidays, anniversaries, etc., will be included in the
+agenda buffer created by Org-mode. @key{SPC}, @key{TAB}, and
+@key{RET} can be used from the agenda buffer to jump to the diary
+file in order to edit existing diary entries. The @kbd{i} command to
+insert new entries for the current date works in the agenda buffer, as
+well as the commands @kbd{S}, @kbd{M}, and @kbd{C} to display
+Sunrise/Sunset times, show lunar phases and to convert to other
+calendars, respectively. @kbd{c} can be used to switch back and forth
+between calendar and agenda.
+
+If you are using the diary only for sexp entries and holidays, it is
+faster to not use the above setting, but instead to copy or even move
+the entries into an Org file. Org-mode evaluates diary-style sexp
+entries, and does it faster because there is no overhead for first
+creating the diary display. Note that the sexp entries must start at
+the left margin, no whitespace is allowed before them. For example,
+the following segment of an Org file will be processed and entries
+will be made in the agenda:
+
+@example
+* Birthdays and similar stuff
+#+CATEGORY: Holiday
+%%(org-calendar-holiday) ; special function for holiday names
+#+CATEGORY: Ann
+%%(diary-anniversary 5 14 1956)@footnote{Note that the order of the arguments (month, day, year) depends on the setting of @code{calendar-date-style}.} Arthur Dent is %d years old
+%%(diary-anniversary 10 2 1869) Mahatma Gandhi would be %d years old
+@end example
+
+@subsubheading Anniversaries from BBDB
+@cindex BBDB, anniversaries
+@cindex anniversaries, from BBDB
+
+If you are using the Big Brothers Database to store your contacts, you will
+very likely prefer to store anniversaries in BBDB rather than in a
+separate Org or diary file. Org supports this and will show BBDB
+anniversaries as part of the agenda. All you need to do is to add the
+following to one your your agenda files:
+
+@example
+* Anniversaries
+ :PROPERTIES:
+ :CATEGORY: Anniv
+ :END:
+%%(org-bbdb-anniversaries)
+@end example
+
+You can then go ahead and define anniversaries for a BBDB record. Basically,
+you need to press @kbd{C-o anniversary @key{RET}} with the cursor in a BBDB
+record and then add the date in the format @code{YYYY-MM-DD}, followed by a
+space and the class of the anniversary (@samp{birthday} or @samp{wedding}, or
+a format string). If you omit the class, it will default to @samp{birthday}.
+Here are a few examples, the header for the file @file{org-bbdb.el} contains
+more detailed information.
+
+@example
+1973-06-22
+1955-08-02 wedding
+2008-04-14 %s released version 6.01 of org-mode, %d years ago
+@end example
+
+After a change to BBDB, or for the first agenda display during an Emacs
+session, the agenda display will suffer a short delay as Org updates its
+hash with anniversaries. However, from then on things will be very fast---much
+faster in fact than a long list of @samp{%%(diary-anniversary)} entries
+in an Org or Diary file.
+
+@subsubheading Appointment reminders
+@cindex @file{appt.el}
+@cindex appointment reminders
+
+Org can interact with Emacs appointments notification facility. To add all
+the appointments of your agenda files, use the command
+@code{org-agenda-to-appt}. This command also lets you filter through the
+list of your appointments and add only those belonging to a specific category
+or matching a regular expression. See the docstring for details.
+
+@node Global TODO list, Matching tags and properties, Weekly/daily agenda, Built-in agenda views
+@subsection The global TODO list
+@cindex global TODO list
+@cindex TODO list, global
+
+The global TODO list contains all unfinished TODO items formatted and
+collected into a single place.
+
+@table @kbd
+@orgcmd{C-c a t,org-todo-list}
+Show the global TODO list. This collects the TODO items from all agenda
+files (@pxref{Agenda Views}) into a single buffer. By default, this lists
+items with a state the is not a DONE state. The buffer is in
+@code{agenda-mode}, so there are commands to examine and manipulate the TODO
+entries directly from that buffer (@pxref{Agenda commands}).
+@orgcmd{C-c a T,org-todo-list}
+@cindex TODO keyword matching
+@vindex org-todo-keywords
+Like the above, but allows selection of a specific TODO keyword. You can
+also do this by specifying a prefix argument to @kbd{C-c a t}. You are
+prompted for a keyword, and you may also specify several keywords by
+separating them with @samp{|} as the boolean OR operator. With a numeric
+prefix, the Nth keyword in @code{org-todo-keywords} is selected.
+@kindex r
+The @kbd{r} key in the agenda buffer regenerates it, and you can give
+a prefix argument to this command to change the selected TODO keyword,
+for example @kbd{3 r}. If you often need a search for a specific
+keyword, define a custom command for it (@pxref{Agenda dispatcher}).@*
+Matching specific TODO keywords can also be done as part of a tags
+search (@pxref{Tag searches}).
+@end table
+
+Remote editing of TODO items means that you can change the state of a
+TODO entry with a single key press. The commands available in the
+TODO list are described in @ref{Agenda commands}.
+
+@cindex sublevels, inclusion into TODO list
+Normally the global TODO list simply shows all headlines with TODO
+keywords. This list can become very long. There are two ways to keep
+it more compact:
+@itemize @minus
+@item
+@vindex org-agenda-todo-ignore-scheduled
+@vindex org-agenda-todo-ignore-deadlines
+@vindex org-agenda-todo-ignore-timestamp
+@vindex org-agenda-todo-ignore-with-date
+Some people view a TODO item that has been @emph{scheduled} for execution or
+have a @emph{deadline} (@pxref{Timestamps}) as no longer @emph{open}.
+Configure the variables @code{org-agenda-todo-ignore-scheduled},
+@code{org-agenda-todo-ignore-deadlines},
+@code{org-agenda-todo-ignore-timestamp} and/or
+@code{org-agenda-todo-ignore-with-date} to exclude such items from the global
+TODO list.
+@item
+@vindex org-agenda-todo-list-sublevels
+TODO items may have sublevels to break up the task into subtasks. In
+such cases it may be enough to list only the highest level TODO headline
+and omit the sublevels from the global list. Configure the variable
+@code{org-agenda-todo-list-sublevels} to get this behavior.
+@end itemize
+
+@node Matching tags and properties, Timeline, Global TODO list, Built-in agenda views
+@subsection Matching tags and properties
+@cindex matching, of tags
+@cindex matching, of properties
+@cindex tags view
+@cindex match view
+
+If headlines in the agenda files are marked with @emph{tags} (@pxref{Tags}),
+or have properties (@pxref{Properties and Columns}), you can select headlines
+based on this metadata and collect them into an agenda buffer. The match
+syntax described here also applies when creating sparse trees with @kbd{C-c /
+m}.
+
+@table @kbd
+@orgcmd{C-c a m,org-tags-view}
+Produce a list of all headlines that match a given set of tags. The
+command prompts for a selection criterion, which is a boolean logic
+expression with tags, like @samp{+work+urgent-withboss} or
+@samp{work|home} (@pxref{Tags}). If you often need a specific search,
+define a custom command for it (@pxref{Agenda dispatcher}).
+@orgcmd{C-c a M,org-tags-view}
+@vindex org-tags-match-list-sublevels
+@vindex org-agenda-tags-todo-honor-ignore-options
+Like @kbd{C-c a m}, but only select headlines that are also TODO items in a
+not-DONE state and force checking subitems (see variable
+@code{org-tags-match-list-sublevels}). To exclude scheduled/deadline items,
+see the variable @code{org-agenda-tags-todo-honor-ignore-options}. Matching
+specific TODO keywords together with a tags match is also possible, see
+@ref{Tag searches}.
+@end table
+
+The commands available in the tags list are described in @ref{Agenda
+commands}.
+
+@subsubheading Match syntax
+
+@cindex Boolean logic, for tag/property searches
+A search string can use Boolean operators @samp{&} for AND and @samp{|} for
+OR. @samp{&} binds more strongly than @samp{|}. Parentheses are currently
+not implemented. Each element in the search is either a tag, a regular
+expression matching tags, or an expression like @code{PROPERTY OPERATOR
+VALUE} with a comparison operator, accessing a property value. Each element
+may be preceded by @samp{-}, to select against it, and @samp{+} is syntactic
+sugar for positive selection. The AND operator @samp{&} is optional when
+@samp{+} or @samp{-} is present. Here are some examples, using only tags.
+
+@table @samp
+@item +work-boss
+Select headlines tagged @samp{:work:}, but discard those also tagged
+@samp{:boss:}.
+@item work|laptop
+Selects lines tagged @samp{:work:} or @samp{:laptop:}.
+@item work|laptop+night
+Like before, but require the @samp{:laptop:} lines to be tagged also
+@samp{:night:}.
+@end table
+
+@cindex regular expressions, with tags search
+Instead of a tag, you may also specify a regular expression enclosed in curly
+braces. For example,
+@samp{work+@{^boss.*@}} matches headlines that contain the tag
+@samp{:work:} and any tag @i{starting} with @samp{boss}.
+
+@cindex TODO keyword matching, with tags search
+@cindex level, require for tags/property match
+@cindex category, require for tags/property match
+@vindex org-odd-levels-only
+You may also test for properties (@pxref{Properties and Columns}) at the same
+time as matching tags. The properties may be real properties, or special
+properties that represent other metadata (@pxref{Special properties}). For
+example, the ``property'' @code{TODO} represents the TODO keyword of the
+entry. Or, the ``property'' @code{LEVEL} represents the level of an entry.
+So a search @samp{+LEVEL=3+boss-TODO="DONE"} lists all level three headlines
+that have the tag @samp{boss} and are @emph{not} marked with the TODO keyword
+DONE. In buffers with @code{org-odd-levels-only} set, @samp{LEVEL} does not
+count the number of stars, but @samp{LEVEL=2} will correspond to 3 stars etc.
+
+Here are more examples:
+@table @samp
+@item work+TODO="WAITING"
+Select @samp{:work:}-tagged TODO lines with the specific TODO
+keyword @samp{WAITING}.
+@item work+TODO="WAITING"|home+TODO="WAITING"
+Waiting tasks both at work and at home.
+@end table
+
+When matching properties, a number of different operators can be used to test
+the value of a property. Here is a complex example:
+
+@example
++work-boss+PRIORITY="A"+Coffee="unlimited"+Effort<2 \
+ +With=@{Sarah\|Denny@}+SCHEDULED>="<2008-10-11>"
+@end example
+
+@noindent
+The type of comparison will depend on how the comparison value is written:
+@itemize @minus
+@item
+If the comparison value is a plain number, a numerical comparison is done,
+and the allowed operators are @samp{<}, @samp{=}, @samp{>}, @samp{<=},
+@samp{>=}, and @samp{<>}.
+@item
+If the comparison value is enclosed in double-quotes,
+a string comparison is done, and the same operators are allowed.
+@item
+If the comparison value is enclosed in double-quotes @emph{and} angular
+brackets (like @samp{DEADLINE<="<2008-12-24 18:30>"}), both values are
+assumed to be date/time specifications in the standard Org way, and the
+comparison will be done accordingly. Special values that will be recognized
+are @code{"<now>"} for now (including time), and @code{"<today>"}, and
+@code{"<tomorrow>"} for these days at 0:00 hours, i.e. without a time
+specification. Also strings like @code{"<+5d>"} or @code{"<-2m>"} with units
+@code{d}, @code{w}, @code{m}, and @code{y} for day, week, month, and year,
+respectively, can be used.
+@item
+If the comparison value is enclosed
+in curly braces, a regexp match is performed, with @samp{=} meaning that the
+regexp matches the property value, and @samp{<>} meaning that it does not
+match.
+@end itemize
+
+So the search string in the example finds entries tagged @samp{:work:} but
+not @samp{:boss:}, which also have a priority value @samp{A}, a
+@samp{:Coffee:} property with the value @samp{unlimited}, an @samp{Effort}
+property that is numerically smaller than 2, a @samp{:With:} property that is
+matched by the regular expression @samp{Sarah\|Denny}, and that are scheduled
+on or after October 11, 2008.
+
+Accessing TODO, LEVEL, and CATEGORY during a search is fast. Accessing any
+other properties will slow down the search. However, once you have paid the
+price by accessing one property, testing additional properties is cheap
+again.
+
+You can configure Org-mode to use property inheritance during a search, but
+beware that this can slow down searches considerably. See @ref{Property
+inheritance}, for details.
+
+For backward compatibility, and also for typing speed, there is also a
+different way to test TODO states in a search. For this, terminate the
+tags/property part of the search string (which may include several terms
+connected with @samp{|}) with a @samp{/} and then specify a Boolean
+expression just for TODO keywords. The syntax is then similar to that for
+tags, but should be applied with care: for example, a positive selection on
+several TODO keywords cannot meaningfully be combined with boolean AND.
+However, @emph{negative selection} combined with AND can be meaningful. To
+make sure that only lines are checked that actually have any TODO keyword
+(resulting in a speed-up), use @kbd{C-c a M}, or equivalently start the TODO
+part after the slash with @samp{!}. Using @kbd{C-c a M} or @samp{/!} will
+not match TODO keywords in a DONE state. Examples:
+
+@table @samp
+@item work/WAITING
+Same as @samp{work+TODO="WAITING"}
+@item work/!-WAITING-NEXT
+Select @samp{:work:}-tagged TODO lines that are neither @samp{WAITING}
+nor @samp{NEXT}
+@item work/!+WAITING|+NEXT
+Select @samp{:work:}-tagged TODO lines that are either @samp{WAITING} or
+@samp{NEXT}.
+@end table
+
+@node Timeline, Search view, Matching tags and properties, Built-in agenda views
+@subsection Timeline for a single file
+@cindex timeline, single file
+@cindex time-sorted view
+
+The timeline summarizes all time-stamped items from a single Org-mode
+file in a @emph{time-sorted view}. The main purpose of this command is
+to give an overview over events in a project.
+
+@table @kbd
+@orgcmd{C-c a L,org-timeline}
+Show a time-sorted view of the Org file, with all time-stamped items.
+When called with a @kbd{C-u} prefix, all unfinished TODO entries
+(scheduled or not) are also listed under the current date.
+@end table
+
+@noindent
+The commands available in the timeline buffer are listed in
+@ref{Agenda commands}.
+
+@node Search view, Stuck projects, Timeline, Built-in agenda views
+@subsection Search view
+@cindex search view
+@cindex text search
+@cindex searching, for text
+
+This agenda view is a general text search facility for Org-mode entries.
+It is particularly useful to find notes.
+
+@table @kbd
+@orgcmd{C-c a s,org-search-view}
+This is a special search that lets you select entries by matching a substring
+or specific words using a boolean logic.
+@end table
+For example, the search string @samp{computer equipment} will find entries
+that contain @samp{computer equipment} as a substring. If the two words are
+separated by more space or a line break, the search will still match.
+Search view can also search for specific keywords in the entry, using Boolean
+logic. The search string @samp{+computer +wifi -ethernet -@{8\.11[bg]@}}
+will search for note entries that contain the keywords @code{computer}
+and @code{wifi}, but not the keyword @code{ethernet}, and which are also
+not matched by the regular expression @code{8\.11[bg]}, meaning to
+exclude both 8.11b and 8.11g. The first @samp{+} is necessary to turn on
+word search, other @samp{+} characters are optional. For more details, see
+the docstring of the command @code{org-search-view}.
+
+@vindex org-agenda-text-search-extra-files
+Note that in addition to the agenda files, this command will also search
+the files listed in @code{org-agenda-text-search-extra-files}.
+
+@node Stuck projects, , Search view, Built-in agenda views
+@subsection Stuck projects
+
+If you are following a system like David Allen's GTD to organize your
+work, one of the ``duties'' you have is a regular review to make sure
+that all projects move along. A @emph{stuck} project is a project that
+has no defined next actions, so it will never show up in the TODO lists
+Org-mode produces. During the review, you need to identify such
+projects and define next actions for them.
+
+@table @kbd
+@orgcmd{C-c a #,org-agenda-list-stuck-projects}
+List projects that are stuck.
+@kindex C-c a !
+@item C-c a !
+@vindex org-stuck-projects
+Customize the variable @code{org-stuck-projects} to define what a stuck
+project is and how to find it.
+@end table
+
+You almost certainly will have to configure this view before it will
+work for you. The built-in default assumes that all your projects are
+level-2 headlines, and that a project is not stuck if it has at least
+one entry marked with a TODO keyword TODO or NEXT or NEXTACTION.
+
+Let's assume that you, in your own way of using Org-mode, identify
+projects with a tag PROJECT, and that you use a TODO keyword MAYBE to
+indicate a project that should not be considered yet. Let's further
+assume that the TODO keyword DONE marks finished projects, and that NEXT
+and TODO indicate next actions. The tag @@SHOP indicates shopping and
+is a next action even without the NEXT tag. Finally, if the project
+contains the special word IGNORE anywhere, it should not be listed
+either. In this case you would start by identifying eligible projects
+with a tags/todo match@footnote{@xref{Tag searches}.}
+@samp{+PROJECT/-MAYBE-DONE}, and then check for TODO, NEXT, @@SHOP, and
+IGNORE in the subtree to identify projects that are not stuck. The
+correct customization for this is
+
+@lisp
+(setq org-stuck-projects
+ '("+PROJECT/-MAYBE-DONE" ("NEXT" "TODO") ("@@SHOP")
+ "\\<IGNORE\\>"))
+@end lisp
+
+Note that if a project is identified as non-stuck, the subtree of this entry
+will still be searched for stuck projects.
+
+@node Presentation and sorting, Agenda commands, Built-in agenda views, Agenda Views
+@section Presentation and sorting
+@cindex presentation, of agenda items
+
+@vindex org-agenda-prefix-format
+Before displaying items in an agenda view, Org-mode visually prepares
+the items and sorts them. Each item occupies a single line. The line
+starts with a @emph{prefix} that contains the @emph{category}
+(@pxref{Categories}) of the item and other important information. You can
+customize the prefix using the option @code{org-agenda-prefix-format}.
+The prefix is followed by a cleaned-up version of the outline headline
+associated with the item.
+
+@menu
+* Categories:: Not all tasks are equal
+* Time-of-day specifications:: How the agenda knows the time
+* Sorting of agenda items:: The order of things
+@end menu
+
+@node Categories, Time-of-day specifications, Presentation and sorting, Presentation and sorting
+@subsection Categories
+
+@cindex category
+@cindex #+CATEGORY
+The category is a broad label assigned to each agenda item. By default,
+the category is simply derived from the file name, but you can also
+specify it with a special line in the buffer, like this@footnote{For
+backward compatibility, the following also works: if there are several
+such lines in a file, each specifies the category for the text below it.
+The first category also applies to any text before the first CATEGORY
+line. However, using this method is @emph{strongly} deprecated as it is
+incompatible with the outline structure of the document. The correct
+method for setting multiple categories in a buffer is using a
+property.}:
+
+@example
+#+CATEGORY: Thesis
+@end example
+
+@noindent
+@cindex property, CATEGORY
+If you would like to have a special CATEGORY for a single entry or a
+(sub)tree, give the entry a @code{:CATEGORY:} property with the
+special category you want to apply as the value.
+
+@noindent
+The display in the agenda buffer looks best if the category is not
+longer than 10 characters.
+
+@noindent
+You can set up icons for category by customizing the
+@code{org-agenda-category-icon-alist} variable.
+
+@node Time-of-day specifications, Sorting of agenda items, Categories, Presentation and sorting
+@subsection Time-of-day specifications
+@cindex time-of-day specification
+
+Org-mode checks each agenda item for a time-of-day specification. The
+time can be part of the timestamp that triggered inclusion into the
+agenda, for example as in @w{@samp{<2005-05-10 Tue 19:00>}}. Time
+ranges can be specified with two timestamps, like
+@c
+@w{@samp{<2005-05-10 Tue 20:30>--<2005-05-10 Tue 22:15>}}.
+
+In the headline of the entry itself, a time(range) may also appear as
+plain text (like @samp{12:45} or a @samp{8:30-1pm}). If the agenda
+integrates the Emacs diary (@pxref{Weekly/daily agenda}), time
+specifications in diary entries are recognized as well.
+
+For agenda display, Org-mode extracts the time and displays it in a
+standard 24 hour format as part of the prefix. The example times in
+the previous paragraphs would end up in the agenda like this:
+
+@example
+ 8:30-13:00 Arthur Dent lies in front of the bulldozer
+ 12:45...... Ford Prefect arrives and takes Arthur to the pub
+ 19:00...... The Vogon reads his poem
+ 20:30-22:15 Marvin escorts the Hitchhikers to the bridge
+@end example
+
+@cindex time grid
+If the agenda is in single-day mode, or for the display of today, the
+timed entries are embedded in a time grid, like
+
+@example
+ 8:00...... ------------------
+ 8:30-13:00 Arthur Dent lies in front of the bulldozer
+ 10:00...... ------------------
+ 12:00...... ------------------
+ 12:45...... Ford Prefect arrives and takes Arthur to the pub
+ 14:00...... ------------------
+ 16:00...... ------------------
+ 18:00...... ------------------
+ 19:00...... The Vogon reads his poem
+ 20:00...... ------------------
+ 20:30-22:15 Marvin escorts the Hitchhikers to the bridge
+@end example
+
+@vindex org-agenda-use-time-grid
+@vindex org-agenda-time-grid
+The time grid can be turned on and off with the variable
+@code{org-agenda-use-time-grid}, and can be configured with
+@code{org-agenda-time-grid}.
+
+@node Sorting of agenda items, , Time-of-day specifications, Presentation and sorting
+@subsection Sorting of agenda items
+@cindex sorting, of agenda items
+@cindex priorities, of agenda items
+Before being inserted into a view, the items are sorted. How this is
+done depends on the type of view.
+@itemize @bullet
+@item
+@vindex org-agenda-files
+For the daily/weekly agenda, the items for each day are sorted. The
+default order is to first collect all items containing an explicit
+time-of-day specification. These entries will be shown at the beginning
+of the list, as a @emph{schedule} for the day. After that, items remain
+grouped in categories, in the sequence given by @code{org-agenda-files}.
+Within each category, items are sorted by priority (@pxref{Priorities}),
+which is composed of the base priority (2000 for priority @samp{A}, 1000
+for @samp{B}, and 0 for @samp{C}), plus additional increments for
+overdue scheduled or deadline items.
+@item
+For the TODO list, items remain in the order of categories, but within
+each category, sorting takes place according to priority
+(@pxref{Priorities}). The priority used for sorting derives from the
+priority cookie, with additions depending on how close an item is to its due
+or scheduled date.
+@item
+For tags matches, items are not sorted at all, but just appear in the
+sequence in which they are found in the agenda files.
+@end itemize
+
+@vindex org-agenda-sorting-strategy
+Sorting can be customized using the variable
+@code{org-agenda-sorting-strategy}, and may also include criteria based on
+the estimated effort of an entry (@pxref{Effort estimates}).
+
+@node Agenda commands, Custom agenda views, Presentation and sorting, Agenda Views
+@section Commands in the agenda buffer
+@cindex commands, in agenda buffer
+
+Entries in the agenda buffer are linked back to the Org file or diary
+file where they originate. You are not allowed to edit the agenda
+buffer itself, but commands are provided to show and jump to the
+original entry location, and to edit the Org files ``remotely'' from
+the agenda buffer. In this way, all information is stored only once,
+removing the risk that your agenda and note files may diverge.
+
+Some commands can be executed with mouse clicks on agenda lines. For
+the other commands, the cursor needs to be in the desired line.
+
+@table @kbd
+@tsubheading{Motion}
+@cindex motion commands in agenda
+@orgcmd{n,org-agenda-next-line}
+Next line (same as @key{up} and @kbd{C-p}).
+@orgcmd{p,org-agenda-previous-line}
+Previous line (same as @key{down} and @kbd{C-n}).
+@tsubheading{View/Go to Org file}
+@orgcmdkkc{@key{SPC},mouse-3,org-agenda-show-and-scroll-up}
+Display the original location of the item in another window.
+With prefix arg, make sure that the entire entry is made visible in the
+outline, not only the heading.
+@c
+@orgcmd{L,org-agenda-recenter}
+Display original location and recenter that window.
+@c
+@orgcmdkkc{@key{TAB},mouse-2,org-agenda-goto}
+Go to the original location of the item in another window.
+@c
+@orgcmd{@key{RET},org-agenda-switch-to}
+Go to the original location of the item and delete other windows.
+@c
+@orgcmd{F,org-agenda-follow-mode}
+@vindex org-agenda-start-with-follow-mode
+Toggle Follow mode. In Follow mode, as you move the cursor through
+the agenda buffer, the other window always shows the corresponding
+location in the Org file. The initial setting for this mode in new
+agenda buffers can be set with the variable
+@code{org-agenda-start-with-follow-mode}.
+@c
+@orgcmd{C-c C-x b,org-agenda-tree-to-indirect-buffer}
+Display the entire subtree of the current item in an indirect buffer. With a
+numeric prefix argument N, go up to level N and then take that tree. If N is
+negative, go up that many levels. With a @kbd{C-u} prefix, do not remove the
+previously used indirect buffer.
+
+@orgcmd{C-c C-o,org-agenda-open-link}
+Follow a link in the entry. This will offer a selection of any links in the
+text belonging to the referenced Org node. If there is only one link, it
+will be followed without a selection prompt.
+
+@tsubheading{Change display}
+@cindex display changing, in agenda
+@kindex o
+@item o
+Delete other windows.
+@c
+@c @kindex v d
+@c @kindex d
+@c @kindex v w
+@c @kindex w
+@c @kindex v m
+@c @kindex v y
+@c @item v d @ @r{or short} @ d
+@c @itemx v w @ @r{or short} @ w
+@c @itemx v m
+@c @itemx v y
+@orgcmdkskc{v d,d,org-aganda-day-view}
+@xorgcmdkskc{v w,w,org-aganda-day-view}
+@xorgcmd{v m,org-agenda-month-view}
+@xorgcmd{v y,org-agenda-month-year}
+Switch to day/week/month/year view. When switching to day or week view,
+this setting becomes the default for subsequent agenda commands. Since
+month and year views are slow to create, they do not become the default.
+A numeric prefix argument may be used to jump directly to a specific day
+of the year, ISO week, month, or year, respectively. For example,
+@kbd{32 d} jumps to February 1st, @kbd{9 w} to ISO week number 9. When
+setting day, week, or month view, a year may be encoded in the prefix
+argument as well. For example, @kbd{200712 w} will jump to week 12 in
+2007. If such a year specification has only one or two digits, it will
+be mapped to the interval 1938-2037.
+@c
+@orgcmd{f,org-agenda-later}
+Go forward in time to display the following @code{org-agenda-current-span} days.
+For example, if the display covers a week, switch to the following week.
+With prefix arg, go forward that many times @code{org-agenda-current-span} days.
+@c
+@orgcmd{b,org-agenda-earlier}
+Go backward in time to display earlier dates.
+@c
+@orgcmd{.,org-agenda-goto-today}
+Go to today.
+@c
+@orgcmd{j,org-agenda-goto-date}
+Prompt for a date and go there.
+@c
+@orgcmd{J,org-agenda-clock-goto}
+Go to the currently clocked-in task @i{in the agenda buffer}.
+@c
+@orgcmd{D,org-agenda-toggle-diary}
+Toggle the inclusion of diary entries. See @ref{Weekly/daily agenda}.
+@c
+@orgcmdkskc{v l,l,org-agenda-log-mode}
+@kindex v L
+@vindex org-log-done
+@vindex org-agenda-log-mode-items
+Toggle Logbook mode. In Logbook mode, entries that were marked DONE while
+logging was on (variable @code{org-log-done}) are shown in the agenda, as are
+entries that have been clocked on that day. You can configure the entry
+types that should be included in log mode using the variable
+@code{org-agenda-log-mode-items}. When called with a @kbd{C-u} prefix, show
+all possible logbook entries, including state changes. When called with two
+prefix args @kbd{C-u C-u}, show only logging information, nothing else.
+@kbd{v L} is equivalent to @kbd{C-u v l}.
+@c
+@orgcmdkskc{v [,[,org-agenda-manipulate-query-add}
+Include inactive timestamps into the current view. Only for weekly/daily
+agenda and timeline views.
+@c
+@orgcmd{v a,org-agenda-archives-mode}
+@xorgcmd{v A,org-agenda-archives-mode 'files}
+Toggle Archives mode. In Archives mode, trees that are marked
+@code{ARCHIVED} are also scanned when producing the agenda. When you use the
+capital @kbd{A}, even all archive files are included. To exit archives mode,
+press @kbd{v a} again.
+@c
+@orgcmdkskc{v R,R,org-agenda-clockreport-mode}
+@vindex org-agenda-start-with-clockreport-mode
+Toggle Clockreport mode. In Clockreport mode, the daily/weekly agenda will
+always show a table with the clocked times for the timespan and file scope
+covered by the current agenda view. The initial setting for this mode in new
+agenda buffers can be set with the variable
+@code{org-agenda-start-with-clockreport-mode}. By using a prefix argument
+when toggling this mode (i.e. @kbd{C-u R}), the clock table will not show
+contributions from entries that are hidden by agenda filtering@footnote{Only
+tags filtering will be respected here, effort filtering is ignored.}.
+@c
+@orgcmdkskc{v E,E,org-agenda-entry-text-mode}
+@vindex org-agenda-start-with-entry-text-mode
+@vindex org-agenda-entry-text-maxlines
+Toggle entry text mode. In entry text mode, a number of lines from the Org
+outline node referenced by an agenda line will be displayed below the line.
+The maximum number of lines is given by the variable
+@code{org-agenda-entry-text-maxlines}. Calling this command with a numeric
+prefix argument will temporarily modify that number to the prefix value.
+@c
+@orgcmd{G,org-agenda-toggle-time-grid}
+@vindex org-agenda-use-time-grid
+@vindex org-agenda-time-grid
+Toggle the time grid on and off. See also the variables
+@code{org-agenda-use-time-grid} and @code{org-agenda-time-grid}.
+@c
+@orgcmd{r,org-agenda-rodo}
+Recreate the agenda buffer, for example to reflect the changes after
+modification of the timestamps of items with @kbd{S-@key{left}} and
+@kbd{S-@key{right}}. When the buffer is the global TODO list, a prefix
+argument is interpreted to create a selective list for a specific TODO
+keyword.
+@orgcmd{g,org-agenda-rodo}
+Same as @kbd{r}.
+@c
+@orgcmdkskc{C-x C-s,s,org-save-all-org-buffers}
+Save all Org buffers in the current Emacs session, and also the locations of
+IDs.
+@c
+@orgcmd{C-c C-x C-c,org-agenda-columns}
+@vindex org-columns-default-format
+Invoke column view (@pxref{Column view}) in the agenda buffer. The column
+view format is taken from the entry at point, or (if there is no entry at
+point), from the first entry in the agenda view. So whatever the format for
+that entry would be in the original buffer (taken from a property, from a
+@code{#+COLUMNS} line, or from the default variable
+@code{org-columns-default-format}), will be used in the agenda.
+
+@orgcmd{C-c C-x >,org-agenda-remove-restriction-lock}
+Remove the restriction lock on the agenda, if it is currently restricted to a
+file or subtree (@pxref{Agenda files}).
+
+@tsubheading{Secondary filtering and query editing}
+@cindex filtering, by tag and effort, in agenda
+@cindex tag filtering, in agenda
+@cindex effort filtering, in agenda
+@cindex query editing, in agenda
+
+@orgcmd{/,org-agenda-filter-by-tag}
+@vindex org-agenda-filter-preset
+Filter the current agenda view with respect to a tag and/or effort estimates.
+The difference between this and a custom agenda command is that filtering is
+very fast, so that you can switch quickly between different filters without
+having to recreate the agenda.@footnote{Custom commands can preset a filter by
+binding the variable @code{org-agenda-filter-preset} as an option. This
+filter will then be applied to the view and persist as a basic filter through
+refreshes and more secondary filtering. The filter is a global property of
+the entire agenda view---in a block agenda, you should only set this in the
+global options section, not in the section of an individual block.}
+
+You will be prompted for a tag selection letter; @key{SPC} will mean any tag at
+all. Pressing @key{TAB} at that prompt will offer use completion to select a
+tag (including any tags that do not have a selection character). The command
+then hides all entries that do not contain or inherit this tag. When called
+with prefix arg, remove the entries that @emph{do} have the tag. A second
+@kbd{/} at the prompt will turn off the filter and unhide any hidden entries.
+If the first key you press is either @kbd{+} or @kbd{-}, the previous filter
+will be narrowed by requiring or forbidding the selected additional tag.
+Instead of pressing @kbd{+} or @kbd{-} after @kbd{/}, you can also
+immediately use the @kbd{\} command.
+
+@vindex org-sort-agenda-noeffort-is-high
+In order to filter for effort estimates, you should set up allowed
+efforts globally, for example
+@lisp
+(setq org-global-properties
+ '(("Effort_ALL". "0 0:10 0:30 1:00 2:00 3:00 4:00")))
+@end lisp
+You can then filter for an effort by first typing an operator, one of
+@kbd{<}, @kbd{>}, and @kbd{=}, and then the one-digit index of an effort
+estimate in your array of allowed values, where @kbd{0} means the 10th value.
+The filter will then restrict to entries with effort smaller-or-equal, equal,
+or larger-or-equal than the selected value. If the digits 0-9 are not used
+as fast access keys to tags, you can also simply press the index digit
+directly without an operator. In this case, @kbd{<} will be assumed. For
+application of the operator, entries without a defined effort will be treated
+according to the value of @code{org-sort-agenda-noeffort-is-high}. To filter
+for tasks without effort definition, press @kbd{?} as the operator.
+
+Org also supports automatic, context-aware tag filtering. If the variable
+@code{org-agenda-auto-exclude-function} is set to a user-defined function,
+that function can decide which tags should be excluded from the agenda
+automatically. Once this is set, the @kbd{/} command then accepts @kbd{RET}
+as a sub-option key and runs the auto exclusion logic. For example, let's
+say you use a @code{Net} tag to identify tasks which need network access, an
+@code{Errand} tag for errands in town, and a @code{Call} tag for making phone
+calls. You could auto-exclude these tags based on the availability of the
+Internet, and outside of business hours, with something like this:
+
+@lisp
+@group
+(defun org-my-auto-exclude-function (tag)
+ (and (cond
+ ((string= tag "Net")
+ (/= 0 (call-process "/sbin/ping" nil nil nil
+ "-c1" "-q" "-t1" "mail.gnu.org")))
+ ((or (string= tag "Errand") (string= tag "Call"))
+ (let ((hour (nth 2 (decode-time))))
+ (or (< hour 8) (> hour 21)))))
+ (concat "-" tag)))
+
+(setq org-agenda-auto-exclude-function 'org-my-auto-exclude-function)
+@end group
+@end lisp
+
+@orgcmd{\,org-agenda-filter-by-tag-refine}
+Narrow the current agenda filter by an additional condition. When called with
+prefix arg, remove the entries that @emph{do} have the tag, or that do match
+the effort criterion. You can achieve the same effect by pressing @kbd{+} or
+@kbd{-} as the first key after the @kbd{/} command.
+
+@c
+@kindex [
+@kindex ]
+@kindex @{
+@kindex @}
+@item [ ] @{ @}
+@table @i
+@item @r{in} search view
+add new search words (@kbd{[} and @kbd{]}) or new regular expressions
+(@kbd{@{} and @kbd{@}}) to the query string. The opening bracket/brace will
+add a positive search term prefixed by @samp{+}, indicating that this search
+term @i{must} occur/match in the entry. The closing bracket/brace will add a
+negative search term which @i{must not} occur/match in the entry for it to be
+selected.
+@end table
+
+@tsubheading{Remote editing}
+@cindex remote editing, from agenda
+
+@item 0-9
+Digit argument.
+@c
+@cindex undoing remote-editing events
+@cindex remote editing, undo
+@orgcmd{C-_,org-agenda-undo}
+Undo a change due to a remote editing command. The change is undone
+both in the agenda buffer and in the remote buffer.
+@c
+@orgcmd{t,org-agenda-todo}
+Change the TODO state of the item, both in the agenda and in the
+original org file.
+@c
+@orgcmd{C-S-@key{right},org-agenda-todo-nextset}
+@orgcmd{C-S-@key{left},org-agenda-todo-previousset}
+Switch to the next/previous set of TODO keywords.
+@c
+@orgcmd{C-k,org-agenda-kill}
+@vindex org-agenda-confirm-kill
+Delete the current agenda item along with the entire subtree belonging
+to it in the original Org file. If the text to be deleted remotely
+is longer than one line, the kill needs to be confirmed by the user. See
+variable @code{org-agenda-confirm-kill}.
+@c
+@orgcmd{C-c C-w,org-agenda-refile}
+Refile the entry at point.
+@c
+@orgcmdkskc{C-c C-x C-a,a,org-agenda-archive-default-with-confirmation}
+@vindex org-archive-default-command
+Archive the subtree corresponding to the entry at point using the default
+archiving command set in @code{org-archive-default-command}. When using the
+@code{a} key, confirmation will be required.
+@c
+@orgcmd{C-c C-x a,org-agenda-toggle-archive-tag}
+Toggle the ARCHIVE tag for the current headline.
+@c
+@orgcmd{C-c C-x A,org-agenda-archive-to-archive-sibling}
+Move the subtree corresponding to the current entry to its @emph{archive
+sibling}.
+@c
+@orgcmdkskc{C-c C-x C-s,$,org-agenda-archive}
+Archive the subtree corresponding to the current headline. This means the
+entry will be moved to the configured archive location, most likely a
+different file.
+@c
+@orgcmd{T,org-agenda-show-tags}
+@vindex org-agenda-show-inherited-tags
+Show all tags associated with the current item. This is useful if you have
+turned off @code{org-agenda-show-inherited-tags}, but still want to see all
+tags of a headline occasionally.
+@c
+@orgcmd{:,org-agenda-set-tags}
+Set tags for the current headline. If there is an active region in the
+agenda, change a tag for all headings in the region.
+@c
+@kindex ,
+@item ,
+Set the priority for the current item (@command{org-agenda-priority}).
+Org-mode prompts for the priority character. If you reply with @key{SPC}, the
+priority cookie is removed from the entry.
+@c
+@orgcmd{P,org-agenda-show-priority}
+Display weighted priority of current item.
+@c
+@orgcmdkkc{+,S-@key{up},org-agenda-priority-up}
+Increase the priority of the current item. The priority is changed in
+the original buffer, but the agenda is not resorted. Use the @kbd{r}
+key for this.
+@c
+@orgcmdkkc{-,S-@key{down},org-agenda-priority-down}
+Decrease the priority of the current item.
+@c
+@orgcmdkkc{z,C-c C-z,org-agenda-add-note}
+@vindex org-log-into-drawer
+Add a note to the entry. This note will be recorded, and then filed to the
+same location where state change notes are put. Depending on
+@code{org-log-into-drawer}, this may be inside a drawer.
+@c
+@orgcmd{C-c C-a,org-attach}
+Dispatcher for all command related to attachments.
+@c
+@orgcmd{C-c C-s,org-agenda-schedule}
+Schedule this item. With prefix arg remove the scheduling timestamp
+@c
+@orgcmd{C-c C-d,org-agenda-deadline}
+Set a deadline for this item. With prefix arg remove the deadline.
+@c
+@orgcmd{k,org-agenda-action}
+Agenda actions, to set dates for selected items to the cursor date.
+This command also works in the calendar! The command prompts for an
+additional key:
+@example
+m @r{Mark the entry at point for action. You can also make entries}
+ @r{in Org files with @kbd{C-c C-x C-k}.}
+d @r{Set the deadline of the marked entry to the date at point.}
+s @r{Schedule the marked entry at the date at point.}
+r @r{Call @code{org-capture} with the cursor date as default date.}
+@end example
+@noindent
+Press @kbd{r} afterward to refresh the agenda and see the effect of the
+command.
+@c
+@orgcmd{S-@key{right},org-agenda-do-date-later}
+Change the timestamp associated with the current line by one day into the
+future. With a numeric prefix argument, change it by that many days. For
+example, @kbd{3 6 5 S-@key{right}} will change it by a year. With a
+@kbd{C-u} prefix, change the time by one hour. If you immediately repeat the
+command, it will continue to change hours even without the prefix arg. With
+a double @kbd{C-u C-u} prefix, do the same for changing minutes. The stamp
+is changed in the original Org file, but the change is not directly reflected
+in the agenda buffer. Use @kbd{r} or @kbd{g} to update the buffer.
+@c
+@orgcmd{S-@key{left},org-agenda-do-date-earlier}
+Change the timestamp associated with the current line by one day
+into the past.
+@c
+@orgcmd{>,org-agenda-date-prompt}
+Change the timestamp associated with the current line. The key @kbd{>} has
+been chosen, because it is the same as @kbd{S-.} on my keyboard.
+@c
+@orgcmd{I,org-agenda-clock-in}
+Start the clock on the current item. If a clock is running already, it
+is stopped first.
+@c
+@orgcmd{O,org-agenda-clock-out}
+Stop the previously started clock.
+@c
+@orgcmd{X,org-agenda-clock-cancel}
+Cancel the currently running clock.
+@c
+@orgcmd{J,org-agenda-clock-goto}
+Jump to the running clock in another window.
+
+@tsubheading{Bulk remote editing selected entries}
+@cindex remote editing, bulk, from agenda
+
+@orgcmd{m,org-agenda-bulk-mark}
+Mark the entry at point for bulk action. With prefix arg, mark that many
+successive entries.
+@c
+@orgcmd{u,org-agenda-bulk-unmark}
+Unmark entry for bulk action.
+@c
+@orgcmd{U,org-agenda-bulk-remove-all-marks}
+Unmark all marked entries for bulk action.
+@c
+@orgcmd{B,org-agenda-bulk-action}
+Bulk action: act on all marked entries in the agenda. This will prompt for
+another key to select the action to be applied. The prefix arg to @kbd{B}
+will be passed through to the @kbd{s} and @kbd{d} commands, to bulk-remove
+these special timestamps.
+@example
+r @r{Prompt for a single refile target and move all entries. The entries}
+ @r{will no longer be in the agenda; refresh (@kbd{g}) to bring them back.}
+$ @r{Archive all selected entries.}
+A @r{Archive entries by moving them to their respective archive siblings.}
+t @r{Change TODO state. This prompts for a single TODO keyword and}
+ @r{changes the state of all selected entries, bypassing blocking and}
+ @r{suppressing logging notes (but not time stamps).}
++ @r{Add a tag to all selected entries.}
+- @r{Remove a tag from all selected entries.}
+s @r{Schedule all items to a new date. To shift existing schedule dates}
+ @r{by a fixed number of days, use something starting with double plus}
+ @r{at the prompt, for example @samp{++8d} or @samp{++2w}.}
+S @r{Reschedule randomly by N days. N will be prompted for. With prefix}
+ @r{arg (@kbd{C-u B S}), scatter only accross weekdays.}
+d @r{Set deadline to a specific date.}
+@end example
+
+
+@tsubheading{Calendar commands}
+@cindex calendar commands, from agenda
+
+@orgcmd{c,org-agenda-goto-calendar}
+Open the Emacs calendar and move to the date at the agenda cursor.
+@c
+@orgcmd{c,org-calendar-goto-agenda}
+When in the calendar, compute and show the Org-mode agenda for the
+date at the cursor.
+@c
+@cindex diary entries, creating from agenda
+@orgcmd{i,org-agenda-diary-entry}
+@vindex org-agenda-diary-file
+Insert a new entry into the diary, using the date at the cursor and (for
+block entries) the date at the mark. This will add to the Emacs diary
+file@footnote{This file is parsed for the agenda when
+@code{org-agenda-include-diary} is set.}, in a way similar to the @kbd{i}
+command in the calendar. The diary file will pop up in another window, where
+you can add the entry.
+
+If you configure @code{org-agenda-diary-file} to point to an Org-mode file,
+Org will create entries (in org-mode syntax) in that file instead. Most
+entries will be stored in a date-based outline tree that will later make it
+easy to archive appointments from previous months/years. The tree will be
+built under an entry with a @code{DATE_TREE} property, or else with years as
+top-level entries. Emacs will prompt you for the entry text---if you specify
+it, the entry will be created in @code{org-agenda-diary-file} without further
+interaction. If you directly press @key{RET} at the prompt without typing
+text, the target file will be shown in another window for you to finish the
+entry there. See also the @kbd{k r} command.
+@c
+@orgcmd{M,org-agenda-phases-of-moon}
+Show the phases of the moon for the three months around current date.
+@c
+@orgcmd{S,org-agenda-sunrise-sunset}
+Show sunrise and sunset times. The geographical location must be set
+with calendar variables, see the documentation for the Emacs calendar.
+@c
+@orgcmd{C,org-agenda-convert-date}
+Convert the date at cursor into many other cultural and historic
+calendars.
+@c
+@orgcmd{H,org-agenda-holidays}
+Show holidays for three months around the cursor date.
+
+@item M-x org-export-icalendar-combine-agenda-files
+Export a single iCalendar file containing entries from all agenda files.
+This is a globally available command, and also available in the agenda menu.
+
+@tsubheading{Exporting to a file}
+@orgcmd{C-x C-w,org-write-agenda}
+@cindex exporting agenda views
+@cindex agenda views, exporting
+@vindex org-agenda-exporter-settings
+Write the agenda view to a file. Depending on the extension of the selected
+file name, the view will be exported as HTML (extension @file{.html} or
+@file{.htm}), Postscript (extension @file{.ps}), PDF (extension @file{.pdf}),
+and plain text (any other extension). When called with a @kbd{C-u} prefix
+argument, immediately open the newly created file. Use the variable
+@code{org-agenda-exporter-settings} to set options for @file{ps-print} and
+for @file{htmlize} to be used during export.
+
+@tsubheading{Quit and Exit}
+@orgcmd{q,org-agenda-quit}
+Quit agenda, remove the agenda buffer.
+@c
+@cindex agenda files, removing buffers
+@orgcmd{x,org-agenda-exit}
+Exit agenda, remove the agenda buffer and all buffers loaded by Emacs
+for the compilation of the agenda. Buffers created by the user to
+visit Org files will not be removed.
+@end table
+
+
+@node Custom agenda views, Exporting Agenda Views, Agenda commands, Agenda Views
+@section Custom agenda views
+@cindex custom agenda views
+@cindex agenda views, custom
+
+Custom agenda commands serve two purposes: to store and quickly access
+frequently used TODO and tags searches, and to create special composite
+agenda buffers. Custom agenda commands will be accessible through the
+dispatcher (@pxref{Agenda dispatcher}), just like the default commands.
+
+@menu
+* Storing searches:: Type once, use often
+* Block agenda:: All the stuff you need in a single buffer
+* Setting Options:: Changing the rules
+@end menu
+
+@node Storing searches, Block agenda, Custom agenda views, Custom agenda views
+@subsection Storing searches
+
+The first application of custom searches is the definition of keyboard
+shortcuts for frequently used searches, either creating an agenda
+buffer, or a sparse tree (the latter covering of course only the current
+buffer).
+@kindex C-c a C
+@vindex org-agenda-custom-commands
+Custom commands are configured in the variable
+@code{org-agenda-custom-commands}. You can customize this variable, for
+example by pressing @kbd{C-c a C}. You can also directly set it with
+Emacs Lisp in @file{.emacs}. The following example contains all valid
+search types:
+
+@lisp
+@group
+(setq org-agenda-custom-commands
+ '(("w" todo "WAITING")
+ ("W" todo-tree "WAITING")
+ ("u" tags "+boss-urgent")
+ ("v" tags-todo "+boss-urgent")
+ ("U" tags-tree "+boss-urgent")
+ ("f" occur-tree "\\<FIXME\\>")
+ ("h" . "HOME+Name tags searches") ; description for "h" prefix
+ ("hl" tags "+home+Lisa")
+ ("hp" tags "+home+Peter")
+ ("hk" tags "+home+Kim")))
+@end group
+@end lisp
+
+@noindent
+The initial string in each entry defines the keys you have to press
+after the dispatcher command @kbd{C-c a} in order to access the command.
+Usually this will be just a single character, but if you have many
+similar commands, you can also define two-letter combinations where the
+first character is the same in several combinations and serves as a
+prefix key@footnote{You can provide a description for a prefix key by
+inserting a cons cell with the prefix and the description.}. The second
+parameter is the search type, followed by the string or regular
+expression to be used for the matching. The example above will
+therefore define:
+
+@table @kbd
+@item C-c a w
+as a global search for TODO entries with @samp{WAITING} as the TODO
+keyword
+@item C-c a W
+as the same search, but only in the current buffer and displaying the
+results as a sparse tree
+@item C-c a u
+as a global tags search for headlines marked @samp{:boss:} but not
+@samp{:urgent:}
+@item C-c a v
+as the same search as @kbd{C-c a u}, but limiting the search to
+headlines that are also TODO items
+@item C-c a U
+as the same search as @kbd{C-c a u}, but only in the current buffer and
+displaying the result as a sparse tree
+@item C-c a f
+to create a sparse tree (again: current buffer only) with all entries
+containing the word @samp{FIXME}
+@item C-c a h
+as a prefix command for a HOME tags search where you have to press an
+additional key (@kbd{l}, @kbd{p} or @kbd{k}) to select a name (Lisa,
+Peter, or Kim) as additional tag to match.
+@end table
+
+@node Block agenda, Setting Options, Storing searches, Custom agenda views
+@subsection Block agenda
+@cindex block agenda
+@cindex agenda, with block views
+
+Another possibility is the construction of agenda views that comprise
+the results of @emph{several} commands, each of which creates a block in
+the agenda buffer. The available commands include @code{agenda} for the
+daily or weekly agenda (as created with @kbd{C-c a a}), @code{alltodo}
+for the global TODO list (as constructed with @kbd{C-c a t}), and the
+matching commands discussed above: @code{todo}, @code{tags}, and
+@code{tags-todo}. Here are two examples:
+
+@lisp
+@group
+(setq org-agenda-custom-commands
+ '(("h" "Agenda and Home-related tasks"
+ ((agenda "")
+ (tags-todo "home")
+ (tags "garden")))
+ ("o" "Agenda and Office-related tasks"
+ ((agenda "")
+ (tags-todo "work")
+ (tags "office")))))
+@end group
+@end lisp
+
+@noindent
+This will define @kbd{C-c a h} to create a multi-block view for stuff
+you need to attend to at home. The resulting agenda buffer will contain
+your agenda for the current week, all TODO items that carry the tag
+@samp{home}, and also all lines tagged with @samp{garden}. Finally the
+command @kbd{C-c a o} provides a similar view for office tasks.
+
+@node Setting Options, , Block agenda, Custom agenda views
+@subsection Setting options for custom commands
+@cindex options, for custom agenda views
+
+@vindex org-agenda-custom-commands
+Org-mode contains a number of variables regulating agenda construction
+and display. The global variables define the behavior for all agenda
+commands, including the custom commands. However, if you want to change
+some settings just for a single custom view, you can do so. Setting
+options requires inserting a list of variable names and values at the
+right spot in @code{org-agenda-custom-commands}. For example:
+
+@lisp
+@group
+(setq org-agenda-custom-commands
+ '(("w" todo "WAITING"
+ ((org-agenda-sorting-strategy '(priority-down))
+ (org-agenda-prefix-format " Mixed: ")))
+ ("U" tags-tree "+boss-urgent"
+ ((org-show-following-heading nil)
+ (org-show-hierarchy-above nil)))
+ ("N" search ""
+ ((org-agenda-files '("~org/notes.org"))
+ (org-agenda-text-search-extra-files nil)))))
+@end group
+@end lisp
+
+@noindent
+Now the @kbd{C-c a w} command will sort the collected entries only by
+priority, and the prefix format is modified to just say @samp{ Mixed: }
+instead of giving the category of the entry. The sparse tags tree of
+@kbd{C-c a U} will now turn out ultra-compact, because neither the
+headline hierarchy above the match, nor the headline following the match
+will be shown. The command @kbd{C-c a N} will do a text search limited
+to only a single file.
+
+@vindex org-agenda-custom-commands
+For command sets creating a block agenda,
+@code{org-agenda-custom-commands} has two separate spots for setting
+options. You can add options that should be valid for just a single
+command in the set, and options that should be valid for all commands in
+the set. The former are just added to the command entry; the latter
+must come after the list of command entries. Going back to the block
+agenda example (@pxref{Block agenda}), let's change the sorting strategy
+for the @kbd{C-c a h} commands to @code{priority-down}, but let's sort
+the results for GARDEN tags query in the opposite order,
+@code{priority-up}. This would look like this:
+
+@lisp
+@group
+(setq org-agenda-custom-commands
+ '(("h" "Agenda and Home-related tasks"
+ ((agenda)
+ (tags-todo "home")
+ (tags "garden"
+ ((org-agenda-sorting-strategy '(priority-up)))))
+ ((org-agenda-sorting-strategy '(priority-down))))
+ ("o" "Agenda and Office-related tasks"
+ ((agenda)
+ (tags-todo "work")
+ (tags "office")))))
+@end group
+@end lisp
+
+As you see, the values and parentheses setting is a little complex.
+When in doubt, use the customize interface to set this variable---it
+fully supports its structure. Just one caveat: when setting options in
+this interface, the @emph{values} are just Lisp expressions. So if the
+value is a string, you need to add the double-quotes around the value
+yourself.
+
+
+@node Exporting Agenda Views, Agenda column view, Custom agenda views, Agenda Views
+@section Exporting Agenda Views
+@cindex agenda views, exporting
+
+If you are away from your computer, it can be very useful to have a printed
+version of some agenda views to carry around. Org-mode can export custom
+agenda views as plain text, HTML@footnote{You need to install Hrvoje Niksic's
+@file{htmlize.el}.}, Postscript, PDF@footnote{To create PDF output, the
+ghostscript @file{ps2pdf} utility must be installed on the system. Selecting
+a PDF file with also create the postscript file.}, and iCalendar files. If
+you want to do this only occasionally, use the command
+
+@table @kbd
+@orgcmd{C-x C-w,org-write-agenda}
+@cindex exporting agenda views
+@cindex agenda views, exporting
+@vindex org-agenda-exporter-settings
+Write the agenda view to a file. Depending on the extension of the selected
+file name, the view will be exported as HTML (extension @file{.html} or
+@file{.htm}), Postscript (extension @file{.ps}), iCalendar (extension
+@file{.ics}), or plain text (any other extension). Use the variable
+@code{org-agenda-exporter-settings} to set options for @file{ps-print} and
+for @file{htmlize} to be used during export, for example
+
+@vindex org-agenda-add-entry-text-maxlines
+@vindex htmlize-output-type
+@vindex ps-number-of-columns
+@vindex ps-landscape-mode
+@lisp
+(setq org-agenda-exporter-settings
+ '((ps-number-of-columns 2)
+ (ps-landscape-mode t)
+ (org-agenda-add-entry-text-maxlines 5)
+ (htmlize-output-type 'css)))
+@end lisp
+@end table
+
+If you need to export certain agenda views frequently, you can associate
+any custom agenda command with a list of output file names
+@footnote{If you want to store standard views like the weekly agenda
+or the global TODO list as well, you need to define custom commands for
+them in order to be able to specify file names.}. Here is an example
+that first defines custom commands for the agenda and the global
+TODO list, together with a number of files to which to export them.
+Then we define two block agenda commands and specify file names for them
+as well. File names can be relative to the current working directory,
+or absolute.
+
+@lisp
+@group
+(setq org-agenda-custom-commands
+ '(("X" agenda "" nil ("agenda.html" "agenda.ps"))
+ ("Y" alltodo "" nil ("todo.html" "todo.txt" "todo.ps"))
+ ("h" "Agenda and Home-related tasks"
+ ((agenda "")
+ (tags-todo "home")
+ (tags "garden"))
+ nil
+ ("~/views/home.html"))
+ ("o" "Agenda and Office-related tasks"
+ ((agenda)
+ (tags-todo "work")
+ (tags "office"))
+ nil
+ ("~/views/office.ps" "~/calendars/office.ics"))))
+@end group
+@end lisp
+
+The extension of the file name determines the type of export. If it is
+@file{.html}, Org-mode will use the @file{htmlize.el} package to convert
+the buffer to HTML and save it to this file name. If the extension is
+@file{.ps}, @code{ps-print-buffer-with-faces} is used to produce
+Postscript output. If the extension is @file{.ics}, iCalendar export is
+run export over all files that were used to construct the agenda, and
+limit the export to entries listed in the agenda. Any other
+extension produces a plain ASCII file.
+
+The export files are @emph{not} created when you use one of those
+commands interactively because this might use too much overhead.
+Instead, there is a special command to produce @emph{all} specified
+files in one step:
+
+@table @kbd
+@orgcmd{C-c a e,org-store-agenda-views}
+Export all agenda views that have export file names associated with
+them.
+@end table
+
+You can use the options section of the custom agenda commands to also
+set options for the export commands. For example:
+
+@lisp
+(setq org-agenda-custom-commands
+ '(("X" agenda ""
+ ((ps-number-of-columns 2)
+ (ps-landscape-mode t)
+ (org-agenda-prefix-format " [ ] ")
+ (org-agenda-with-colors nil)
+ (org-agenda-remove-tags t))
+ ("theagenda.ps"))))
+@end lisp
+
+@noindent
+This command sets two options for the Postscript exporter, to make it
+print in two columns in landscape format---the resulting page can be cut
+in two and then used in a paper agenda. The remaining settings modify
+the agenda prefix to omit category and scheduling information, and
+instead include a checkbox to check off items. We also remove the tags
+to make the lines compact, and we don't want to use colors for the
+black-and-white printer. Settings specified in
+@code{org-agenda-exporter-settings} will also apply, but the settings
+in @code{org-agenda-custom-commands} take precedence.
+
+@noindent
+From the command line you may also use
+@example
+emacs -f org-batch-store-agenda-views -kill
+@end example
+@noindent
+or, if you need to modify some parameters@footnote{Quoting depends on the
+system you use, please check the FAQ for examples.}
+@example
+emacs -eval '(org-batch-store-agenda-views \
+ org-agenda-span month \
+ org-agenda-start-day "2007-11-01" \
+ org-agenda-include-diary nil \
+ org-agenda-files (quote ("~/org/project.org")))' \
+ -kill
+@end example
+@noindent
+which will create the agenda views restricted to the file
+@file{~/org/project.org}, without diary entries and with a 30-day
+extent.
+
+You can also extract agenda information in a way that allows further
+processing by other programs. See @ref{Extracting agenda information}, for
+more information.
+
+
+@node Agenda column view, , Exporting Agenda Views, Agenda Views
+@section Using column view in the agenda
+@cindex column view, in agenda
+@cindex agenda, column view
+
+Column view (@pxref{Column view}) is normally used to view and edit
+properties embedded in the hierarchical structure of an Org file. It can be
+quite useful to use column view also from the agenda, where entries are
+collected by certain criteria.
+
+@table @kbd
+@orgcmd{C-c C-x C-c,org-agenda-columns}
+Turn on column view in the agenda.
+@end table
+
+To understand how to use this properly, it is important to realize that the
+entries in the agenda are no longer in their proper outline environment.
+This causes the following issues:
+
+@enumerate
+@item
+@vindex org-columns-default-format
+@vindex org-overriding-columns-format
+Org needs to make a decision which @code{COLUMNS} format to use. Since the
+entries in the agenda are collected from different files, and different files
+may have different @code{COLUMNS} formats, this is a non-trivial problem.
+Org first checks if the variable @code{org-overriding-columns-format} is
+currently set, and if so, takes the format from there. Otherwise it takes
+the format associated with the first item in the agenda, or, if that item
+does not have a specific format (defined in a property, or in its file), it
+uses @code{org-columns-default-format}.
+@item
+@cindex property, special, CLOCKSUM
+If any of the columns has a summary type defined (@pxref{Column attributes}),
+turning on column view in the agenda will visit all relevant agenda files and
+make sure that the computations of this property are up to date. This is
+also true for the special @code{CLOCKSUM} property. Org will then sum the
+values displayed in the agenda. In the daily/weekly agenda, the sums will
+cover a single day; in all other views they cover the entire block. It is
+vital to realize that the agenda may show the same entry @emph{twice} (for
+example as scheduled and as a deadline), and it may show two entries from the
+same hierarchy (for example a @emph{parent} and its @emph{child}). In these
+cases, the summation in the agenda will lead to incorrect results because
+some values will count double.
+@item
+When the column view in the agenda shows the @code{CLOCKSUM}, that is always
+the entire clocked time for this item. So even in the daily/weekly agenda,
+the clocksum listed in column view may originate from times outside the
+current view. This has the advantage that you can compare these values with
+a column listing the planned total effort for a task---one of the major
+applications for column view in the agenda. If you want information about
+clocked time in the displayed period use clock table mode (press @kbd{R} in
+the agenda).
+@end enumerate
+
+
+@node Markup, Exporting, Agenda Views, Top
+@chapter Markup for rich export
+
+When exporting Org-mode documents, the exporter tries to reflect the
+structure of the document as accurately as possible in the backend. Since
+export targets like HTML, @LaTeX{}, or DocBook allow much richer formatting,
+Org-mode has rules on how to prepare text for rich export. This section
+summarizes the markup rules used in an Org-mode buffer.
+
+@menu
+* Structural markup elements:: The basic structure as seen by the exporter
+* Images and tables:: Tables and Images will be included
+* Literal examples:: Source code examples with special formatting
+* Include files:: Include additional files into a document
+* Index entries:: Making an index
+* Macro replacement:: Use macros to create complex output
+* Embedded LaTeX:: LaTeX can be freely used inside Org documents
+@end menu
+
+@node Structural markup elements, Images and tables, Markup, Markup
+@section Structural markup elements
+
+@menu
+* Document title:: Where the title is taken from
+* Headings and sections:: The document structure as seen by the exporter
+* Table of contents:: The if and where of the table of contents
+* Initial text:: Text before the first heading?
+* Lists:: Lists
+* Paragraphs:: Paragraphs
+* Footnote markup:: Footnotes
+* Emphasis and monospace:: Bold, italic, etc.
+* Horizontal rules:: Make a line
+* Comment lines:: What will *not* be exported
+@end menu
+
+@node Document title, Headings and sections, Structural markup elements, Structural markup elements
+@subheading Document title
+@cindex document title, markup rules
+
+@noindent
+The title of the exported document is taken from the special line
+
+@cindex #+TITLE
+@example
+#+TITLE: This is the title of the document
+@end example
+
+@noindent
+If this line does not exist, the title is derived from the first non-empty,
+non-comment line in the buffer. If no such line exists, or if you have
+turned off exporting of the text before the first headline (see below), the
+title will be the file name without extension.
+
+@cindex property, EXPORT_TITLE
+If you are exporting only a subtree by marking is as the region, the heading
+of the subtree will become the title of the document. If the subtree has a
+property @code{EXPORT_TITLE}, that will take precedence.
+
+@node Headings and sections, Table of contents, Document title, Structural markup elements
+@subheading Headings and sections
+@cindex headings and sections, markup rules
+
+@vindex org-export-headline-levels
+The outline structure of the document as described in @ref{Document
+Structure}, forms the basis for defining sections of the exported document.
+However, since the outline structure is also used for (for example) lists of
+tasks, only the first three outline levels will be used as headings. Deeper
+levels will become itemized lists. You can change the location of this
+switch globally by setting the variable @code{org-export-headline-levels}, or on a
+per-file basis with a line
+
+@cindex #+OPTIONS
+@example
+#+OPTIONS: H:4
+@end example
+
+@node Table of contents, Initial text, Headings and sections, Structural markup elements
+@subheading Table of contents
+@cindex table of contents, markup rules
+
+@vindex org-export-with-toc
+The table of contents is normally inserted directly before the first headline
+of the file. If you would like to get it to a different location, insert the
+string @code{[TABLE-OF-CONTENTS]} on a line by itself at the desired
+location. The depth of the table of contents is by default the same as the
+number of headline levels, but you can choose a smaller number, or turn off
+the table of contents entirely, by configuring the variable
+@code{org-export-with-toc}, or on a per-file basis with a line like
+
+@example
+#+OPTIONS: toc:2 (only to two levels in TOC)
+#+OPTIONS: toc:nil (no TOC at all)
+@end example
+
+@node Initial text, Lists, Table of contents, Structural markup elements
+@subheading Text before the first headline
+@cindex text before first headline, markup rules
+@cindex #+TEXT
+
+Org-mode normally exports the text before the first headline, and even uses
+the first line as the document title. The text will be fully marked up. If
+you need to include literal HTML, @LaTeX{}, or DocBook code, use the special
+constructs described below in the sections for the individual exporters.
+
+@vindex org-export-skip-text-before-1st-heading
+Some people like to use the space before the first headline for setup and
+internal links and therefore would like to control the exported text before
+the first headline in a different way. You can do so by setting the variable
+@code{org-export-skip-text-before-1st-heading} to @code{t}. On a per-file
+basis, you can get the same effect with @samp{#+OPTIONS: skip:t}.
+
+@noindent
+If you still want to have some text before the first headline, use the
+@code{#+TEXT} construct:
+
+@example
+#+OPTIONS: skip:t
+#+TEXT: This text will go before the *first* headline.
+#+TEXT: [TABLE-OF-CONTENTS]
+#+TEXT: This goes between the table of contents and the first headline
+@end example
+
+@node Lists, Paragraphs, Initial text, Structural markup elements
+@subheading Lists
+@cindex lists, markup rules
+
+Plain lists as described in @ref{Plain lists}, are translated to the backend's
+syntax for such lists. Most backends support unordered, ordered, and
+description lists.
+
+@node Paragraphs, Footnote markup, Lists, Structural markup elements
+@subheading Paragraphs, line breaks, and quoting
+@cindex paragraphs, markup rules
+
+Paragraphs are separated by at least one empty line. If you need to enforce
+a line break within a paragraph, use @samp{\\} at the end of a line.
+
+To keep the line breaks in a region, but otherwise use normal formatting, you
+can use this construct, which can also be used to format poetry.
+
+@cindex #+BEGIN_VERSE
+@example
+#+BEGIN_VERSE
+ Great clouds overhead
+ Tiny black birds rise and fall
+ Snow covers Emacs
+
+ -- AlexSchroeder
+#+END_VERSE
+@end example
+
+When quoting a passage from another document, it is customary to format this
+as a paragraph that is indented on both the left and the right margin. You
+can include quotations in Org-mode documents like this:
+
+@cindex #+BEGIN_QUOTE
+@example
+#+BEGIN_QUOTE
+Everything should be made as simple as possible,
+but not any simpler -- Albert Einstein
+#+END_QUOTE
+@end example
+
+If you would like to center some text, do it like this:
+@cindex #+BEGIN_CENTER
+@example
+#+BEGIN_CENTER
+Everything should be made as simple as possible, \\
+but not any simpler
+#+END_CENTER
+@end example
+
+
+@node Footnote markup, Emphasis and monospace, Paragraphs, Structural markup elements
+@subheading Footnote markup
+@cindex footnotes, markup rules
+@cindex @file{footnote.el}
+
+Footnotes defined in the way described in @ref{Footnotes}, will be exported by
+all backends. Org allows multiple references to the same note, and
+different backends support this to varying degrees.
+
+@node Emphasis and monospace, Horizontal rules, Footnote markup, Structural markup elements
+@subheading Emphasis and monospace
+
+@cindex underlined text, markup rules
+@cindex bold text, markup rules
+@cindex italic text, markup rules
+@cindex verbatim text, markup rules
+@cindex code text, markup rules
+@cindex strike-through text, markup rules
+You can make words @b{*bold*}, @i{/italic/}, _underlined_, @code{=code=}
+and @code{~verbatim~}, and, if you must, @samp{+strike-through+}. Text
+in the code and verbatim string is not processed for Org-mode specific
+syntax; it is exported verbatim.
+
+@node Horizontal rules, Comment lines, Emphasis and monospace, Structural markup elements
+@subheading Horizontal rules
+@cindex horizontal rules, markup rules
+A line consisting of only dashes, and at least 5 of them, will be
+exported as a horizontal line (@samp{<hr/>} in HTML).
+
+@node Comment lines, , Horizontal rules, Structural markup elements
+@subheading Comment lines
+@cindex comment lines
+@cindex exporting, not
+@cindex #+BEGIN_COMMENT
+
+Lines starting with @samp{#} in column zero are treated as comments and will
+never be exported. If you want an indented line to be treated as a comment,
+start it with @samp{#+ }. Also entire subtrees starting with the word
+@samp{COMMENT} will never be exported. Finally, regions surrounded by
+@samp{#+BEGIN_COMMENT} ... @samp{#+END_COMMENT} will not be exported.
+
+@table @kbd
+@kindex C-c ;
+@item C-c ;
+Toggle the COMMENT keyword at the beginning of an entry.
+@end table
+
+
+@node Images and tables, Literal examples, Structural markup elements, Markup
+@section Images and Tables
+
+@cindex tables, markup rules
+@cindex #+CAPTION
+@cindex #+LABEL
+Both the native Org-mode tables (@pxref{Tables}) and tables formatted with
+the @file{table.el} package will be exported properly. For Org-mode tables,
+the lines before the first horizontal separator line will become table header
+lines. You can use the following lines somewhere before the table to assign
+a caption and a label for cross references, and in the text you can refer to
+the object with @code{\ref@{tab:basic-data@}}:
+
+@example
+#+CAPTION: This is the caption for the next table (or link)
+#+LABEL: tbl:basic-data
+ | ... | ...|
+ |-----|----|
+@end example
+
+@cindex inlined images, markup rules
+Some backends (HTML, @LaTeX{}, and DocBook) allow you to directly include
+images into the exported document. Org does this, if a link to an image
+files does not have a description part, for example @code{[[./img/a.jpg]]}.
+If you wish to define a caption for the image and maybe a label for internal
+cross references, make sure that the link is on a line by itself and precede
+it with @code{#+CAPTION} and @code{#+LABEL} as follows:
+
+@example
+#+CAPTION: This is the caption for the next figure link (or table)
+#+LABEL: fig:SED-HR4049
+[[./img/a.jpg]]
+@end example
+
+You may also define additional attributes for the figure. As this is
+backend-specific, see the sections about the individual backends for more
+information.
+
+@xref{Handling links,the discussion of image links}.
+
+@node Literal examples, Include files, Images and tables, Markup
+@section Literal examples
+@cindex literal examples, markup rules
+@cindex code line references, markup rules
+
+You can include literal examples that should not be subjected to
+markup. Such examples will be typeset in monospace, so this is well suited
+for source code and similar examples.
+@cindex #+BEGIN_EXAMPLE
+
+@example
+#+BEGIN_EXAMPLE
+Some example from a text file.
+#+END_EXAMPLE
+@end example
+
+Note that such blocks may be @i{indented} in order to align nicely with
+indented text and in particular with plain list structure (@pxref{Plain
+lists}). For simplicity when using small examples, you can also start the
+example lines with a colon followed by a space. There may also be additional
+whitespace before the colon:
+
+@example
+Here is an example
+ : Some example from a text file.
+@end example
+
+@cindex formatting source code, markup rules
+If the example is source code from a programming language, or any other text
+that can be marked up by font-lock in Emacs, you can ask for the example to
+look like the fontified Emacs buffer@footnote{This works automatically for
+the HTML backend (it requires version 1.34 of the @file{htmlize.el} package,
+which is distributed with Org). Fontified code chunks in LaTeX can be
+achieved using either the listings or the
+@url{http://code.google.com/p/minted, minted,} package. To use listings, turn
+on the variable @code{org-export-latex-listings} and ensure that the listings
+package is included by the LaTeX header (e.g. by configuring
+@code{org-export-latex-packages-alist}). See the listings documentation for
+configuration options, including obtaining colored output. For minted it is
+necessary to install the program @url{http://pygments.org, pygments}, in
+addition to setting @code{org-export-latex-minted}, ensuring that the minted
+package is included by the LaTeX header, and ensuring that the
+@code{-shell-escape} option is passed to @file{pdflatex} (see
+@code{org-latex-to-pdf-process}). See the documentation of the variables
+@code{org-export-latex-listings} and @code{org-export-latex-minted} for
+further details.}. This is done with the @samp{src} block, where you also
+need to specify the name of the major mode that should be used to fontify the
+example:
+@cindex #+BEGIN_SRC
+
+@example
+#+BEGIN_SRC emacs-lisp
+ (defun org-xor (a b)
+ "Exclusive or."
+ (if a (not b) b))
+#+END_SRC
+@end example
+
+Both in @code{example} and in @code{src} snippets, you can add a @code{-n}
+switch to the end of the @code{BEGIN} line, to get the lines of the example
+numbered. If you use a @code{+n} switch, the numbering from the previous
+numbered snippet will be continued in the current one. In literal examples,
+Org will interpret strings like @samp{(ref:name)} as labels, and use them as
+targets for special hyperlinks like @code{[[(name)]]} (i.e. the reference name
+enclosed in single parenthesis). In HTML, hovering the mouse over such a
+link will remote-highlight the corresponding code line, which is kind of
+cool.
+
+You can also add a @code{-r} switch which @i{removes} the labels from the
+source code@footnote{Adding @code{-k} to @code{-n -r} will @i{keep} the
+labels in the source code while using line numbers for the links, which might
+be useful to explain those in an org-mode example code.}. With the @code{-n}
+switch, links to these references will be labeled by the line numbers from
+the code listing, otherwise links will use the labels with no parentheses.
+Here is an example:
+
+@example
+#+BEGIN_SRC emacs-lisp -n -r
+(save-excursion (ref:sc)
+ (goto-char (point-min)) (ref:jump)
+#+END_SRC
+In line [[(sc)]] we remember the current position. [[(jump)][Line (jump)]]
+jumps to point-min.
+@end example
+
+@vindex org-coderef-label-format
+If the syntax for the label format conflicts with the language syntax, use a
+@code{-l} switch to change the format, for example @samp{#+BEGIN_SRC pascal
+-n -r -l "((%s))"}. See also the variable @code{org-coderef-label-format}.
+
+HTML export also allows examples to be published as text areas, @xref{Text
+areas in HTML export}.
+
+@table @kbd
+@kindex C-c '
+@item C-c '
+Edit the source code example at point in its native mode. This works by
+switching to a temporary buffer with the source code. You need to exit by
+pressing @kbd{C-c '} again@footnote{Upon exit, lines starting with @samp{*}
+or @samp{#} will get a comma prepended, to keep them from being interpreted
+by Org as outline nodes or special comments. These commas will be stripped
+for editing with @kbd{C-c '}, and also for export.}. The edited version will
+then replace the old version in the Org buffer. Fixed-width regions
+(where each line starts with a colon followed by a space) will be edited
+using @code{artist-mode}@footnote{You may select a different-mode with the
+variable @code{org-edit-fixed-width-region-mode}.} to allow creating ASCII
+drawings easily. Using this command in an empty line will create a new
+fixed-width region.
+@kindex C-c l
+@item C-c l
+Calling @code{org-store-link} while editing a source code example in a
+temporary buffer created with @kbd{C-c '} will prompt for a label. Make sure
+that it is unique in the current buffer, and insert it with the proper
+formatting like @samp{(ref:label)} at the end of the current line. Then the
+label is stored as a link @samp{(label)}, for retrieval with @kbd{C-c C-l}.
+@end table
+
+
+@node Include files, Index entries, Literal examples, Markup
+@section Include files
+@cindex include files, markup rules
+
+During export, you can include the content of another file. For example, to
+include your @file{.emacs} file, you could use:
+@cindex #+INCLUDE
+
+@example
+#+INCLUDE: "~/.emacs" src emacs-lisp
+@end example
+@noindent
+The optional second and third parameter are the markup (e.g. @samp{quote},
+@samp{example}, or @samp{src}), and, if the markup is @samp{src}, the
+language for formatting the contents. The markup is optional; if it is not
+given, the text will be assumed to be in Org-mode format and will be
+processed normally. The include line will also allow additional keyword
+parameters @code{:prefix1} and @code{:prefix} to specify prefixes for the
+first line and for each following line, @code{:minlevel} in order to get
+org-mode content demoted to a specified level, as well as any options
+accepted by the selected markup. For example, to include a file as an item,
+use
+
+@example
+#+INCLUDE: "~/snippets/xx" :prefix1 " + " :prefix " "
+@end example
+
+@table @kbd
+@kindex C-c '
+@item C-c '
+Visit the include file at point.
+@end table
+
+@node Index entries, Macro replacement, Include files, Markup
+@section Index entries
+@cindex index entries, for publishing
+
+You can specify entries that will be used for generating an index during
+publishing. This is done by lines starting with @code{#+INDEX}. An entry
+the contains an exclamation mark will create a sub item. See @ref{Generating
+an index} for more information.
+
+@example
+* Curriculum Vitae
+#+INDEX: CV
+#+INDEX: Application!CV
+@end example
+
+
+
+
+@node Macro replacement, Embedded LaTeX, Index entries, Markup
+@section Macro replacement
+@cindex macro replacement, during export
+@cindex #+MACRO
+
+You can define text snippets with
+
+@example
+#+MACRO: name replacement text $1, $2 are arguments
+@end example
+
+@noindent which can be referenced anywhere in the document (even in
+code examples) with @code{@{@{@{name(arg1,arg2)@}@}@}}. In addition to
+defined macros, @code{@{@{@{title@}@}@}}, @code{@{@{@{author@}@}@}}, etc.,
+will reference information set by the @code{#+TITLE:}, @code{#+AUTHOR:}, and
+similar lines. Also, @code{@{@{@{date(@var{FORMAT})@}@}@}} and
+@code{@{@{@{modification-time(@var{FORMAT})@}@}@}} refer to current date time
+and to the modification time of the file being exported, respectively.
+@var{FORMAT} should be a format string understood by
+@code{format-time-string}.
+
+Macro expansion takes place during export, and some people use it to
+construct complex HTML code.
+
+
+@node Embedded LaTeX, , Macro replacement, Markup
+@section Embedded @LaTeX{}
+@cindex @TeX{} interpretation
+@cindex @LaTeX{} interpretation
+
+Plain ASCII is normally sufficient for almost all note taking. Exceptions
+include scientific notes, which often require mathematical symbols and the
+occasional formula. @LaTeX{}@footnote{@LaTeX{} is a macro system based on
+Donald E. Knuth's @TeX{} system. Many of the features described here as
+``@LaTeX{}'' are really from @TeX{}, but for simplicity I am blurring this
+distinction.} is widely used to typeset scientific documents. Org-mode
+supports embedding @LaTeX{} code into its files, because many academics are
+used to writing and reading @LaTeX{} source code, and because it can be
+readily processed to produce pretty output for a number of export backends.
+
+@menu
+* Special symbols:: Greek letters and other symbols
+* Subscripts and superscripts:: Simple syntax for raising/lowering text
+* LaTeX fragments:: Complex formulas made easy
+* Previewing LaTeX fragments:: What will this snippet look like?
+* CDLaTeX mode:: Speed up entering of formulas
+@end menu
+
+@node Special symbols, Subscripts and superscripts, Embedded LaTeX, Embedded LaTeX
+@subsection Special symbols
+@cindex math symbols
+@cindex special symbols
+@cindex @TeX{} macros
+@cindex @LaTeX{} fragments, markup rules
+@cindex HTML entities
+@cindex @LaTeX{} entities
+
+You can use @LaTeX{} macros to insert special symbols like @samp{\alpha} to
+indicate the Greek letter, or @samp{\to} to indicate an arrow. Completion
+for these macros is available, just type @samp{\} and maybe a few letters,
+and press @kbd{M-@key{TAB}} to see possible completions. Unlike @LaTeX{}
+code, Org-mode allows these macros to be present without surrounding math
+delimiters, for example:
+
+@example
+Angles are written as Greek letters \alpha, \beta and \gamma.
+@end example
+
+@vindex org-entities
+During export, these symbols will be transformed into the native format of
+the exporter backend. Strings like @code{\alpha} will be exported as
+@code{&alpha;} in the HTML output, and as @code{$\alpha$} in the @LaTeX{}
+output. Similarly, @code{\nbsp} will become @code{&nbsp;} in HTML and
+@code{~} in @LaTeX{}. If you need such a symbol inside a word, terminate it
+like this: @samp{\Aacute@{@}stor}.
+
+A large number of entities is provided, with names taken from both HTML and
+@LaTeX{}; see the variable @code{org-entities} for the complete list.
+@samp{\-} is treated as a shy hyphen, and @samp{--}, @samp{---}, and
+@samp{...} are all converted into special commands creating hyphens of
+different lengths or a compact set of dots.
+
+If you would like to see entities displayed as UTF8 characters, use the
+following command@footnote{You can turn this on by default by setting the
+variable @code{org-pretty-entities}, or on a per-file base with the
+@code{#+STARTUP} option @code{entitiespretty}.}:
+
+@table @kbd
+@kindex C-c C-x \
+@item C-c C-x \
+Toggle display of entities as UTF-8 characters. This does not change the
+buffer content which remains plain ASCII, but it overlays the UTF-8 character
+for display purposes only.
+@end table
+
+@node Subscripts and superscripts, LaTeX fragments, Special symbols, Embedded LaTeX
+@subsection Subscripts and superscripts
+@cindex subscript
+@cindex superscript
+
+Just like in @LaTeX{}, @samp{^} and @samp{_} are used to indicate super-
+and subscripts. Again, these can be used without embedding them in
+math-mode delimiters. To increase the readability of ASCII text, it is
+not necessary (but OK) to surround multi-character sub- and superscripts
+with curly braces. For example
+
+@example
+The mass of the sun is M_sun = 1.989 x 10^30 kg. The radius of
+the sun is R_@{sun@} = 6.96 x 10^8 m.
+@end example
+
+@vindex org-export-with-sub-superscripts
+To avoid interpretation as raised or lowered text, you can quote @samp{^} and
+@samp{_} with a backslash: @samp{\^} and @samp{\_}. If you write a text
+where the underscore is often used in a different context, Org's convention
+to always interpret these as subscripts can get in your way. Configure the
+variable @code{org-export-with-sub-superscripts} to globally change this
+convention, or use, on a per-file basis:
+
+@example
+#+OPTIONS: ^:@{@}
+@end example
+
+@noindent With this setting, @samp{a_b} will not be interpreted as a
+subscript, but @samp{a_@{b@}} will.
+
+@table @kbd
+@kindex C-c C-x \
+@item C-c C-x \
+In addition to showing entities as UTF-8 characters, this command will also
+format sub- and superscripts in a WYSIWYM way.
+@end table
+
+@node LaTeX fragments, Previewing LaTeX fragments, Subscripts and superscripts, Embedded LaTeX
+@subsection @LaTeX{} fragments
+@cindex @LaTeX{} fragments
+
+@vindex org-format-latex-header
+Going beyond symbols and sub- and superscripts, a full formula language is
+needed. Org-mode can contain @LaTeX{} math fragments, and it supports ways
+to process these for several export backends. When exporting to @LaTeX{},
+the code is obviously left as it is. When exporting to HTML, Org invokes the
+@uref{http://www.mathjax.org, MathJax library} (@pxref{Math formatting in
+HTML export}) to process and display the math@footnote{If you plan to use
+this regularly or on pages with significant page views, you should install
+@file{MathJax} on your own
+server in order to limit the load of our server.}. Finally, it can also
+process the mathematical expressions into images@footnote{For this to work
+you need to be on a system with a working @LaTeX{} installation. You also
+need the @file{dvipng} program, available at
+@url{http://sourceforge.net/projects/dvipng/}. The @LaTeX{} header that will
+be used when processing a fragment can be configured with the variable
+@code{org-format-latex-header}.} that can be displayed in a browser or in
+DocBook documents.
+
+@LaTeX{} fragments don't need any special marking at all. The following
+snippets will be identified as @LaTeX{} source code:
+@itemize @bullet
+@item
+Environments of any kind@footnote{When @file{MathJax} is used, only the
+environment recognized by @file{MathJax} will be processed. When
+@file{dvipng} is used to create images, any @LaTeX{} environments will be
+handled.}. The only requirement is that the @code{\begin} statement appears
+on a new line, preceded by only whitespace.
+@item
+Text within the usual @LaTeX{} math delimiters. To avoid conflicts with
+currency specifications, single @samp{$} characters are only recognized as
+math delimiters if the enclosed text contains at most two line breaks, is
+directly attached to the @samp{$} characters with no whitespace in between,
+and if the closing @samp{$} is followed by whitespace, punctuation or a dash.
+For the other delimiters, there is no such restriction, so when in doubt, use
+@samp{\(...\)} as inline math delimiters.
+@end itemize
+
+@noindent For example:
+
+@example
+\begin@{equation@} % arbitrary environments,
+x=\sqrt@{b@} % even tables, figures
+\end@{equation@} % etc
+
+If $a^2=b$ and \( b=2 \), then the solution must be
+either $$ a=+\sqrt@{2@} $$ or \[ a=-\sqrt@{2@} \].
+@end example
+
+@noindent
+@vindex org-format-latex-options
+If you need any of the delimiter ASCII sequences for other purposes, you
+can configure the option @code{org-format-latex-options} to deselect the
+ones you do not wish to have interpreted by the @LaTeX{} converter.
+
+@vindex org-export-with-LaTeX-fragments
+LaTeX processing can be configured with the variable
+@code{org-export-with-LaTeX-fragments}. The default setting is @code{t}
+which means @file{MathJax} for HTML, and no processing for DocBook, ASCII and
+LaTeX backends. You can also set this variable on a per-file basis using one
+of these lines:
+
+@example
+#+OPTIONS: LaTeX:t @r{Do the right thing automatically (MathJax)}
+#+OPTIONS: LaTeX:dvipng @r{Force using dvipng images}
+#+OPTIONS: LaTeX:nil @r{Do not process @LaTeX{} fragments at all}
+#+OPTIONS: LaTeX:verbatim @r{Verbatim export, for jsMath or so}
+@end example
+
+@node Previewing LaTeX fragments, CDLaTeX mode, LaTeX fragments, Embedded LaTeX
+@subsection Previewing LaTeX fragments
+@cindex LaTeX fragments, preview
+
+If you have @file{dvipng} installed, @LaTeX{} fragments can be processed to
+produce preview images of the typeset expressions:
+
+@table @kbd
+@kindex C-c C-x C-l
+@item C-c C-x C-l
+Produce a preview image of the @LaTeX{} fragment at point and overlay it
+over the source code. If there is no fragment at point, process all
+fragments in the current entry (between two headlines). When called
+with a prefix argument, process the entire subtree. When called with
+two prefix arguments, or when the cursor is before the first headline,
+process the entire buffer.
+@kindex C-c C-c
+@item C-c C-c
+Remove the overlay preview images.
+@end table
+
+@vindex org-format-latex-options
+You can customize the variable @code{org-format-latex-options} to influence
+some aspects of the preview. In particular, the @code{:scale} (and for HTML
+export, @code{:html-scale}) property can be used to adjust the size of the
+preview images.
+
+@node CDLaTeX mode, , Previewing LaTeX fragments, Embedded LaTeX
+@subsection Using CDLa@TeX{} to enter math
+@cindex CDLa@TeX{}
+
+CDLa@TeX{} mode is a minor mode that is normally used in combination with a
+major @LaTeX{} mode like AUC@TeX{} in order to speed-up insertion of
+environments and math templates. Inside Org-mode, you can make use of
+some of the features of CDLa@TeX{} mode. You need to install
+@file{cdlatex.el} and @file{texmathp.el} (the latter comes also with
+AUC@TeX{}) from @url{http://www.astro.uva.nl/~dominik/Tools/cdlatex}.
+Don't use CDLa@TeX{} mode itself under Org-mode, but use the light
+version @code{org-cdlatex-mode} that comes as part of Org-mode. Turn it
+on for the current buffer with @code{M-x org-cdlatex-mode}, or for all
+Org files with
+
+@lisp
+(add-hook 'org-mode-hook 'turn-on-org-cdlatex)
+@end lisp
+
+When this mode is enabled, the following features are present (for more
+details see the documentation of CDLa@TeX{} mode):
+@itemize @bullet
+@kindex C-c @{
+@item
+Environment templates can be inserted with @kbd{C-c @{}.
+@item
+@kindex @key{TAB}
+The @key{TAB} key will do template expansion if the cursor is inside a
+@LaTeX{} fragment@footnote{Org-mode has a method to test if the cursor is
+inside such a fragment, see the documentation of the function
+@code{org-inside-LaTeX-fragment-p}.}. For example, @key{TAB} will
+expand @code{fr} to @code{\frac@{@}@{@}} and position the cursor
+correctly inside the first brace. Another @key{TAB} will get you into
+the second brace. Even outside fragments, @key{TAB} will expand
+environment abbreviations at the beginning of a line. For example, if
+you write @samp{equ} at the beginning of a line and press @key{TAB},
+this abbreviation will be expanded to an @code{equation} environment.
+To get a list of all abbreviations, type @kbd{M-x cdlatex-command-help}.
+@item
+@kindex _
+@kindex ^
+@vindex cdlatex-simplify-sub-super-scripts
+Pressing @kbd{_} and @kbd{^} inside a @LaTeX{} fragment will insert these
+characters together with a pair of braces. If you use @key{TAB} to move
+out of the braces, and if the braces surround only a single character or
+macro, they are removed again (depending on the variable
+@code{cdlatex-simplify-sub-super-scripts}).
+@item
+@kindex `
+Pressing the backquote @kbd{`} followed by a character inserts math
+macros, also outside @LaTeX{} fragments. If you wait more than 1.5 seconds
+after the backquote, a help window will pop up.
+@item
+@kindex '
+Pressing the single-quote @kbd{'} followed by another character modifies
+the symbol before point with an accent or a font. If you wait more than
+1.5 seconds after the single-quote, a help window will pop up. Character
+modification will work only inside @LaTeX{} fragments; outside the quote
+is normal.
+@end itemize
+
+@node Exporting, Publishing, Markup, Top
+@chapter Exporting
+@cindex exporting
+
+Org-mode documents can be exported into a variety of other formats. For
+printing and sharing of notes, ASCII export produces a readable and simple
+version of an Org file. HTML export allows you to publish a notes file on
+the web, while the XOXO format provides a solid base for exchange with a
+broad range of other applications. @LaTeX{} export lets you use Org-mode and
+its structured editing functions to easily create @LaTeX{} files. DocBook
+export makes it possible to convert Org files to many other formats using
+DocBook tools. For project management you can create gantt and resource
+charts by using TaskJuggler export. To incorporate entries with associated
+times like deadlines or appointments into a desktop calendar program like
+iCal, Org-mode can also produce extracts in the iCalendar format. Currently
+Org-mode only supports export, not import of these different formats.
+
+Org supports export of selected regions when @code{transient-mark-mode} is
+enabled (default in Emacs 23).
+
+@menu
+* Selective export:: Using tags to select and exclude trees
+* Export options:: Per-file export settings
+* The export dispatcher:: How to access exporter commands
+* ASCII/Latin-1/UTF-8 export:: Exporting to flat files with encoding
+* HTML export:: Exporting to HTML
+* LaTeX and PDF export:: Exporting to @LaTeX{}, and processing to PDF
+* DocBook export:: Exporting to DocBook
+* TaskJuggler export:: Exporting to TaskJuggler
+* Freemind export:: Exporting to Freemind mind maps
+* XOXO export:: Exporting to XOXO
+* iCalendar export:: Exporting in iCalendar format
+@end menu
+
+@node Selective export, Export options, Exporting, Exporting
+@section Selective export
+@cindex export, selective by tags
+
+@vindex org-export-select-tags
+@vindex org-export-exclude-tags
+You may use tags to select the parts of a document that should be exported,
+or to exclude parts from export. This behavior is governed by two variables:
+@code{org-export-select-tags} and @code{org-export-exclude-tags}.
+
+Org first checks if any of the @emph{select} tags is present in the buffer.
+If yes, all trees that do not carry one of these tags will be excluded. If a
+selected tree is a subtree, the heading hierarchy above it will also be
+selected for export, but not the text below those headings.
+
+@noindent
+If none of the select tags is found, the whole buffer will be selected for
+export.
+
+@noindent
+Finally, all subtrees that are marked by any of the @emph{exclude} tags will
+be removed from the export buffer.
+
+@node Export options, The export dispatcher, Selective export, Exporting
+@section Export options
+@cindex options, for export
+
+@cindex completion, of option keywords
+The exporter recognizes special lines in the buffer which provide
+additional information. These lines may be put anywhere in the file.
+The whole set of lines can be inserted into the buffer with @kbd{C-c
+C-e t}. For individual lines, a good way to make sure the keyword is
+correct is to type @samp{#+} and then use @kbd{M-@key{TAB}} completion
+(@pxref{Completion}). For a summary of other in-buffer settings not
+specifically related to export, see @ref{In-buffer settings}.
+In particular, note that you can place commonly-used (export) options in
+a separate file which can be included using @code{#+SETUPFILE}.
+
+@table @kbd
+@orgcmd{C-c C-e t,org-insert-export-options-template}
+Insert template with export options, see example below.
+@end table
+
+@cindex #+TITLE
+@cindex #+AUTHOR
+@cindex #+DATE
+@cindex #+EMAIL
+@cindex #+DESCRIPTION
+@cindex #+KEYWORDS
+@cindex #+LANGUAGE
+@cindex #+TEXT
+@cindex #+OPTIONS
+@cindex #+BIND
+@cindex #+LINK_UP
+@cindex #+LINK_HOME
+@cindex #+EXPORT_SELECT_TAGS
+@cindex #+EXPORT_EXCLUDE_TAGS
+@cindex #+XSLT
+@cindex #+LATEX_HEADER
+@vindex user-full-name
+@vindex user-mail-address
+@vindex org-export-default-language
+@example
+#+TITLE: the title to be shown (default is the buffer name)
+#+AUTHOR: the author (default taken from @code{user-full-name})
+#+DATE: a date, fixed, or a format string for @code{format-time-string}
+#+EMAIL: his/her email address (default from @code{user-mail-address})
+#+DESCRIPTION: the page description, e.g. for the XHTML meta tag
+#+KEYWORDS: the page keywords, e.g. for the XHTML meta tag
+#+LANGUAGE: language for HTML, e.g. @samp{en} (@code{org-export-default-language})
+#+TEXT: Some descriptive text to be inserted at the beginning.
+#+TEXT: Several lines may be given.
+#+OPTIONS: H:2 num:t toc:t \n:nil @@:t ::t |:t ^:t f:t TeX:t ...
+#+BIND: lisp-var lisp-val, e.g.: org-export-latex-low-levels itemize
+ @r{You need to confirm using these, or configure @code{org-export-allow-BIND}}
+#+LINK_UP: the ``up'' link of an exported page
+#+LINK_HOME: the ``home'' link of an exported page
+#+LATEX_HEADER: extra line(s) for the LaTeX header, like \usepackage@{xyz@}
+#+EXPORT_SELECT_TAGS: Tags that select a tree for export
+#+EXPORT_EXCLUDE_TAGS: Tags that exclude a tree from export
+#+XSLT: the XSLT stylesheet used by DocBook exporter to generate FO file
+@end example
+
+@noindent
+The OPTIONS line is a compact@footnote{If you want to configure many options
+this way, you can use several OPTIONS lines.} form to specify export
+settings. Here you can:
+@cindex headline levels
+@cindex section-numbers
+@cindex table of contents
+@cindex line-break preservation
+@cindex quoted HTML tags
+@cindex fixed-width sections
+@cindex tables
+@cindex @TeX{}-like syntax for sub- and superscripts
+@cindex footnotes
+@cindex special strings
+@cindex emphasized text
+@cindex @TeX{} macros
+@cindex @LaTeX{} fragments
+@cindex author info, in export
+@cindex time info, in export
+@example
+H: @r{set the number of headline levels for export}
+num: @r{turn on/off section-numbers}
+toc: @r{turn on/off table of contents, or set level limit (integer)}
+\n: @r{turn on/off line-break-preservation (DOES NOT WORK)}
+@@: @r{turn on/off quoted HTML tags}
+:: @r{turn on/off fixed-width sections}
+|: @r{turn on/off tables}
+^: @r{turn on/off @TeX{}-like syntax for sub- and superscripts. If}
+ @r{you write "^:@{@}", @code{a_@{b@}} will be interpreted, but}
+ @r{the simple @code{a_b} will be left as it is.}
+-: @r{turn on/off conversion of special strings.}
+f: @r{turn on/off footnotes like this[1].}
+todo: @r{turn on/off inclusion of TODO keywords into exported text}
+pri: @r{turn on/off priority cookies}
+tags: @r{turn on/off inclusion of tags, may also be @code{not-in-toc}}
+<: @r{turn on/off inclusion of any time/date stamps like DEADLINES}
+*: @r{turn on/off emphasized text (bold, italic, underlined)}
+TeX: @r{turn on/off simple @TeX{} macros in plain text}
+LaTeX: @r{configure export of @LaTeX{} fragments. Default @code{auto}}
+skip: @r{turn on/off skipping the text before the first heading}
+author: @r{turn on/off inclusion of author name/email into exported file}
+email: @r{turn on/off inclusion of author email into exported file}
+creator: @r{turn on/off inclusion of creator info into exported file}
+timestamp: @r{turn on/off inclusion creation time into exported file}
+d: @r{turn on/off inclusion of drawers}
+@end example
+@noindent
+These options take effect in both the HTML and @LaTeX{} export, except for
+@code{TeX} and @code{LaTeX}, which are respectively @code{t} and @code{nil}
+for the @LaTeX{} export. The default values for these and many other options
+are given by a set of variables. For a list of such variables, the
+corresponding OPTIONS keys and also the publishing keys (@pxref{Project
+alist}), see the constant @code{org-export-plist-vars}.
+
+When exporting only a single subtree by selecting it with @kbd{C-c @@} before
+calling an export command, the subtree can overrule some of the file's export
+settings with properties @code{EXPORT_FILE_NAME}, @code{EXPORT_TITLE},
+@code{EXPORT_TEXT}, @code{EXPORT_AUTHOR}, @code{EXPORT_DATE}, and
+@code{EXPORT_OPTIONS}.
+
+@node The export dispatcher, ASCII/Latin-1/UTF-8 export, Export options, Exporting
+@section The export dispatcher
+@cindex dispatcher, for export commands
+
+All export commands can be reached using the export dispatcher, which is a
+prefix key that prompts for an additional key specifying the command.
+Normally the entire file is exported, but if there is an active region that
+contains one outline tree, the first heading is used as document title and
+the subtrees are exported.
+
+@table @kbd
+@orgcmd{C-c C-e,org-export}
+@vindex org-export-run-in-background
+Dispatcher for export and publishing commands. Displays a help-window
+listing the additional key(s) needed to launch an export or publishing
+command. The prefix arg is passed through to the exporter. A double prefix
+@kbd{C-u C-u} causes most commands to be executed in the background, in a
+separate Emacs process@footnote{To make this behavior the default, customize
+the variable @code{org-export-run-in-background}.}.
+@orgcmd{C-c C-e v,org-export-visible}
+Like @kbd{C-c C-e}, but only export the text that is currently visible
+(i.e. not hidden by outline visibility).
+@orgcmd{C-u C-u C-c C-e,org-export}
+@vindex org-export-run-in-background
+Call the exporter, but reverse the setting of
+@code{org-export-run-in-background}, i.e. request background processing if
+not set, or force processing in the current Emacs process if set.
+@end table
+
+@node ASCII/Latin-1/UTF-8 export, HTML export, The export dispatcher, Exporting
+@section ASCII/Latin-1/UTF-8 export
+@cindex ASCII export
+@cindex Latin-1 export
+@cindex UTF-8 export
+
+ASCII export produces a simple and very readable version of an Org-mode
+file, containing only plain ASCII. Latin-1 and UTF-8 export augment the file
+with special characters and symbols available in these encodings.
+
+@cindex region, active
+@cindex active region
+@cindex transient-mark-mode
+@table @kbd
+@orgcmd{C-c C-e a,org-export-as-ascii}
+@cindex property, EXPORT_FILE_NAME
+Export as ASCII file. For an Org file, @file{myfile.org}, the ASCII file
+will be @file{myfile.txt}. The file will be overwritten without
+warning. If there is an active region@footnote{This requires
+@code{transient-mark-mode} be turned on.}, only the region will be
+exported. If the selected region is a single tree@footnote{To select the
+current subtree, use @kbd{C-c @@}.}, the tree head will
+become the document title. If the tree head entry has or inherits an
+@code{EXPORT_FILE_NAME} property, that name will be used for the
+export.
+@orgcmd{C-c C-e A,org-export-as-ascii-to-buffer}
+Export to a temporary buffer. Do not create a file.
+@orgcmd{C-c C-e n,org-export-as-latin1}
+@xorgcmd{C-c C-e N,org-export-as-latin1-to-buffer}
+Like the above commands, but use Latin-1 encoding.
+@orgcmd{C-c C-e u,org-export-as-utf8}
+@xorgcmd{C-c C-e U,org-export-as-utf8-to-buffer}
+Like the above commands, but use UTF-8 encoding.
+@item C-c C-e v a/n/u
+Export only the visible part of the document.
+@end table
+
+@cindex headline levels, for exporting
+In the exported version, the first 3 outline levels will become
+headlines, defining a general document structure. Additional levels
+will be exported as itemized lists. If you want that transition to occur
+at a different level, specify it with a prefix argument. For example,
+
+@example
+@kbd{C-1 C-c C-e a}
+@end example
+
+@noindent
+creates only top level headlines and does the rest as items. When
+headlines are converted to items, the indentation of the text following
+the headline is changed to fit nicely under the item. This is done with
+the assumption that the first body line indicates the base indentation of
+the body text. Any indentation larger than this is adjusted to preserve
+the layout relative to the first line. Should there be lines with less
+indentation than the first, these are left alone.
+
+@vindex org-export-ascii-links-to-notes
+Links will be exported in a footnote-like style, with the descriptive part in
+the text and the link in a note before the next heading. See the variable
+@code{org-export-ascii-links-to-notes} for details and other options.
+
+@node HTML export, LaTeX and PDF export, ASCII/Latin-1/UTF-8 export, Exporting
+@section HTML export
+@cindex HTML export
+
+Org-mode contains an HTML (XHTML 1.0 strict) exporter with extensive
+HTML formatting, in ways similar to John Gruber's @emph{markdown}
+language, but with additional support for tables.
+
+@menu
+* HTML Export commands:: How to invoke HTML export
+* Quoting HTML tags:: Using direct HTML in Org-mode
+* Links in HTML export:: How links will be interpreted and formatted
+* Tables in HTML export:: How to modify the formatting of tables
+* Images in HTML export:: How to insert figures into HTML output
+* Math formatting in HTML export:: Beautiful math also on the web
+* Text areas in HTML export:: An alternative way to show an example
+* CSS support:: Changing the appearance of the output
+* JavaScript support:: Info and Folding in a web browser
+@end menu
+
+@node HTML Export commands, Quoting HTML tags, HTML export, HTML export
+@subsection HTML export commands
+
+@cindex region, active
+@cindex active region
+@cindex transient-mark-mode
+@table @kbd
+@orgcmd{C-c C-e h,org-export-as-html}
+@cindex property, EXPORT_FILE_NAME
+Export as HTML file @file{myfile.html}. For an Org file @file{myfile.org},
+the ASCII file will be @file{myfile.html}. The file will be overwritten
+without warning. If there is an active region@footnote{This requires
+@code{transient-mark-mode} be turned on.}, only the region will be
+exported. If the selected region is a single tree@footnote{To select the
+current subtree, use @kbd{C-c @@}.}, the tree head will become the document
+title. If the tree head entry has, or inherits, an @code{EXPORT_FILE_NAME}
+property, that name will be used for the export.
+@orgcmd{C-c C-e b,org-export-as-html-and-open}
+Export as HTML file and immediately open it with a browser.
+@orgcmd{C-c C-e H,org-export-as-html-to-buffer}
+Export to a temporary buffer. Do not create a file.
+@orgcmd{C-c C-e R,org-export-region-as-html}
+Export the active region to a temporary buffer. With a prefix argument, do
+not produce the file header and footer, but just the plain HTML section for
+the region. This is good for cut-and-paste operations.
+@item C-c C-e v h/b/H/R
+Export only the visible part of the document.
+@item M-x org-export-region-as-html
+Convert the region to HTML under the assumption that it was Org-mode
+syntax before. This is a global command that can be invoked in any
+buffer.
+@item M-x org-replace-region-by-HTML
+Replace the active region (assumed to be in Org-mode syntax) by HTML
+code.
+@end table
+
+@cindex headline levels, for exporting
+In the exported version, the first 3 outline levels will become headlines,
+defining a general document structure. Additional levels will be exported as
+itemized lists. If you want that transition to occur at a different level,
+specify it with a numeric prefix argument. For example,
+
+@example
+@kbd{C-2 C-c C-e b}
+@end example
+
+@noindent
+creates two levels of headings and does the rest as items.
+
+@node Quoting HTML tags, Links in HTML export, HTML Export commands, HTML export
+@subsection Quoting HTML tags
+
+Plain @samp{<} and @samp{>} are always transformed to @samp{&lt;} and
+@samp{&gt;} in HTML export. If you want to include simple HTML tags
+which should be interpreted as such, mark them with @samp{@@} as in
+@samp{@@<b>bold text@@</b>}. Note that this really works only for
+simple tags. For more extensive HTML that should be copied verbatim to
+the exported file use either
+
+@cindex #+HTML
+@cindex #+BEGIN_HTML
+@example
+#+HTML: Literal HTML code for export
+@end example
+
+@noindent or
+@cindex #+BEGIN_HTML
+
+@example
+#+BEGIN_HTML
+All lines between these markers are exported literally
+#+END_HTML
+@end example
+
+
+@node Links in HTML export, Tables in HTML export, Quoting HTML tags, HTML export
+@subsection Links in HTML export
+
+@cindex links, in HTML export
+@cindex internal links, in HTML export
+@cindex external links, in HTML export
+Internal links (@pxref{Internal links}) will continue to work in HTML. This
+includes automatic links created by radio targets (@pxref{Radio
+targets}). Links to external files will still work if the target file is on
+the same @i{relative} path as the published Org file. Links to other
+@file{.org} files will be translated into HTML links under the assumption
+that an HTML version also exists of the linked file, at the same relative
+path. @samp{id:} links can then be used to jump to specific entries across
+files. For information related to linking files while publishing them to a
+publishing directory see @ref{Publishing links}.
+
+If you want to specify attributes for links, you can do so using a special
+@code{#+ATTR_HTML} line to define attributes that will be added to the
+@code{<a>} or @code{<img>} tags. Here is an example that sets @code{title}
+and @code{style} attributes for a link:
+
+@cindex #+ATTR_HTML
+@example
+#+ATTR_HTML: title="The Org-mode homepage" style="color:red;"
+[[http://orgmode.org]]
+@end example
+
+@node Tables in HTML export, Images in HTML export, Links in HTML export, HTML export
+@subsection Tables
+@cindex tables, in HTML
+@vindex org-export-html-table-tag
+
+Org-mode tables are exported to HTML using the table tag defined in
+@code{org-export-html-table-tag}. The default setting makes tables without
+cell borders and frame. If you would like to change this for individual
+tables, place something like the following before the table:
+
+@cindex #+CAPTION
+@cindex #+ATTR_HTML
+@example
+#+CAPTION: This is a table with lines around and between cells
+#+ATTR_HTML: border="2" rules="all" frame="all"
+@end example
+
+@node Images in HTML export, Math formatting in HTML export, Tables in HTML export, HTML export
+@subsection Images in HTML export
+
+@cindex images, inline in HTML
+@cindex inlining images in HTML
+@vindex org-export-html-inline-images
+HTML export can inline images given as links in the Org file, and
+it can make an image the clickable part of a link. By
+default@footnote{But see the variable
+@code{org-export-html-inline-images}.}, images are inlined if a link does
+not have a description. So @samp{[[file:myimg.jpg]]} will be inlined,
+while @samp{[[file:myimg.jpg][the image]]} will just produce a link
+@samp{the image} that points to the image. If the description part
+itself is a @code{file:} link or a @code{http:} URL pointing to an
+image, this image will be inlined and activated so that clicking on the
+image will activate the link. For example, to include a thumbnail that
+will link to a high resolution version of the image, you could use:
+
+@example
+[[file:highres.jpg][file:thumb.jpg]]
+@end example
+
+If you need to add attributes to an inlined image, use a @code{#+ATTR_HTML}.
+In the example below we specify the @code{alt} and @code{title} attributes to
+support text viewers and accessibility, and align it to the right.
+
+@cindex #+CAPTION
+@cindex #+ATTR_HTML
+@example
+#+CAPTION: A black cat stalking a spider
+#+ATTR_HTML: alt="cat/spider image" title="Action!" align="right"
+[[./img/a.jpg]]
+@end example
+
+@noindent
+and you could use @code{http} addresses just as well.
+
+@node Math formatting in HTML export, Text areas in HTML export, Images in HTML export, HTML export
+@subsection Math formatting in HTML export
+@cindex MathJax
+@cindex dvipng
+
+@LaTeX{} math snippets (@pxref{LaTeX fragments}) can be displayed in two
+different ways on HTML pages. The default is to use the
+@uref{http://www.mathjax.org, MathJax system} which should work out of the
+box with Org mode installation because @code{http://orgmode.org} serves
+@file{MathJax} for Org-mode users for small applications and for testing
+purposes. @b{If you plan to use this regularly or on pages with significant
+page views, you should install@footnote{Installation instructions can be
+found on the MathJax website, see
+@uref{http://www.mathjax.org/resources/docs/?installation.html}.} MathJax on
+your own server in order to limit the load of our server.} To configure
+@file{MathJax}, use the variable @code{org-export-html-mathjax-options} or
+insert something like the following into the buffer:
+
+@example
+#+MATHJAX: align:"left" mathml:t path:"/MathJax/MathJax.js"
+@end example
+
+@noindent See the docstring of the variable
+@code{org-export-html-mathjax-options} for the meaning of the parameters in
+this line.
+
+If you prefer, you can also request that @LaTeX{} fragments are processed
+into small images that will be inserted into the browser page. Before the
+availability of MathJax, this was the default method for Org files. This
+method requires that the @file{dvipng} program is available on your system.
+You can still get this processing with
+
+@example
+#+OPTIONS: LaTeX:dvipng
+@end example
+
+@node Text areas in HTML export, CSS support, Math formatting in HTML export, HTML export
+@subsection Text areas in HTML export
+
+@cindex text areas, in HTML
+An alternative way to publish literal code examples in HTML is to use text
+areas, where the example can even be edited before pasting it into an
+application. It is triggered by a @code{-t} switch at an @code{example} or
+@code{src} block. Using this switch disables any options for syntax and
+label highlighting, and line numbering, which may be present. You may also
+use @code{-h} and @code{-w} switches to specify the height and width of the
+text area, which default to the number of lines in the example, and 80,
+respectively. For example
+
+@example
+#+BEGIN_EXAMPLE -t -w 40
+ (defun org-xor (a b)
+ "Exclusive or."
+ (if a (not b) b))
+#+END_EXAMPLE
+@end example
+
+
+@node CSS support, JavaScript support, Text areas in HTML export, HTML export
+@subsection CSS support
+@cindex CSS, for HTML export
+@cindex HTML export, CSS
+
+@vindex org-export-html-todo-kwd-class-prefix
+@vindex org-export-html-tag-class-prefix
+You can also give style information for the exported file. The HTML exporter
+assigns the following special CSS classes@footnote{If the classes on TODO
+keywords and tags lead to conflicts, use the variables
+@code{org-export-html-todo-kwd-class-prefix} and
+@code{org-export-html-tag-class-prefix} to make them unique.} to appropriate
+parts of the document---your style specifications may change these, in
+addition to any of the standard classes like for headlines, tables, etc.
+@example
+p.author @r{author information, including email}
+p.date @r{publishing date}
+p.creator @r{creator info, about org-mode version}
+.title @r{document title}
+.todo @r{TODO keywords, all not-done states}
+.done @r{the DONE keywords, all stated the count as done}
+.WAITING @r{each TODO keyword also uses a class named after itself}
+.timestamp @r{timestamp}
+.timestamp-kwd @r{keyword associated with a timestamp, like SCHEDULED}
+.timestamp-wrapper @r{span around keyword plus timestamp}
+.tag @r{tag in a headline}
+._HOME @r{each tag uses itself as a class, "@@" replaced by "_"}
+.target @r{target for links}
+.linenr @r{the line number in a code example}
+.code-highlighted @r{for highlighting referenced code lines}
+div.outline-N @r{div for outline level N (headline plus text))}
+div.outline-text-N @r{extra div for text at outline level N}
+.section-number-N @r{section number in headlines, different for each level}
+div.figure @r{how to format an inlined image}
+pre.src @r{formatted source code}
+pre.example @r{normal example}
+p.verse @r{verse paragraph}
+div.footnotes @r{footnote section headline}
+p.footnote @r{footnote definition paragraph, containing a footnote}
+.footref @r{a footnote reference number (always a <sup>)}
+.footnum @r{footnote number in footnote definition (always <sup>)}
+@end example
+
+@vindex org-export-html-style-default
+@vindex org-export-html-style-include-default
+@vindex org-export-html-style
+@vindex org-export-html-extra
+@vindex org-export-html-style-default
+Each exported file contains a compact default style that defines these
+classes in a basic way@footnote{This style is defined in the constant
+@code{org-export-html-style-default}, which you should not modify. To turn
+inclusion of these defaults off, customize
+@code{org-export-html-style-include-default}}. You may overwrite these
+settings, or add to them by using the variables @code{org-export-html-style}
+(for Org-wide settings) and @code{org-export-html-style-extra} (for more
+fine-grained settings, like file-local settings). To set the latter variable
+individually for each file, you can use
+
+@cindex #+STYLE
+@example
+#+STYLE: <link rel="stylesheet" type="text/css" href="stylesheet.css" />
+@end example
+
+@noindent
+For longer style definitions, you can use several such lines. You could also
+directly write a @code{<style>} @code{</style>} section in this way, without
+referring to an external file.
+
+In order to add styles to a subtree, use the @code{:HTML_CONTAINER_CLASS:}
+property to assign a class to the tree. In order to specify CSS styles for a
+particular headline, you can use the id specified in a @code{:CUSTOM_ID:}
+property.
+
+@c FIXME: More about header and footer styles
+@c FIXME: Talk about links and targets.
+
+@node JavaScript support, , CSS support, HTML export
+@subsection JavaScript supported display of web pages
+
+@cindex Rose, Sebastian
+Sebastian Rose has written a JavaScript program especially designed to
+enhance the web viewing experience of HTML files created with Org. This
+program allows you to view large files in two different ways. The first one
+is an @emph{Info}-like mode where each section is displayed separately and
+navigation can be done with the @kbd{n} and @kbd{p} keys (and some other keys
+as well, press @kbd{?} for an overview of the available keys). The second
+view type is a @emph{folding} view much like Org provides inside Emacs. The
+script is available at @url{http://orgmode.org/org-info.js} and you can find
+the documentation for it at @url{http://orgmode.org/worg/code/org-info-js/}.
+We host the script at our site, but if you use it a lot, you might
+not want to be dependent on @url{orgmode.org} and prefer to install a local
+copy on your own web server.
+
+To use the script, you need to make sure that the @file{org-jsinfo.el} module
+gets loaded. It should be loaded by default, but you can try @kbd{M-x
+customize-variable @key{RET} org-modules @key{RET}} to convince yourself that
+this is indeed the case. All it then takes to make use of the program is
+adding a single line to the Org file:
+
+@cindex #+INFOJS_OPT
+@example
+#+INFOJS_OPT: view:info toc:nil
+@end example
+
+@noindent
+If this line is found, the HTML header will automatically contain the code
+needed to invoke the script. Using the line above, you can set the following
+viewing options:
+
+@example
+path: @r{The path to the script. The default is to grab the script from}
+ @r{@url{http://orgmode.org/org-info.js}, but you might want to have}
+ @r{a local copy and use a path like @samp{../scripts/org-info.js}.}
+view: @r{Initial view when website is first shown. Possible values are:}
+ info @r{Info-like interface with one section per page.}
+ overview @r{Folding interface, initially showing only top-level.}
+ content @r{Folding interface, starting with all headlines visible.}
+ showall @r{Folding interface, all headlines and text visible.}
+sdepth: @r{Maximum headline level that will still become an independent}
+ @r{section for info and folding modes. The default is taken from}
+ @r{@code{org-export-headline-levels} (= the @code{H} switch in @code{#+OPTIONS}).}
+ @r{If this is smaller than in @code{org-export-headline-levels}, each}
+ @r{info/folding section can still contain child headlines.}
+toc: @r{Should the table of contents @emph{initially} be visible?}
+ @r{Even when @code{nil}, you can always get to the "toc" with @kbd{i}.}
+tdepth: @r{The depth of the table of contents. The defaults are taken from}
+ @r{the variables @code{org-export-headline-levels} and @code{org-export-with-toc}.}
+ftoc: @r{Does the CSS of the page specify a fixed position for the "toc"?}
+ @r{If yes, the toc will never be displayed as a section.}
+ltoc: @r{Should there be short contents (children) in each section?}
+ @r{Make this @code{above} if the section should be above initial text.}
+mouse: @r{Headings are highlighted when the mouse is over them. Should be}
+ @r{@samp{underline} (default) or a background color like @samp{#cccccc}.}
+buttons: @r{Should view-toggle buttons be everywhere? When @code{nil} (the}
+ @r{default), only one such button will be present.}
+@end example
+@noindent
+@vindex org-infojs-options
+@vindex org-export-html-use-infojs
+You can choose default values for these options by customizing the variable
+@code{org-infojs-options}. If you always want to apply the script to your
+pages, configure the variable @code{org-export-html-use-infojs}.
+
+@node LaTeX and PDF export, DocBook export, HTML export, Exporting
+@section @LaTeX{} and PDF export
+@cindex @LaTeX{} export
+@cindex PDF export
+@cindex Guerry, Bastien
+
+Org-mode contains a @LaTeX{} exporter written by Bastien Guerry. With
+further processing@footnote{The default LaTeX output is designed for
+processing with pdftex or latex. It includes packages that are not
+compatible with xetex and possibly luatex. See the variables
+@code{org-export-latex-default-packages-alist} and
+@code{org-export-latex-packages-alist}.}, this backend is also used to
+produce PDF output. Since the @LaTeX{} output uses @file{hyperref} to
+implement links and cross references, the PDF output file will be fully
+linked.
+
+@menu
+* LaTeX/PDF export commands:: Which key invokes which commands
+* Header and sectioning:: Setting up the export file structure
+* Quoting LaTeX code:: Incorporating literal @LaTeX{} code
+* Tables in LaTeX export:: Options for exporting tables to @LaTeX{}
+* Images in LaTeX export:: How to insert figures into @LaTeX{} output
+* Beamer class export:: Turning the file into a presentation
+@end menu
+
+@node LaTeX/PDF export commands, Header and sectioning, LaTeX and PDF export, LaTeX and PDF export
+@subsection @LaTeX{} export commands
+
+@cindex region, active
+@cindex active region
+@cindex transient-mark-mode
+@table @kbd
+@orgcmd{C-c C-e l,org-export-as-latex}
+@cindex property EXPORT_FILE_NAME
+Export as @LaTeX{} file @file{myfile.tex}. For an Org file
+@file{myfile.org}, the ASCII file will be @file{myfile.tex}. The file will
+be overwritten without warning. If there is an active region@footnote{This
+requires @code{transient-mark-mode} be turned on.}, only the region will be
+exported. If the selected region is a single tree@footnote{To select the
+current subtree, use @kbd{C-c @@}.}, the tree head will become the document
+title. If the tree head entry has or inherits an @code{EXPORT_FILE_NAME}
+property, that name will be used for the export.
+@orgcmd{C-c C-e L,org-export-as-latex-to-buffer}
+Export to a temporary buffer. Do not create a file.
+@item C-c C-e v l/L
+Export only the visible part of the document.
+@item M-x org-export-region-as-latex
+Convert the region to @LaTeX{} under the assumption that it was Org-mode
+syntax before. This is a global command that can be invoked in any
+buffer.
+@item M-x org-replace-region-by-latex
+Replace the active region (assumed to be in Org-mode syntax) by @LaTeX{}
+code.
+@orgcmd{C-c C-e p,org-export-as-pdf}
+Export as @LaTeX{} and then process to PDF.
+@orgcmd{C-c C-e d,org-export-as-pdf-and-open}
+Export as @LaTeX{} and then process to PDF, then open the resulting PDF file.
+@end table
+
+@cindex headline levels, for exporting
+@vindex org-latex-low-levels
+In the exported version, the first 3 outline levels will become
+headlines, defining a general document structure. Additional levels
+will be exported as description lists. The exporter can ignore them or
+convert them to a custom string depending on
+@code{org-latex-low-levels}.
+
+If you want that transition to occur at a different level, specify it
+with a numeric prefix argument. For example,
+
+@example
+@kbd{C-2 C-c C-e l}
+@end example
+
+@noindent
+creates two levels of headings and does the rest as items.
+
+@node Header and sectioning, Quoting LaTeX code, LaTeX/PDF export commands, LaTeX and PDF export
+@subsection Header and sectioning structure
+@cindex @LaTeX{} class
+@cindex @LaTeX{} sectioning structure
+@cindex @LaTeX{} header
+@cindex header, for LaTeX files
+@cindex sectioning structure, for LaTeX export
+
+By default, the @LaTeX{} output uses the class @code{article}.
+
+@vindex org-export-latex-default-class
+@vindex org-export-latex-classes
+@vindex org-export-latex-default-packages-alist
+@vindex org-export-latex-packages-alist
+@cindex #+LATEX_HEADER
+@cindex #+LATEX_CLASS
+@cindex #+LATEX_CLASS_OPTIONS
+@cindex property, LATEX_CLASS
+@cindex property, LATEX_CLASS_OPTIONS
+You can change this globally by setting a different value for
+@code{org-export-latex-default-class} or locally by adding an option like
+@code{#+LaTeX_CLASS: myclass} in your file, or with a @code{:LaTeX_CLASS:}
+property that applies when exporting a region containing only this (sub)tree.
+The class must be listed in @code{org-export-latex-classes}. This variable
+defines a header template for each class@footnote{Into which the values of
+@code{org-export-latex-default-packages-alist} and
+@code{org-export-latex-packages-alist} are spliced.}, and allows you to
+define the sectioning structure for each class. You can also define your own
+classes there. @code{#+LaTeX_CLASS_OPTIONS} or a @code{LaTeX_CLASS_OPTIONS}
+property can specify the options for the @code{\documentclass} macro. You
+can also use @code{#+LATEX_HEADER: \usepackage@{xyz@}} to add lines to the
+header. See the docstring of @code{org-export-latex-classes} for more
+information.
+
+@node Quoting LaTeX code, Tables in LaTeX export, Header and sectioning, LaTeX and PDF export
+@subsection Quoting @LaTeX{} code
+
+Embedded @LaTeX{} as described in @ref{Embedded LaTeX}, will be correctly
+inserted into the @LaTeX{} file. This includes simple macros like
+@samp{\ref@{LABEL@}} to create a cross reference to a figure. Furthermore,
+you can add special code that should only be present in @LaTeX{} export with
+the following constructs:
+
+@cindex #+LaTeX
+@cindex #+BEGIN_LaTeX
+@example
+#+LaTeX: Literal LaTeX code for export
+@end example
+
+@noindent or
+@cindex #+BEGIN_LaTeX
+
+@example
+#+BEGIN_LaTeX
+All lines between these markers are exported literally
+#+END_LaTeX
+@end example
+
+
+@node Tables in LaTeX export, Images in LaTeX export, Quoting LaTeX code, LaTeX and PDF export
+@subsection Tables in @LaTeX{} export
+@cindex tables, in @LaTeX{} export
+
+For @LaTeX{} export of a table, you can specify a label and a caption
+(@pxref{Images and tables}). You can also use the @code{ATTR_LaTeX} line to
+request a @code{longtable} environment for the table, so that it may span
+several pages, or provide the @code{multicolumn} keyword that will make the
+table span the page in a multicolumn environment (@code{table*} environment).
+Finally, you can set the alignment string:
+
+@cindex #+CAPTION
+@cindex #+LABEL
+@cindex #+ATTR_LaTeX
+@example
+#+CAPTION: A long table
+#+LABEL: tbl:long
+#+ATTR_LaTeX: longtable align=l|lp@{3cm@}r|l
+| ..... | ..... |
+| ..... | ..... |
+@end example
+
+
+@node Images in LaTeX export, Beamer class export, Tables in LaTeX export, LaTeX and PDF export
+@subsection Images in @LaTeX{} export
+@cindex images, inline in @LaTeX{}
+@cindex inlining images in @LaTeX{}
+
+Images that are linked to without a description part in the link, like
+@samp{[[file:img.jpg]]} or @samp{[[./img.jpg]]} will be inserted into the PDF
+output file resulting from @LaTeX{} processing. Org will use an
+@code{\includegraphics} macro to insert the image. If you have specified a
+caption and/or a label as described in @ref{Images and tables}, the figure
+will be wrapped into a @code{figure} environment and thus become a floating
+element. You can use an @code{#+ATTR_LaTeX:} line to specify the various
+options that can be used in the optional argument of the
+@code{\includegraphics} macro. To modify the placement option of the
+@code{figure} environment, add something like @samp{placement=[h!]} to the
+Attributes.
+
+If you would like to let text flow around the image, add the word @samp{wrap}
+to the @code{#+ATTR_LaTeX:} line, which will make the figure occupy the left
+half of the page. To fine-tune, the @code{placement} field will be the set
+of additional arguments needed by the @code{wrapfigure} environment. Note
+that if you change the size of the image, you need to use compatible settings
+for @code{\includegraphics} and @code{wrapfigure}.
+
+@cindex #+CAPTION
+@cindex #+LABEL
+@cindex #+ATTR_LaTeX
+@example
+#+CAPTION: The black-body emission of the disk around HR 4049
+#+LABEL: fig:SED-HR4049
+#+ATTR_LaTeX: width=5cm,angle=90
+[[./img/sed-hr4049.pdf]]
+
+#+ATTR_LaTeX: width=0.38\textwidth wrap placement=@{r@}@{0.4\textwidth@}
+[[./img/hst.png]]
+@end example
+
+If you need references to a label created in this way, write
+@samp{\ref@{fig:SED-HR4049@}} just like in @LaTeX{}.
+
+@node Beamer class export, , Images in LaTeX export, LaTeX and PDF export
+@subsection Beamer class export
+
+The LaTeX class @file{beamer} allows production of high quality presentations
+using LaTeX and pdf processing. Org-mode has special support for turning an
+Org-mode file or tree into a @file{beamer} presentation.
+
+When the LaTeX class for the current buffer (as set with @code{#+LaTeX_CLASS:
+beamer}) or subtree (set with a @code{LaTeX_CLASS} property) is
+@code{beamer}, a special export mode will turn the file or tree into a beamer
+presentation. Any tree with not-too-deep level nesting should in principle be
+exportable as a beamer presentation. By default, the top-level entries (or
+the first level below the selected subtree heading) will be turned into
+frames, and the outline structure below this level will become itemize lists.
+You can also configure the variable @code{org-beamer-frame-level} to a
+different level---then the hierarchy above frames will produce the sectioning
+structure of the presentation.
+
+A template for useful in-buffer settings or properties can be inserted into
+the buffer with @kbd{M-x org-insert-beamer-options-template}. Among other
+things, this will install a column view format which is very handy for
+editing special properties used by beamer.
+
+You can influence the structure of the presentation using the following
+properties:
+
+@table @code
+@item BEAMER_env
+The environment that should be used to format this entry. Valid environments
+are defined in the constant @code{org-beamer-environments-default}, and you
+can define more in @code{org-beamer-environments-extra}. If this property is
+set, the entry will also get a @code{:B_environment:} tag to make this
+visible. This tag has no semantic meaning, it is only a visual aid.
+@item BEAMER_envargs
+The beamer-special arguments that should be used for the environment, like
+@code{[t]} or @code{[<+->]} of @code{<2-3>}. If the @code{BEAMER_col}
+property is also set, something like @code{C[t]} can be added here as well to
+set an options argument for the implied @code{columns} environment.
+@code{c[t]} or @code{c<2->} will set an options for the implied @code{column}
+environment.
+@item BEAMER_col
+The width of a column that should start with this entry. If this property is
+set, the entry will also get a @code{:BMCOL:} property to make this visible.
+Also this tag is only a visual aid. When this is a plain number, it will be
+interpreted as a fraction of @code{\textwidth}. Otherwise it will be assumed
+that you have specified the units, like @samp{3cm}. The first such property
+in a frame will start a @code{columns} environment to surround the columns.
+This environment is closed when an entry has a @code{BEAMER_col} property
+with value 0 or 1, or automatically at the end of the frame.
+@item BEAMER_extra
+Additional commands that should be inserted after the environment has been
+opened. For example, when creating a frame, this can be used to specify
+transitions.
+@end table
+
+Frames will automatically receive a @code{fragile} option if they contain
+source code that uses the verbatim environment. Special @file{beamer}
+specific code can be inserted using @code{#+BEAMER:} and
+@code{#+BEGIN_beamer...#+end_beamer} constructs, similar to other export
+backends, but with the difference that @code{#+LaTeX:} stuff will be included
+in the presentation as well.
+
+Outline nodes with @code{BEAMER_env} property value @samp{note} or
+@samp{noteNH} will be formatted as beamer notes, i,e, they will be wrapped
+into @code{\note@{...@}}. The former will include the heading as part of the
+note text, the latter will ignore the heading of that node. To simplify note
+generation, it is actually enough to mark the note with a @emph{tag} (either
+@code{:B_note:} or @code{:B_noteNH:}) instead of creating the
+@code{BEAMER_env} property.
+
+You can turn on a special minor mode @code{org-beamer-mode} for editing
+support with
+
+@example
+#+STARTUP: beamer
+@end example
+
+@table @kbd
+@orgcmd{C-c C-b,org-beamer-select-environment}
+In @code{org-beamer-mode}, this key offers fast selection of a beamer
+environment or the @code{BEAMER_col} property.
+@end table
+
+Column view provides a great way to set the environment of a node and other
+important parameters. Make sure you are using a COLUMN format that is geared
+toward this special purpose. The command @kbd{M-x
+org-insert-beamer-options-template} defines such a format.
+
+Here is a simple example Org document that is intended for beamer export.
+
+@smallexample
+#+LaTeX_CLASS: beamer
+#+TITLE: Example Presentation
+#+AUTHOR: Carsten Dominik
+#+LaTeX_CLASS_OPTIONS: [presentation]
+#+BEAMER_FRAME_LEVEL: 2
+#+BEAMER_HEADER_EXTRA: \usetheme@{Madrid@}\usecolortheme@{default@}
+#+COLUMNS: %35ITEM %10BEAMER_env(Env) %10BEAMER_envargs(Args) %4BEAMER_col(Col) %8BEAMER_extra(Ex)
+
+* This is the first structural section
+
+** Frame 1 \\ with a subtitle
+*** Thanks to Eric Fraga :BMCOL:B_block:
+ :PROPERTIES:
+ :BEAMER_env: block
+ :BEAMER_envargs: C[t]
+ :BEAMER_col: 0.5
+ :END:
+ for the first viable beamer setup in Org
+*** Thanks to everyone else :BMCOL:B_block:
+ :PROPERTIES:
+ :BEAMER_col: 0.5
+ :BEAMER_env: block
+ :BEAMER_envargs: <2->
+ :END:
+ for contributing to the discussion
+**** This will be formatted as a beamer note :B_note:
+** Frame 2 \\ where we will not use columns
+*** Request :B_block:
+ Please test this stuff!
+ :PROPERTIES:
+ :BEAMER_env: block
+ :END:
+@end smallexample
+
+For more information, see the documentation on Worg.
+
+@node DocBook export, TaskJuggler export, LaTeX and PDF export, Exporting
+@section DocBook export
+@cindex DocBook export
+@cindex PDF export
+@cindex Cui, Baoqiu
+
+Org contains a DocBook exporter written by Baoqiu Cui. Once an Org file is
+exported to DocBook format, it can be further processed to produce other
+formats, including PDF, HTML, man pages, etc., using many available DocBook
+tools and stylesheets.
+
+Currently DocBook exporter only supports DocBook V5.0.
+
+@menu
+* DocBook export commands:: How to invoke DocBook export
+* Quoting DocBook code:: Incorporating DocBook code in Org files
+* Recursive sections:: Recursive sections in DocBook
+* Tables in DocBook export:: Tables are exported as HTML tables
+* Images in DocBook export:: How to insert figures into DocBook output
+* Special characters:: How to handle special characters
+@end menu
+
+@node DocBook export commands, Quoting DocBook code, DocBook export, DocBook export
+@subsection DocBook export commands
+
+@cindex region, active
+@cindex active region
+@cindex transient-mark-mode
+@table @kbd
+@orgcmd{C-c C-e D,org-export-as-docbook}
+@cindex property EXPORT_FILE_NAME
+Export as DocBook file. For an Org file, @file{myfile.org}, the DocBook XML
+file will be @file{myfile.xml}. The file will be overwritten without
+warning. If there is an active region@footnote{This requires
+@code{transient-mark-mode} to be turned on}, only the region will be
+exported. If the selected region is a single tree@footnote{To select the
+current subtree, use @kbd{C-c @@}.}, the tree head will become the document
+title. If the tree head entry has, or inherits, an @code{EXPORT_FILE_NAME}
+property, that name will be used for the export.
+@orgcmd{C-c C-e V,org-export-as-docbook-pdf-and-open}
+Export as DocBook file, process to PDF, then open the resulting PDF file.
+
+@vindex org-export-docbook-xslt-proc-command
+@vindex org-export-docbook-xsl-fo-proc-command
+Note that, in order to produce PDF output based on exported DocBook file, you
+need to have XSLT processor and XSL-FO processor software installed on your
+system. Check variables @code{org-export-docbook-xslt-proc-command} and
+@code{org-export-docbook-xsl-fo-proc-command}.
+
+@vindex org-export-docbook-xslt-stylesheet
+The stylesheet argument @code{%s} in variable
+@code{org-export-docbook-xslt-proc-command} is replaced by the value of
+variable @code{org-export-docbook-xslt-stylesheet}, which needs to be set by
+the user. You can also overrule this global setting on a per-file basis by
+adding an in-buffer setting @code{#+XSLT:} to the Org file.
+
+@orgkey{C-c C-e v D}
+Export only the visible part of the document.
+@end table
+
+@node Quoting DocBook code, Recursive sections, DocBook export commands, DocBook export
+@subsection Quoting DocBook code
+
+You can quote DocBook code in Org files and copy it verbatim into exported
+DocBook file with the following constructs:
+
+@cindex #+DOCBOOK
+@cindex #+BEGIN_DOCBOOK
+@example
+#+DOCBOOK: Literal DocBook code for export
+@end example
+
+@noindent or
+@cindex #+BEGIN_DOCBOOK
+
+@example
+#+BEGIN_DOCBOOK
+All lines between these markers are exported by DocBook exporter
+literally.
+#+END_DOCBOOK
+@end example
+
+For example, you can use the following lines to include a DocBook warning
+admonition. As to what this warning says, you should pay attention to the
+document context when quoting DocBook code in Org files. You may make
+exported DocBook XML files invalid by not quoting DocBook code correctly.
+
+@example
+#+BEGIN_DOCBOOK
+<warning>
+ <para>You should know what you are doing when quoting DocBook XML code
+ in your Org file. Invalid DocBook XML may be generated by
+ DocBook exporter if you are not careful!</para>
+</warning>
+#+END_DOCBOOK
+@end example
+
+@node Recursive sections, Tables in DocBook export, Quoting DocBook code, DocBook export
+@subsection Recursive sections
+@cindex DocBook recursive sections
+
+DocBook exporter exports Org files as articles using the @code{article}
+element in DocBook. Recursive sections, i.e. @code{section} elements, are
+used in exported articles. Top level headlines in Org files are exported as
+top level sections, and lower level headlines are exported as nested
+sections. The entire structure of Org files will be exported completely, no
+matter how many nested levels of headlines there are.
+
+Using recursive sections makes it easy to port and reuse exported DocBook
+code in other DocBook document types like @code{book} or @code{set}.
+
+@node Tables in DocBook export, Images in DocBook export, Recursive sections, DocBook export
+@subsection Tables in DocBook export
+@cindex tables, in DocBook export
+
+Tables in Org files are exported as HTML tables, which have been supported since
+DocBook V4.3.
+
+If a table does not have a caption, an informal table is generated using the
+@code{informaltable} element; otherwise, a formal table will be generated
+using the @code{table} element.
+
+@node Images in DocBook export, Special characters, Tables in DocBook export, DocBook export
+@subsection Images in DocBook export
+@cindex images, inline in DocBook
+@cindex inlining images in DocBook
+
+Images that are linked to without a description part in the link, like
+@samp{[[file:img.jpg]]} or @samp{[[./img.jpg]]}, will be exported to DocBook
+using @code{mediaobject} elements. Each @code{mediaobject} element contains
+an @code{imageobject} that wraps an @code{imagedata} element. If you have
+specified a caption for an image as described in @ref{Images and tables}, a
+@code{caption} element will be added in @code{mediaobject}. If a label is
+also specified, it will be exported as an @code{xml:id} attribute of the
+@code{mediaobject} element.
+
+@vindex org-export-docbook-default-image-attributes
+Image attributes supported by the @code{imagedata} element, like @code{align}
+or @code{width}, can be specified in two ways: you can either customize
+variable @code{org-export-docbook-default-image-attributes} or use the
+@code{#+ATTR_DOCBOOK:} line. Attributes specified in variable
+@code{org-export-docbook-default-image-attributes} are applied to all inline
+images in the Org file to be exported (unless they are overridden by image
+attributes specified in @code{#+ATTR_DOCBOOK:} lines).
+
+The @code{#+ATTR_DOCBOOK:} line can be used to specify additional image
+attributes or override default image attributes for individual images. If
+the same attribute appears in both the @code{#+ATTR_DOCBOOK:} line and
+variable @code{org-export-docbook-default-image-attributes}, the former
+takes precedence. Here is an example about how image attributes can be
+set:
+
+@cindex #+CAPTION
+@cindex #+LABEL
+@cindex #+ATTR_DOCBOOK
+@example
+#+CAPTION: The logo of Org-mode
+#+LABEL: unicorn-svg
+#+ATTR_DOCBOOK: scalefit="1" width="100%" depth="100%"
+[[./img/org-mode-unicorn.svg]]
+@end example
+
+@vindex org-export-docbook-inline-image-extensions
+By default, DocBook exporter recognizes the following image file types:
+@file{jpeg}, @file{jpg}, @file{png}, @file{gif}, and @file{svg}. You can
+customize variable @code{org-export-docbook-inline-image-extensions} to add
+more types to this list as long as DocBook supports them.
+
+@node Special characters, , Images in DocBook export, DocBook export
+@subsection Special characters in DocBook export
+@cindex Special characters in DocBook export
+
+@vindex org-export-docbook-doctype
+@vindex org-entities
+Special characters that are written in @TeX{}-like syntax, such as @code{\alpha},
+@code{\Gamma}, and @code{\Zeta}, are supported by DocBook exporter. These
+characters are rewritten to XML entities, like @code{&alpha;},
+@code{&Gamma;}, and @code{&Zeta;}, based on the list saved in variable
+@code{org-entities}. As long as the generated DocBook file includes the
+corresponding entities, these special characters are recognized.
+
+You can customize variable @code{org-export-docbook-doctype} to include the
+entities you need. For example, you can set variable
+@code{org-export-docbook-doctype} to the following value to recognize all
+special characters included in XHTML entities:
+
+@example
+"<!DOCTYPE article [
+<!ENTITY % xhtml1-symbol PUBLIC
+\"-//W3C//ENTITIES Symbol for HTML//EN//XML\"
+\"http://www.w3.org/2003/entities/2007/xhtml1-symbol.ent\"
+>
+%xhtml1-symbol;
+]>
+"
+@end example
+
+@node TaskJuggler export, Freemind export, DocBook export, Exporting
+@section TaskJuggler export
+@cindex TaskJuggler export
+@cindex Project management
+
+@uref{http://www.taskjuggler.org/, TaskJuggler} is a project management tool.
+It provides an optimizing scheduler that computes your project time lines and
+resource assignments based on the project outline and the constraints that
+you have provided.
+
+The TaskJuggler exporter is a bit different from other exporters, such as the
+HTML and LaTeX exporters for example, in that it does not export all the
+nodes of a document or strictly follow the order of the nodes in the
+document.
+
+Instead the TaskJuggler exporter looks for a tree that defines the tasks and
+a optionally tree that defines the resources for this project. It then
+creates a TaskJuggler file based on these trees and the attributes defined in
+all the nodes.
+
+@subsection TaskJuggler export commands
+
+@table @kbd
+@orgcmd{C-c C-e j,org-export-as-taskjuggler}
+Export as TaskJuggler file.
+
+@orgcmd{C-c C-e J,org-export-as-taskjuggler-and-open}
+Export as TaskJuggler file and then open the file with TaskJugglerUI.
+@end table
+
+@subsection Tasks
+
+@vindex org-export-taskjuggler-project-tag
+Create your tasks as you usually do with Org-mode. Assign efforts to each
+task using properties (it's easiest to do this in the column view). You
+should end up with something similar to the example by Peter Jones in
+@url{http://www.contextualdevelopment.com/static/artifacts/articles/2008/project-planning/project-planning.org}.
+Now mark the top node of your tasks with a tag named
+@code{:taskjuggler_project:} (or whatever you customized
+@code{org-export-taskjuggler-project-tag} to). You are now ready to export
+the project plan with @kbd{C-c C-e J} which will export the project plan and
+open a gantt chart in TaskJugglerUI.
+
+@subsection Resources
+
+@vindex org-export-taskjuggler-resource-tag
+Next you can define resources and assign those to work on specific tasks. You
+can group your resources hierarchically. Tag the top node of the resources
+with @code{:taskjuggler_resource:} (or whatever you customized
+@code{org-export-taskjuggler-resource-tag} to). You can optionally assign an
+identifier (named @samp{resource_id}) to the resources (using the standard
+Org properties commands, @pxref{Property syntax}) or you can let the exporter
+generate identifiers automatically (the exporter picks the first word of the
+headline as the identifier as long as it is unique---see the documentation of
+@code{org-taskjuggler-get-unique-id}). Using that identifier you can then
+allocate resources to tasks. This is again done with the @samp{allocate}
+property on the tasks. Do this in column view or when on the task type
+@kbd{C-c C-x p allocate @key{RET} <resource_id> @key{RET}}.
+
+Once the allocations are done you can again export to TaskJuggler and check
+in the Resource Allocation Graph which person is working on what task at what
+time.
+
+@subsection Export of properties
+
+The exporter also takes TODO state information into consideration, i.e. if a
+task is marked as done it will have the corresponding attribute in
+TaskJuggler (@samp{complete 100}). Also it will export any property on a task
+resource or resource node which is known to TaskJuggler, such as
+@samp{limits}, @samp{vacation}, @samp{shift}, @samp{booking},
+@samp{efficiency}, @samp{journalentry}, @samp{rate} for resources or
+@samp{account}, @samp{start}, @samp{note}, @samp{duration}, @samp{end},
+@samp{journalentry}, @samp{milestone}, @samp{reference}, @samp{responsible},
+@samp{scheduling}, etc for tasks.
+
+@subsection Dependencies
+
+The exporter will handle dependencies that are defined in the tasks either
+with the @samp{ORDERED} attribute (@pxref{TODO dependencies}), with the
+@samp{BLOCKER} attribute (see @file{org-depend.el}) or alternatively with a
+@samp{depends} attribute. Both the @samp{BLOCKER} and the @samp{depends}
+attribute can be either @samp{previous-sibling} or a reference to an
+identifier (named @samp{task_id}) which is defined for another task in the
+project. @samp{BLOCKER} and the @samp{depends} attribute can define multiple
+dependencies separated by either space or comma. You can also specify
+optional attributes on the dependency by simply appending it. The following
+examples should illustrate this:
+
+@example
+* Preparation
+ :PROPERTIES:
+ :task_id: preparation
+ :ORDERED: t
+ :END:
+* Training material
+ :PROPERTIES:
+ :task_id: training_material
+ :ORDERED: t
+ :END:
+** Markup Guidelines
+ :PROPERTIES:
+ :Effort: 2.0
+ :END:
+** Workflow Guidelines
+ :PROPERTIES:
+ :Effort: 2.0
+ :END:
+* Presentation
+ :PROPERTIES:
+ :Effort: 2.0
+ :BLOCKER: training_material @{ gapduration 1d @} preparation
+ :END:
+@end example
+
+@subsection Reports
+
+@vindex org-export-taskjuggler-default-reports
+TaskJuggler can produce many kinds of reports (e.g. gantt chart, resource
+allocation, etc). The user defines what kind of reports should be generated
+for a project in the TaskJuggler file. The exporter will automatically insert
+some default reports in the file. These defaults are defined in
+@code{org-export-taskjuggler-default-reports}. They can be modified using
+customize along with a number of other options. For a more complete list, see
+@kbd{M-x customize-group @key{RET} org-export-taskjuggler @key{RET}}.
+
+For more information and examples see the Org-taskjuggler tutorial at
+@uref{http://orgmode.org/worg/org-tutorials/org-taskjuggler.php}.
+
+@node Freemind export, XOXO export, TaskJuggler export, Exporting
+@section Freemind export
+@cindex Freemind export
+@cindex mind map
+
+The Freemind exporter was written by Lennart Borgman.
+
+@table @kbd
+@orgcmd{C-c C-e m,org-export-as-freemind}
+Export as Freemind mind map @file{myfile.mm}.
+@end table
+
+@node XOXO export, iCalendar export, Freemind export, Exporting
+@section XOXO export
+@cindex XOXO export
+
+Org-mode contains an exporter that produces XOXO-style output.
+Currently, this exporter only handles the general outline structure and
+does not interpret any additional Org-mode features.
+
+@table @kbd
+@orgcmd{C-c C-e x,org-export-as-xoxo}
+Export as XOXO file @file{myfile.html}.
+@orgkey{C-c C-e v x}
+Export only the visible part of the document.
+@end table
+
+@node iCalendar export, , XOXO export, Exporting
+@section iCalendar export
+@cindex iCalendar export
+
+@vindex org-icalendar-include-todo
+@vindex org-icalendar-use-deadline
+@vindex org-icalendar-use-scheduled
+@vindex org-icalendar-categories
+@vindex org-icalendar-alarm-time
+Some people use Org-mode for keeping track of projects, but still prefer a
+standard calendar application for anniversaries and appointments. In this
+case it can be useful to show deadlines and other time-stamped items in Org
+files in the calendar application. Org-mode can export calendar information
+in the standard iCalendar format. If you also want to have TODO entries
+included in the export, configure the variable
+@code{org-icalendar-include-todo}. Plain timestamps are exported as VEVENT,
+and TODO items as VTODO. It will also create events from deadlines that are
+in non-TODO items. Deadlines and scheduling dates in TODO items will be used
+to set the start and due dates for the TODO entry@footnote{See the variables
+@code{org-icalendar-use-deadline} and @code{org-icalendar-use-scheduled}.}.
+As categories, it will use the tags locally defined in the heading, and the
+file/tree category@footnote{To add inherited tags or the TODO state,
+configure the variable @code{org-icalendar-categories}.}. See the variable
+@code{org-icalendar-alarm-time} for a way to assign alarms to entries with a
+time.
+
+@vindex org-icalendar-store-UID
+@cindex property, ID
+The iCalendar standard requires each entry to have a globally unique
+identifier (UID). Org creates these identifiers during export. If you set
+the variable @code{org-icalendar-store-UID}, the UID will be stored in the
+@code{:ID:} property of the entry and re-used next time you report this
+entry. Since a single entry can give rise to multiple iCalendar entries (as
+a timestamp, a deadline, a scheduled item, and as a TODO item), Org adds
+prefixes to the UID, depending on what triggered the inclusion of the entry.
+In this way the UID remains unique, but a synchronization program can still
+figure out from which entry all the different instances originate.
+
+@table @kbd
+@orgcmd{C-c C-e i,org-export-icalendar-this-file}
+Create iCalendar entries for the current file and store them in the same
+directory, using a file extension @file{.ics}.
+@orgcmd{C-c C-e I, org-export-icalendar-all-agenda-files}
+@vindex org-agenda-files
+Like @kbd{C-c C-e i}, but do this for all files in
+@code{org-agenda-files}. For each of these files, a separate iCalendar
+file will be written.
+@orgcmd{C-c C-e c,org-export-icalendar-combine-agenda-files}
+@vindex org-combined-agenda-icalendar-file
+Create a single large iCalendar file from all files in
+@code{org-agenda-files} and write it to the file given by
+@code{org-combined-agenda-icalendar-file}.
+@end table
+
+@vindex org-use-property-inheritance
+@vindex org-icalendar-include-body
+@cindex property, SUMMARY
+@cindex property, DESCRIPTION
+@cindex property, LOCATION
+The export will honor SUMMARY, DESCRIPTION and LOCATION@footnote{The LOCATION
+property can be inherited from higher in the hierarchy if you configure
+@code{org-use-property-inheritance} accordingly.} properties if the selected
+entries have them. If not, the summary will be derived from the headline,
+and the description from the body (limited to
+@code{org-icalendar-include-body} characters).
+
+How this calendar is best read and updated, depends on the application
+you are using. The FAQ covers this issue.
+
+@node Publishing, Working With Source Code, Exporting, Top
+@chapter Publishing
+@cindex publishing
+
+Org includes a publishing management system that allows you to configure
+automatic HTML conversion of @emph{projects} composed of interlinked org
+files. You can also configure Org to automatically upload your exported HTML
+pages and related attachments, such as images and source code files, to a web
+server.
+
+You can also use Org to convert files into PDF, or even combine HTML and PDF
+conversion so that files are available in both formats on the server.
+
+Publishing has been contributed to Org by David O'Toole.
+
+@menu
+* Configuration:: Defining projects
+* Uploading files:: How to get files up on the server
+* Sample configuration:: Example projects
+* Triggering publication:: Publication commands
+@end menu
+
+@node Configuration, Uploading files, Publishing, Publishing
+@section Configuration
+
+Publishing needs significant configuration to specify files, destination
+and many other properties of a project.
+
+@menu
+* Project alist:: The central configuration variable
+* Sources and destinations:: From here to there
+* Selecting files:: What files are part of the project?
+* Publishing action:: Setting the function doing the publishing
+* Publishing options:: Tweaking HTML export
+* Publishing links:: Which links keep working after publishing?
+* Sitemap:: Generating a list of all pages
+* Generating an index:: An index that reaches across pages
+@end menu
+
+@node Project alist, Sources and destinations, Configuration, Configuration
+@subsection The variable @code{org-publish-project-alist}
+@cindex org-publish-project-alist
+@cindex projects, for publishing
+
+@vindex org-publish-project-alist
+Publishing is configured almost entirely through setting the value of one
+variable, called @code{org-publish-project-alist}. Each element of the list
+configures one project, and may be in one of the two following forms:
+
+@lisp
+ ("project-name" :property value :property value ...)
+ @r{i.e. a well-formed property list with alternating keys and values}
+@r{or}
+ ("project-name" :components ("project-name" "project-name" ...))
+
+@end lisp
+
+In both cases, projects are configured by specifying property values. A
+project defines the set of files that will be published, as well as the
+publishing configuration to use when publishing those files. When a project
+takes the second form listed above, the individual members of the
+@code{:components} property are taken to be sub-projects, which group
+together files requiring different publishing options. When you publish such
+a ``meta-project'', all the components will also be published, in the
+sequence given.
+
+@node Sources and destinations, Selecting files, Project alist, Configuration
+@subsection Sources and destinations for files
+@cindex directories, for publishing
+
+Most properties are optional, but some should always be set. In
+particular, Org needs to know where to look for source files,
+and where to put published files.
+
+@multitable @columnfractions 0.3 0.7
+@item @code{:base-directory}
+@tab Directory containing publishing source files
+@item @code{:publishing-directory}
+@tab Directory where output files will be published. You can directly
+publish to a webserver using a file name syntax appropriate for
+the Emacs @file{tramp} package. Or you can publish to a local directory and
+use external tools to upload your website (@pxref{Uploading files}).
+@item @code{:preparation-function}
+@tab Function or list of functions to be called before starting the
+publishing process, for example, to run @code{make} for updating files to be
+published. The project property list is scoped into this call as the
+variable @code{project-plist}.
+@item @code{:completion-function}
+@tab Function or list of functions called after finishing the publishing
+process, for example, to change permissions of the resulting files. The
+project property list is scoped into this call as the variable
+@code{project-plist}.
+@end multitable
+@noindent
+
+@node Selecting files, Publishing action, Sources and destinations, Configuration
+@subsection Selecting files
+@cindex files, selecting for publishing
+
+By default, all files with extension @file{.org} in the base directory
+are considered part of the project. This can be modified by setting the
+properties
+@multitable @columnfractions 0.25 0.75
+@item @code{:base-extension}
+@tab Extension (without the dot!) of source files. This actually is a
+regular expression. Set this to the symbol @code{any} if you want to get all
+files in @code{:base-directory}, even without extension.
+
+@item @code{:exclude}
+@tab Regular expression to match file names that should not be
+published, even though they have been selected on the basis of their
+extension.
+
+@item @code{:include}
+@tab List of files to be included regardless of @code{:base-extension}
+and @code{:exclude}.
+
+@item @code{:recursive}
+@tab Non-nil means, check base-directory recursively for files to publish.
+@end multitable
+
+@node Publishing action, Publishing options, Selecting files, Configuration
+@subsection Publishing action
+@cindex action, for publishing
+
+Publishing means that a file is copied to the destination directory and
+possibly transformed in the process. The default transformation is to export
+Org files as HTML files, and this is done by the function
+@code{org-publish-org-to-html} which calls the HTML exporter (@pxref{HTML
+export}). But you also can publish your content as PDF files using
+@code{org-publish-org-to-pdf}, or as @code{ascii}, @code{latin1} or
+@code{utf8} encoded files using the corresponding functions. If you want to
+publish the Org file itself, but with @i{archived}, @i{commented}, and
+@i{tag-excluded} trees removed, use @code{org-publish-org-to-org} and set the
+parameters @code{:plain-source} and/or @code{:htmlized-source}. This will
+produce @file{file.org} and @file{file.org.html} in the publishing
+directory@footnote{@file{file-source.org} and @file{file-source.org.html} if
+source and publishing directories are equal. Note that with this kind of
+setup, you need to add @code{:exclude "-source\\.org"} to the project
+definition in @code{org-publish-project-alist} to prevent the published
+source files from being considered as new org files the next time the project
+is published.}. Other files like images only need to be copied to the
+publishing destination; for this you may use @code{org-publish-attachment}.
+For non-Org files, you always need to specify the publishing function:
+
+@multitable @columnfractions 0.3 0.7
+@item @code{:publishing-function}
+@tab Function executing the publication of a file. This may also be a
+list of functions, which will all be called in turn.
+@item @code{:plain-source}
+@tab Non-nil means, publish plain source.
+@item @code{:htmlized-source}
+@tab Non-nil means, publish htmlized source.
+@end multitable
+
+The function must accept three arguments: a property list containing at least
+a @code{:publishing-directory} property, the name of the file to be
+published, and the path to the publishing directory of the output file. It
+should take the specified file, make the necessary transformation (if any)
+and place the result into the destination folder.
+
+@node Publishing options, Publishing links, Publishing action, Configuration
+@subsection Options for the HTML/@LaTeX{} exporters
+@cindex options, for publishing
+
+The property list can be used to set many export options for the HTML
+and @LaTeX{} exporters. In most cases, these properties correspond to user
+variables in Org. The table below lists these properties along
+with the variable they belong to. See the documentation string for the
+respective variable for details.
+
+@vindex org-export-html-link-up
+@vindex org-export-html-link-home
+@vindex org-export-default-language
+@vindex org-display-custom-times
+@vindex org-export-headline-levels
+@vindex org-export-with-section-numbers
+@vindex org-export-section-number-format
+@vindex org-export-with-toc
+@vindex org-export-preserve-breaks
+@vindex org-export-with-archived-trees
+@vindex org-export-with-emphasize
+@vindex org-export-with-sub-superscripts
+@vindex org-export-with-special-strings
+@vindex org-export-with-footnotes
+@vindex org-export-with-drawers
+@vindex org-export-with-tags
+@vindex org-export-with-todo-keywords
+@vindex org-export-with-priority
+@vindex org-export-with-TeX-macros
+@vindex org-export-with-LaTeX-fragments
+@vindex org-export-skip-text-before-1st-heading
+@vindex org-export-with-fixed-width
+@vindex org-export-with-timestamps
+@vindex org-export-author-info
+@vindex org-export-email
+@vindex org-export-creator-info
+@vindex org-export-with-tables
+@vindex org-export-highlight-first-table-line
+@vindex org-export-html-style-include-default
+@vindex org-export-html-style
+@vindex org-export-html-style-extra
+@vindex org-export-html-link-org-files-as-html
+@vindex org-export-html-inline-images
+@vindex org-export-html-extension
+@vindex org-export-html-table-tag
+@vindex org-export-html-expand
+@vindex org-export-html-with-timestamp
+@vindex org-export-publishing-directory
+@vindex org-export-html-preamble
+@vindex org-export-html-postamble
+@vindex org-export-html-auto-preamble
+@vindex org-export-html-auto-postamble
+@vindex user-full-name
+@vindex user-mail-address
+@vindex org-export-select-tags
+@vindex org-export-exclude-tags
+
+@multitable @columnfractions 0.32 0.68
+@item @code{:link-up} @tab @code{org-export-html-link-up}
+@item @code{:link-home} @tab @code{org-export-html-link-home}
+@item @code{:language} @tab @code{org-export-default-language}
+@item @code{:customtime} @tab @code{org-display-custom-times}
+@item @code{:headline-levels} @tab @code{org-export-headline-levels}
+@item @code{:section-numbers} @tab @code{org-export-with-section-numbers}
+@item @code{:section-number-format} @tab @code{org-export-section-number-format}
+@item @code{:table-of-contents} @tab @code{org-export-with-toc}
+@item @code{:preserve-breaks} @tab @code{org-export-preserve-breaks}
+@item @code{:archived-trees} @tab @code{org-export-with-archived-trees}
+@item @code{:emphasize} @tab @code{org-export-with-emphasize}
+@item @code{:sub-superscript} @tab @code{org-export-with-sub-superscripts}
+@item @code{:special-strings} @tab @code{org-export-with-special-strings}
+@item @code{:footnotes} @tab @code{org-export-with-footnotes}
+@item @code{:drawers} @tab @code{org-export-with-drawers}
+@item @code{:tags} @tab @code{org-export-with-tags}
+@item @code{:todo-keywords} @tab @code{org-export-with-todo-keywords}
+@item @code{:priority} @tab @code{org-export-with-priority}
+@item @code{:TeX-macros} @tab @code{org-export-with-TeX-macros}
+@item @code{:LaTeX-fragments} @tab @code{org-export-with-LaTeX-fragments}
+@item @code{:latex-listings} @tab @code{org-export-latex-listings}
+@item @code{:skip-before-1st-heading} @tab @code{org-export-skip-text-before-1st-heading}
+@item @code{:fixed-width} @tab @code{org-export-with-fixed-width}
+@item @code{:timestamps} @tab @code{org-export-with-timestamps}
+@item @code{:author-info} @tab @code{org-export-author-info}
+@item @code{:email-info} @tab @code{org-export-email-info}
+@item @code{:creator-info} @tab @code{org-export-creator-info}
+@item @code{:tables} @tab @code{org-export-with-tables}
+@item @code{:table-auto-headline} @tab @code{org-export-highlight-first-table-line}
+@item @code{:style-include-default} @tab @code{org-export-html-style-include-default}
+@item @code{:style} @tab @code{org-export-html-style}
+@item @code{:style-extra} @tab @code{org-export-html-style-extra}
+@item @code{:convert-org-links} @tab @code{org-export-html-link-org-files-as-html}
+@item @code{:inline-images} @tab @code{org-export-html-inline-images}
+@item @code{:html-extension} @tab @code{org-export-html-extension}
+@item @code{:xml-declaration} @tab @code{org-export-html-xml-declaration}
+@item @code{:html-table-tag} @tab @code{org-export-html-table-tag}
+@item @code{:expand-quoted-html} @tab @code{org-export-html-expand}
+@item @code{:timestamp} @tab @code{org-export-html-with-timestamp}
+@item @code{:publishing-directory} @tab @code{org-export-publishing-directory}
+@item @code{:preamble} @tab @code{org-export-html-preamble}
+@item @code{:postamble} @tab @code{org-export-html-postamble}
+@item @code{:auto-preamble} @tab @code{org-export-html-auto-preamble}
+@item @code{:auto-postamble} @tab @code{org-export-html-auto-postamble}
+@item @code{:author} @tab @code{user-full-name}
+@item @code{:email} @tab @code{user-mail-address} : @code{addr;addr;..}
+@item @code{:select-tags} @tab @code{org-export-select-tags}
+@item @code{:exclude-tags} @tab @code{org-export-exclude-tags}
+@item @code{:latex-image-options} @tab @code{org-export-latex-image-default-option}
+@end multitable
+
+Most of the @code{org-export-with-*} variables have the same effect in
+both HTML and @LaTeX{} exporters, except for @code{:TeX-macros} and
+@code{:LaTeX-fragments}, respectively @code{nil} and @code{t} in the
+@LaTeX{} export.
+
+@vindex org-publish-project-alist
+When a property is given a value in @code{org-publish-project-alist},
+its setting overrides the value of the corresponding user variable (if
+any) during publishing. Options set within a file (@pxref{Export
+options}), however, override everything.
+
+@node Publishing links, Sitemap, Publishing options, Configuration
+@subsection Links between published files
+@cindex links, publishing
+
+To create a link from one Org file to another, you would use
+something like @samp{[[file:foo.org][The foo]]} or simply
+@samp{file:foo.org.} (@pxref{Hyperlinks}). When published, this link
+becomes a link to @file{foo.html}. In this way, you can interlink the
+pages of your "org web" project and the links will work as expected when
+you publish them to HTML. If you also publish the Org source file and want
+to link to that, use an @code{http:} link instead of a @code{file:} link,
+because @code{file:} links are converted to link to the corresponding
+@file{html} file.
+
+You may also link to related files, such as images. Provided you are careful
+with relative file names, and provided you have also configured Org to upload
+the related files, these links will work too. See @ref{Complex example}, for
+an example of this usage.
+
+Sometimes an Org file to be published may contain links that are
+only valid in your production environment, but not in the publishing
+location. In this case, use the property
+
+@multitable @columnfractions 0.4 0.6
+@item @code{:link-validation-function}
+@tab Function to validate links
+@end multitable
+
+@noindent
+to define a function for checking link validity. This function must
+accept two arguments, the file name and a directory relative to which
+the file name is interpreted in the production environment. If this
+function returns @code{nil}, then the HTML generator will only insert a
+description into the HTML file, but no link. One option for this
+function is @code{org-publish-validate-link} which checks if the given
+file is part of any project in @code{org-publish-project-alist}.
+
+@node Sitemap, Generating an index, Publishing links, Configuration
+@subsection Generating a sitemap
+@cindex sitemap, of published pages
+
+The following properties may be used to control publishing of
+a map of files for a given project.
+
+@multitable @columnfractions 0.35 0.65
+@item @code{:auto-sitemap}
+@tab When non-nil, publish a sitemap during @code{org-publish-current-project}
+or @code{org-publish-all}.
+
+@item @code{:sitemap-filename}
+@tab Filename for output of sitemap. Defaults to @file{sitemap.org} (which
+becomes @file{sitemap.html}).
+
+@item @code{:sitemap-title}
+@tab Title of sitemap page. Defaults to name of file.
+
+@item @code{:sitemap-function}
+@tab Plug-in function to use for generation of the sitemap.
+Defaults to @code{org-publish-org-sitemap}, which generates a plain list
+of links to all files in the project.
+
+@item @code{:sitemap-sort-folders}
+@tab Where folders should appear in the sitemap. Set this to @code{first}
+(default) or @code{last} to display folders first or last,
+respectively. Any other value will mix files and folders.
+
+@item @code{:sitemap-alphabetically}
+@tab The site map is normally sorted alphabetically. Set this explicitly to
+@code{nil} to turn off sorting.
+
+@item @code{:sitemap-ignore-case}
+@tab Should sorting be case-sensitive? Default @code{nil}.
+
+@end multitable
+
+@node Generating an index, , Sitemap, Configuration
+@subsection Generating an index
+@cindex index, in a publishing project
+
+Org-mode can generate an index across the files of a publishing project.
+
+@multitable @columnfractions 0.25 0.75
+@item @code{:makeindex}
+@tab When non-nil, generate in index in the file @file{theindex.org} and
+publish it as @file{theindex.html}.
+@end multitable
+
+The file will be create when first publishing a project with the
+@code{:makeindex} set. The file only contains a statement @code{#+include:
+"theindex.inc"}. You can then built around this include statement by adding
+a title, style information etc.
+
+@node Uploading files, Sample configuration, Configuration, Publishing
+@section Uploading files
+@cindex rsync
+@cindex unison
+
+For those people already utilizing third party sync tools such as
+@command{rsync} or @command{unison}, it might be preferable not to use the built in
+@i{remote} publishing facilities of Org-mode which rely heavily on
+Tramp. Tramp, while very useful and powerful, tends not to be
+so efficient for multiple file transfer and has been known to cause problems
+under heavy usage.
+
+Specialized synchronization utilities offer several advantages. In addition
+to timestamp comparison, they also do content and permissions/attribute
+checks. For this reason you might prefer to publish your web to a local
+directory (possibly even @i{in place} with your Org files) and then use
+@file{unison} or @file{rsync} to do the synchronization with the remote host.
+
+Since Unison (for example) can be configured as to which files to transfer to
+a certain remote destination, it can greatly simplify the project publishing
+definition. Simply keep all files in the correct location, process your Org
+files with @code{org-publish} and let the synchronization tool do the rest.
+You do not need, in this scenario, to include attachments such as @file{jpg},
+@file{css} or @file{gif} files in the project definition since the 3rd party
+tool syncs them.
+
+Publishing to a local directory is also much faster than to a remote one, so
+that you can afford more easily to republish entire projects. If you set
+@code{org-publish-use-timestamps-flag} to @code{nil}, you gain the main
+benefit of re-including any changed external files such as source example
+files you might include with @code{#+INCLUDE}. The timestamp mechanism in
+Org is not smart enough to detect if included files have been modified.
+
+@node Sample configuration, Triggering publication, Uploading files, Publishing
+@section Sample configuration
+
+Below we provide two example configurations. The first one is a simple
+project publishing only a set of Org files. The second example is
+more complex, with a multi-component project.
+
+@menu
+* Simple example:: One-component publishing
+* Complex example:: A multi-component publishing example
+@end menu
+
+@node Simple example, Complex example, Sample configuration, Sample configuration
+@subsection Example: simple publishing configuration
+
+This example publishes a set of Org files to the @file{public_html}
+directory on the local machine.
+
+@lisp
+(setq org-publish-project-alist
+ '(("org"
+ :base-directory "~/org/"
+ :publishing-directory "~/public_html"
+ :section-numbers nil
+ :table-of-contents nil
+ :style "<link rel=\"stylesheet\"
+ href=\"../other/mystyle.css\"
+ type=\"text/css\"/>")))
+@end lisp
+
+@node Complex example, , Simple example, Sample configuration
+@subsection Example: complex publishing configuration
+
+This more complicated example publishes an entire website, including
+Org files converted to HTML, image files, Emacs Lisp source code, and
+style sheets. The publishing directory is remote and private files are
+excluded.
+
+To ensure that links are preserved, care should be taken to replicate
+your directory structure on the web server, and to use relative file
+paths. For example, if your Org files are kept in @file{~/org} and your
+publishable images in @file{~/images}, you would link to an image with
+@c
+@example
+file:../images/myimage.png
+@end example
+@c
+On the web server, the relative path to the image should be the
+same. You can accomplish this by setting up an "images" folder in the
+right place on the web server, and publishing images to it.
+
+@lisp
+(setq org-publish-project-alist
+ '(("orgfiles"
+ :base-directory "~/org/"
+ :base-extension "org"
+ :publishing-directory "/ssh:user@@host:~/html/notebook/"
+ :publishing-function org-publish-org-to-html
+ :exclude "PrivatePage.org" ;; regexp
+ :headline-levels 3
+ :section-numbers nil
+ :table-of-contents nil
+ :style "<link rel=\"stylesheet\"
+ href=\"../other/mystyle.css\" type=\"text/css\"/>"
+ :auto-preamble t
+ :auto-postamble nil)
+
+ ("images"
+ :base-directory "~/images/"
+ :base-extension "jpg\\|gif\\|png"
+ :publishing-directory "/ssh:user@@host:~/html/images/"
+ :publishing-function org-publish-attachment)
+
+ ("other"
+ :base-directory "~/other/"
+ :base-extension "css\\|el"
+ :publishing-directory "/ssh:user@@host:~/html/other/"
+ :publishing-function org-publish-attachment)
+ ("website" :components ("orgfiles" "images" "other"))))
+@end lisp
+
+@node Triggering publication, , Sample configuration, Publishing
+@section Triggering publication
+
+Once properly configured, Org can publish with the following commands:
+
+@table @kbd
+@orgcmd{C-c C-e X,org-publish}
+Prompt for a specific project and publish all files that belong to it.
+@orgcmd{C-c C-e P,org-publish-current-project}
+Publish the project containing the current file.
+@orgcmd{C-c C-e F,org-publish-current-file}
+Publish only the current file.
+@orgcmd{C-c C-e E,org-publish-all}
+Publish every project.
+@end table
+
+@vindex org-publish-use-timestamps-flag
+Org uses timestamps to track when a file has changed. The above functions
+normally only publish changed files. You can override this and force
+publishing of all files by giving a prefix argument to any of the commands
+above, or by customizing the variable @code{org-publish-use-timestamps-flag}.
+This may be necessary in particular if files include other files via
+@code{#+SETUPFILE:} or @code{#+INCLUDE:}.
+
+@comment node-name, next, previous, up
+@comment Working With Source Code, Miscellaneous, Publishing, Top
+
+@node Working With Source Code, Miscellaneous, Publishing, Top
+@chapter Working with source code
+@cindex Schulte, Eric
+@cindex Davison, Dan
+@cindex source code, working with
+
+Source code can be included in Org-mode documents using a @samp{src} block,
+e.g.
+
+@example
+#+BEGIN_SRC emacs-lisp
+ (defun org-xor (a b)
+ "Exclusive or."
+ (if a (not b) b))
+#+END_SRC
+@end example
+
+Org-mode provides a number of features for working with live source code,
+including editing of code blocks in their native major-mode, evaluation of
+code blocks, tangling of code blocks, and exporting code blocks and their
+results in several formats. This functionality was contributed by Eric
+Schulte and Dan Davison, and was originally named Org-babel.
+
+The following sections describe Org-mode's code block handling facilities.
+
+@menu
+* Structure of code blocks:: Code block syntax described
+* Editing source code:: Language major-mode editing
+* Exporting code blocks:: Export contents and/or results
+* Extracting source code:: Create pure source code files
+* Evaluating code blocks:: Place results of evaluation in the Org-mode buffer
+* Library of Babel:: Use and contribute to a library of useful code blocks
+* Languages:: List of supported code block languages
+* Header arguments:: Configure code block functionality
+* Results of evaluation:: How evaluation results are handled
+* Noweb reference syntax:: Literate programming in Org-mode
+* Key bindings and useful functions:: Work quickly with code blocks
+* Batch execution:: Call functions from the command line
+@end menu
+
+@comment node-name, next, previous, up
+@comment Structure of code blocks, Editing source code, Working With Source Code, Working With Source Code
+
+@node Structure of code blocks, Editing source code, Working With Source Code, Working With Source Code
+@section Structure of code blocks
+@cindex code block, structure
+@cindex source code, block structure
+
+The structure of code blocks is as follows:
+
+@example
+#+srcname: <name>
+#+begin_src <language> <switches> <header arguments>
+ <body>
+#+end_src
+@end example
+
+code blocks can also be embedded in text as so called inline code blocks as
+
+@example
+src_<language>@{<body>@}
+@end example
+
+or
+
+@example
+src_<language>[<header arguments>]@{<body>@}
+@end example
+
+@table @code
+@item <name>
+This name is associated with the code block. This is similar to the
+@samp{#+tblname} lines that can be used to name tables in Org-mode files.
+Referencing the name of a code block makes it possible to evaluate the
+block from other places in the file, other files, or from Org-mode table
+formulas (see @ref{The spreadsheet}).
+@item <language>
+The language of the code in the block.
+@item <switches>
+Switches controlling exportation of the code block (see switches discussion in
+@ref{Literal examples})
+@item <header arguments>
+Optional header arguments control many aspects of evaluation, export and
+tangling of code blocks. See the @ref{Header arguments}
+section. Header arguments can also be set on a per-buffer or per-subtree
+basis using properties.
+@item <body>
+The source code.
+@end table
+
+@comment node-name, next, previous, up
+@comment Editing source code, Exporting code blocks, Structure of code blocks, Working With Source Code
+
+@node Editing source code, Exporting code blocks, Structure of code blocks, Working With Source Code
+@section Editing source code
+@cindex code block, editing
+@cindex source code, editing
+
+@kindex C-c '
+Use @kbd{C-c '} to edit the current code block. This brings up
+a language major-mode edit buffer containing the body of the code
+block. Saving this buffer will write the new contents back to the Org
+buffer. Use @kbd{C-c '} again to exit.
+
+The @code{org-src-mode} minor mode will be active in the edit buffer. The
+following variables can be used to configure the behavior of the edit
+buffer. See also the customization group @code{org-edit-structure} for
+further configuration options.
+
+@table @code
+@item org-src-lang-modes
+If an Emacs major-mode named @code{<lang>-mode} exists, where
+@code{<lang>} is the language named in the header line of the code block,
+then the edit buffer will be placed in that major-mode. This variable
+can be used to map arbitrary language names to existing major modes.
+@item org-src-window-setup
+Controls the way Emacs windows are rearranged when the edit buffer is created.
+@item org-src-preserve-indentation
+This variable is especially useful for tangling languages such as
+Python, in which whitespace indentation in the output is critical.
+@item org-src-ask-before-returning-to-edit-buffer
+By default, Org will ask before returning to an open edit buffer. Set
+this variable to nil to switch without asking.
+@end table
+
+@comment node-name, next, previous, up
+@comment Exporting code blocks, Extracting source code, Editing source code, Working With Source Code
+
+@node Exporting code blocks, Extracting source code, Editing source code, Working With Source Code
+@section Exporting code blocks
+@cindex code block, exporting
+@cindex source code, exporting
+
+It is possible to export the @emph{contents} of code blocks, the
+@emph{results} of code block evaluation, @emph{neither}, or @emph{both}. For
+most languages, the default exports the contents of code blocks. However, for
+some languages (e.g. @code{ditaa}) the default exports the results of code
+block evaluation. For information on exporting code block bodies, see
+@ref{Literal examples}.
+
+The @code{:exports} header argument can be used to specify export
+behavior:
+
+@subsubheading Header arguments:
+@table @code
+@item :exports code
+The default in most languages. The body of the code block is exported, as
+described in @ref{Literal examples}.
+@item :exports results
+The code block will be evaluated and the results will be placed in the
+Org-mode buffer for export, either updating previous results of the code
+block located anywhere in the buffer or, if no previous results exist,
+placing the results immediately after the code block. The body of the code
+block will not be exported.
+@item :exports both
+Both the code block and its results will be exported.
+@item :exports none
+Neither the code block nor its results will be exported.
+@end table
+
+It is possible to inhibit the evaluation of code blocks during export.
+Setting the @code{org-export-babel-evaluate} variable to @code{nil} will
+ensure that no code blocks are evaluated as part of the export process. This
+can be useful in situations where potentially untrusted Org-mode files are
+exported in an automated fashion, for example when Org-mode is used as the
+markup language for a wiki.
+
+@comment node-name, next, previous, up
+@comment Extracting source code, Evaluating code blocks, Exporting code blocks, Working With Source Code
+@node Extracting source code, Evaluating code blocks, Exporting code blocks, Working With Source Code
+@section Extracting source code
+@cindex source code, extracting
+@cindex code block, extracting source code
+
+Creating pure source code files by extracting code from source blocks is
+referred to as ``tangling''---a term adopted from the literate programming
+community. During ``tangling'' of code blocks their bodies are expanded
+using @code{org-babel-expand-src-block} which can expand both variable and
+``noweb'' style references (see @ref{Noweb reference syntax}).
+
+@subsubheading Header arguments
+@table @code
+@item :tangle no
+The default. The code block is not included in the tangled output.
+@item :tangle yes
+Include the code block in the tangled output. The output file name is the
+name of the org file with the extension @samp{.org} replaced by the extension
+for the block language.
+@item :tangle filename
+Include the code block in the tangled output to file @samp{filename}.
+@end table
+
+@kindex C-c C-v t
+@subsubheading Functions
+@table @code
+@item org-babel-tangle
+Tangle the current file. Bound to @kbd{C-c C-v t}.
+@item org-babel-tangle-file
+Choose a file to tangle. Bound to @kbd{C-c C-v f}.
+@end table
+
+@subsubheading Hooks
+@table @code
+@item org-babel-post-tangle-hook
+This hook is run from within code files tangled by @code{org-babel-tangle}.
+Example applications could include post-processing, compilation or evaluation
+of tangled code files.
+@end table
+
+@node Evaluating code blocks, Library of Babel, Extracting source code, Working With Source Code
+@section Evaluating code blocks
+@cindex code block, evaluating
+@cindex source code, evaluating
+
+Code blocks can be evaluated@footnote{Whenever code is evaluated there is a
+potential for that code to do harm. Org-mode provides a number of safeguards
+to ensure that it only evaluates code with explicit confirmation from the
+user. For information on these safeguards (and on how to disable them) see
+@ref{Code evaluation security}.} and the results placed in the Org-mode
+buffer. By default, evaluation is only turned on for @code{emacs-lisp} code
+blocks, however support exists for evaluating blocks in many languages. See
+@ref{Languages} for a list of supported languages. See @ref{Structure of
+code blocks} for information on the syntax used to define a code block.
+
+@kindex C-c C-c
+There are a number of ways to evaluate code blocks. The simplest is to press
+@kbd{C-c C-c} or @kbd{C-c C-v e} with the point on a code block@footnote{The
+@code{org-babel-no-eval-on-ctrl-c-ctrl-c} variable can be used to remove code
+evaluation from the @kbd{C-c C-c} key binding.}. This will call the
+@code{org-babel-execute-src-block} function to evaluate the block and insert
+its results into the Org-mode buffer.
+
+It is also possible to evaluate named code blocks from anywhere in an
+Org-mode buffer or an Org-mode table. @code{#+call} (or synonymously
+@code{#+function} or @code{#+lob}) lines can be used to remotely execute code
+blocks located in the current Org-mode buffer or in the ``Library of Babel''
+(see @ref{Library of Babel}). These lines use the following syntax.
+
+@example
+#+call: <name>(<arguments>) <header arguments>
+#+function: <name>(<arguments>) <header arguments>
+#+lob: <name>(<arguments>) <header arguments>
+@end example
+
+@table @code
+@item <name>
+The name of the code block to be evaluated.
+@item <arguments>
+Arguments specified in this section will be passed to the code block.
+@item <header arguments>
+Header arguments can be placed after the function invocation. See
+@ref{Header arguments} for more information on header arguments.
+@end table
+
+
+@node Library of Babel, Languages, Evaluating code blocks, Working With Source Code
+@section Library of Babel
+@cindex babel, library of
+@cindex source code, library
+@cindex code block, library
+
+The ``Library of Babel'' is a library of code blocks
+that can be called from any Org-mode file. The library is housed in an
+Org-mode file located in the @samp{contrib} directory of Org-mode.
+Org-mode users can deposit functions they believe to be generally
+useful in the library.
+
+Code blocks defined in the ``Library of Babel'' can be called remotely as if
+they were in the current Org-mode buffer (see @ref{Evaluating code blocks}
+for information on the syntax of remote code block evaluation).
+
+@kindex C-c C-v i
+Code blocks located in any Org-mode file can be loaded into the ``Library of
+Babel'' with the @code{org-babel-lob-ingest} function, bound to @kbd{C-c C-v
+i}.
+
+@node Languages, Header arguments, Library of Babel, Working With Source Code
+@section Languages
+@cindex babel, languages
+@cindex source code, languages
+@cindex code block, languages
+
+Code blocks in the following languages are supported.
+
+@multitable @columnfractions 0.28 0.3 0.22 0.2
+@item @b{Language} @tab @b{Identifier} @tab @b{Language} @tab @b{Identifier}
+@item Asymptote @tab asymptote @tab C @tab C
+@item C++ @tab C++ @tab Clojure @tab clojure
+@item CSS @tab css @tab ditaa @tab ditaa
+@item Graphviz @tab dot @tab Emacs Lisp @tab emacs-lisp
+@item gnuplot @tab gnuplot @tab Haskell @tab haskell
+@item LaTeX @tab latex @tab MATLAB @tab matlab
+@item Mscgen @tab mscgen @tab Objective Caml @tab ocaml
+@item Octave @tab octave @tab Oz @tab oz
+@item Perl @tab perl @tab Python @tab python
+@item R @tab R @tab Ruby @tab ruby
+@item Sass @tab sass @tab GNU Screen @tab screen
+@item shell @tab sh @tab SQL @tab sql
+@item SQLite @tab sqlite
+@end multitable
+
+Language-specific documentation is available for some languages. If
+available, it can be found at
+@uref{http://orgmode.org/worg/org-contrib/babel/languages}.
+
+The @code{org-babel-load-languages} controls which languages are enabled for
+evaluation (by default only @code{emacs-lisp} is enabled). This variable can
+be set using the customization interface or by adding code like the following
+to your emacs configuration.
+
+@quotation
+The following disables @code{emacs-lisp} evaluation and enables evaluation of
+@code{R} code blocks.
+@end quotation
+
+@lisp
+(org-babel-do-load-languages
+ 'org-babel-load-languages
+ '((emacs-lisp . nil)
+ (R . t)))
+@end lisp
+
+It is also possible to enable support for a language by loading the related
+elisp file with @code{require}.
+
+@quotation
+The following adds support for evaluating @code{clojure} code blocks.
+@end quotation
+
+@lisp
+(require 'ob-clojure)
+@end lisp
+
+@node Header arguments, Results of evaluation, Languages, Working With Source Code
+@section Header arguments
+@cindex code block, header arguments
+@cindex source code, block header arguments
+
+Code block functionality can be configured with header arguments. This
+section provides an overview of the use of header arguments, and then
+describes each header argument in detail.
+
+@menu
+* Using header arguments:: Different ways to set header arguments
+* Specific header arguments:: List of header arguments
+@end menu
+
+@node Using header arguments, Specific header arguments, Header arguments, Header arguments
+@subsection Using header arguments
+
+The values of header arguments can be set in six different ways, each more
+specific (and having higher priority) than the last.
+@menu
+* System-wide header arguments:: Set global default values
+* Language-specific header arguments:: Set default values by language
+* Buffer-wide header arguments:: Set default values for a specific buffer
+* Header arguments in Org-mode properties:: Set default values for a buffer or heading
+* Code block specific header arguments:: The most common way to set values
+* Header arguments in function calls:: The most specific level
+@end menu
+
+
+@node System-wide header arguments, Language-specific header arguments, Using header arguments, Using header arguments
+@subsubheading System-wide header arguments
+@vindex org-babel-default-header-args
+System-wide values of header arguments can be specified by customizing the
+@code{org-babel-default-header-args} variable:
+
+@example
+:session => "none"
+:results => "replace"
+:exports => "code"
+:cache => "no"
+:noweb => "no"
+@end example
+
+@c @example
+@c org-babel-default-header-args is a variable defined in `org-babel.el'.
+@c Its value is
+@c ((:session . "none")
+@c (:results . "replace")
+@c (:exports . "code")
+@c (:cache . "no")
+@c (:noweb . "no"))
+
+
+@c Documentation:
+@c Default arguments to use when evaluating a code block.
+@c @end example
+
+For example, the following example could be used to set the default value of
+@code{:noweb} header arguments to @code{yes}. This would have the effect of
+expanding @code{:noweb} references by default when evaluating source code
+blocks.
+
+@lisp
+(setq org-babel-default-header-args
+(cons '(:noweb . "yes")
+(assq-delete-all :noweb org-babel-default-header-args)))
+@end lisp
+
+@node Language-specific header arguments, Buffer-wide header arguments, System-wide header arguments, Using header arguments
+@subsubheading Language-specific header arguments
+Each language can define its own set of default header arguments. See the
+language-specific documentation available online at
+@uref{http://orgmode.org/worg/org-contrib/babel}.
+
+@node Buffer-wide header arguments, Header arguments in Org-mode properties, Language-specific header arguments, Using header arguments
+@subsubheading Buffer-wide header arguments
+Buffer-wide header arguments may be specified through the use of a special
+line placed anywhere in an Org-mode file. The line consists of the
+@code{#+BABEL:} keyword followed by a series of header arguments which may be
+specified using the standard header argument syntax.
+
+For example the following would set @code{session} to @code{*R*}, and
+@code{results} to @code{silent} for every code block in the buffer, ensuring
+that all execution took place in the same session, and no results would be
+inserted into the buffer.
+
+@example
+#+BABEL: :session *R* :results silent
+@end example
+
+@node Header arguments in Org-mode properties, Code block specific header arguments, Buffer-wide header arguments, Using header arguments
+@subsubheading Header arguments in Org-mode properties
+
+Header arguments are also read from Org-mode properties (see @ref{Property
+syntax}), which can be set on a buffer-wide or per-heading basis. An example
+of setting a header argument for all code blocks in a buffer is
+
+@example
+#+property: tangle yes
+@end example
+
+When properties are used to set default header arguments, they are looked up
+with inheritance, so the value of the @code{:cache} header argument will default
+to @code{yes} in all code blocks in the subtree rooted at the following
+heading:
+
+@example
+* outline header
+:PROPERTIES:
+:cache: yes
+:END:
+@end example
+
+@kindex C-c C-x p
+@vindex org-babel-default-header-args
+Properties defined in this way override the properties set in
+@code{org-babel-default-header-args}. It is convenient to use the
+@code{org-set-property} function bound to @kbd{C-c C-x p} to set properties
+in Org-mode documents.
+
+@node Code block specific header arguments, Header arguments in function calls, Header arguments in Org-mode properties, Using header arguments
+@subsubheading Code block specific header arguments
+
+The most common way to assign values to header arguments is at the
+code block level. This can be done by listing a sequence of header
+arguments and their values as part of the @code{#+begin_src} line.
+Properties set in this way override both the values of
+@code{org-babel-default-header-args} and header arguments specified as
+properties. In the following example, the @code{:results} header argument
+is set to @code{silent}, meaning the results of execution will not be
+inserted in the buffer, and the @code{:exports} header argument is set to
+@code{code}, meaning only the body of the code block will be
+preserved on export to HTML or LaTeX.
+
+@example
+#+source: factorial
+#+begin_src haskell :results silent :exports code :var n=0
+fac 0 = 1
+fac n = n * fac (n-1)
+#+end_src
+@end example
+Similarly, it is possible to set header arguments for inline code blocks:
+
+@example
+src_haskell[:exports both]@{fac 5@}
+@end example
+
+@node Header arguments in function calls, , Code block specific header arguments, Using header arguments
+@comment node-name, next, previous, up
+@subsubheading Header arguments in function calls
+
+At the most specific level, header arguments for ``Library of Babel'' or
+function call lines can be set as shown below:
+
+@example
+#+call: factorial(n=5) :exports results
+@end example
+
+@node Specific header arguments, , Using header arguments, Header arguments
+@subsection Specific header arguments
+The following header arguments are defined:
+
+@menu
+* var:: Pass arguments to code blocks
+* results:: Specify the type of results and how they will
+ be collected and handled
+* file:: Specify a path for file output
+* dir:: Specify the default (possibly remote)
+ directory for code block execution
+* exports:: Export code and/or results
+* tangle:: Toggle tangling and specify file name
+* comments:: Toggle insertion of comments in tangled
+ code files
+* no-expand:: Turn off variable assignment and noweb
+ expansion during tangling
+* session:: Preserve the state of code evaluation
+* noweb:: Toggle expansion of noweb references
+* cache:: Avoid re-evaluating unchanged code blocks
+* hlines:: Handle horizontal lines in tables
+* colnames:: Handle column names in tables
+* rownames:: Handle row names in tables
+* shebang:: Make tangled files executable
+* eval:: Limit evaluation of specific code blocks
+@end menu
+
+@node var, results, Specific header arguments, Specific header arguments
+@subsubsection @code{:var}
+The @code{:var} header argument is used to pass arguments to code blocks.
+The specifics of how arguments are included in a code block vary by language;
+these are addressed in the language-specific documentation. However, the
+syntax used to specify arguments is the same across all languages. The
+values passed to arguments can be literal values, values from org-mode tables
+and literal example blocks, or the results of other code blocks.
+
+These values can be indexed in a manner similar to arrays---see the
+``indexable variable values'' heading below.
+
+The following syntax is used to pass arguments to code blocks using the
+@code{:var} header argument.
+
+@example
+:var name=assign
+@end example
+
+where @code{assign} can take one of the following forms
+
+@itemize @bullet
+@item literal value
+either a string @code{"string"} or a number @code{9}.
+@item reference
+a table name:
+
+@example
+#+tblname: example-table
+| 1 |
+| 2 |
+| 3 |
+| 4 |
+
+#+source: table-length
+#+begin_src emacs-lisp :var table=example-table
+(length table)
+#+end_src
+
+#+results: table-length
+: 4
+@end example
+
+a code block name, as assigned by @code{#+srcname:}, followed by
+parentheses:
+
+@example
+#+begin_src emacs-lisp :var length=table-length()
+(* 2 length)
+#+end_src
+
+#+results:
+: 8
+@end example
+
+In addition, an argument can be passed to the code block referenced
+by @code{:var}. The argument is passed within the parentheses following the
+code block name:
+
+@example
+#+source: double
+#+begin_src emacs-lisp :var input=8
+(* 2 input)
+#+end_src
+
+#+results: double
+: 16
+
+#+source: squared
+#+begin_src emacs-lisp :var input=double(input=1)
+(* input input)
+#+end_src
+
+#+results: squared
+: 4
+@end example
+@end itemize
+
+@subsubheading Alternate argument syntax
+It is also possible to specify arguments in a potentially more natural way
+using the @code{#+source:} line of a code block. As in the following
+example arguments can be packed inside of parenthesis, separated by commas,
+following the source name.
+
+@example
+#+source: double(input=0, x=2)
+#+begin_src emacs-lisp
+(* 2 (+ input x))
+#+end_src
+@end example
+
+@subsubheading Indexable variable values
+It is possible to reference portions of variable values by ``indexing'' into
+the variables. Indexes are 0 based with negative values counting back from
+the end. If an index is separated by @code{,}s then each subsequent section
+will index into the next deepest nesting or dimension of the value. The
+following example assigns the last cell of the first row the table
+@code{example-table} to the variable @code{data}:
+
+@example
+#+results: example-table
+| 1 | a |
+| 2 | b |
+| 3 | c |
+| 4 | d |
+
+#+begin_src emacs-lisp :var data=example-table[0,-1]
+ data
+#+end_src
+
+#+results:
+: a
+@end example
+
+Ranges of variable values can be referenced using two integers separated by a
+@code{:}, in which case the entire inclusive range is referenced. For
+example the following assigns the middle three rows of @code{example-table}
+to @code{data}.
+
+@example
+#+results: example-table
+| 1 | a |
+| 2 | b |
+| 3 | c |
+| 4 | d |
+| 5 | 3 |
+
+#+begin_src emacs-lisp :var data=example-table[1:3]
+ data
+#+end_src
+
+#+results:
+| 2 | b |
+| 3 | c |
+| 4 | d |
+@end example
+
+Additionally, an empty index, or the single character @code{*}, are both
+interpreted to mean the entire range and as such are equivalent to
+@code{0:-1}, as shown in the following example in which the entire first
+column is referenced.
+
+@example
+#+results: example-table
+| 1 | a |
+| 2 | b |
+| 3 | c |
+| 4 | d |
+
+#+begin_src emacs-lisp :var data=example-table[,0]
+ data
+#+end_src
+
+#+results:
+| 1 | 2 | 3 | 4 |
+@end example
+
+It is possible to index into the results of code blocks as well as tables.
+Any number of dimensions can be indexed. Dimensions are separated from one
+another by commas, as shown in the following example.
+
+@example
+#+source: 3D
+#+begin_src emacs-lisp
+ '(((1 2 3) (4 5 6) (7 8 9))
+ ((10 11 12) (13 14 15) (16 17 18))
+ ((19 20 21) (22 23 24) (25 26 27)))
+#+end_src
+
+#+begin_src emacs-lisp :var data=3D[1,,1]
+ data
+#+end_src
+
+#+results:
+| 11 | 14 | 17 |
+@end example
+
+@node results, file, var, Specific header arguments
+@subsubsection @code{:results}
+
+There are three classes of @code{:results} header argument. Only one option
+per class may be supplied per code block.
+
+@itemize @bullet
+@item
+@b{collection} header arguments specify how the results should be collected
+from the code block
+@item
+@b{type} header arguments specify what type of result the code block will
+return---which has implications for how they will be inserted into the
+Org-mode buffer
+@item
+@b{handling} header arguments specify how the results of evaluating the code
+block should be handled.
+@end itemize
+
+@subsubheading Collection
+The following options are mutually exclusive, and specify how the results
+should be collected from the code block.
+
+@itemize @bullet
+@item @code{value}
+This is the default. The result is the value of the last statement in the
+code block. This header argument places the evaluation in functional
+mode. Note that in some languages, e.g., Python, use of this result type
+requires that a @code{return} statement be included in the body of the source
+code block. E.g., @code{:results value}.
+@item @code{output}
+The result is the collection of everything printed to STDOUT during the
+execution of the code block. This header argument places the
+evaluation in scripting mode. E.g., @code{:results output}.
+@end itemize
+
+@subsubheading Type
+
+The following options are mutually exclusive and specify what type of results
+the code block will return. By default, results are inserted as either a
+table or scalar depending on their value.
+
+@itemize @bullet
+@item @code{table}, @code{vector}
+The results should be interpreted as an Org-mode table. If a single value is
+returned, it will be converted into a table with one row and one column.
+E.g., @code{:results value table}.
+@item @code{list}
+The results should be interpreted as an Org-mode list. If a single scalar
+value is returned it will be converted into a list with only one element.
+@item @code{scalar}, @code{verbatim}
+The results should be interpreted literally---they will not be
+converted into a table. The results will be inserted into the Org-mode
+buffer as quoted text. E.g., @code{:results value verbatim}.
+@item @code{file}
+The results will be interpreted as the path to a file, and will be inserted
+into the Org-mode buffer as a file link. E.g., @code{:results value file}.
+@item @code{raw}, @code{org}
+The results are interpreted as raw Org-mode code and are inserted directly
+into the buffer. If the results look like a table they will be aligned as
+such by Org-mode. E.g., @code{:results value raw}.
+@item @code{html}
+Results are assumed to be HTML and will be enclosed in a @code{begin_html}
+block. E.g., @code{:results value html}.
+@item @code{latex}
+Results assumed to be LaTeX and are enclosed in a @code{begin_latex} block.
+E.g., @code{:results value latex}.
+@item @code{code}
+Result are assumed to be parseable code and are enclosed in a code block.
+E.g., @code{:results value code}.
+@item @code{pp}
+The result is converted to pretty-printed code and is enclosed in a code
+block. This option currently supports Emacs Lisp, Python, and Ruby. E.g.,
+@code{:results value pp}.
+@end itemize
+
+@subsubheading Handling
+The following results options indicate what happens with the
+results once they are collected.
+
+@itemize @bullet
+@item @code{silent}
+The results will be echoed in the minibuffer but will not be inserted into
+the Org-mode buffer. E.g., @code{:results output silent}.
+@item @code{replace}
+The default value. Any existing results will be removed, and the new results
+will be inserted into the Org-mode buffer in their place. E.g.,
+@code{:results output replace}.
+@item @code{append}
+If there are pre-existing results of the code block then the new results will
+be appended to the existing results. Otherwise the new results will be
+inserted as with @code{replace}.
+@item @code{prepend}
+If there are pre-existing results of the code block then the new results will
+be prepended to the existing results. Otherwise the new results will be
+inserted as with @code{replace}.
+@end itemize
+
+@node file, dir, results, Specific header arguments
+@subsubsection @code{:file}
+
+The header argument @code{:file} is used to specify a path for file output.
+An Org-mode style @code{file:} link is inserted into the buffer as the result
+(see @ref{Link format}). Common examples are graphical output from R,
+gnuplot, ditaa and LaTeX code blocks.
+
+Note that for some languages, including R, gnuplot, LaTeX and ditaa,
+graphical output is sent to the specified file without the file being
+referenced explicitly in the code block. See the documentation for the
+individual languages for details. In contrast, general purpose languages such
+as Python and Ruby require that the code explicitly create output
+corresponding to the path indicated by @code{:file}.
+
+
+@node dir, exports, file, Specific header arguments
+@subsubsection @code{:dir} and remote execution
+
+While the @code{:file} header argument can be used to specify the path to the
+output file, @code{:dir} specifies the default directory during code block
+execution. If it is absent, then the directory associated with the current
+buffer is used. In other words, supplying @code{:dir path} temporarily has
+the same effect as changing the current directory with @kbd{M-x cd path}, and
+then not supplying @code{:dir}. Under the surface, @code{:dir} simply sets
+the value of the Emacs variable @code{default-directory}.
+
+When using @code{:dir}, you should supply a relative path for file output
+(e.g. @code{:file myfile.jpg} or @code{:file results/myfile.jpg}) in which
+case that path will be interpreted relative to the default directory.
+
+In other words, if you want your plot to go into a folder called @file{Work}
+in your home directory, you could use
+
+@example
+#+begin_src R :file myplot.png :dir ~/Work
+matplot(matrix(rnorm(100), 10), type="l")
+#+end_src
+@end example
+
+@subsubheading Remote execution
+A directory on a remote machine can be specified using tramp file syntax, in
+which case the code will be evaluated on the remote machine. An example is
+
+@example
+#+begin_src R :file plot.png :dir /dand@@yakuba.princeton.edu:
+plot(1:10, main=system("hostname", intern=TRUE))
+#+end_src
+@end example
+
+Text results will be returned to the local Org-mode buffer as usual, and file
+output will be created on the remote machine with relative paths interpreted
+relative to the remote directory. An Org-mode link to the remote file will be
+created.
+
+So, in the above example a plot will be created on the remote machine,
+and a link of the following form will be inserted in the org buffer:
+
+@example
+[[file:/scp:dand@@yakuba.princeton.edu:/home/dand/plot.png][plot.png]]
+@end example
+
+Most of this functionality follows immediately from the fact that @code{:dir}
+sets the value of the Emacs variable @code{default-directory}, thanks to
+tramp. Those using XEmacs, or GNU Emacs prior to version 23 may need to
+install tramp separately in order for these features to work correctly.
+
+@subsubheading Further points
+
+@itemize @bullet
+@item
+If @code{:dir} is used in conjunction with @code{:session}, although it will
+determine the starting directory for a new session as expected, no attempt is
+currently made to alter the directory associated with an existing session.
+@item
+@code{:dir} should typically not be used to create files during export with
+@code{:exports results} or @code{:exports both}. The reason is that, in order
+to retain portability of exported material between machines, during export
+links inserted into the buffer will *not* be expanded against @code{default
+directory}. Therefore, if @code{default-directory} is altered using
+@code{:dir}, it is probable that the file will be created in a location to
+which the link does not point.
+@end itemize
+
+@node exports, tangle, dir, Specific header arguments
+@subsubsection @code{:exports}
+
+The @code{:exports} header argument specifies what should be included in HTML
+or LaTeX exports of the Org-mode file.
+
+@itemize @bullet
+@item @code{code}
+The default. The body of code is included into the exported file. E.g.,
+@code{:exports code}.
+@item @code{results}
+The result of evaluating the code is included in the exported file. E.g.,
+@code{:exports results}.
+@item @code{both}
+Both the code and results are included in the exported file. E.g.,
+@code{:exports both}.
+@item @code{none}
+Nothing is included in the exported file. E.g., @code{:exports none}.
+@end itemize
+
+@node tangle, comments, exports, Specific header arguments
+@subsubsection @code{:tangle}
+
+The @code{:tangle} header argument specifies whether or not the code
+block should be included in tangled extraction of source code files.
+
+@itemize @bullet
+@item @code{tangle}
+The code block is exported to a source code file named after the
+basename (name w/o extension) of the Org-mode file. E.g., @code{:tangle
+yes}.
+@item @code{no}
+The default. The code block is not exported to a source code file.
+E.g., @code{:tangle no}.
+@item other
+Any other string passed to the @code{:tangle} header argument is interpreted
+as a file basename to which the block will be exported. E.g., @code{:tangle
+basename}.
+@end itemize
+
+@node comments, no-expand, tangle, Specific header arguments
+@subsubsection @code{:comments}
+By default code blocks are tangled to source-code files without any insertion
+of comments beyond those which may already exist in the body of the code
+block. The @code{:comments} header argument can be set as follows to control
+the insertion of extra comments into the tangled code file.
+
+@itemize @bullet
+@item @code{no}
+The default. No extra comments are inserted during tangling.
+@item @code{link}
+The code block is wrapped in comments which contain pointers back to the
+original Org file from which the code was tangled.
+@item @code{yes}
+A synonym for ``link'' to maintain backwards compatibility.
+@item @code{org}
+Include text from the org-mode file as a comment.
+
+The text is picked from the leading context of the tangled code and is
+limited by the nearest headline or source block as the case may be.
+@item @code{both}
+Turns on both the ``link'' and ``org'' comment options.
+@end itemize
+
+@node no-expand, session, comments, Specific header arguments
+@subsubsection @code{:no-expand}
+
+By default, code blocks are expanded with @code{org-babel-expand-src-block}
+during tangling. This has the effect of assigning values to variables
+specified with @code{:var} (see @ref{var}), and of replacing ``noweb''
+references (see @ref{Noweb reference syntax}) with their targets. The
+@code{:no-expand} header argument can be used to turn off this behavior.
+
+@node session, noweb, no-expand, Specific header arguments
+@subsubsection @code{:session}
+
+The @code{:session} header argument starts a session for an interpreted
+language where state is preserved.
+
+By default, a session is not started.
+
+A string passed to the @code{:session} header argument will give the session
+a name. This makes it possible to run concurrent sessions for each
+interpreted language.
+
+@node noweb, cache, session, Specific header arguments
+@subsubsection @code{:noweb}
+
+The @code{:noweb} header argument controls expansion of ``noweb'' style (see
+@ref{Noweb reference syntax}) references in a code block. This header
+argument can have one of three values: @code{yes} @code{no} or @code{tangle}.
+
+@itemize @bullet
+@item @code{yes}
+All ``noweb'' syntax references in the body of the code block will be
+expanded before the block is evaluated, tangled or exported.
+@item @code{no}
+The default. No ``noweb'' syntax specific action is taken on evaluating
+code blocks, However, noweb references will still be expanded during
+tangling.
+@item @code{tangle}
+All ``noweb'' syntax references in the body of the code block will be
+expanded before the block is tangled, however ``noweb'' references will not
+be expanded when the block is evaluated or exported.
+@end itemize
+
+@subsubheading Noweb prefix lines
+Noweb insertions are now placed behind the line prefix of the
+@code{<<reference>>}.
+This behavior is illustrated in the following example. Because the
+@code{<<example>>} noweb reference appears behind the SQL comment syntax,
+each line of the expanded noweb reference will be commented.
+
+This code block:
+
+@example
+-- <<example>>
+@end example
+
+
+expands to:
+
+@example
+-- this is the
+-- multi-line body of example
+@end example
+
+Note that noweb replacement text that does not contain any newlines will not
+be affected by this change, so it is still possible to use inline noweb
+references.
+
+@node cache, hlines, noweb, Specific header arguments
+@subsubsection @code{:cache}
+
+The @code{:cache} header argument controls the use of in-buffer caching of
+the results of evaluating code blocks. It can be used to avoid re-evaluating
+unchanged code blocks. This header argument can have one of two
+values: @code{yes} or @code{no}.
+
+@itemize @bullet
+@item @code{no}
+The default. No caching takes place, and the code block will be evaluated
+every time it is called.
+@item @code{yes}
+Every time the code block is run a SHA1 hash of the code and arguments
+passed to the block will be generated. This hash is packed into the
+@code{#+results:} line and will be checked on subsequent
+executions of the code block. If the code block has not
+changed since the last time it was evaluated, it will not be re-evaluated.
+@end itemize
+
+@node hlines, colnames, cache, Specific header arguments
+@subsubsection @code{:hlines}
+
+Tables are frequently represented with one or more horizontal lines, or
+hlines. The @code{:hlines} argument to a code block accepts the
+values @code{yes} or @code{no}, with a default value of @code{no}.
+
+@itemize @bullet
+@item @code{no}
+Strips horizontal lines from the input table. In most languages this is the
+desired effect because an @code{hline} symbol is interpreted as an unbound
+variable and raises an error. Setting @code{:hlines no} or relying on the
+default value yields the following results.
+
+@example
+#+tblname: many-cols
+| a | b | c |
+|---+---+---|
+| d | e | f |
+|---+---+---|
+| g | h | i |
+
+#+source: echo-table
+#+begin_src python :var tab=many-cols
+ return tab
+#+end_src
+
+#+results: echo-table
+| a | b | c |
+| d | e | f |
+| g | h | i |
+@end example
+
+@item @code{yes}
+Leaves hlines in the table. Setting @code{:hlines yes} has this effect.
+
+@example
+#+tblname: many-cols
+| a | b | c |
+|---+---+---|
+| d | e | f |
+|---+---+---|
+| g | h | i |
+
+#+source: echo-table
+#+begin_src python :var tab=many-cols :hlines yes
+ return tab
+#+end_src
+
+#+results: echo-table
+| a | b | c |
+|---+---+---|
+| d | e | f |
+|---+---+---|
+| g | h | i |
+@end example
+@end itemize
+
+@node colnames, rownames, hlines, Specific header arguments
+@subsubsection @code{:colnames}
+
+The @code{:colnames} header argument accepts the values @code{yes},
+@code{no}, or @code{nil} for unassigned. The default value is @code{nil}.
+
+@itemize @bullet
+@item @code{nil}
+If an input table looks like it has column names
+(because its second row is an hline), then the column
+names will be removed from the table before
+processing, then reapplied to the results.
+
+@example
+#+tblname: less-cols
+| a |
+|---|
+| b |
+| c |
+
+#+srcname: echo-table-again
+#+begin_src python :var tab=less-cols
+ return [[val + '*' for val in row] for row in tab]
+#+end_src
+
+#+results: echo-table-again
+| a |
+|----|
+| b* |
+| c* |
+@end example
+
+@item @code{no}
+No column name pre-processing takes place
+
+@item @code{yes}
+Column names are removed and reapplied as with @code{nil} even if the table
+does not ``look like'' it has column names (i.e. the second row is not an
+hline)
+@end itemize
+
+@node rownames, shebang, colnames, Specific header arguments
+@subsubsection @code{:rownames}
+
+The @code{:rownames} header argument can take on the values @code{yes}
+or @code{no}, with a default value of @code{no}.
+
+@itemize @bullet
+@item @code{no}
+No row name pre-processing will take place.
+
+@item @code{yes}
+The first column of the table is removed from the table before processing,
+and is then reapplied to the results.
+
+@example
+#+tblname: with-rownames
+| one | 1 | 2 | 3 | 4 | 5 |
+| two | 6 | 7 | 8 | 9 | 10 |
+
+#+srcname: echo-table-once-again
+#+begin_src python :var tab=with-rownames :rownames yes
+ return [[val + 10 for val in row] for row in tab]
+#+end_src
+
+#+results: echo-table-once-again
+| one | 11 | 12 | 13 | 14 | 15 |
+| two | 16 | 17 | 18 | 19 | 20 |
+@end example
+@end itemize
+
+@node shebang, eval, rownames, Specific header arguments
+@subsubsection @code{:shebang}
+
+Setting the @code{:shebang} header argument to a string value
+(e.g. @code{:shebang "#!/bin/bash"}) causes the string to be inserted as the
+first line of any tangled file holding the code block, and the file
+permissions of the tangled file are set to make it executable.
+
+@node eval, , shebang, Specific header arguments
+@subsubsection @code{:eval}
+The @code{:eval} header argument can be used to limit the evaluation of
+specific code blocks. @code{:eval} accepts two arguments ``never'' and
+``query''. @code{:eval never} will ensure that a code block is never
+evaluated, this can be useful for protecting against the evaluation of
+dangerous code blocks. @code{:eval query} will require a query for every
+execution of a code block regardless of the value of the
+@code{org-confirm-babel-evaluate} variable.
+
+@node Results of evaluation, Noweb reference syntax, Header arguments, Working With Source Code
+@section Results of evaluation
+@cindex code block, results of evaluation
+@cindex source code, results of evaluation
+
+The way in which results are handled depends on whether a session is invoked,
+as well as on whether @code{:results value} or @code{:results output} is
+used. The following table shows the possibilities:
+
+@multitable @columnfractions 0.26 0.33 0.41
+@item @tab @b{Non-session} @tab @b{Session}
+@item @code{:results value} @tab value of last expression @tab value of last expression
+@item @code{:results output} @tab contents of STDOUT @tab concatenation of interpreter output
+@end multitable
+
+Note: With @code{:results value}, the result in both @code{:session} and
+non-session is returned to Org-mode as a table (a one- or two-dimensional
+vector of strings or numbers) when appropriate.
+
+@subsection Non-session
+@subsubsection @code{:results value}
+This is the default. Internally, the value is obtained by wrapping the code
+in a function definition in the external language, and evaluating that
+function. Therefore, code should be written as if it were the body of such a
+function. In particular, note that Python does not automatically return a
+value from a function unless a @code{return} statement is present, and so a
+@samp{return} statement will usually be required in Python.
+
+This is the only one of the four evaluation contexts in which the code is
+automatically wrapped in a function definition.
+
+@subsubsection @code{:results output}
+The code is passed to the interpreter as an external process, and the
+contents of the standard output stream are returned as text. (In certain
+languages this also contains the error output stream; this is an area for
+future work.)
+
+@subsection Session
+@subsubsection @code{:results value}
+The code is passed to the interpreter running as an interactive Emacs
+inferior process. The result returned is the result of the last evaluation
+performed by the interpreter. (This is obtained in a language-specific
+manner: the value of the variable @code{_} in Python and Ruby, and the value
+of @code{.Last.value} in R).
+
+@subsubsection @code{:results output}
+The code is passed to the interpreter running as an interactive Emacs
+inferior process. The result returned is the concatenation of the sequence of
+(text) output from the interactive interpreter. Notice that this is not
+necessarily the same as what would be sent to @code{STDOUT} if the same code
+were passed to a non-interactive interpreter running as an external
+process. For example, compare the following two blocks:
+
+@example
+#+begin_src python :results output
+ print "hello"
+ 2
+ print "bye"
+#+end_src
+
+#+resname:
+: hello
+: bye
+@end example
+
+In non-session mode, the `2' is not printed and does not appear.
+@example
+#+begin_src python :results output :session
+ print "hello"
+ 2
+ print "bye"
+#+end_src
+
+#+resname:
+: hello
+: 2
+: bye
+@end example
+
+But in @code{:session} mode, the interactive interpreter receives input `2'
+and prints out its value, `2'. (Indeed, the other print statements are
+unnecessary here).
+
+@node Noweb reference syntax, Key bindings and useful functions, Results of evaluation, Working With Source Code
+@section Noweb reference syntax
+@cindex code block, noweb reference
+@cindex syntax, noweb
+@cindex source code, noweb reference
+
+The ``noweb'' (see @uref{http://www.cs.tufts.edu/~nr/noweb/}) Literate
+Programming system allows named blocks of code to be referenced by using the
+familiar Noweb syntax:
+
+@example
+<<code-block-name>>
+@end example
+
+When a code block is tangled or evaluated, whether or not ``noweb''
+references are expanded depends upon the value of the @code{:noweb} header
+argument. If @code{:noweb yes}, then a Noweb reference is expanded before
+evaluation. If @code{:noweb no}, the default, then the reference is not
+expanded before evaluation.
+
+Note: the default value, @code{:noweb no}, was chosen to ensure that
+correct code is not broken in a language, such as Ruby, where
+@code{<<arg>>} is a syntactically valid construct. If @code{<<arg>>} is not
+syntactically valid in languages that you use, then please consider setting
+the default value.
+
+@node Key bindings and useful functions, Batch execution, Noweb reference syntax, Working With Source Code
+@section Key bindings and useful functions
+@cindex code block, key bindings
+
+Many common Org-mode key sequences are re-bound depending on
+the context.
+
+Within a code block, the following key bindings
+are active:
+
+@multitable @columnfractions 0.25 0.75
+@kindex C-c C-c
+@item @kbd{C-c C-c} @tab org-babel-execute-src-block
+@kindex C-c C-o
+@item @kbd{C-c C-o} @tab org-babel-open-src-block-result
+@kindex C-up
+@item @kbd{C-@key{up}} @tab org-babel-load-in-session
+@kindex M-down
+@item @kbd{M-@key{down}} @tab org-babel-pop-to-session
+@end multitable
+
+In an Org-mode buffer, the following key bindings are active:
+
+@multitable @columnfractions 0.45 0.55
+@kindex C-c C-v a
+@kindex C-c C-v C-a
+@item @kbd{C-c C-v a} @ @ @r{or} @ @ @kbd{C-c C-v C-a} @tab org-babel-sha1-hash
+@kindex C-c C-v b
+@kindex C-c C-v C-b
+@item @kbd{C-c C-v b} @ @ @r{or} @ @ @kbd{C-c C-v C-b} @tab org-babel-execute-buffer
+@kindex C-c C-v f
+@kindex C-c C-v C-f
+@item @kbd{C-c C-v f} @ @ @r{or} @ @ @kbd{C-c C-v C-f} @tab org-babel-tangle-file
+@kindex C-c C-v g
+@item @kbd{C-c C-v g} @tab org-babel-goto-named-source-block
+@kindex C-c C-v h
+@item @kbd{C-c C-v h} @tab org-babel-describe-bindings
+@kindex C-c C-v l
+@kindex C-c C-v C-l
+@item @kbd{C-c C-v l} @ @ @r{or} @ @ @kbd{C-c C-v C-l} @tab org-babel-lob-ingest
+@kindex C-c C-v p
+@kindex C-c C-v C-p
+@item @kbd{C-c C-v p} @ @ @r{or} @ @ @kbd{C-c C-v C-p} @tab org-babel-expand-src-block
+@kindex C-c C-v s
+@kindex C-c C-v C-s
+@item @kbd{C-c C-v s} @ @ @r{or} @ @ @kbd{C-c C-v C-s} @tab org-babel-execute-subtree
+@kindex C-c C-v t
+@kindex C-c C-v C-t
+@item @kbd{C-c C-v t} @ @ @r{or} @ @ @kbd{C-c C-v C-t} @tab org-babel-tangle
+@kindex C-c C-v z
+@kindex C-c C-v C-z
+@item @kbd{C-c C-v z} @ @ @r{or} @ @ @kbd{C-c C-v C-z} @tab org-babel-switch-to-session
+@end multitable
+
+@c When possible these keybindings were extended to work when the control key is
+@c kept pressed, resulting in the following additional keybindings.
+
+@c @multitable @columnfractions 0.25 0.75
+@c @item @kbd{C-c C-v C-a} @tab org-babel-sha1-hash
+@c @item @kbd{C-c C-v C-b} @tab org-babel-execute-buffer
+@c @item @kbd{C-c C-v C-f} @tab org-babel-tangle-file
+@c @item @kbd{C-c C-v C-l} @tab org-babel-lob-ingest
+@c @item @kbd{C-c C-v C-p} @tab org-babel-expand-src-block
+@c @item @kbd{C-c C-v C-s} @tab org-babel-execute-subtree
+@c @item @kbd{C-c C-v C-t} @tab org-babel-tangle
+@c @item @kbd{C-c C-v C-z} @tab org-babel-switch-to-session
+@c @end multitable
+
+@node Batch execution, , Key bindings and useful functions, Working With Source Code
+@section Batch execution
+@cindex code block, batch execution
+@cindex source code, batch execution
+
+It is possible to call functions from the command line. This shell
+script calls @code{org-babel-tangle} on every one of its arguments.
+
+Be sure to adjust the paths to fit your system.
+
+@example
+#!/bin/sh
+# -*- mode: shell-script -*-
+#
+# tangle files with org-mode
+#
+DIR=`pwd`
+FILES=""
+ORGINSTALL="~/src/org/lisp/org-install.el"
+
+# wrap each argument in the code required to call tangle on it
+for i in $@@; do
+ FILES="$FILES \"$i\""
+done
+
+emacs -Q --batch -l $ORGINSTALL \
+--eval "(progn
+(add-to-list 'load-path (expand-file-name \"~/src/org/lisp/\"))
+(add-to-list 'load-path (expand-file-name \"~/src/org/contrib/lisp/\"))
+(require 'org)(require 'org-exp)(require 'ob)(require 'ob-tangle)
+(mapc (lambda (file)
+ (find-file (expand-file-name file \"$DIR\"))
+ (org-babel-tangle)
+ (kill-buffer)) '($FILES)))" 2>&1 |grep tangled
+@end example
+
+@node Miscellaneous, Hacking, Working With Source Code, Top
+@chapter Miscellaneous
+
+@menu
+* Completion:: M-TAB knows what you need
+* Easy Templates:: Quick insertion of structural elements
+* Speed keys:: Electric commands at the beginning of a headline
+* Code evaluation security:: Org mode files evaluate inline code
+* Customization:: Adapting Org to your taste
+* In-buffer settings:: Overview of the #+KEYWORDS
+* The very busy C-c C-c key:: When in doubt, press C-c C-c
+* Clean view:: Getting rid of leading stars in the outline
+* TTY keys:: Using Org on a tty
+* Interaction:: Other Emacs packages
+@end menu
+
+
+@node Completion, Easy Templates, Miscellaneous, Miscellaneous
+@section Completion
+@cindex completion, of @TeX{} symbols
+@cindex completion, of TODO keywords
+@cindex completion, of dictionary words
+@cindex completion, of option keywords
+@cindex completion, of tags
+@cindex completion, of property keys
+@cindex completion, of link abbreviations
+@cindex @TeX{} symbol completion
+@cindex TODO keywords completion
+@cindex dictionary word completion
+@cindex option keyword completion
+@cindex tag completion
+@cindex link abbreviations, completion of
+
+Emacs would not be Emacs without completion, and Org-mode uses it whenever it
+makes sense. If you prefer an @i{iswitchb}- or @i{ido}-like interface for
+some of the completion prompts, you can specify your preference by setting at
+most one of the variables @code{org-completion-use-iswitchb}
+@code{org-completion-use-ido}.
+
+Org supports in-buffer completion. This type of completion does
+not make use of the minibuffer. You simply type a few letters into
+the buffer and use the key to complete text right there.
+
+@table @kbd
+@kindex M-@key{TAB}
+@item M-@key{TAB}
+Complete word at point
+@itemize @bullet
+@item
+At the beginning of a headline, complete TODO keywords.
+@item
+After @samp{\}, complete @TeX{} symbols supported by the exporter.
+@item
+After @samp{*}, complete headlines in the current buffer so that they
+can be used in search links like @samp{[[*find this headline]]}.
+@item
+After @samp{:} in a headline, complete tags. The list of tags is taken
+from the variable @code{org-tag-alist} (possibly set through the
+@samp{#+TAGS} in-buffer option, @pxref{Setting tags}), or it is created
+dynamically from all tags used in the current buffer.
+@item
+After @samp{:} and not in a headline, complete property keys. The list
+of keys is constructed dynamically from all keys used in the current
+buffer.
+@item
+After @samp{[}, complete link abbreviations (@pxref{Link abbreviations}).
+@item
+After @samp{#+}, complete the special keywords like @samp{TYP_TODO} or
+@samp{OPTIONS} which set file-specific options for Org-mode. When the
+option keyword is already complete, pressing @kbd{M-@key{TAB}} again
+will insert example settings for this keyword.
+@item
+In the line after @samp{#+STARTUP: }, complete startup keywords,
+i.e. valid keys for this line.
+@item
+Elsewhere, complete dictionary words using Ispell.
+@end itemize
+@end table
+
+@node Easy Templates, Speed keys, Completion, Miscellaneous
+@section Easy Templates
+@cindex template insertion
+@cindex insertion, of templates
+
+Org-mode supports insertion of empty structural elements (like
+@code{#+BEGIN_SRC} and @code{#+END_SRC} pairs) with just a few key
+strokes. This is achieved through a native template expansion mechanism.
+Note that Emacs has several other template mechanisms which could be used in
+a similar way, for example @file{yasnippet}.
+
+To insert a structural element, type a @samp{<}, followed by a template
+selector and @kbd{@key{TAB}}. Completion takes effect only when the above
+keystrokes are typed on a line by itself.
+
+The following template selectors are currently supported.
+
+@multitable @columnfractions 0.1 0.9
+@item @kbd{s} @tab @code{#+begin_src ... #+end_src}
+@item @kbd{e} @tab @code{#+begin_example ... #+end_example}
+@item @kbd{q} @tab @code{#+begin_quote ... #+end_quote}
+@item @kbd{v} @tab @code{#+begin_verse ... #+end_verse}
+@item @kbd{c} @tab @code{#+begin_center ... #+end_center}
+@item @kbd{l} @tab @code{#+begin_latex ... #+end_latex}
+@item @kbd{L} @tab @code{#+latex:}
+@item @kbd{h} @tab @code{#+begin_html ... #+end_html}
+@item @kbd{H} @tab @code{#+html:}
+@item @kbd{a} @tab @code{#+begin_ascii ... #+end_ascii}
+@item @kbd{A} @tab @code{#+ascii:}
+@item @kbd{i} @tab @code{#+include:} line
+@end multitable
+
+For example, on an empty line, typing "<e" and then pressing TAB, will expand
+into a complete EXAMPLE template.
+
+You can install additional templates by customizing the variable
+@code{org-structure-template-alist}. See the docstring of the variable for
+additional details.
+
+@node Speed keys, Code evaluation security, Easy Templates, Miscellaneous
+@section Speed keys
+@cindex speed keys
+@vindex org-use-speed-commands
+@vindex org-speed-commands-user
+
+Single keys can be made to execute commands when the cursor is at the
+beginning of a headline, i.e. before the first star. Configure the variable
+@code{org-use-speed-commands} to activate this feature. There is a
+pre-defined list of commands, and you can add more such commands using the
+variable @code{org-speed-commands-user}. Speed keys do not only speed up
+navigation and other commands, but they also provide an alternative way to
+execute commands bound to keys that are not or not easily available on a TTY,
+or on a small mobile device with a limited keyboard.
+
+To see which commands are available, activate the feature and press @kbd{?}
+with the cursor at the beginning of a headline.
+
+@node Code evaluation security, Customization, Speed keys, Miscellaneous
+@section Code evaluation and security issues
+
+Org provides tools to work with the code snippets, including evaluating them.
+
+Running code on your machine always comes with a security risk. Badly
+written or malicious code can be executed on purpose or by accident. Org has
+default settings which will only evaluate such code if you give explicit
+permission to do so, and as a casual user of these features you should leave
+these precautions intact.
+
+For people who regularly work with such code, the confirmation prompts can
+become annoying, and you might want to turn them off. This can be done, but
+you must be aware of the risks that are involved.
+
+Code evaluation can happen under the following circumstances:
+
+@table @i
+@item Source code blocks
+Source code blocks can be evaluated during export, or when pressing @kbd{C-c
+C-c} in the block. The most important thing to realize here is that Org mode
+files which contain code snippets are, in a certain sense, like executable
+files. So you should accept them and load them into Emacs only from trusted
+sources---just like you would do with a program you install on your computer.
+
+Make sure you know what you are doing before customizing the variables
+which take off the default security brakes.
+
+@defopt org-confirm-babel-evaluate
+When set to t user is queried before code block evaluation
+@end defopt
+
+@item Following @code{shell} and @code{elisp} links
+Org has two link types that can directly evaluate code (@pxref{External
+links}). These links can be problematic because the code to be evaluated is
+not visible.
+
+@defopt org-confirm-shell-link-function
+Function to queries user about shell link execution.
+@end defopt
+@defopt org-confirm-elisp-link-function
+Functions to query user for Emacs Lisp link execution.
+@end defopt
+
+@item Formulas in tables
+Formulas in tables (@pxref{The spreadsheet}) are code that is evaluated
+either by the @i{calc} interpreter, or by the @i{Emacs Lisp} interpreter.
+@end table
+
+@node Customization, In-buffer settings, Code evaluation security, Miscellaneous
+@section Customization
+@cindex customization
+@cindex options, for customization
+@cindex variables, for customization
+
+There are more than 180 variables that can be used to customize
+Org. For the sake of compactness of the manual, I am not
+describing the variables here. A structured overview of customization
+variables is available with @kbd{M-x org-customize}. Or select
+@code{Browse Org Group} from the @code{Org->Customization} menu. Many
+settings can also be activated on a per-file basis, by putting special
+lines into the buffer (@pxref{In-buffer settings}).
+
+@node In-buffer settings, The very busy C-c C-c key, Customization, Miscellaneous
+@section Summary of in-buffer settings
+@cindex in-buffer settings
+@cindex special keywords
+
+Org-mode uses special lines in the buffer to define settings on a
+per-file basis. These lines start with a @samp{#+} followed by a
+keyword, a colon, and then individual words defining a setting. Several
+setting words can be in the same line, but you can also have multiple
+lines for the keyword. While these settings are described throughout
+the manual, here is a summary. After changing any of those lines in the
+buffer, press @kbd{C-c C-c} with the cursor still in the line to
+activate the changes immediately. Otherwise they become effective only
+when the file is visited again in a new Emacs session.
+
+@vindex org-archive-location
+@table @kbd
+@item #+ARCHIVE: %s_done::
+This line sets the archive location for the agenda file. It applies for
+all subsequent lines until the next @samp{#+ARCHIVE} line, or the end
+of the file. The first such line also applies to any entries before it.
+The corresponding variable is @code{org-archive-location}.
+@item #+CATEGORY:
+This line sets the category for the agenda file. The category applies
+for all subsequent lines until the next @samp{#+CATEGORY} line, or the
+end of the file. The first such line also applies to any entries before it.
+@item #+COLUMNS: %25ITEM .....
+@cindex property, COLUMNS
+Set the default format for columns view. This format applies when
+columns view is invoked in locations where no @code{COLUMNS} property
+applies.
+@item #+CONSTANTS: name1=value1 ...
+@vindex org-table-formula-constants
+@vindex org-table-formula
+Set file-local values for constants to be used in table formulas. This
+line sets the local variable @code{org-table-formula-constants-local}.
+The global version of this variable is
+@code{org-table-formula-constants}.
+@item #+FILETAGS: :tag1:tag2:tag3:
+Set tags that can be inherited by any entry in the file, including the
+top-level entries.
+@item #+DRAWERS: NAME1 .....
+@vindex org-drawers
+Set the file-local set of drawers. The corresponding global variable is
+@code{org-drawers}.
+@item #+LINK: linkword replace
+@vindex org-link-abbrev-alist
+These lines (several are allowed) specify link abbreviations.
+@xref{Link abbreviations}. The corresponding variable is
+@code{org-link-abbrev-alist}.
+@item #+PRIORITIES: highest lowest default
+@vindex org-highest-priority
+@vindex org-lowest-priority
+@vindex org-default-priority
+This line sets the limits and the default for the priorities. All three
+must be either letters A-Z or numbers 0-9. The highest priority must
+have a lower ASCII number than the lowest priority.
+@item #+PROPERTY: Property_Name Value
+This line sets a default inheritance value for entries in the current
+buffer, most useful for specifying the allowed values of a property.
+@cindex #+SETUPFILE
+@item #+SETUPFILE: file
+This line defines a file that holds more in-buffer setup. Normally this is
+entirely ignored. Only when the buffer is parsed for option-setting lines
+(i.e. when starting Org-mode for a file, when pressing @kbd{C-c C-c} in a
+settings line, or when exporting), then the contents of this file are parsed
+as if they had been included in the buffer. In particular, the file can be
+any other Org-mode file with internal setup. You can visit the file the
+cursor is in the line with @kbd{C-c '}.
+@item #+STARTUP:
+@cindex #+STARTUP:
+This line sets options to be used at startup of Org-mode, when an
+Org file is being visited.
+
+The first set of options deals with the initial visibility of the outline
+tree. The corresponding variable for global default settings is
+@code{org-startup-folded}, with a default value @code{t}, which means
+@code{overview}.
+@vindex org-startup-folded
+@cindex @code{overview}, STARTUP keyword
+@cindex @code{content}, STARTUP keyword
+@cindex @code{showall}, STARTUP keyword
+@cindex @code{showeverything}, STARTUP keyword
+@example
+overview @r{top-level headlines only}
+content @r{all headlines}
+showall @r{no folding of any entries}
+showeverything @r{show even drawer contents}
+@end example
+
+@vindex org-startup-indented
+@cindex @code{indent}, STARTUP keyword
+@cindex @code{noindent}, STARTUP keyword
+Dynamic virtual indentation is controlled by the variable
+@code{org-startup-indented}@footnote{Emacs 23 and Org-mode 6.29 are required}
+@example
+indent @r{start with @code{org-indent-mode} turned on}
+noindent @r{start with @code{org-indent-mode} turned off}
+@end example
+
+@vindex org-startup-align-all-tables
+Then there are options for aligning tables upon visiting a file. This
+is useful in files containing narrowed table columns. The corresponding
+variable is @code{org-startup-align-all-tables}, with a default value
+@code{nil}.
+@cindex @code{align}, STARTUP keyword
+@cindex @code{noalign}, STARTUP keyword
+@example
+align @r{align all tables}
+noalign @r{don't align tables on startup}
+@end example
+
+@vindex org-startup-with-inline-images
+When visiting a file, inline images can be automatically displayed. The
+corresponding variable is @code{org-startup-with-inline-images}, with a
+default value @code{nil} to avoid delays when visiting a file.
+@cindex @code{inlineimages}, STARTUP keyword
+@cindex @code{noinlineimages}, STARTUP keyword
+@example
+inlineimages @r{show inline images}
+noinlineimages @r{don't show inline images on startup}
+@end example
+
+@vindex org-log-done
+@vindex org-log-note-clock-out
+@vindex org-log-repeat
+Logging the closing and reopening of TODO items and clock intervals can be
+configured using these options (see variables @code{org-log-done},
+@code{org-log-note-clock-out} and @code{org-log-repeat})
+@cindex @code{logdone}, STARTUP keyword
+@cindex @code{lognotedone}, STARTUP keyword
+@cindex @code{nologdone}, STARTUP keyword
+@cindex @code{lognoteclock-out}, STARTUP keyword
+@cindex @code{nolognoteclock-out}, STARTUP keyword
+@cindex @code{logrepeat}, STARTUP keyword
+@cindex @code{lognoterepeat}, STARTUP keyword
+@cindex @code{nologrepeat}, STARTUP keyword
+@cindex @code{logreschedule}, STARTUP keyword
+@cindex @code{lognotereschedule}, STARTUP keyword
+@cindex @code{nologreschedule}, STARTUP keyword
+@cindex @code{logredeadline}, STARTUP keyword
+@cindex @code{lognoteredeadline}, STARTUP keyword
+@cindex @code{nologredeadline}, STARTUP keyword
+@cindex @code{logrefile}, STARTUP keyword
+@cindex @code{lognoterefile}, STARTUP keyword
+@cindex @code{nologrefile}, STARTUP keyword
+@example
+logdone @r{record a timestamp when an item is marked DONE}
+lognotedone @r{record timestamp and a note when DONE}
+nologdone @r{don't record when items are marked DONE}
+logrepeat @r{record a time when reinstating a repeating item}
+lognoterepeat @r{record a note when reinstating a repeating item}
+nologrepeat @r{do not record when reinstating repeating item}
+lognoteclock-out @r{record a note when clocking out}
+nolognoteclock-out @r{don't record a note when clocking out}
+logreschedule @r{record a timestamp when scheduling time changes}
+lognotereschedule @r{record a note when scheduling time changes}
+nologreschedule @r{do not record when a scheduling date changes}
+logredeadline @r{record a timestamp when deadline changes}
+lognoteredeadline @r{record a note when deadline changes}
+nologredeadline @r{do not record when a deadline date changes}
+logrefile @r{record a timestamp when refiling}
+lognoterefile @r{record a note when refiling}
+nologrefile @r{do not record when refiling}
+@end example
+@vindex org-hide-leading-stars
+@vindex org-odd-levels-only
+Here are the options for hiding leading stars in outline headings, and for
+indenting outlines. The corresponding variables are
+@code{org-hide-leading-stars} and @code{org-odd-levels-only}, both with a
+default setting @code{nil} (meaning @code{showstars} and @code{oddeven}).
+@cindex @code{hidestars}, STARTUP keyword
+@cindex @code{showstars}, STARTUP keyword
+@cindex @code{odd}, STARTUP keyword
+@cindex @code{even}, STARTUP keyword
+@example
+hidestars @r{make all but one of the stars starting a headline invisible.}
+showstars @r{show all stars starting a headline}
+indent @r{virtual indentation according to outline level}
+noindent @r{no virtual indentation according to outline level}
+odd @r{allow only odd outline levels (1,3,...)}
+oddeven @r{allow all outline levels}
+@end example
+@vindex org-put-time-stamp-overlays
+@vindex org-time-stamp-overlay-formats
+To turn on custom format overlays over timestamps (variables
+@code{org-put-time-stamp-overlays} and
+@code{org-time-stamp-overlay-formats}), use
+@cindex @code{customtime}, STARTUP keyword
+@example
+customtime @r{overlay custom time format}
+@end example
+@vindex constants-unit-system
+The following options influence the table spreadsheet (variable
+@code{constants-unit-system}).
+@cindex @code{constcgs}, STARTUP keyword
+@cindex @code{constSI}, STARTUP keyword
+@example
+constcgs @r{@file{constants.el} should use the c-g-s unit system}
+constSI @r{@file{constants.el} should use the SI unit system}
+@end example
+@vindex org-footnote-define-inline
+@vindex org-footnote-auto-label
+@vindex org-footnote-auto-adjust
+To influence footnote settings, use the following keywords. The
+corresponding variables are @code{org-footnote-define-inline},
+@code{org-footnote-auto-label}, and @code{org-footnote-auto-adjust}.
+@cindex @code{fninline}, STARTUP keyword
+@cindex @code{nofninline}, STARTUP keyword
+@cindex @code{fnlocal}, STARTUP keyword
+@cindex @code{fnprompt}, STARTUP keyword
+@cindex @code{fnauto}, STARTUP keyword
+@cindex @code{fnconfirm}, STARTUP keyword
+@cindex @code{fnplain}, STARTUP keyword
+@cindex @code{fnadjust}, STARTUP keyword
+@cindex @code{nofnadjust}, STARTUP keyword
+@example
+fninline @r{define footnotes inline}
+fnnoinline @r{define footnotes in separate section}
+fnlocal @r{define footnotes near first reference, but not inline}
+fnprompt @r{prompt for footnote labels}
+fnauto @r{create [fn:1]-like labels automatically (default)}
+fnconfirm @r{offer automatic label for editing or confirmation}
+fnplain @r{create [1]-like labels automatically}
+fnadjust @r{automatically renumber and sort footnotes}
+nofnadjust @r{do not renumber and sort automatically}
+@end example
+@cindex org-hide-block-startup
+To hide blocks on startup, use these keywords. The corresponding variable is
+@code{org-hide-block-startup}.
+@cindex @code{hideblocks}, STARTUP keyword
+@cindex @code{nohideblocks}, STARTUP keyword
+@example
+hideblocks @r{Hide all begin/end blocks on startup}
+nohideblocks @r{Do not hide blocks on startup}
+@end example
+@cindex org-pretty-entities
+The display of entities as UTF-8 characters is governed by the variable
+@code{org-pretty-entities} and the keywords
+@cindex @code{entitiespretty}, STARTUP keyword
+@cindex @code{entitiesplain}, STARTUP keyword
+@example
+entitiespretty @r{Show entities as UTF-8 characters where possible}
+entitiesplain @r{Leave entities plain}
+@end example
+@item #+TAGS: TAG1(c1) TAG2(c2)
+@vindex org-tag-alist
+These lines (several such lines are allowed) specify the valid tags in
+this file, and (potentially) the corresponding @emph{fast tag selection}
+keys. The corresponding variable is @code{org-tag-alist}.
+@item #+TBLFM:
+This line contains the formulas for the table directly above the line.
+@item #+TITLE:, #+AUTHOR:, #+EMAIL:, #+LANGUAGE:, #+TEXT:, #+DATE:,
+@itemx #+OPTIONS:, #+BIND:, #+XSLT:,
+@itemx #+DESCRIPTION:, #+KEYWORDS:,
+@itemx #+LATEX_HEADER:, #+STYLE:, #+LINK_UP:, #+LINK_HOME:,
+@itemx #+EXPORT_SELECT_TAGS:, #+EXPORT_EXCLUDE_TAGS:
+These lines provide settings for exporting files. For more details see
+@ref{Export options}.
+@item #+TODO: #+SEQ_TODO: #+TYP_TODO:
+@vindex org-todo-keywords
+These lines set the TODO keywords and their interpretation in the
+current file. The corresponding variable is @code{org-todo-keywords}.
+@end table
+
+@node The very busy C-c C-c key, Clean view, In-buffer settings, Miscellaneous
+@section The very busy C-c C-c key
+@kindex C-c C-c
+@cindex C-c C-c, overview
+
+The key @kbd{C-c C-c} has many purposes in Org, which are all
+mentioned scattered throughout this manual. One specific function of
+this key is to add @emph{tags} to a headline (@pxref{Tags}). In many
+other circumstances it means something like @emph{``Hey Org, look
+here and update according to what you see here''}. Here is a summary of
+what this means in different contexts.
+
+@itemize @minus
+@item
+If there are highlights in the buffer from the creation of a sparse
+tree, or from clock display, remove these highlights.
+@item
+If the cursor is in one of the special @code{#+KEYWORD} lines, this
+triggers scanning the buffer for these lines and updating the
+information.
+@item
+If the cursor is inside a table, realign the table. This command
+works even if the automatic table editor has been turned off.
+@item
+If the cursor is on a @code{#+TBLFM} line, re-apply the formulas to
+the entire table.
+@item
+If the current buffer is a capture buffer, close the note and file it.
+With a prefix argument, file it, without further interaction, to the
+default location.
+@item
+If the cursor is on a @code{<<<target>>>}, update radio targets and
+corresponding links in this buffer.
+@item
+If the cursor is in a property line or at the start or end of a property
+drawer, offer property commands.
+@item
+If the cursor is at a footnote reference, go to the corresponding
+definition, and vice versa.
+@item
+If the cursor is on a statistics cookie, update it.
+@item
+If the cursor is in a plain list item with a checkbox, toggle the status
+of the checkbox.
+@item
+If the cursor is on a numbered item in a plain list, renumber the
+ordered list.
+@item
+If the cursor is on the @code{#+BEGIN} line of a dynamic block, the
+block is updated.
+@end itemize
+
+@node Clean view, TTY keys, The very busy C-c C-c key, Miscellaneous
+@section A cleaner outline view
+@cindex hiding leading stars
+@cindex dynamic indentation
+@cindex odd-levels-only outlines
+@cindex clean outline view
+
+Some people find it noisy and distracting that the Org headlines start with a
+potentially large number of stars, and that text below the headlines is not
+indented. While this is no problem when writing a @emph{book-like} document
+where the outline headings are really section headings, in a more
+@emph{list-oriented} outline, indented structure is a lot cleaner:
+
+@example
+@group
+* Top level headline | * Top level headline
+** Second level | * Second level
+*** 3rd level | * 3rd level
+some text | some text
+*** 3rd level | * 3rd level
+more text | more text
+* Another top level headline | * Another top level headline
+@end group
+@end example
+
+@noindent
+
+If you are using at least Emacs 23.2@footnote{Emacs 23.1 can actually crash
+with @code{org-indent-mode}} and version 6.29 of Org, this kind of view can
+be achieved dynamically at display time using @code{org-indent-mode}. In
+this minor mode, all lines are prefixed for display with the necessary amount
+of space@footnote{@code{org-indent-mode} also sets the @code{wrap-prefix}
+property, such that @code{visual-line-mode} (or purely setting
+@code{word-wrap}) wraps long lines (including headlines) correctly indented.
+}. Also headlines are prefixed with additional stars, so that the amount of
+indentation shifts by two@footnote{See the variable
+@code{org-indent-indentation-per-level}.} spaces per level. All headline
+stars but the last one are made invisible using the @code{org-hide}
+face@footnote{Turning on @code{org-indent-mode} sets
+@code{org-hide-leading-stars} to @code{t} and @code{org-adapt-indentation} to
+@code{nil}.} - see below under @samp{2.} for more information on how this
+works. You can turn on @code{org-indent-mode} for all files by customizing
+the variable @code{org-startup-indented}, or you can turn it on for
+individual files using
+
+@example
+#+STARTUP: indent
+@end example
+
+If you want a similar effect in an earlier version of Emacs and/or Org, or if
+you want the indentation to be hard space characters so that the plain text
+file looks as similar as possible to the Emacs display, Org supports you in
+the following way:
+
+@enumerate
+@item
+@emph{Indentation of text below headlines}@*
+You may indent text below each headline to make the left boundary line up
+with the headline, like
+
+@example
+*** 3rd level
+ more text, now indented
+@end example
+
+@vindex org-adapt-indentation
+Org supports this with paragraph filling, line wrapping, and structure
+editing@footnote{See also the variable @code{org-adapt-indentation}.},
+preserving or adapting the indentation as appropriate.
+
+@item
+@vindex org-hide-leading-stars
+@emph{Hiding leading stars}@* You can modify the display in such a way that
+all leading stars become invisible. To do this in a global way, configure
+the variable @code{org-hide-leading-stars} or change this on a per-file basis
+with
+
+@example
+#+STARTUP: hidestars
+#+STARTUP: showstars
+@end example
+
+With hidden stars, the tree becomes:
+
+@example
+@group
+* Top level headline
+ * Second level
+ * 3rd level
+ ...
+@end group
+@end example
+
+@noindent
+@vindex org-hide @r{(face)}
+The leading stars are not truly replaced by whitespace, they are only
+fontified with the face @code{org-hide} that uses the background color as
+font color. If you are not using either white or black background, you may
+have to customize this face to get the wanted effect. Another possibility is
+to set this font such that the extra stars are @i{almost} invisible, for
+example using the color @code{grey90} on a white background.
+
+@item
+@vindex org-odd-levels-only
+Things become cleaner still if you skip all the even levels and use only odd
+levels 1, 3, 5..., effectively adding two stars to go from one outline level
+to the next@footnote{When you need to specify a level for a property search
+or refile targets, @samp{LEVEL=2} will correspond to 3 stars, etc@.}. In this
+way we get the outline view shown at the beginning of this section. In order
+to make the structure editing and export commands handle this convention
+correctly, configure the variable @code{org-odd-levels-only}, or set this on
+a per-file basis with one of the following lines:
+
+@example
+#+STARTUP: odd
+#+STARTUP: oddeven
+@end example
+
+You can convert an Org file from single-star-per-level to the
+double-star-per-level convention with @kbd{M-x org-convert-to-odd-levels
+RET} in that file. The reverse operation is @kbd{M-x
+org-convert-to-oddeven-levels}.
+@end enumerate
+
+@node TTY keys, Interaction, Clean view, Miscellaneous
+@section Using Org on a tty
+@cindex tty key bindings
+
+Because Org contains a large number of commands, by default many of
+Org's core commands are bound to keys that are generally not
+accessible on a tty, such as the cursor keys (@key{left}, @key{right},
+@key{up}, @key{down}), @key{TAB} and @key{RET}, in particular when used
+together with modifiers like @key{Meta} and/or @key{Shift}. To access
+these commands on a tty when special keys are unavailable, the following
+alternative bindings can be used. The tty bindings below will likely be
+more cumbersome; you may find for some of the bindings below that a
+customized workaround suits you better. For example, changing a timestamp
+is really only fun with @kbd{S-@key{cursor}} keys, whereas on a
+tty you would rather use @kbd{C-c .} to re-insert the timestamp.
+
+@multitable @columnfractions 0.15 0.2 0.1 0.2
+@item @b{Default} @tab @b{Alternative 1} @tab @b{Speed key} @tab @b{Alternative 2}
+@item @kbd{S-@key{TAB}} @tab @kbd{C-u @key{TAB}} @tab @kbd{C} @tab
+@item @kbd{M-@key{left}} @tab @kbd{C-c C-x l} @tab @kbd{l} @tab @kbd{@key{Esc} @key{left}}
+@item @kbd{M-S-@key{left}} @tab @kbd{C-c C-x L} @tab @kbd{L} @tab
+@item @kbd{M-@key{right}} @tab @kbd{C-c C-x r} @tab @kbd{r} @tab @kbd{@key{Esc} @key{right}}
+@item @kbd{M-S-@key{right}} @tab @kbd{C-c C-x R} @tab @kbd{R} @tab
+@item @kbd{M-@key{up}} @tab @kbd{C-c C-x u} @tab @kbd{ } @tab @kbd{@key{Esc} @key{up}}
+@item @kbd{M-S-@key{up}} @tab @kbd{C-c C-x U} @tab @kbd{U} @tab
+@item @kbd{M-@key{down}} @tab @kbd{C-c C-x d} @tab @kbd{ } @tab @kbd{@key{Esc} @key{down}}
+@item @kbd{M-S-@key{down}} @tab @kbd{C-c C-x D} @tab @kbd{D} @tab
+@item @kbd{S-@key{RET}} @tab @kbd{C-c C-x c} @tab @kbd{ } @tab
+@item @kbd{M-@key{RET}} @tab @kbd{C-c C-x m} @tab @kbd{ } @tab @kbd{@key{Esc} @key{RET}}
+@item @kbd{M-S-@key{RET}} @tab @kbd{C-c C-x M} @tab @kbd{ } @tab
+@item @kbd{S-@key{left}} @tab @kbd{C-c @key{left}} @tab @kbd{ } @tab
+@item @kbd{S-@key{right}} @tab @kbd{C-c @key{right}} @tab @kbd{ } @tab
+@item @kbd{S-@key{up}} @tab @kbd{C-c @key{up}} @tab @kbd{ } @tab
+@item @kbd{S-@key{down}} @tab @kbd{C-c @key{down}} @tab @kbd{ } @tab
+@item @kbd{C-S-@key{left}} @tab @kbd{C-c C-x @key{left}} @tab @kbd{ } @tab
+@item @kbd{C-S-@key{right}} @tab @kbd{C-c C-x @key{right}} @tab @kbd{ } @tab
+@end multitable
+
+
+@node Interaction, , TTY keys, Miscellaneous
+@section Interaction with other packages
+@cindex packages, interaction with other
+Org lives in the world of GNU Emacs and interacts in various ways
+with other code out there.
+
+@menu
+* Cooperation:: Packages Org cooperates with
+* Conflicts:: Packages that lead to conflicts
+@end menu
+
+@node Cooperation, Conflicts, Interaction, Interaction
+@subsection Packages that Org cooperates with
+
+@table @asis
+@cindex @file{calc.el}
+@cindex Gillespie, Dave
+@item @file{calc.el} by Dave Gillespie
+Org uses the Calc package for implementing spreadsheet
+functionality in its tables (@pxref{The spreadsheet}). Org
+checks for the availability of Calc by looking for the function
+@code{calc-eval} which will have been autoloaded during setup if Calc has
+been installed properly. As of Emacs 22, Calc is part of the Emacs
+distribution. Another possibility for interaction between the two
+packages is using Calc for embedded calculations. @xref{Embedded Mode,
+, Embedded Mode, Calc, GNU Emacs Calc Manual}.
+@item @file{constants.el} by Carsten Dominik
+@cindex @file{constants.el}
+@cindex Dominik, Carsten
+@vindex org-table-formula-constants
+In a table formula (@pxref{The spreadsheet}), it is possible to use
+names for natural constants or units. Instead of defining your own
+constants in the variable @code{org-table-formula-constants}, install
+the @file{constants} package which defines a large number of constants
+and units, and lets you use unit prefixes like @samp{M} for
+@samp{Mega}, etc@. You will need version 2.0 of this package, available
+at @url{http://www.astro.uva.nl/~dominik/Tools}. Org checks for
+the function @code{constants-get}, which has to be autoloaded in your
+setup. See the installation instructions in the file
+@file{constants.el}.
+@item @file{cdlatex.el} by Carsten Dominik
+@cindex @file{cdlatex.el}
+@cindex Dominik, Carsten
+Org-mode can make use of the CDLa@TeX{} package to efficiently enter
+@LaTeX{} fragments into Org files. See @ref{CDLaTeX mode}.
+@item @file{imenu.el} by Ake Stenhoff and Lars Lindberg
+@cindex @file{imenu.el}
+Imenu allows menu access to an index of items in a file. Org-mode
+supports Imenu---all you need to do to get the index is the following:
+@lisp
+(add-hook 'org-mode-hook
+ (lambda () (imenu-add-to-menubar "Imenu")))
+@end lisp
+@vindex org-imenu-depth
+By default the index is two levels deep---you can modify the depth using
+the option @code{org-imenu-depth}.
+@item @file{remember.el} by John Wiegley
+@cindex @file{remember.el}
+@cindex Wiegley, John
+Org used to use this package for capture, but no longer does.
+@item @file{speedbar.el} by Eric M. Ludlam
+@cindex @file{speedbar.el}
+@cindex Ludlam, Eric M.
+Speedbar is a package that creates a special frame displaying files and
+index items in files. Org-mode supports Speedbar and allows you to
+drill into Org files directly from the Speedbar. It also allows you to
+restrict the scope of agenda commands to a file or a subtree by using
+the command @kbd{<} in the Speedbar frame.
+@cindex @file{table.el}
+@item @file{table.el} by Takaaki Ota
+@kindex C-c C-c
+@cindex table editor, @file{table.el}
+@cindex @file{table.el}
+@cindex Ota, Takaaki
+
+Complex ASCII tables with automatic line wrapping, column- and row-spanning,
+and alignment can be created using the Emacs table package by Takaaki Ota
+(@uref{http://sourceforge.net/projects/table}, and also part of Emacs 22).
+Org-mode will recognize these tables and export them properly. Because of
+interference with other Org-mode functionality, you unfortunately cannot edit
+these tables directly in the buffer. Instead, you need to use the command
+@kbd{C-c '} to edit them, similar to source code snippets.
+
+@table @kbd
+@orgcmd{C-c ',org-edit-special}
+Edit a @file{table.el} table. Works when the cursor is in a table.el table.
+@c
+@orgcmd{C-c ~,org-table-create-with-table.el}
+Insert a @file{table.el} table. If there is already a table at point, this
+command converts it between the @file{table.el} format and the Org-mode
+format. See the documentation string of the command
+@code{org-convert-table} for the restrictions under which this is
+possible.
+@end table
+@file{table.el} is part of Emacs since Emacs 22.
+@item @file{footnote.el} by Steven L. Baur
+@cindex @file{footnote.el}
+@cindex Baur, Steven L.
+Org-mode recognizes numerical footnotes as provided by this package.
+However, Org-mode also has its own footnote support (@pxref{Footnotes}),
+which makes using @file{footnote.el} unnecessary.
+@end table
+
+@node Conflicts, , Cooperation, Interaction
+@subsection Packages that lead to conflicts with Org-mode
+
+@table @asis
+
+@cindex @code{shift-selection-mode}
+@vindex org-support-shift-select
+In Emacs 23, @code{shift-selection-mode} is on by default, meaning that
+cursor motions combined with the shift key should start or enlarge regions.
+This conflicts with the use of @kbd{S-@key{cursor}} commands in Org to change
+timestamps, TODO keywords, priorities, and item bullet types if the cursor is
+at such a location. By default, @kbd{S-@key{cursor}} commands outside
+special contexts don't do anything, but you can customize the variable
+@code{org-support-shift-select}. Org-mode then tries to accommodate shift
+selection by (i) using it outside of the special contexts where special
+commands apply, and by (ii) extending an existing active region even if the
+cursor moves across a special context.
+
+@item @file{CUA.el} by Kim. F. Storm
+@cindex @file{CUA.el}
+@cindex Storm, Kim. F.
+@vindex org-replace-disputed-keys
+Key bindings in Org conflict with the @kbd{S-<cursor>} keys used by CUA mode
+(as well as @code{pc-select-mode} and @code{s-region-mode}) to select and extend the
+region. In fact, Emacs 23 has this built-in in the form of
+@code{shift-selection-mode}, see previous paragraph. If you are using Emacs
+23, you probably don't want to use another package for this purpose. However,
+if you prefer to leave these keys to a different package while working in
+Org-mode, configure the variable @code{org-replace-disputed-keys}. When set,
+Org will move the following key bindings in Org files, and in the agenda
+buffer (but not during date selection).
+
+@example
+S-UP -> M-p S-DOWN -> M-n
+S-LEFT -> M-- S-RIGHT -> M-+
+C-S-LEFT -> M-S-- C-S-RIGHT -> M-S-+
+@end example
+
+@vindex org-disputed-keys
+Yes, these are unfortunately more difficult to remember. If you want
+to have other replacement keys, look at the variable
+@code{org-disputed-keys}.
+
+@item @file{yasnippet.el}
+@cindex @file{yasnippet.el}
+The way Org-mode binds the TAB key (binding to @code{[tab]} instead of
+@code{"\t"}) overrules YASnippet's access to this key. The following code
+fixed this problem:
+
+@lisp
+(add-hook 'org-mode-hook
+ (lambda ()
+ (org-set-local 'yas/trigger-key [tab])
+ (define-key yas/keymap [tab] 'yas/next-field-group)))
+@end lisp
+
+@item @file{windmove.el} by Hovav Shacham
+@cindex @file{windmove.el}
+This package also uses the @kbd{S-<cursor>} keys, so everything written
+in the paragraph above about CUA mode also applies here. If you want make
+the windmove function active in locations where Org-mode does not have
+special functionality on @kbd{S-@key{cursor}}, add this to your
+configuration:
+
+@lisp
+;; Make windmove work in org-mode:
+(add-hook 'org-shiftup-final-hook 'windmove-up)
+(add-hook 'org-shiftleft-final-hook 'windmove-left)
+(add-hook 'org-shiftdown-final-hook 'windmove-down)
+(add-hook 'org-shiftright-final-hook 'windmove-right)
+@end lisp
+
+@item @file{viper.el} by Michael Kifer
+@cindex @file{viper.el}
+@kindex C-c /
+Viper uses @kbd{C-c /} and therefore makes this key not access the
+corresponding Org-mode command @code{org-sparse-tree}. You need to find
+another key for this command, or override the key in
+@code{viper-vi-global-user-map} with
+
+@lisp
+(define-key viper-vi-global-user-map "C-c /" 'org-sparse-tree)
+@end lisp
+
+@end table
+
+
+@node Hacking, MobileOrg, Miscellaneous, Top
+@appendix Hacking
+@cindex hacking
+
+This appendix covers some aspects where users can extend the functionality of
+Org.
+
+@menu
+* Hooks:: Who to reach into Org's internals
+* Add-on packages:: Available extensions
+* Adding hyperlink types:: New custom link types
+* Context-sensitive commands:: How to add functionality to such commands
+* Tables in arbitrary syntax:: Orgtbl for @LaTeX{} and other programs
+* Dynamic blocks:: Automatically filled blocks
+* Special agenda views:: Customized views
+* Extracting agenda information:: Postprocessing of agenda information
+* Using the property API:: Writing programs that use entry properties
+* Using the mapping API:: Mapping over all or selected entries
+@end menu
+
+@node Hooks, Add-on packages, Hacking, Hacking
+@section Hooks
+@cindex hooks
+
+Org has a large number of hook variables that can be used to add
+functionality. This appendix about hacking is going to illustrate the
+use of some of them. A complete list of all hooks with documentation is
+maintained by the Worg project and can be found at
+@uref{http://orgmode.org/worg/org-configs/org-hooks.php}.
+
+@node Add-on packages, Adding hyperlink types, Hooks, Hacking
+@section Add-on packages
+@cindex add-on packages
+
+A large number of add-on packages have been written by various authors.
+These packages are not part of Emacs, but they are distributed as contributed
+packages with the separate release available at the Org-mode home page at
+@uref{http://orgmode.org}. The list of contributed packages, along with
+documentation about each package, is maintained by the Worg project at
+@uref{http://orgmode.org/worg/org-contrib/}.
+
+
+
+@node Adding hyperlink types, Context-sensitive commands, Add-on packages, Hacking
+@section Adding hyperlink types
+@cindex hyperlinks, adding new types
+
+Org has a large number of hyperlink types built-in
+(@pxref{Hyperlinks}). If you would like to add new link types, Org
+provides an interface for doing so. Let's look at an example file,
+@file{org-man.el}, that will add support for creating links like
+@samp{[[man:printf][The printf manpage]]} to show Unix manual pages inside
+Emacs:
+
+@lisp
+;;; org-man.el - Support for links to manpages in Org
+
+(require 'org)
+
+(org-add-link-type "man" 'org-man-open)
+(add-hook 'org-store-link-functions 'org-man-store-link)
+
+(defcustom org-man-command 'man
+ "The Emacs command to be used to display a man page."
+ :group 'org-link
+ :type '(choice (const man) (const woman)))
+
+(defun org-man-open (path)
+ "Visit the manpage on PATH.
+PATH should be a topic that can be thrown at the man command."
+ (funcall org-man-command path))
+
+(defun org-man-store-link ()
+ "Store a link to a manpage."
+ (when (memq major-mode '(Man-mode woman-mode))
+ ;; This is a man page, we do make this link
+ (let* ((page (org-man-get-page-name))
+ (link (concat "man:" page))
+ (description (format "Manpage for %s" page)))
+ (org-store-link-props
+ :type "man"
+ :link link
+ :description description))))
+
+(defun org-man-get-page-name ()
+ "Extract the page name from the buffer name."
+ ;; This works for both `Man-mode' and `woman-mode'.
+ (if (string-match " \\(\\S-+\\)\\*" (buffer-name))
+ (match-string 1 (buffer-name))
+ (error "Cannot create link to this man page")))
+
+(provide 'org-man)
+
+;;; org-man.el ends here
+@end lisp
+
+@noindent
+You would activate this new link type in @file{.emacs} with
+
+@lisp
+(require 'org-man)
+@end lisp
+
+@noindent
+Let's go through the file and see what it does.
+@enumerate
+@item
+It does @code{(require 'org)} to make sure that @file{org.el} has been
+loaded.
+@item
+The next line calls @code{org-add-link-type} to define a new link type
+with prefix @samp{man}. The call also contains the name of a function
+that will be called to follow such a link.
+@item
+@vindex org-store-link-functions
+The next line adds a function to @code{org-store-link-functions}, in
+order to allow the command @kbd{C-c l} to record a useful link in a
+buffer displaying a man page.
+@end enumerate
+
+The rest of the file defines the necessary variables and functions.
+First there is a customization variable that determines which Emacs
+command should be used to display man pages. There are two options,
+@code{man} and @code{woman}. Then the function to follow a link is
+defined. It gets the link path as an argument---in this case the link
+path is just a topic for the manual command. The function calls the
+value of @code{org-man-command} to display the man page.
+
+Finally the function @code{org-man-store-link} is defined. When you try
+to store a link with @kbd{C-c l}, this function will be called to
+try to make a link. The function must first decide if it is supposed to
+create the link for this buffer type; we do this by checking the value
+of the variable @code{major-mode}. If not, the function must exit and
+return the value @code{nil}. If yes, the link is created by getting the
+manual topic from the buffer name and prefixing it with the string
+@samp{man:}. Then it must call the command @code{org-store-link-props}
+and set the @code{:type} and @code{:link} properties. Optionally you
+can also set the @code{:description} property to provide a default for
+the link description when the link is later inserted into an Org
+buffer with @kbd{C-c C-l}.
+
+When it makes sense for your new link type, you may also define a function
+@code{org-PREFIX-complete-link} that implements special (e.g. completion)
+support for inserting such a link with @kbd{C-c C-l}. Such a function should
+not accept any arguments, and return the full link with prefix.
+
+@node Context-sensitive commands, Tables in arbitrary syntax, Adding hyperlink types, Hacking
+@section Context-sensitive commands
+@cindex context-sensitive commands, hooks
+@cindex add-ons, context-sensitive commands
+@vindex org-ctrl-c-ctrl-c-hook
+
+Org has several commands that act differently depending on context. The most
+important example it the @kbd{C-c C-c} (@pxref{The very busy C-c C-c key}).
+Also the @kbd{M-cursor} and @kbd{M-S-cursor} keys have this property.
+
+Add-ons can tap into this functionality by providing a function that detects
+special context for that add-on and executes functionality appropriate for
+the context. Here is an example from Dan Davison's @file{org-R.el} which
+allows you to evaluate commands based on the @file{R} programming language
+@footnote{@file{org-R.el} has been replaced by the org-mode functionality
+described in @ref{Working With Source Code} and is now obsolete.}. For this
+package, special contexts are lines that start with @code{#+R:} or
+@code{#+RR:}.
+
+@lisp
+(defun org-R-apply-maybe ()
+ "Detect if this is context for org-R and execute R commands."
+ (if (save-excursion
+ (beginning-of-line 1)
+ (looking-at "#\\+RR?:"))
+ (progn (call-interactively 'org-R-apply)
+ t) ;; to signal that we took action
+ nil)) ;; to signal that we did not
+
+(add-hook 'org-ctrl-c-ctrl-c-hook 'org-R-apply-maybe)
+@end lisp
+
+The function first checks if the cursor is in such a line. If that is the
+case, @code{org-R-apply} is called and the function returns @code{t} to
+signal that action was taken, and @kbd{C-c C-c} will stop looking for other
+contexts. If the function finds it should do nothing locally, it returns @code{nil} so that other, similar functions can have a try.
+
+
+@node Tables in arbitrary syntax, Dynamic blocks, Context-sensitive commands, Hacking
+@section Tables and lists in arbitrary syntax
+@cindex tables, in other modes
+@cindex lists, in other modes
+@cindex Orgtbl mode
+
+Since Orgtbl mode can be used as a minor mode in arbitrary buffers, a
+frequent feature request has been to make it work with native tables in
+specific languages, for example @LaTeX{}. However, this is extremely
+hard to do in a general way, would lead to a customization nightmare,
+and would take away much of the simplicity of the Orgtbl-mode table
+editor.
+
+This appendix describes a different approach. We keep the Orgtbl mode
+table in its native format (the @i{source table}), and use a custom
+function to @i{translate} the table to the correct syntax, and to
+@i{install} it in the right location (the @i{target table}). This puts
+the burden of writing conversion functions on the user, but it allows
+for a very flexible system.
+
+Bastien added the ability to do the same with lists, in Orgstruct mode. You
+can use Org's facilities to edit and structure lists by turning
+@code{orgstruct-mode} on, then locally exporting such lists in another format
+(HTML, @LaTeX{} or Texinfo.)
+
+
+@menu
+* Radio tables:: Sending and receiving radio tables
+* A LaTeX example:: Step by step, almost a tutorial
+* Translator functions:: Copy and modify
+* Radio lists:: Doing the same for lists
+@end menu
+
+@node Radio tables, A LaTeX example, Tables in arbitrary syntax, Tables in arbitrary syntax
+@subsection Radio tables
+@cindex radio tables
+
+To define the location of the target table, you first need to create two
+lines that are comments in the current mode, but contain magic words for
+Orgtbl mode to find. Orgtbl mode will insert the translated table
+between these lines, replacing whatever was there before. For example:
+
+@example
+/* BEGIN RECEIVE ORGTBL table_name */
+/* END RECEIVE ORGTBL table_name */
+@end example
+
+@noindent
+Just above the source table, we put a special line that tells
+Orgtbl mode how to translate this table and where to install it. For
+example:
+@cindex #+ORGTBL
+@example
+#+ORGTBL: SEND table_name translation_function arguments....
+@end example
+
+@noindent
+@code{table_name} is the reference name for the table that is also used
+in the receiver lines. @code{translation_function} is the Lisp function
+that does the translation. Furthermore, the line can contain a list of
+arguments (alternating key and value) at the end. The arguments will be
+passed as a property list to the translation function for
+interpretation. A few standard parameters are already recognized and
+acted upon before the translation function is called:
+
+@table @code
+@item :skip N
+Skip the first N lines of the table. Hlines do count as separate lines for
+this parameter!
+
+@item :skipcols (n1 n2 ...)
+List of columns that should be skipped. If the table has a column with
+calculation marks, that column is automatically discarded as well.
+Please note that the translator function sees the table @emph{after} the
+removal of these columns, the function never knows that there have been
+additional columns.
+@end table
+
+@noindent
+The one problem remaining is how to keep the source table in the buffer
+without disturbing the normal workings of the file, for example during
+compilation of a C file or processing of a @LaTeX{} file. There are a
+number of different solutions:
+
+@itemize @bullet
+@item
+The table could be placed in a block comment if that is supported by the
+language. For example, in C mode you could wrap the table between
+@samp{/*} and @samp{*/} lines.
+@item
+Sometimes it is possible to put the table after some kind of @i{END}
+statement, for example @samp{\bye} in @TeX{} and @samp{\end@{document@}}
+in @LaTeX{}.
+@item
+You can just comment the table line-by-line whenever you want to process
+the file, and uncomment it whenever you need to edit the table. This
+only sounds tedious---the command @kbd{M-x orgtbl-toggle-comment}
+makes this comment-toggling very easy, in particular if you bind it to a
+key.
+@end itemize
+
+@node A LaTeX example, Translator functions, Radio tables, Tables in arbitrary syntax
+@subsection A @LaTeX{} example of radio tables
+@cindex @LaTeX{}, and Orgtbl mode
+
+The best way to wrap the source table in @LaTeX{} is to use the
+@code{comment} environment provided by @file{comment.sty}. It has to be
+activated by placing @code{\usepackage@{comment@}} into the document
+header. Orgtbl mode can insert a radio table skeleton@footnote{By
+default this works only for @LaTeX{}, HTML, and Texinfo. Configure the
+variable @code{orgtbl-radio-tables} to install templates for other
+modes.} with the command @kbd{M-x orgtbl-insert-radio-table}. You will
+be prompted for a table name, let's say we use @samp{salesfigures}. You
+will then get the following template:
+
+@cindex #+ORGTBL, SEND
+@example
+% BEGIN RECEIVE ORGTBL salesfigures
+% END RECEIVE ORGTBL salesfigures
+\begin@{comment@}
+#+ORGTBL: SEND salesfigures orgtbl-to-latex
+| | |
+\end@{comment@}
+@end example
+
+@noindent
+@vindex @LaTeX{}-verbatim-environments
+The @code{#+ORGTBL: SEND} line tells Orgtbl mode to use the function
+@code{orgtbl-to-latex} to convert the table into @LaTeX{} and to put it
+into the receiver location with name @code{salesfigures}. You may now
+fill in the table---feel free to use the spreadsheet features@footnote{If
+the @samp{#+TBLFM} line contains an odd number of dollar characters,
+this may cause problems with font-lock in @LaTeX{} mode. As shown in the
+example you can fix this by adding an extra line inside the
+@code{comment} environment that is used to balance the dollar
+expressions. If you are using AUC@TeX{} with the font-latex library, a
+much better solution is to add the @code{comment} environment to the
+variable @code{LaTeX-verbatim-environments}.}:
+
+@example
+% BEGIN RECEIVE ORGTBL salesfigures
+% END RECEIVE ORGTBL salesfigures
+\begin@{comment@}
+#+ORGTBL: SEND salesfigures orgtbl-to-latex
+| Month | Days | Nr sold | per day |
+|-------+------+---------+---------|
+| Jan | 23 | 55 | 2.4 |
+| Feb | 21 | 16 | 0.8 |
+| March | 22 | 278 | 12.6 |
+#+TBLFM: $4=$3/$2;%.1f
+% $ (optional extra dollar to keep font-lock happy, see footnote)
+\end@{comment@}
+@end example
+
+@noindent
+When you are done, press @kbd{C-c C-c} in the table to get the converted
+table inserted between the two marker lines.
+
+Now let's assume you want to make the table header by hand, because you
+want to control how columns are aligned, etc@. In this case we make sure
+that the table translator skips the first 2 lines of the source
+table, and tell the command to work as a @i{splice}, i.e. to not produce
+header and footer commands of the target table:
+
+@example
+\begin@{tabular@}@{lrrr@}
+Month & \multicolumn@{1@}@{c@}@{Days@} & Nr.\ sold & per day\\
+% BEGIN RECEIVE ORGTBL salesfigures
+% END RECEIVE ORGTBL salesfigures
+\end@{tabular@}
+%
+\begin@{comment@}
+#+ORGTBL: SEND salesfigures orgtbl-to-latex :splice t :skip 2
+| Month | Days | Nr sold | per day |
+|-------+------+---------+---------|
+| Jan | 23 | 55 | 2.4 |
+| Feb | 21 | 16 | 0.8 |
+| March | 22 | 278 | 12.6 |
+#+TBLFM: $4=$3/$2;%.1f
+\end@{comment@}
+@end example
+
+The @LaTeX{} translator function @code{orgtbl-to-latex} is already part of
+Orgtbl mode. It uses a @code{tabular} environment to typeset the table
+and marks horizontal lines with @code{\hline}. Furthermore, it
+interprets the following parameters (see also @pxref{Translator functions}):
+
+@table @code
+@item :splice nil/t
+When set to t, return only table body lines, don't wrap them into a
+tabular environment. Default is nil.
+
+@item :fmt fmt
+A format to be used to wrap each field, it should contain @code{%s} for the
+original field value. For example, to wrap each field value in dollars,
+you could use @code{:fmt "$%s$"}. This may also be a property list with
+column numbers and formats. for example @code{:fmt (2 "$%s$" 4 "%s\\%%")}.
+A function of one argument can be used in place of the strings; the
+function must return a formatted string.
+
+@item :efmt efmt
+Use this format to print numbers with exponentials. The format should
+have @code{%s} twice for inserting mantissa and exponent, for example
+@code{"%s\\times10^@{%s@}"}. The default is @code{"%s\\,(%s)"}. This
+may also be a property list with column numbers and formats, for example
+@code{:efmt (2 "$%s\\times10^@{%s@}$" 4 "$%s\\cdot10^@{%s@}$")}. After
+@code{efmt} has been applied to a value, @code{fmt} will also be
+applied. Similar to @code{fmt}, functions of two arguments can be
+supplied instead of strings.
+@end table
+
+@node Translator functions, Radio lists, A LaTeX example, Tables in arbitrary syntax
+@subsection Translator functions
+@cindex HTML, and Orgtbl mode
+@cindex translator function
+
+Orgtbl mode has several translator functions built-in: @code{orgtbl-to-csv}
+(comma-separated values), @code{orgtbl-to-tsv} (TAB-separated values)
+@code{orgtbl-to-latex}, @code{orgtbl-to-html}, and @code{orgtbl-to-texinfo}.
+Except for @code{orgtbl-to-html}@footnote{The HTML translator uses the same
+code that produces tables during HTML export.}, these all use a generic
+translator, @code{orgtbl-to-generic}. For example, @code{orgtbl-to-latex}
+itself is a very short function that computes the column definitions for the
+@code{tabular} environment, defines a few field and line separators and then
+hands processing over to the generic translator. Here is the entire code:
+
+@lisp
+@group
+(defun orgtbl-to-latex (table params)
+ "Convert the Orgtbl mode TABLE to LaTeX."
+ (let* ((alignment (mapconcat (lambda (x) (if x "r" "l"))
+ org-table-last-alignment ""))
+ (params2
+ (list
+ :tstart (concat "\\begin@{tabular@}@{" alignment "@}")
+ :tend "\\end@{tabular@}"
+ :lstart "" :lend " \\\\" :sep " & "
+ :efmt "%s\\,(%s)" :hline "\\hline")))
+ (orgtbl-to-generic table (org-combine-plists params2 params))))
+@end group
+@end lisp
+
+As you can see, the properties passed into the function (variable
+@var{PARAMS}) are combined with the ones newly defined in the function
+(variable @var{PARAMS2}). The ones passed into the function (i.e. the
+ones set by the @samp{ORGTBL SEND} line) take precedence. So if you
+would like to use the @LaTeX{} translator, but wanted the line endings to
+be @samp{\\[2mm]} instead of the default @samp{\\}, you could just
+overrule the default with
+
+@example
+#+ORGTBL: SEND test orgtbl-to-latex :lend " \\\\[2mm]"
+@end example
+
+For a new language, you can either write your own converter function in
+analogy with the @LaTeX{} translator, or you can use the generic function
+directly. For example, if you have a language where a table is started
+with @samp{!BTBL!}, ended with @samp{!ETBL!}, and where table lines are
+started with @samp{!BL!}, ended with @samp{!EL!}, and where the field
+separator is a TAB, you could call the generic translator like this (on
+a single line!):
+
+@example
+#+ORGTBL: SEND test orgtbl-to-generic :tstart "!BTBL!" :tend "!ETBL!"
+ :lstart "!BL! " :lend " !EL!" :sep "\t"
+@end example
+
+@noindent
+Please check the documentation string of the function
+@code{orgtbl-to-generic} for a full list of parameters understood by
+that function, and remember that you can pass each of them into
+@code{orgtbl-to-latex}, @code{orgtbl-to-texinfo}, and any other function
+using the generic function.
+
+Of course you can also write a completely new function doing complicated
+things the generic translator cannot do. A translator function takes
+two arguments. The first argument is the table, a list of lines, each
+line either the symbol @code{hline} or a list of fields. The second
+argument is the property list containing all parameters specified in the
+@samp{#+ORGTBL: SEND} line. The function must return a single string
+containing the formatted table. If you write a generally useful
+translator, please post it on @email{emacs-orgmode@@gnu.org} so that
+others can benefit from your work.
+
+@node Radio lists, , Translator functions, Tables in arbitrary syntax
+@subsection Radio lists
+@cindex radio lists
+@cindex org-list-insert-radio-list
+
+Sending and receiving radio lists works exactly the same way as sending and
+receiving radio tables (@pxref{Radio tables}). As for radio tables, you can
+insert radio list templates in HTML, @LaTeX{} and Texinfo modes by calling
+@code{org-list-insert-radio-list}.
+
+Here are the differences with radio tables:
+
+@itemize @minus
+@item
+Orgstruct mode must be active.
+@item
+Use the @code{ORGLST} keyword instead of @code{ORGTBL}.
+@item
+The available translation functions for radio lists don't take
+parameters.
+@item
+@kbd{C-c C-c} will work when pressed on the first item of the list.
+@end itemize
+
+Here is a @LaTeX{} example. Let's say that you have this in your
+@LaTeX{} file:
+
+@cindex #+ORGLST
+@example
+% BEGIN RECEIVE ORGLST to-buy
+% END RECEIVE ORGLST to-buy
+\begin@{comment@}
+#+ORGLST: SEND to-buy org-list-to-latex
+- a new house
+- a new computer
+ + a new keyboard
+ + a new mouse
+- a new life
+\end@{comment@}
+@end example
+
+Pressing `C-c C-c' on @code{a new house} and will insert the converted
+@LaTeX{} list between the two marker lines.
+
+@node Dynamic blocks, Special agenda views, Tables in arbitrary syntax, Hacking
+@section Dynamic blocks
+@cindex dynamic blocks
+
+Org documents can contain @emph{dynamic blocks}. These are
+specially marked regions that are updated by some user-written function.
+A good example for such a block is the clock table inserted by the
+command @kbd{C-c C-x C-r} (@pxref{Clocking work time}).
+
+Dynamic blocks are enclosed by a BEGIN-END structure that assigns a name
+to the block and can also specify parameters for the function producing
+the content of the block.
+
+@cindex #+BEGIN:dynamic block
+@example
+#+BEGIN: myblock :parameter1 value1 :parameter2 value2 ...
+
+#+END:
+@end example
+
+Dynamic blocks are updated with the following commands
+
+@table @kbd
+@orgcmd{C-c C-x C-u,org-dblock-update}
+Update dynamic block at point.
+@orgkey{C-u C-c C-x C-u}
+Update all dynamic blocks in the current file.
+@end table
+
+Updating a dynamic block means to remove all the text between BEGIN and
+END, parse the BEGIN line for parameters and then call the specific
+writer function for this block to insert the new content. If you want
+to use the original content in the writer function, you can use the
+extra parameter @code{:content}.
+
+For a block with name @code{myblock}, the writer function is
+@code{org-dblock-write:myblock} with as only parameter a property list
+with the parameters given in the begin line. Here is a trivial example
+of a block that keeps track of when the block update function was last
+run:
+
+@example
+#+BEGIN: block-update-time :format "on %m/%d/%Y at %H:%M"
+
+#+END:
+@end example
+
+@noindent
+The corresponding block writer function could look like this:
+
+@lisp
+(defun org-dblock-write:block-update-time (params)
+ (let ((fmt (or (plist-get params :format) "%d. %m. %Y")))
+ (insert "Last block update at: "
+ (format-time-string fmt (current-time)))))
+@end lisp
+
+If you want to make sure that all dynamic blocks are always up-to-date,
+you could add the function @code{org-update-all-dblocks} to a hook, for
+example @code{before-save-hook}. @code{org-update-all-dblocks} is
+written in a way such that it does nothing in buffers that are not in
+@code{org-mode}.
+
+@node Special agenda views, Extracting agenda information, Dynamic blocks, Hacking
+@section Special agenda views
+@cindex agenda views, user-defined
+
+Org provides a special hook that can be used to narrow down the selection
+made by these agenda views: @code{todo}, @code{alltodo}, @code{tags}, @code{tags-todo},
+@code{tags-tree}. You may specify a function that is used at each match to verify
+if the match should indeed be part of the agenda view, and if not, how
+much should be skipped.
+
+Let's say you want to produce a list of projects that contain a WAITING
+tag anywhere in the project tree. Let's further assume that you have
+marked all tree headings that define a project with the TODO keyword
+PROJECT. In this case you would run a TODO search for the keyword
+PROJECT, but skip the match unless there is a WAITING tag anywhere in
+the subtree belonging to the project line.
+
+To achieve this, you must write a function that searches the subtree for
+the tag. If the tag is found, the function must return @code{nil} to
+indicate that this match should not be skipped. If there is no such
+tag, return the location of the end of the subtree, to indicate that
+search should continue from there.
+
+@lisp
+(defun my-skip-unless-waiting ()
+ "Skip trees that are not waiting"
+ (let ((subtree-end (save-excursion (org-end-of-subtree t))))
+ (if (re-search-forward ":waiting:" subtree-end t)
+ nil ; tag found, do not skip
+ subtree-end))) ; tag not found, continue after end of subtree
+@end lisp
+
+Now you may use this function in an agenda custom command, for example
+like this:
+
+@lisp
+(org-add-agenda-custom-command
+ '("b" todo "PROJECT"
+ ((org-agenda-skip-function 'my-skip-unless-waiting)
+ (org-agenda-overriding-header "Projects waiting for something: "))))
+@end lisp
+
+@vindex org-agenda-overriding-header
+Note that this also binds @code{org-agenda-overriding-header} to get a
+meaningful header in the agenda view.
+
+@vindex org-odd-levels-only
+@vindex org-agenda-skip-function
+A general way to create custom searches is to base them on a search for
+entries with a certain level limit. If you want to study all entries with
+your custom search function, simply do a search for
+@samp{LEVEL>0}@footnote{Note that, when using @code{org-odd-levels-only}, a
+level number corresponds to order in the hierarchy, not to the number of
+stars.}, and then use @code{org-agenda-skip-function} to select the entries
+you really want to have.
+
+You may also put a Lisp form into @code{org-agenda-skip-function}. In
+particular, you may use the functions @code{org-agenda-skip-entry-if}
+and @code{org-agenda-skip-subtree-if} in this form, for example:
+
+@table @code
+@item '(org-agenda-skip-entry-if 'scheduled)
+Skip current entry if it has been scheduled.
+@item '(org-agenda-skip-entry-if 'notscheduled)
+Skip current entry if it has not been scheduled.
+@item '(org-agenda-skip-entry-if 'deadline)
+Skip current entry if it has a deadline.
+@item '(org-agenda-skip-entry-if 'scheduled 'deadline)
+Skip current entry if it has a deadline, or if it is scheduled.
+@item '(org-agenda-skip-entry-if 'todo '("TODO" "WAITING"))
+Skip current entry if the TODO keyword is TODO or WAITING.
+@item '(org-agenda-skip-entry-if 'todo 'done)
+Skip current entry if the TODO keyword marks a DONE state.
+@item '(org-agenda-skip-entry-if 'timestamp)
+Skip current entry if it has any timestamp, may also be deadline or scheduled.
+@item '(org-agenda-skip-entry 'regexp "regular expression")
+Skip current entry if the regular expression matches in the entry.
+@item '(org-agenda-skip-entry 'notregexp "regular expression")
+Skip current entry unless the regular expression matches.
+@item '(org-agenda-skip-subtree-if 'regexp "regular expression")
+Same as above, but check and skip the entire subtree.
+@end table
+
+Therefore we could also have written the search for WAITING projects
+like this, even without defining a special function:
+
+@lisp
+(org-add-agenda-custom-command
+ '("b" todo "PROJECT"
+ ((org-agenda-skip-function '(org-agenda-skip-subtree-if
+ 'regexp ":waiting:"))
+ (org-agenda-overriding-header "Projects waiting for something: "))))
+@end lisp
+
+@node Extracting agenda information, Using the property API, Special agenda views, Hacking
+@section Extracting agenda information
+@cindex agenda, pipe
+@cindex Scripts, for agenda processing
+
+@vindex org-agenda-custom-commands
+Org provides commands to access agenda information for the command
+line in Emacs batch mode. This extracted information can be sent
+directly to a printer, or it can be read by a program that does further
+processing of the data. The first of these commands is the function
+@code{org-batch-agenda}, that produces an agenda view and sends it as
+ASCII text to STDOUT. The command takes a single string as parameter.
+If the string has length 1, it is used as a key to one of the commands
+you have configured in @code{org-agenda-custom-commands}, basically any
+key you can use after @kbd{C-c a}. For example, to directly print the
+current TODO list, you could use
+
+@example
+emacs -batch -l ~/.emacs -eval '(org-batch-agenda "t")' | lpr
+@end example
+
+If the parameter is a string with 2 or more characters, it is used as a
+tags/TODO match string. For example, to print your local shopping list
+(all items with the tag @samp{shop}, but excluding the tag
+@samp{NewYork}), you could use
+
+@example
+emacs -batch -l ~/.emacs \
+ -eval '(org-batch-agenda "+shop-NewYork")' | lpr
+@end example
+
+@noindent
+You may also modify parameters on the fly like this:
+
+@example
+emacs -batch -l ~/.emacs \
+ -eval '(org-batch-agenda "a" \
+ org-agenda-span month \
+ org-agenda-include-diary nil \
+ org-agenda-files (quote ("~/org/project.org")))' \
+ | lpr
+@end example
+
+@noindent
+which will produce a 30-day agenda, fully restricted to the Org file
+@file{~/org/projects.org}, not even including the diary.
+
+If you want to process the agenda data in more sophisticated ways, you
+can use the command @code{org-batch-agenda-csv} to get a comma-separated
+list of values for each agenda item. Each line in the output will
+contain a number of fields separated by commas. The fields in a line
+are:
+
+@example
+category @r{The category of the item}
+head @r{The headline, without TODO keyword, TAGS and PRIORITY}
+type @r{The type of the agenda entry, can be}
+ todo @r{selected in TODO match}
+ tagsmatch @r{selected in tags match}
+ diary @r{imported from diary}
+ deadline @r{a deadline}
+ scheduled @r{scheduled}
+ timestamp @r{appointment, selected by timestamp}
+ closed @r{entry was closed on date}
+ upcoming-deadline @r{warning about nearing deadline}
+ past-scheduled @r{forwarded scheduled item}
+ block @r{entry has date block including date}
+todo @r{The TODO keyword, if any}
+tags @r{All tags including inherited ones, separated by colons}
+date @r{The relevant date, like 2007-2-14}
+time @r{The time, like 15:00-16:50}
+extra @r{String with extra planning info}
+priority-l @r{The priority letter if any was given}
+priority-n @r{The computed numerical priority}
+@end example
+
+@noindent
+Time and date will only be given if a timestamp (or deadline/scheduled)
+led to the selection of the item.
+
+A CSV list like this is very easy to use in a post-processing script.
+For example, here is a Perl program that gets the TODO list from
+Emacs/Org and prints all the items, preceded by a checkbox:
+
+@example
+#!/usr/bin/perl
+
+# define the Emacs command to run
+$cmd = "emacs -batch -l ~/.emacs -eval '(org-batch-agenda-csv \"t\")'";
+
+# run it and capture the output
+$agenda = qx@{$cmd 2>/dev/null@};
+
+# loop over all lines
+foreach $line (split(/\n/,$agenda)) @{
+ # get the individual values
+ ($category,$head,$type,$todo,$tags,$date,$time,$extra,
+ $priority_l,$priority_n) = split(/,/,$line);
+ # process and print
+ print "[ ] $head\n";
+@}
+@end example
+
+@node Using the property API, Using the mapping API, Extracting agenda information, Hacking
+@section Using the property API
+@cindex API, for properties
+@cindex properties, API
+
+Here is a description of the functions that can be used to work with
+properties.
+
+@defun org-entry-properties &optional pom which
+Get all properties of the entry at point-or-marker POM.@*
+This includes the TODO keyword, the tags, time strings for deadline,
+scheduled, and clocking, and any additional properties defined in the
+entry. The return value is an alist. Keys may occur multiple times
+if the property key was used several times.@*
+POM may also be nil, in which case the current entry is used.
+If WHICH is nil or `all', get all properties. If WHICH is
+`special' or `standard', only get that subclass.
+@end defun
+@vindex org-use-property-inheritance
+@defun org-entry-get pom property &optional inherit
+Get value of PROPERTY for entry at point-or-marker POM. By default,
+this only looks at properties defined locally in the entry. If INHERIT
+is non-nil and the entry does not have the property, then also check
+higher levels of the hierarchy. If INHERIT is the symbol
+@code{selective}, use inheritance if and only if the setting of
+@code{org-use-property-inheritance} selects PROPERTY for inheritance.
+@end defun
+
+@defun org-entry-delete pom property
+Delete the property PROPERTY from entry at point-or-marker POM.
+@end defun
+
+@defun org-entry-put pom property value
+Set PROPERTY to VALUE for entry at point-or-marker POM.
+@end defun
+
+@defun org-buffer-property-keys &optional include-specials
+Get all property keys in the current buffer.
+@end defun
+
+@defun org-insert-property-drawer
+Insert a property drawer at point.
+@end defun
+
+@defun org-entry-put-multivalued-property pom property &rest values
+Set PROPERTY at point-or-marker POM to VALUES. VALUES should be a list of
+strings. They will be concatenated, with spaces as separators.
+@end defun
+
+@defun org-entry-get-multivalued-property pom property
+Treat the value of the property PROPERTY as a whitespace-separated list of
+values and return the values as a list of strings.
+@end defun
+
+@defun org-entry-add-to-multivalued-property pom property value
+Treat the value of the property PROPERTY as a whitespace-separated list of
+values and make sure that VALUE is in this list.
+@end defun
+
+@defun org-entry-remove-from-multivalued-property pom property value
+Treat the value of the property PROPERTY as a whitespace-separated list of
+values and make sure that VALUE is @emph{not} in this list.
+@end defun
+
+@defun org-entry-member-in-multivalued-property pom property value
+Treat the value of the property PROPERTY as a whitespace-separated list of
+values and check if VALUE is in this list.
+@end defun
+
+@defopt org-property-allowed-value-functions
+Hook for functions supplying allowed values for a specific property.
+The functions must take a single argument, the name of the property, and
+return a flat list of allowed values. If @samp{:ETC} is one of
+the values, use the values as completion help, but allow also other values
+to be entered. The functions must return @code{nil} if they are not
+responsible for this property.
+@end defopt
+
+@node Using the mapping API, , Using the property API, Hacking
+@section Using the mapping API
+@cindex API, for mapping
+@cindex mapping entries, API
+
+Org has sophisticated mapping capabilities to find all entries satisfying
+certain criteria. Internally, this functionality is used to produce agenda
+views, but there is also an API that can be used to execute arbitrary
+functions for each or selected entries. The main entry point for this API
+is:
+
+@defun org-map-entries func &optional match scope &rest skip
+Call FUNC at each headline selected by MATCH in SCOPE.
+
+FUNC is a function or a Lisp form. The function will be called without
+arguments, with the cursor positioned at the beginning of the headline.
+The return values of all calls to the function will be collected and
+returned as a list.
+
+The call to FUNC will be wrapped into a save-excursion form, so FUNC
+does not need to preserve point. After evaluation, the cursor will be
+moved to the end of the line (presumably of the headline of the
+processed entry) and search continues from there. Under some
+circumstances, this may not produce the wanted results. For example,
+if you have removed (e.g. archived) the current (sub)tree it could
+mean that the next entry will be skipped entirely. In such cases, you
+can specify the position from where search should continue by making
+FUNC set the variable `org-map-continue-from' to the desired buffer
+position.
+
+MATCH is a tags/property/todo match as it is used in the agenda match view.
+Only headlines that are matched by this query will be considered during
+the iteration. When MATCH is nil or t, all headlines will be
+visited by the iteration.
+
+SCOPE determines the scope of this command. It can be any of:
+
+@example
+nil @r{the current buffer, respecting the restriction if any}
+tree @r{the subtree started with the entry at point}
+file @r{the current buffer, without restriction}
+file-with-archives
+ @r{the current buffer, and any archives associated with it}
+agenda @r{all agenda files}
+agenda-with-archives
+ @r{all agenda files with any archive files associated with them}
+(file1 file2 ...)
+ @r{if this is a list, all files in the list will be scanned}
+@end example
+@noindent
+The remaining args are treated as settings for the skipping facilities of
+the scanner. The following items can be given here:
+
+@vindex org-agenda-skip-function
+@example
+archive @r{skip trees with the archive tag}
+comment @r{skip trees with the COMMENT keyword}
+function or Lisp form
+ @r{will be used as value for @code{org-agenda-skip-function},}
+ @r{so whenever the function returns t, FUNC}
+ @r{will not be called for that entry and search will}
+ @r{continue from the point where the function leaves it}
+@end example
+@end defun
+
+The function given to that mapping routine can really do anything you like.
+It can use the property API (@pxref{Using the property API}) to gather more
+information about the entry, or in order to change metadata in the entry.
+Here are a couple of functions that might be handy:
+
+@defun org-todo &optional arg
+Change the TODO state of the entry. See the docstring of the functions for
+the many possible values for the argument ARG.
+@end defun
+
+@defun org-priority &optional action
+Change the priority of the entry. See the docstring of this function for the
+possible values for ACTION.
+@end defun
+
+@defun org-toggle-tag tag &optional onoff
+Toggle the tag TAG in the current entry. Setting ONOFF to either @code{on}
+or @code{off} will not toggle tag, but ensure that it is either on or off.
+@end defun
+
+@defun org-promote
+Promote the current entry.
+@end defun
+
+@defun org-demote
+Demote the current entry.
+@end defun
+
+Here is a simple example that will turn all entries in the current file with
+a tag @code{TOMORROW} into TODO entries with the keyword @code{UPCOMING}.
+Entries in comment trees and in archive trees will be ignored.
+
+@lisp
+(org-map-entries
+ '(org-todo "UPCOMING")
+ "+TOMORROW" 'file 'archive 'comment)
+@end lisp
+
+The following example counts the number of entries with TODO keyword
+@code{WAITING}, in all agenda files.
+
+@lisp
+(length (org-map-entries t "/+WAITING" 'agenda))
+@end lisp
+
+@node MobileOrg, History and Acknowledgments, Hacking, Top
+@appendix MobileOrg
+@cindex iPhone
+@cindex MobileOrg
+
+@uref{http://mobileorg.ncogni.to/, MobileOrg} is an application for the
+@i{iPhone/iPod Touch} series of devices, developed by Richard Moreland.
+@i{MobileOrg} offers offline viewing and capture support for an Org-mode
+system rooted on a ``real'' computer. It does also allow you to record
+changes to existing entries. Android users should check out
+@uref{http://wiki.github.com/matburt/mobileorg-android/, MobileOrg Android}
+by Matt Jones.
+
+This appendix describes the support Org has for creating agenda views in a
+format that can be displayed by @i{MobileOrg}, and for integrating notes
+captured and changes made by @i{MobileOrg} into the main system.
+
+For changing tags and TODO states in MobileOrg, you should have set up the
+customization variables @code{org-todo-keywords} and @code{org-tags-alist} to
+cover all important tags and TODO keywords, even if individual files use only
+part of these. MobileOrg will also offer you states and tags set up with
+in-buffer settings, but it will understand the logistics of TODO state
+@i{sets} (@pxref{Per-file keywords}) and @i{mutually exclusive} tags
+(@pxref{Setting tags}) only for those set in these variables.
+
+@menu
+* Setting up the staging area:: Where to interact with the mobile device
+* Pushing to MobileOrg:: Uploading Org files and agendas
+* Pulling from MobileOrg:: Integrating captured and flagged items
+@end menu
+
+@node Setting up the staging area, Pushing to MobileOrg, MobileOrg, MobileOrg
+@section Setting up the staging area
+
+MobileOrg needs to interact with Emacs through a directory on a server. If you
+are using a public server, you should consider to encrypt the files that are
+uploaded to the server. This can be done with Org-mode 7.02 and with
+@i{MobileOrg 1.5} (iPhone version), and you need an @file{openssl}
+installation on your system. To turn on encryption, set a password in
+@i{MobileOrg} and, on the Emacs side, configure the variable
+@code{org-mobile-use-encryption}@footnote{If you can safely store the
+password in your Emacs setup, you might also want to configure
+@code{org-mobile-encryption-password}. Please read the docstring of that
+variable. Note that encryption will apply only to the contents of the
+@file{.org} files. The file names themselves will remain visible.}.
+
+The easiest way to create that directory is to use a free
+@uref{http://dropbox.com,Dropbox.com} account@footnote{If you cannot use
+Dropbox, or if your version of MobileOrg does not support it, you can use a
+webdav server. For more information, check out the documentation of MobileOrg and also this
+@uref{http://orgmode.org/worg/org-faq.php#mobileorg_webdav, FAQ entry}.}.
+When MobileOrg first connects to your Dropbox, it will create a directory
+@i{MobileOrg} inside the Dropbox. After the directory has been created, tell
+Emacs about it:
+
+@lisp
+(setq org-mobile-directory "~/Dropbox/MobileOrg")
+@end lisp
+
+Org-mode has commands to put files for @i{MobileOrg} into that directory,
+and to read captured notes from there.
+
+@node Pushing to MobileOrg, Pulling from MobileOrg, Setting up the staging area, MobileOrg
+@section Pushing to MobileOrg
+
+This operation copies all files currently listed in @code{org-mobile-files}
+to the directory @code{org-mobile-directory}. By default this list contains
+all agenda files (as listed in @code{org-agenda-files}), but additional files
+can be included by customizing @code{org-mobiles-files}. File names will be
+staged with paths relative to @code{org-directory}, so all files should be
+inside this directory. The push operation also creates a special Org file
+@file{agendas.org} with all custom agenda view defined by the
+user@footnote{While creating the agendas, Org-mode will force ID properties
+on all referenced entries, so that these entries can be uniquely identified
+if @i{MobileOrg} flags them for further action. If you do not want to get
+these properties in so many entries, you can set the variable
+@code{org-mobile-force-id-on-agenda-items} to @code{nil}. Org mode will then
+rely on outline paths, in the hope that these will be unique enough.}.
+Finally, Org writes the file @file{index.org}, containing links to all other
+files. @i{MobileOrg} first reads this file from the server, and then
+downloads all agendas and Org files listed in it. To speed up the download,
+MobileOrg will only read files whose checksums@footnote{stored automatically
+in the file @file{checksums.dat}} have changed.
+
+@node Pulling from MobileOrg, , Pushing to MobileOrg, MobileOrg
+@section Pulling from MobileOrg
+
+When @i{MobileOrg} synchronizes with the server, it not only pulls the Org
+files for viewing. It also appends captured entries and pointers to flagged
+and changed entries to the file @file{mobileorg.org} on the server. Org has
+a @emph{pull} operation that integrates this information into an inbox file
+and operates on the pointers to flagged entries. Here is how it works:
+
+@enumerate
+@item
+Org moves all entries found in
+@file{mobileorg.org}@footnote{@file{mobileorg.org} will be empty after this
+operation.} and appends them to the file pointed to by the variable
+@code{org-mobile-inbox-for-pull}. Each captured entry and each editing event
+will be a top-level entry in the inbox file.
+@item
+After moving the entries, Org will attempt to implement the changes made in
+@i{MobileOrg}. Some changes are applied directly and without user
+interaction. Examples are all changes to tags, TODO state, headline and body
+text that can be cleanly applied. Entries that have been flagged for further
+action will receive a tag @code{:FLAGGED:}, so that they can be easily found
+again. When there is a problem finding an entry or applying the change, the
+pointer entry will remain in the inbox and will be marked with an error
+message. You need to later resolve these issues by hand.
+@item
+Org will then generate an agenda view with all flagged entries. The user
+should then go through these entries and do whatever actions are necessary.
+If a note has been stored while flagging an entry in @i{MobileOrg}, that note
+will be displayed in the echo area when the cursor is on the corresponding
+agenda line.
+@table @kbd
+@kindex ?
+@item ?
+Pressing @kbd{?} in that special agenda will display the full flagging note in
+another window and also push it onto the kill ring. So you could use @kbd{?
+z C-y C-c C-c} to store that flagging note as a normal note in the entry.
+Pressing @kbd{?} twice in succession will offer to remove the
+@code{:FLAGGED:} tag along with the recorded flagging note (which is stored
+in a property). In this way you indicate that the intended processing for
+this flagged entry is finished.
+@end table
+@end enumerate
+
+@kindex C-c a ?
+If you are not able to process all flagged entries directly, you can always
+return to this agenda view@footnote{Note, however, that there is a subtle
+difference. The view created automatically by @kbd{M-x org-mobile-pull
+@key{RET}} is guaranteed to search all files that have been addressed by the
+last pull. This might include a file that is not currently in your list of
+agenda files. If you later use @kbd{C-c a ?} to regenerate the view, only
+the current agenda files will be searched.} using @kbd{C-c a ?}.
+
+@node History and Acknowledgments, Main Index, MobileOrg, Top
+@appendix History and acknowledgments
+@cindex acknowledgments
+@cindex history
+@cindex thanks
+
+Org was born in 2003, out of frustration over the user interface of the Emacs
+Outline mode. I was trying to organize my notes and projects, and using
+Emacs seemed to be the natural way to go. However, having to remember eleven
+different commands with two or three keys per command, only to hide and show
+parts of the outline tree, that seemed entirely unacceptable to me. Also,
+when using outlines to take notes, I constantly wanted to restructure the
+tree, organizing it parallel to my thoughts and plans. @emph{Visibility
+cycling} and @emph{structure editing} were originally implemented in the
+package @file{outline-magic.el}, but quickly moved to the more general
+@file{org.el}. As this environment became comfortable for project planning,
+the next step was adding @emph{TODO entries}, basic @emph{timestamps}, and
+@emph{table support}. These areas highlighted the two main goals that Org
+still has today: to be a new, outline-based, plain text mode with innovative
+and intuitive editing features, and to incorporate project planning
+functionality directly into a notes file.
+
+Since the first release, literally thousands of emails to me or to
+@email{emacs-orgmode@@gnu.org} have provided a constant stream of bug
+reports, feedback, new ideas, and sometimes patches and add-on code.
+Many thanks to everyone who has helped to improve this package. I am
+trying to keep here a list of the people who had significant influence
+in shaping one or more aspects of Org. The list may not be
+complete, if I have forgotten someone, please accept my apologies and
+let me know.
+
+Before I get to this list, a few special mentions are in order:
+
+@table @i
+@item Bastien Guerry
+Bastien has written a large number of extensions to Org (most of them
+integrated into the core by now), including the LaTeX exporter and the plain
+list parser. His support during the early days, when he basically acted as
+co-maintainer, was central to the success of this project. Bastien also
+invented Worg, helped establishing the Web presence of Org, and sponsors
+hosting costs for the orgmode.org website.
+@item Eric Schulte and Dan Davison
+Eric and Dan are jointly responsible for the Org-babel system, which turns
+Org into a multi-language environment for evaluating code and doing literate
+programming and reproducible research.
+@item John Wiegley
+John has contributed a number of great ideas and patches directly to Org,
+including the attachment system (@file{org-attach.el}), integration with
+Apple Mail (@file{org-mac-message.el}), hierarchical dependencies of TODO
+items, habit tracking (@file{org-habits.el}), and encryption
+(@file{org-crypt.el}). Also, the capture system is really an extended copy
+of his great @file{remember.el}.
+@item Sebastian Rose
+Without Sebastian, the HTML/XHTML publishing of Org would be the pitiful work
+of an ignorant amateur. Sebastian has pushed this part of Org onto a much
+higher level. He also wrote @file{org-info.js}, a Java script for displaying
+webpages derived from Org using an Info-like or a folding interface with
+single-key navigation.
+@end table
+
+@noindent OK, now to the full list of contributions! Again, please let me
+know what I am missing here!
+
+@itemize @bullet
+
+@item
+@i{Russel Adams} came up with the idea for drawers.
+@item
+@i{Thomas Baumann} wrote @file{org-bbdb.el} and @file{org-mhe.el}.
+@item
+@i{Christophe Bataillon} created the great unicorn logo that we use on the
+Org-mode website.
+@item
+@i{Alex Bochannek} provided a patch for rounding timestamps.
+@item
+@i{Jan Böcker} wrote @file{org-docview.el}.
+@item
+@i{Brad Bozarth} showed how to pull RSS feed data into Org-mode files.
+@item
+@i{Tom Breton} wrote @file{org-choose.el}.
+@item
+@i{Charles Cave}'s suggestion sparked the implementation of templates
+for Remember, which are now templates for capture.
+@item
+@i{Pavel Chalmoviansky} influenced the agenda treatment of items with
+specified time.
+@item
+@i{Gregory Chernov} patched support for Lisp forms into table
+calculations and improved XEmacs compatibility, in particular by porting
+@file{nouline.el} to XEmacs.
+@item
+@i{Sacha Chua} suggested copying some linking code from Planner.
+@item
+@i{Baoqiu Cui} contributed the DocBook exporter.
+@item
+@i{Eddward DeVilla} proposed and tested checkbox statistics. He also
+came up with the idea of properties, and that there should be an API for
+them.
+@item
+@i{Nick Dokos} tracked down several nasty bugs.
+@item
+@i{Kees Dullemond} used to edit projects lists directly in HTML and so
+inspired some of the early development, including HTML export. He also
+asked for a way to narrow wide table columns.
+@item
+@i{Thomas S. Dye} contributed documentation on Worg and helped integrating
+the Org-Babel documentation into the manual.
+@item
+@i{Christian Egli} converted the documentation into Texinfo format, inspired
+the agenda, patched CSS formatting into the HTML exporter, and wrote
+@file{org-taskjuggler.el}.
+@item
+@i{David Emery} provided a patch for custom CSS support in exported
+HTML agendas.
+@item
+@i{Nic Ferrier} contributed mailcap and XOXO support.
+@item
+@i{Miguel A. Figueroa-Villanueva} implemented hierarchical checkboxes.
+@item
+@i{John Foerch} figured out how to make incremental search show context
+around a match in a hidden outline tree.
+@item
+@i{Raimar Finken} wrote @file{org-git-line.el}.
+@item
+@i{Mikael Fornius} works as a mailing list moderator.
+@item
+@i{Austin Frank} works as a mailing list moderator.
+@item
+@i{Eric Fraga} drove the development of BEAMER export with ideas and
+testing.
+@item
+@i{Barry Gidden} did proofreading the manual in preparation for the book
+publication through Network Theory Ltd.
+@item
+@i{Niels Giesen} had the idea to automatically archive DONE trees.
+@item
+@i{Nicolas Goaziou} rewrote much of the plain list code.
+@item
+@i{Kai Grossjohann} pointed out key-binding conflicts with other packages.
+@item
+@i{Brian Gough} of Network Theory Ltd publishes the Org mode manual as a
+book.
+@item
+@i{Bernt Hansen} has driven much of the support for auto-repeating tasks,
+task state change logging, and the clocktable. His clear explanations have
+been critical when we started to adopt the Git version control system.
+@item
+@i{Manuel Hermenegildo} has contributed various ideas, small fixes and
+patches.
+@item
+@i{Phil Jackson} wrote @file{org-irc.el}.
+@item
+@i{Scott Jaderholm} proposed footnotes, control over whitespace between
+folded entries, and column view for properties.
+@item
+@i{Matt Jones} wrote @i{MobileOrg Android}.
+@item
+@i{Tokuya Kameshima} wrote @file{org-wl.el} and @file{org-mew.el}.
+@item
+@i{Shidai Liu} ("Leo") asked for embedded @LaTeX{} and tested it. He also
+provided frequent feedback and some patches.
+@item
+@i{Matt Lundin} has proposed last-row references for table formulas and named
+invisible anchors. He has also worked a lot on the FAQ.
+@item
+@i{David Maus} wrote @file{org-atom.el}, maintains the issues file for Org,
+and is a prolific contributor on the mailing list with competent replies,
+small fixes and patches.
+@item
+@i{Jason F. McBrayer} suggested agenda export to CSV format.
+@item
+@i{Max Mikhanosha} came up with the idea of refiling.
+@item
+@i{Dmitri Minaev} sent a patch to set priority limits on a per-file
+basis.
+@item
+@i{Stefan Monnier} provided a patch to keep the Emacs-Lisp compiler
+happy.
+@item
+@i{Richard Moreland} wrote @i{MobileOrg} for the iPhone.
+@item
+@i{Rick Moynihan} proposed allowing multiple TODO sequences in a file
+and being able to quickly restrict the agenda to a subtree.
+@item
+@i{Todd Neal} provided patches for links to Info files and Elisp forms.
+@item
+@i{Greg Newman} refreshed the unicorn logo into its current form.
+@item
+@i{Tim O'Callaghan} suggested in-file links, search options for general
+file links, and TAGS.
+@item
+@i{Osamu Okano} wrote @file{orgcard2ref.pl}, a Perl program to create a text
+version of the reference card.
+@item
+@i{Takeshi Okano} translated the manual and David O'Toole's tutorial
+into Japanese.
+@item
+@i{Oliver Oppitz} suggested multi-state TODO items.
+@item
+@i{Scott Otterson} sparked the introduction of descriptive text for
+links, among other things.
+@item
+@i{Pete Phillips} helped during the development of the TAGS feature, and
+provided frequent feedback.
+@item
+@i{Martin Pohlack} provided the code snippet to bundle character insertion
+into bundles of 20 for undo.
+@item
+@i{T.V. Raman} reported bugs and suggested improvements.
+@item
+@i{Matthias Rempe} (Oelde) provided ideas, Windows support, and quality
+control.
+@item
+@i{Paul Rivier} provided the basic implementation of named footnotes. He
+also acted as mailing list moderator for some time.
+@item
+@i{Kevin Rogers} contributed code to access VM files on remote hosts.
+@item
+@i{Frank Ruell} solved the mystery of the @code{keymapp nil} bug, a
+conflict with @file{allout.el}.
+@item
+@i{Jason Riedy} generalized the send-receive mechanism for Orgtbl tables with
+extensive patches.
+@item
+@i{Philip Rooke} created the Org reference card, provided lots
+of feedback, developed and applied standards to the Org documentation.
+@item
+@i{Christian Schlauer} proposed angular brackets around links, among
+other things.
+@item
+@i{Paul Sexton} wrote @file{org-ctags.el}.
+@item
+Linking to VM/BBDB/Gnus was first inspired by @i{Tom Shannon}'s
+@file{organizer-mode.el}.
+@item
+@i{Ilya Shlyakhter} proposed the Archive Sibling, line numbering in literal
+examples, and remote highlighting for referenced code lines.
+@item
+@i{Stathis Sideris} wrote the @file{ditaa.jar} ASCII to PNG converter that is
+now packaged into Org's @file{contrib} directory.
+@item
+@i{Daniel Sinder} came up with the idea of internal archiving by locking
+subtrees.
+@item
+@i{Dale Smith} proposed link abbreviations.
+@item
+@i{James TD Smith} has contributed a large number of patches for useful
+tweaks and features.
+@item
+@i{Adam Spiers} asked for global linking commands, inspired the link
+extension system, added support for mairix, and proposed the mapping API.
+@item
+@i{Ulf Stegemann} created the table to translate special symbols to HTML,
+LaTeX, UTF-8, Latin-1 and ASCII.
+@item
+@i{Andy Stewart} contributed code to @file{org-w3m.el}, to copy HTML content
+with links transformation to Org syntax.
+@item
+@i{David O'Toole} wrote @file{org-publish.el} and drafted the manual
+chapter about publishing.
+@item
+@i{Sebastien Vauban} reported many issues with LaTeX and BEAMER export and
+enabled source code highlighling in Gnus.
+@item
+@i{Stefan Vollmar} organized a video-recorded talk at the
+Max-Planck-Institute for Neurology. He also inspired the creation of a
+concept index for HTML export.
+@item
+@i{J@"urgen Vollmer} contributed code generating the table of contents
+in HTML output.
+@item
+@i{Samuel Wales} has provided important feedback and bug reports.
+@item
+@i{Chris Wallace} provided a patch implementing the @samp{QUOTE}
+keyword.
+@item
+@i{David Wainberg} suggested archiving, and improvements to the linking
+system.
+@item
+@i{Carsten Wimmer} suggested some changes and helped fix a bug in
+linking to Gnus.
+@item
+@i{Roland Winkler} requested additional key bindings to make Org
+work on a tty.
+@item
+@i{Piotr Zielinski} wrote @file{org-mouse.el}, proposed agenda blocks
+and contributed various ideas and code snippets.
+@end itemize
+
+
+@node Main Index, Key Index, History and Acknowledgments, Top
+@unnumbered Concept index
+
+@printindex cp
+
+@node Key Index, Command and Function Index, Main Index, Top
+@unnumbered Key index
+
+@printindex ky
+
+@node Command and Function Index, Variable Index, Key Index, Top
+@unnumbered Command and function index
+
+@printindex fn
+
+@node Variable Index, , Command and Function Index, Top
+@unnumbered Variable index
+
+This is not a complete index of variables and faces, only the ones that are
+mentioned in the manual. For a more complete list, use @kbd{M-x
+org-customize @key{RET}} and then click yourself through the tree.
+
+@printindex vr
+
+@bye
+
+@ignore
+ arch-tag: 7893d1Fe-cc57-4d13-b5e5-f494a1CBC7ac
+@end ignore
+
+@c Local variables:
+@c fill-column: 77
+@c indent-tabs-mode: nil
+@c paragraph-start: "\\|^@[a-zA-Z]*[ \n]\\|^@x?org\\(key\\|cmd\\)\\|\f\\|[ ]*$"
+@c paragraph-separate: "\\|^@[a-zA-Z]*[ \n]\\|^@x?org\\(key\\|cmd\\)\\|[ \f]*$"
+@c End:
+
+
+@c LocalWords: webdavhost pre